diff options
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWin32Dll.c | 90 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWin3d.c | 354 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinButton.c | 868 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinClipboard.c | 171 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinColor.c | 223 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinConfig.c | 32 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinCursor.c | 87 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinDialog.c | 77 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinDraw.c | 533 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinEmbed.c | 697 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinFont.c | 1127 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinImage.c | 367 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinInit.c | 54 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinInt.h | 97 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinKey.c | 393 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinPixmap.c | 78 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinPointer.c | 218 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinRegion.c | 107 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinScrlbr.c | 372 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinSend.c | 663 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinTest.c | 143 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinWindow.c | 299 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinWm.c | 3527 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/tkWinX.c | 1129 | ||||
-rw-r--r-- | win/winMain.c | 118 |
25 files changed, 6165 insertions, 5659 deletions
diff --git a/win/tkWin32Dll.c b/win/tkWin32Dll.c index ed869fc..3978f1c 100644 --- a/win/tkWin32Dll.c +++ b/win/tkWin32Dll.c @@ -1,20 +1,21 @@ -/* +/* * tkWin32Dll.c -- * * This file contains a stub dll entry point. * * Copyright (c) 1995 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWin32Dll.c,v 1.11 2005/08/23 18:31:11 mdejong Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWin32Dll.c,v 1.12 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkWinInt.h" #ifndef STATIC_BUILD #ifdef HAVE_NO_SEH + /* * Unlike Borland and Microsoft, we don't register exception handlers by * pushing registration records onto the runtime stack. Instead, we register @@ -30,23 +31,23 @@ typedef struct EXCEPTION_REGISTRATION { int status; } EXCEPTION_REGISTRATION; -/* Need to add noinline flag to DllMain declaration so that gcc -O3 - * does not inline asm code into DllEntryPoint and cause a - * compile time error because of redefined local labels. +/* + * Need to add noinline flag to DllMain declaration so that gcc -O3 does not + * inline asm code into DllEntryPoint and cause a compile time error because + * of redefined local labels. */ -BOOL APIENTRY DllMain(HINSTANCE hInst, DWORD reason, - LPVOID reserved) - __attribute__ ((noinline)); +BOOL APIENTRY DllMain(HINSTANCE hInst, DWORD reason, + LPVOID reserved) __attribute__ ((noinline)); -#else +#else /* !HAVE_NO_SEH */ /* * The following declaration is for the VC++ DLL entry point. */ -BOOL APIENTRY DllMain _ANSI_ARGS_((HINSTANCE hInst, - DWORD reason, LPVOID reserved)); +BOOL APIENTRY DllMain(HINSTANCE hInst, DWORD reason, + LPVOID reserved); #endif /* HAVE_NO_SEH */ /* @@ -54,9 +55,8 @@ BOOL APIENTRY DllMain _ANSI_ARGS_((HINSTANCE hInst, * * DllEntryPoint -- * - * This wrapper function is used by Borland to invoke the - * initialization code for Tk. It simply calls the DllMain - * routine. + * This wrapper function is used by Borland to invoke the initialization + * code for Tk. It simply calls the DllMain routine. * * Results: * See DllMain. @@ -68,10 +68,10 @@ BOOL APIENTRY DllMain _ANSI_ARGS_((HINSTANCE hInst, */ BOOL APIENTRY -DllEntryPoint(hInst, reason, reserved) - HINSTANCE hInst; /* Library instance handle. */ - DWORD reason; /* Reason this function is being called. */ - LPVOID reserved; /* Not used. */ +DllEntryPoint( + HINSTANCE hInst, /* Library instance handle. */ + DWORD reason, /* Reason this function is being called. */ + LPVOID reserved) /* Not used. */ { return DllMain(hInst, reason, reserved); } @@ -81,35 +81,35 @@ DllEntryPoint(hInst, reason, reserved) * * DllMain -- * - * DLL entry point. It is only necessary to specify our dll here so - * that resources are found correctly. Otherwise Tk will initialize - * and clean up after itself through other methods, in order to be - * consistent whether the build is static or dynamic. + * DLL entry point. It is only necessary to specify our dll here so that + * resources are found correctly. Otherwise Tk will initialize and clean + * up after itself through other methods, in order to be consistent + * whether the build is static or dynamic. * * Results: * Always TRUE. * * Side effects: - * This might call some sycronization functions, but MSDN - * documentation states: "Waiting on synchronization objects in - * DllMain can cause a deadlock." + * This might call some sycronization functions, but MSDN documentation + * states: "Waiting on synchronization objects in DllMain can cause a + * deadlock." * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ BOOL APIENTRY -DllMain(hInstance, reason, reserved) - HINSTANCE hInstance; - DWORD reason; - LPVOID reserved; +DllMain( + HINSTANCE hInstance, + DWORD reason, + LPVOID reserved) { #ifdef HAVE_NO_SEH EXCEPTION_REGISTRATION registration; #endif /* - * If we are attaching to the DLL from a new process, tell Tk about - * the hInstance to use. + * If we are attaching to the DLL from a new process, tell Tk about the + * hInstance to use. */ switch (reason) { @@ -120,9 +120,8 @@ DllMain(hInstance, reason, reserved) case DLL_PROCESS_DETACH: /* - * Protect the call to TkFinalize in an SEH block. We can't - * be guarenteed Tk is always being unloaded from a stable - * condition. + * Protect the call to TkFinalize in an SEH block. We can't be + * guarenteed Tk is always being unloaded from a stable condition. */ #ifdef HAVE_NO_SEH @@ -175,7 +174,7 @@ DllMain(hInstance, reason, reserved) "movl 0x8(%%edx), %%edx" "\n" - /* + /* * Come here however we exited. Restore context from the * EXCEPTION_REGISTRATION in case the stack is unbalanced. */ @@ -199,10 +198,10 @@ DllMain(hInstance, reason, reserved) #else /* HAVE_NO_SEH */ __try { /* - * Run and remove our exit handlers, if they haven't already - * been run. Just in case we are being unloaded prior to - * Tcl (it can happen), we won't leave any dangling pointers - * hanging around for when Tcl gets unloaded later. + * Run and remove our exit handlers, if they haven't already been + * run. Just in case we are being unloaded prior to Tcl (it can + * happen), we won't leave any dangling pointers hanging around + * for when Tcl gets unloaded later. */ TkFinalize(NULL); @@ -217,4 +216,11 @@ DllMain(hInstance, reason, reserved) } #endif /* !STATIC_BUILD */ - + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWin3d.c b/win/tkWin3d.c index 3c97560..8d1002b 100644 --- a/win/tkWin3d.c +++ b/win/tkWin3d.c @@ -1,31 +1,30 @@ -/* +/* * tkWin3d.c -- * - * This file contains the platform specific routines for - * drawing 3d borders in the Windows 95 style. + * This file contains the platform specific routines for drawing 3D + * borders in the Windows 95 style. * * Copyright (c) 1996 by Sun Microsystems, Inc. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWin3d.c,v 1.7 2004/01/13 02:06:01 davygrvy Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWin3d.c,v 1.8 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkWinInt.h" #include "tk3d.h" /* - * This structure is used to keep track of the extra colors used by - * Windows 3d borders. + * This structure is used to keep track of the extra colors used by Windows 3D + * borders. */ typedef struct { TkBorder info; - XColor *light2ColorPtr; /* System3dLight */ - XColor *dark2ColorPtr; /* System3dDarkShadow */ + XColor *light2ColorPtr; /* System3dLight */ + XColor *dark2ColorPtr; /* System3dDarkShadow */ } WinBorder; - /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -44,9 +43,10 @@ typedef struct { */ TkBorder * -TkpGetBorder() +TkpGetBorder(void) { WinBorder *borderPtr = (WinBorder *) ckalloc(sizeof(WinBorder)); + borderPtr->light2ColorPtr = NULL; borderPtr->dark2ColorPtr = NULL; return (TkBorder *) borderPtr; @@ -57,8 +57,8 @@ TkpGetBorder() * * TkpFreeBorder -- * - * This function frees any colors allocated by the platform - * specific part of this module. + * This function frees any colors allocated by the platform specific part + * of this module. * * Results: * None. @@ -70,8 +70,8 @@ TkpGetBorder() */ void -TkpFreeBorder(borderPtr) - TkBorder *borderPtr; +TkpFreeBorder( + TkBorder *borderPtr) { WinBorder *winBorderPtr = (WinBorder *) borderPtr; if (winBorderPtr->light2ColorPtr) { @@ -87,18 +87,17 @@ TkpFreeBorder(borderPtr) * * Tk_3DVerticalBevel -- * - * This procedure draws a vertical bevel along one side of - * an object. The bevel is always rectangular in shape: + * This procedure draws a vertical bevel along one side of an object. The + * bevel is always rectangular in shape: * ||| * ||| * ||| * ||| * ||| * ||| - * An appropriate shadow color is chosen for the bevel based - * on the leftBevel and relief arguments. Normally this - * procedure is called first, then Tk_3DHorizontalBevel is - * called next to draw neat corners. + * An appropriate shadow color is chosen for the bevel based on the + * leftBevel and relief arguments. Normally this procedure is called + * first, then Tk_3DHorizontalBevel is called next to draw neat corners. * * Results: * None. @@ -110,19 +109,18 @@ TkpFreeBorder(borderPtr) */ void -Tk_3DVerticalBevel(tkwin, drawable, border, x, y, width, height, - leftBevel, relief) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Window for which border was allocated. */ - Drawable drawable; /* X window or pixmap in which to draw. */ - Tk_3DBorder border; /* Token for border to draw. */ - int x, y, width, height; /* Area of vertical bevel. */ - int leftBevel; /* Non-zero means this bevel forms the - * left side of the object; 0 means it - * forms the right side. */ - int relief; /* Kind of bevel to draw. For example, - * TK_RELIEF_RAISED means interior of - * object should appear higher than - * exterior. */ +Tk_3DVerticalBevel( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Window for which border was allocated. */ + Drawable drawable, /* X window or pixmap in which to draw. */ + Tk_3DBorder border, /* Token for border to draw. */ + int x, int y, int width, int height, + /* Area of vertical bevel. */ + int leftBevel, /* Non-zero means this bevel forms the left + * side of the object; 0 means it forms the + * right side. */ + int relief) /* Kind of bevel to draw. For example, + * TK_RELIEF_RAISED means interior of object + * should appear higher than exterior. */ { TkBorder *borderPtr = (TkBorder *) border; int left, right; @@ -136,36 +134,36 @@ Tk_3DVerticalBevel(tkwin, drawable, border, x, y, width, height, } switch (relief) { - case TK_RELIEF_RAISED: - left = (leftBevel) + case TK_RELIEF_RAISED: + left = (leftBevel) ? borderPtr->lightGC->foreground : borderPtr->darkGC->foreground; - right = (leftBevel) + right = (leftBevel) ? ((WinBorder *)borderPtr)->light2ColorPtr->pixel : ((WinBorder *)borderPtr)->dark2ColorPtr->pixel; - break; - case TK_RELIEF_SUNKEN: - left = (leftBevel) + break; + case TK_RELIEF_SUNKEN: + left = (leftBevel) ? borderPtr->darkGC->foreground : ((WinBorder *)borderPtr)->light2ColorPtr->pixel; - right = (leftBevel) + right = (leftBevel) ? ((WinBorder *)borderPtr)->dark2ColorPtr->pixel : borderPtr->lightGC->foreground; - break; - case TK_RELIEF_RIDGE: - left = borderPtr->lightGC->foreground; - right = borderPtr->darkGC->foreground; - break; - case TK_RELIEF_GROOVE: - left = borderPtr->darkGC->foreground; - right = borderPtr->lightGC->foreground; - break; - case TK_RELIEF_FLAT: - left = right = borderPtr->bgGC->foreground; - break; - case TK_RELIEF_SOLID: - left = right = RGB(0,0,0); - break; + break; + case TK_RELIEF_RIDGE: + left = borderPtr->lightGC->foreground; + right = borderPtr->darkGC->foreground; + break; + case TK_RELIEF_GROOVE: + left = borderPtr->darkGC->foreground; + right = borderPtr->lightGC->foreground; + break; + case TK_RELIEF_FLAT: + left = right = borderPtr->bgGC->foreground; + break; + case TK_RELIEF_SOLID: + left = right = RGB(0,0,0); + break; } half = width/2; if (leftBevel && (width & 1)) { @@ -181,9 +179,9 @@ Tk_3DVerticalBevel(tkwin, drawable, border, x, y, width, height, * * Tk_3DHorizontalBevel -- * - * This procedure draws a horizontal bevel along one side of - * an object. The bevel has mitered corners (depending on - * leftIn and rightIn arguments). + * This procedure draws a horizontal bevel along one side of an object. + * The bevel has mitered corners (depending on leftIn and rightIn + * arguments). * * Results: * None. @@ -195,30 +193,28 @@ Tk_3DVerticalBevel(tkwin, drawable, border, x, y, width, height, */ void -Tk_3DHorizontalBevel(tkwin, drawable, border, x, y, width, height, - leftIn, rightIn, topBevel, relief) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Window for which border was allocated. */ - Drawable drawable; /* X window or pixmap in which to draw. */ - Tk_3DBorder border; /* Token for border to draw. */ - int x, y, width, height; /* Bounding box of area of bevel. Height - * gives width of border. */ - int leftIn, rightIn; /* Describes whether the left and right - * edges of the bevel angle in or out as - * they go down. For example, if "leftIn" - * is true, the left side of the bevel - * looks like this: +Tk_3DHorizontalBevel( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Window for which border was allocated. */ + Drawable drawable, /* X window or pixmap in which to draw. */ + Tk_3DBorder border, /* Token for border to draw. */ + int x, int y, int width, int height, + /* Bounding box of area of bevel. Height gives + * width of border. */ + int leftIn, int rightIn, /* Describes whether the left and right edges + * of the bevel angle in or out as they go + * down. For example, if "leftIn" is true, the + * left side of the bevel looks like this: * ___________ * __________ * _________ * ________ */ - int topBevel; /* Non-zero means this bevel forms the - * top side of the object; 0 means it - * forms the bottom side. */ - int relief; /* Kind of bevel to draw. For example, - * TK_RELIEF_RAISED means interior of - * object should appear higher than - * exterior. */ + int topBevel, /* Non-zero means this bevel forms the top + * side of the object; 0 means it forms the + * bottom side. */ + int relief) /* Kind of bevel to draw. For example, + * TK_RELIEF_RAISED means interior of object + * should appear higher than exterior. */ { TkBorder *borderPtr = (TkBorder *) border; Display *display = Tk_Display(tkwin); @@ -232,40 +228,40 @@ Tk_3DHorizontalBevel(tkwin, drawable, border, x, y, width, height, } /* - * Compute a GC for the top half of the bevel and a GC for the - * bottom half (they're the same in many cases). + * Compute a GC for the top half of the bevel and a GC for the bottom half + * (they're the same in many cases). */ switch (relief) { - case TK_RELIEF_RAISED: - topColor = (topBevel) + case TK_RELIEF_RAISED: + topColor = (topBevel) ? borderPtr->lightGC->foreground : borderPtr->darkGC->foreground; - bottomColor = (topBevel) + bottomColor = (topBevel) ? ((WinBorder *)borderPtr)->light2ColorPtr->pixel : ((WinBorder *)borderPtr)->dark2ColorPtr->pixel; - break; - case TK_RELIEF_SUNKEN: - topColor = (topBevel) + break; + case TK_RELIEF_SUNKEN: + topColor = (topBevel) ? borderPtr->darkGC->foreground : ((WinBorder *)borderPtr)->light2ColorPtr->pixel; - bottomColor = (topBevel) + bottomColor = (topBevel) ? ((WinBorder *)borderPtr)->dark2ColorPtr->pixel : borderPtr->lightGC->foreground; - break; - case TK_RELIEF_RIDGE: - topColor = borderPtr->lightGC->foreground; - bottomColor = borderPtr->darkGC->foreground; - break; - case TK_RELIEF_GROOVE: - topColor = borderPtr->darkGC->foreground; - bottomColor = borderPtr->lightGC->foreground; - break; - case TK_RELIEF_FLAT: - topColor = bottomColor = borderPtr->bgGC->foreground; - break; - case TK_RELIEF_SOLID: - topColor = bottomColor = RGB(0,0,0); + break; + case TK_RELIEF_RIDGE: + topColor = borderPtr->lightGC->foreground; + bottomColor = borderPtr->darkGC->foreground; + break; + case TK_RELIEF_GROOVE: + topColor = borderPtr->darkGC->foreground; + bottomColor = borderPtr->lightGC->foreground; + break; + case TK_RELIEF_FLAT: + topColor = bottomColor = borderPtr->bgGC->foreground; + break; + case TK_RELIEF_SOLID: + topColor = bottomColor = RGB(0,0,0); } /* @@ -298,8 +294,7 @@ Tk_3DHorizontalBevel(tkwin, drawable, border, x, y, width, height, for ( ; y < bottom; y++) { /* * In some weird cases (such as large border widths for skinny - * rectangles) x1 can be >= x2. Don't draw the lines - * in these cases. + * rectangles) x1 can be >= x2. Don't draw the lines in these cases. */ if (x1 < x2) { @@ -317,27 +312,26 @@ Tk_3DHorizontalBevel(tkwin, drawable, border, x, y, width, height, * * TkpGetShadows -- * - * This procedure computes the shadow colors for a 3-D border - * and fills in the corresponding fields of the Border structure. - * It's called lazily, so that the colors aren't allocated until - * something is actually drawn with them. That way, if a border - * is only used for flat backgrounds the shadow colors will - * never be allocated. + * This procedure computes the shadow colors for a 3-D border and fills + * in the corresponding fields of the Border structure. It's called + * lazily, so that the colors aren't allocated until something is + * actually drawn with them. That way, if a border is only used for flat + * backgrounds the shadow colors will never be allocated. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * The lightGC and darkGC fields in borderPtr get filled in, - * if they weren't already. + * The lightGC and darkGC fields in borderPtr get filled in, if they + * weren't already. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -TkpGetShadows(borderPtr, tkwin) - TkBorder *borderPtr; /* Information about border. */ - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Window where border will be used for +TkpGetShadows( + TkBorder *borderPtr, /* Information about border. */ + Tk_Window tkwin) /* Window where border will be used for * drawing. */ { XColor lightColor, darkColor; @@ -354,13 +348,13 @@ TkpGetShadows(borderPtr, tkwin) */ if ((TkWinIndexOfColor(borderPtr->bgColorPtr) == COLOR_3DFACE) - || (TkWinIndexOfColor(borderPtr->bgColorPtr) == COLOR_WINDOW)) { + || (TkWinIndexOfColor(borderPtr->bgColorPtr) == COLOR_WINDOW)) { borderPtr->darkColorPtr = Tk_GetColor(NULL, tkwin, - Tk_GetUid("SystemButtonShadow")); + Tk_GetUid("SystemButtonShadow")); gcValues.foreground = borderPtr->darkColorPtr->pixel; borderPtr->darkGC = Tk_GetGC(tkwin, GCForeground, &gcValues); borderPtr->lightColorPtr = Tk_GetColor(NULL, tkwin, - Tk_GetUid("SystemButtonHighlight")); + Tk_GetUid("SystemButtonHighlight")); gcValues.foreground = borderPtr->lightColorPtr->pixel; borderPtr->lightGC = Tk_GetGC(tkwin, GCForeground, &gcValues); ((WinBorder*)borderPtr)->dark2ColorPtr = Tk_GetColor(NULL, tkwin, @@ -368,45 +362,42 @@ TkpGetShadows(borderPtr, tkwin) ((WinBorder*)borderPtr)->light2ColorPtr = Tk_GetColor(NULL, tkwin, Tk_GetUid("System3dLight")); return; - } else { - darkColor.red = 0; - darkColor.green = 0; - darkColor.blue = 0; - ((WinBorder*)borderPtr)->dark2ColorPtr = Tk_GetColorByValue(tkwin, + } + darkColor.red = 0; + darkColor.green = 0; + darkColor.blue = 0; + ((WinBorder*)borderPtr)->dark2ColorPtr = Tk_GetColorByValue(tkwin, &darkColor); - lightColor = *(borderPtr->bgColorPtr); - ((WinBorder*)borderPtr)->light2ColorPtr = Tk_GetColorByValue(tkwin, + lightColor = *(borderPtr->bgColorPtr); + ((WinBorder*)borderPtr)->light2ColorPtr = Tk_GetColorByValue(tkwin, &lightColor); - } - + /* - * First, handle the case of a color display with lots of colors. - * The shadow colors get computed using whichever formula results - * in the greatest change in color: - * 1. Lighter shadow is half-way to white, darker shadow is half - * way to dark. - * 2. Lighter shadow is 40% brighter than background, darker shadow - * is 40% darker than background. + * First, handle the case of a color display with lots of colors. The + * shadow colors get computed using whichever formula results in the + * greatest change in color: + * 1. Lighter shadow is half-way to white, darker shadow is half way to + * dark. + * 2. Lighter shadow is 40% brighter than background, darker shadow is 40% + * darker than background. */ if (Tk_Depth(tkwin) >= 6) { /* - * This is a color display with lots of colors. For the dark - * shadow, cut 40% from each of the background color components. - * But if the background is already very dark, make the - * dark color a little lighter than the background by increasing - * each color component 1/4th of the way to MAX_INTENSITY. + * This is a color display with lots of colors. For the dark shadow, + * cut 40% from each of the background color components. But if the + * background is already very dark, make the dark color a little + * lighter than the background by increasing each color component + * 1/4th of the way to MAX_INTENSITY. * - * For the light shadow, boost each component by 40% or half-way - * to white, whichever is greater (the first approach works - * better for unsaturated colors, the second for saturated ones). - * But if the background is already very bright, instead choose a - * slightly darker color for the light shadow by reducing each - * color component by 10%. + * For the light shadow, boost each component by 40% or half-way to + * white, whichever is greater (the first approach works better for + * unsaturated colors, the second for saturated ones). But if the + * background is already very bright, instead choose a slightly darker + * color for the light shadow by reducing each color component by 10%. * - * Compute the colors using integers, not using lightColor.red - * etc.: these are shorts and may have problems with integer - * overflow. + * Compute the colors using integers, not using lightColor.red etc.: + * these are shorts and may have problems with integer overflow. */ /* @@ -463,7 +454,7 @@ TkpGetShadows(borderPtr, tkwin) tmp2 = (MAX_INTENSITY + b)/2; lightColor.blue = (tmp1 > tmp2) ? tmp1 : tmp2; } - + /* * Allocate the light shadow color and its GC */ @@ -483,10 +474,10 @@ TkpGetShadows(borderPtr, tkwin) } if (borderPtr->visual->map_entries > 2) { /* - * This isn't a monochrome display, but the colormap either - * ran out of entries or didn't have very many to begin with. - * Generate the light shadows with a white stipple and the - * dark shadows with a black stipple. + * This isn't a monochrome display, but the colormap either ran out of + * entries or didn't have very many to begin with. Generate the light + * shadows with a white stipple and the dark shadows with a black + * stipple. */ gcValues.foreground = borderPtr->bgColorPtr->pixel; @@ -504,8 +495,8 @@ TkpGetShadows(borderPtr, tkwin) /* * This is just a measly monochrome display, hardly even worth its - * existence on this earth. Make one shadow a 50% stipple and the - * other the opposite of the background. + * existence on this earth. Make one shadow a 50% stipple and the other + * the opposite of the background. */ gcValues.foreground = WhitePixelOfScreen(borderPtr->screen); @@ -529,8 +520,7 @@ TkpGetShadows(borderPtr, tkwin) * * TkWinGetBorderPixels -- * - * This routine returns the 5 COLORREFs used to draw a given - * 3d border. + * This routine returns the 5 COLORREFs used to draw a given 3d border. * * Results: * Returns the colors in the specified array. @@ -542,34 +532,42 @@ TkpGetShadows(borderPtr, tkwin) */ COLORREF -TkWinGetBorderPixels(tkwin, border, which) - Tk_Window tkwin; - Tk_3DBorder border; - int which; /* One of TK_3D_FLAT_GC, TK_3D_LIGHT_GC, +TkWinGetBorderPixels( + Tk_Window tkwin, + Tk_3DBorder border, + int which) /* One of TK_3D_FLAT_GC, TK_3D_LIGHT_GC, * TK_3D_DARK_GC, TK_3D_LIGHT2, TK_3D_DARK2 */ { WinBorder *borderPtr = (WinBorder *) border; - + if (borderPtr->info.lightGC == None) { TkpGetShadows(&borderPtr->info, tkwin); } switch (which) { - case TK_3D_FLAT_GC: - return borderPtr->info.bgColorPtr->pixel; - case TK_3D_LIGHT_GC: - if (borderPtr->info.lightColorPtr == NULL) { - return WhitePixelOfScreen(borderPtr->info.screen); - } - return borderPtr->info.lightColorPtr->pixel; - case TK_3D_DARK_GC: - if (borderPtr->info.darkColorPtr == NULL) { - return BlackPixelOfScreen(borderPtr->info.screen); - } - return borderPtr->info.darkColorPtr->pixel; - case TK_3D_LIGHT2: - return borderPtr->light2ColorPtr->pixel; - case TK_3D_DARK2: - return borderPtr->dark2ColorPtr->pixel; + case TK_3D_FLAT_GC: + return borderPtr->info.bgColorPtr->pixel; + case TK_3D_LIGHT_GC: + if (borderPtr->info.lightColorPtr == NULL) { + return WhitePixelOfScreen(borderPtr->info.screen); + } + return borderPtr->info.lightColorPtr->pixel; + case TK_3D_DARK_GC: + if (borderPtr->info.darkColorPtr == NULL) { + return BlackPixelOfScreen(borderPtr->info.screen); + } + return borderPtr->info.darkColorPtr->pixel; + case TK_3D_LIGHT2: + return borderPtr->light2ColorPtr->pixel; + case TK_3D_DARK2: + return borderPtr->dark2ColorPtr->pixel; } return 0; } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWinButton.c b/win/tkWinButton.c index d9b10b5..bd9768c 100644 --- a/win/tkWinButton.c +++ b/win/tkWinButton.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* +/* * tkWinButton.c -- * * This file implements the Windows specific portion of the button @@ -9,7 +9,7 @@ * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinButton.c,v 1.26 2004/06/16 19:53:40 a_kovalenko Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinButton.c,v 1.27 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #define OEMRESOURCE @@ -21,9 +21,9 @@ */ #define LABEL_STYLE (BS_OWNERDRAW | WS_CHILD | WS_VISIBLE | WS_CLIPSIBLINGS) -#define PUSH_STYLE (BS_OWNERDRAW | BS_PUSHBUTTON | WS_CHILD | WS_VISIBLE | WS_CLIPSIBLINGS) -#define CHECK_STYLE (BS_OWNERDRAW | BS_CHECKBOX | WS_CHILD | WS_VISIBLE | WS_CLIPSIBLINGS) -#define RADIO_STYLE (BS_OWNERDRAW | BS_RADIOBUTTON | WS_CHILD | WS_VISIBLE | WS_CLIPSIBLINGS) +#define PUSH_STYLE (LABEL_STYLE | BS_PUSHBUTTON) +#define CHECK_STYLE (LABEL_STYLE | BS_CHECKBOX) +#define RADIO_STYLE (LABEL_STYLE | BS_RADIOBUTTON) /* * Declaration of Windows specific button structure. @@ -37,17 +37,16 @@ typedef struct WinButton { DWORD style; /* Window style flags. */ } WinButton; - /* - * The following macro reverses the order of RGB bytes to convert - * between RGBQUAD and COLORREF values. + * The following macro reverses the order of RGB bytes to convert between + * RGBQUAD and COLORREF values. */ #define FlipColor(rgb) (RGB(GetBValue(rgb),GetGValue(rgb),GetRValue(rgb))) /* - * The following enumeration defines the meaning of the palette entries - * in the "buttons" image used to draw checkbox and radiobutton indicators. + * The following enumeration defines the meaning of the palette entries in the + * "buttons" image used to draw checkbox and radiobutton indicators. */ enum { @@ -61,17 +60,17 @@ enum { }; /* - * Cached information about the boxes bitmap, and the default border - * width for a button in string form for use in Tk_OptionSpec for - * the various button widget classes. + * Cached information about the boxes bitmap, and the default border width for + * a button in string form for use in Tk_OptionSpec for the various button + * widget classes. */ -typedef struct ThreadSpecificData { - BITMAPINFOHEADER *boxesPtr; /* Information about the bitmap. */ - DWORD *boxesPalette; /* Pointer to color palette. */ - LPSTR boxesBits; /* Pointer to bitmap data. */ - DWORD boxHeight; /* Height of each sub-image. */ - DWORD boxWidth ; /* Width of each sub-image. */ +typedef struct ThreadSpecificData { + BITMAPINFOHEADER *boxesPtr; /* Information about the bitmap. */ + DWORD *boxesPalette; /* Pointer to color palette. */ + LPSTR boxesBits; /* Pointer to bitmap data. */ + DWORD boxHeight; /* Height of each sub-image. */ + DWORD boxWidth; /* Width of each sub-image. */ char defWidth[TCL_INTEGER_SPACE]; } ThreadSpecificData; static Tcl_ThreadDataKey dataKey; @@ -79,17 +78,18 @@ static Tcl_ThreadDataKey dataKey; /* * Declarations for functions defined in this file. */ -static LRESULT CALLBACK ButtonProc _ANSI_ARGS_((HWND hwnd, UINT message, - WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam)); -static Window CreateProc _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - Window parent, ClientData instanceData)); -static void InitBoxes _ANSI_ARGS_((void)); + +static LRESULT CALLBACK ButtonProc(HWND hwnd, UINT message, + WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam); +static Window CreateProc(Tk_Window tkwin, Window parent, + ClientData instanceData); +static void InitBoxes(void); /* * The class procedure table for the button widgets. */ -Tk_ClassProcs tkpButtonProcs = { +Tk_ClassProcs tkpButtonProcs = { sizeof(Tk_ClassProcs), /* size */ TkButtonWorldChanged, /* worldChangedProc */ CreateProc, /* createProc */ @@ -101,13 +101,13 @@ Tk_ClassProcs tkpButtonProcs = { * * InitBoxes -- * - * This function load the Tk 3d button bitmap. "buttons" is a 16 - * color bitmap that is laid out such that the top row contains - * the 4 checkbox images, and the bottom row contains the radio - * button images. Note that the bitmap is stored in bottom-up - * format. Also, the first seven palette entries are used to - * identify the different parts of the bitmaps so we can do the - * appropriate color mappings based on the current button colors. + * This function load the Tk 3d button bitmap. "buttons" is a 16 color + * bitmap that is laid out such that the top row contains the 4 checkbox + * images, and the bottom row contains the radio button images. Note that + * the bitmap is stored in bottom-up format. Also, the first seven + * palette entries are used to identify the different parts of the + * bitmaps so we can do the appropriate color mappings based on the + * current button colors. * * Results: * None. @@ -119,7 +119,7 @@ Tk_ClassProcs tkpButtonProcs = { */ static void -InitBoxes() +InitBoxes(void) { /* * For DLLs like Tk, the HINSTANCE is the same as the HMODULE. @@ -130,7 +130,7 @@ InitBoxes() HGLOBAL hblk; LPBITMAPINFOHEADER newBitmap; DWORD size; - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); hrsrc = FindResource(module, "buttons", RT_BITMAP); @@ -145,14 +145,14 @@ InitBoxes() if (tsdPtr->boxesPtr != NULL && !(tsdPtr->boxesPtr->biWidth % 4) && !(tsdPtr->boxesPtr->biHeight % 2)) { - size = tsdPtr->boxesPtr->biSize + (1 << tsdPtr->boxesPtr->biBitCount) + size = tsdPtr->boxesPtr->biSize + (1 << tsdPtr->boxesPtr->biBitCount) * sizeof(RGBQUAD) + tsdPtr->boxesPtr->biSizeImage; newBitmap = (LPBITMAPINFOHEADER) ckalloc(size); memcpy(newBitmap, tsdPtr->boxesPtr, size); tsdPtr->boxesPtr = newBitmap; tsdPtr->boxWidth = tsdPtr->boxesPtr->biWidth / 4; tsdPtr->boxHeight = tsdPtr->boxesPtr->biHeight / 2; - tsdPtr->boxesPalette = (DWORD*) (((LPSTR) tsdPtr->boxesPtr) + tsdPtr->boxesPalette = (DWORD*) (((LPSTR) tsdPtr->boxesPtr) + tsdPtr->boxesPtr->biSize); tsdPtr->boxesBits = ((LPSTR) tsdPtr->boxesPalette) + ((1 << tsdPtr->boxesPtr->biBitCount) * sizeof(RGBQUAD)); @@ -167,8 +167,8 @@ InitBoxes() * TkpButtonSetDefaults -- * * This procedure is invoked before option tables are created for - * buttons. It modifies some of the default values to match the - * current values defined for this platform. + * buttons. It modifies some of the default values to match the current + * values defined for this platform. * * Results: * Some of the default values in *specPtr are modified. @@ -180,13 +180,13 @@ InitBoxes() */ void -TkpButtonSetDefaults(specPtr) - Tk_OptionSpec *specPtr; /* Points to an array of option specs, +TkpButtonSetDefaults( + Tk_OptionSpec *specPtr) /* Points to an array of option specs, * terminated by one with type * TK_OPTION_END. */ { int width; - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); if (tsdPtr->defWidth[0] == 0) { @@ -220,8 +220,8 @@ TkpButtonSetDefaults(specPtr) */ TkButton * -TkpCreateButton(tkwin) - Tk_Window tkwin; +TkpCreateButton( + Tk_Window tkwin) { WinButton *butPtr; @@ -235,8 +235,8 @@ TkpCreateButton(tkwin) * * CreateProc -- * - * This function creates a new Button control, subclasses - * the instance, and generates a new Window object. + * This function creates a new Button control, subclasses the instance, + * and generates a new Window object. * * Results: * Returns the newly allocated Window object, or None on failure. @@ -248,10 +248,10 @@ TkpCreateButton(tkwin) */ static Window -CreateProc(tkwin, parentWin, instanceData) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Token for window. */ - Window parentWin; /* Parent of new window. */ - ClientData instanceData; /* Button instance data. */ +CreateProc( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Token for window. */ + Window parentWin, /* Parent of new window. */ + ClientData instanceData) /* Button instance data. */ { Window window; HWND parent; @@ -300,11 +300,12 @@ CreateProc(tkwin, parentWin, instanceData) */ void -TkpDestroyButton(butPtr) - TkButton *butPtr; +TkpDestroyButton( + TkButton *butPtr) { WinButton *winButPtr = (WinButton *)butPtr; HWND hwnd = winButPtr->hwnd; + if (hwnd) { #ifdef _WIN64 SetWindowLongPtr(hwnd, GWLP_WNDPROC, (LONG_PTR) winButPtr->oldProc); @@ -319,22 +320,21 @@ TkpDestroyButton(butPtr) * * TkpDisplayButton -- * - * This procedure is invoked to display a button widget. It is - * normally invoked as an idle handler. + * This procedure is invoked to display a button widget. It is normally + * invoked as an idle handler. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * Information appears on the screen. The REDRAW_PENDING flag - * is cleared. + * Information appears on the screen. The REDRAW_PENDING flag is cleared. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -TkpDisplayButton(clientData) - ClientData clientData; /* Information about widget. */ +TkpDisplayButton( + ClientData clientData) /* Information about widget. */ { TkWinDCState state; HDC dc; @@ -342,26 +342,27 @@ TkpDisplayButton(clientData) GC gc; Tk_3DBorder border; Pixmap pixmap; - int x = 0; /* Initialization only needed to stop - * compiler warning. */ + int x = 0; /* Initialization only needed to stop compiler + * warning. */ int y, relief; register Tk_Window tkwin = butPtr->tkwin; int width, height, haveImage = 0, haveText = 0, drawRing = 0; RECT rect; int defaultWidth; /* Width of default ring. */ - int offset; /* 0 means this is a label widget. 1 means - * it is a flavor of button, so we offset - * the text to make the button appear to - * move up and down as the relief changes. */ - int textXOffset = 0, textYOffset = 0; /* text offsets for use with - * compound buttons and focus ring */ + int offset; /* 0 means this is a label widget. 1 means it + * is a flavor of button, so we offset the + * text to make the button appear to move up + * and down as the relief changes. */ + int textXOffset = 0, textYOffset = 0; + /* Text offsets for use with compound buttons + * and focus ring. */ int imageWidth, imageHeight; - int imageXOffset = 0, imageYOffset = 0; /* image information that will - * be used to restrict disabled - * pixmap as well */ + int imageXOffset = 0, imageYOffset = 0; + /* Image information that will be used to + * restrict disabled pixmap as well. */ DWORD *boxesPalette; - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); boxesPalette= tsdPtr->boxesPalette; @@ -386,9 +387,8 @@ TkpDisplayButton(clientData) } /* - * Override the relief specified for the button if this is a - * checkbutton or radiobutton and there's no indicator. The new - * relief is as follows: + * Override the relief specified for the button if this is a checkbutton + * or radiobutton and there's no indicator. The new relief is as follows: * If the button is select --> "sunken" * If relief==overrelief --> relief * Otherwise --> overrelief @@ -402,15 +402,15 @@ TkpDisplayButton(clientData) * on no sunken * on yes sunken * - * This is accomplished by configuring the checkbutton or radiobutton - * like this: + * This is accomplished by configuring the checkbutton or radiobutton like + * this: * * -indicatoron 0 -overrelief raised -offrelief flat * * Bindings (see library/button.tcl) will copy the -overrelief into - * -relief on mouseover. Hence, we can tell if we are in mouse-over by - * comparing relief against overRelief. This is an aweful kludge, but - * it gives use the desired behavior while keeping the code backwards + * -relief on mouseover. Hence, we can tell if we are in mouse-over by + * comparing relief against overRelief. This is an aweful kludge, but it + * gives use the desired behavior while keeping the code backwards * compatible. */ @@ -441,10 +441,10 @@ TkpDisplayButton(clientData) } /* - * In order to avoid screen flashes, this procedure redraws - * the button in a pixmap, then copies the pixmap to the - * screen in a single operation. This means that there's no - * point in time where the on-sreen image has been cleared. + * In order to avoid screen flashes, this procedure redraws the button in + * a pixmap, then copies the pixmap to the screen in a single operation. + * This means that there's no point in time where the on-sreen image has + * been cleared. */ pixmap = Tk_GetPixmap(butPtr->display, Tk_WindowId(tkwin), @@ -463,7 +463,7 @@ TkpDisplayButton(clientData) Tk_SizeOfBitmap(butPtr->display, butPtr->bitmap, &width, &height); haveImage = 1; } - imageWidth = width; + imageWidth = width; imageHeight = height; haveText = (butPtr->textWidth != 0 && butPtr->textHeight != 0); @@ -472,49 +472,58 @@ TkpDisplayButton(clientData) int fullWidth = 0, fullHeight = 0; switch ((enum compound) butPtr->compound) { - case COMPOUND_TOP: - case COMPOUND_BOTTOM: { - /* Image is above or below text */ - if (butPtr->compound == COMPOUND_TOP) { - textYOffset = height + butPtr->padY; - } else { - imageYOffset = butPtr->textHeight + butPtr->padY; - } - fullHeight = height + butPtr->textHeight + butPtr->padY; - fullWidth = (width > butPtr->textWidth ? width : - butPtr->textWidth); - textXOffset = (fullWidth - butPtr->textWidth)/2; - imageXOffset = (fullWidth - width)/2; - break; - } - case COMPOUND_LEFT: - case COMPOUND_RIGHT: { - /* Image is left or right of text */ - if (butPtr->compound == COMPOUND_LEFT) { - textXOffset = width + butPtr->padX; - } else { - imageXOffset = butPtr->textWidth + butPtr->padX; - } - fullWidth = butPtr->textWidth + butPtr->padX + width; - fullHeight = (height > butPtr->textHeight ? height : - butPtr->textHeight); - textYOffset = (fullHeight - butPtr->textHeight)/2; - imageYOffset = (fullHeight - height)/2; - break; + case COMPOUND_TOP: + case COMPOUND_BOTTOM: + /* + * Image is above or below text. + */ + + if (butPtr->compound == COMPOUND_TOP) { + textYOffset = height + butPtr->padY; + } else { + imageYOffset = butPtr->textHeight + butPtr->padY; } - case COMPOUND_CENTER: { - /* Image and text are superimposed */ - fullWidth = (width > butPtr->textWidth ? width : - butPtr->textWidth); - fullHeight = (height > butPtr->textHeight ? height : - butPtr->textHeight); - textXOffset = (fullWidth - butPtr->textWidth)/2; - imageXOffset = (fullWidth - width)/2; - textYOffset = (fullHeight - butPtr->textHeight)/2; - imageYOffset = (fullHeight - height)/2; - break; + fullHeight = height + butPtr->textHeight + butPtr->padY; + fullWidth = (width > butPtr->textWidth ? width : + butPtr->textWidth); + textXOffset = (fullWidth - butPtr->textWidth)/2; + imageXOffset = (fullWidth - width)/2; + break; + + case COMPOUND_LEFT: + case COMPOUND_RIGHT: + /* + * Image is left or right of text. + */ + + if (butPtr->compound == COMPOUND_LEFT) { + textXOffset = width + butPtr->padX; + } else { + imageXOffset = butPtr->textWidth + butPtr->padX; } - case COMPOUND_NONE: {break;} + fullWidth = butPtr->textWidth + butPtr->padX + width; + fullHeight = (height > butPtr->textHeight ? height : + butPtr->textHeight); + textYOffset = (fullHeight - butPtr->textHeight)/2; + imageYOffset = (fullHeight - height)/2; + break; + + case COMPOUND_CENTER: + /* + * Image and text are superimposed. + */ + + fullWidth = (width > butPtr->textWidth ? width : + butPtr->textWidth); + fullHeight = (height > butPtr->textHeight ? height : + butPtr->textHeight); + textXOffset = (fullWidth - butPtr->textWidth)/2; + imageXOffset = (fullWidth - width)/2; + textYOffset = (fullHeight - butPtr->textHeight)/2; + imageYOffset = (fullHeight - height)/2; + break; + case COMPOUND_NONE: + break; } TkComputeAnchor(butPtr->anchor, tkwin, butPtr->padX, butPtr->padY, butPtr->indicatorSpace + fullWidth, fullHeight, &x, &y); @@ -530,12 +539,13 @@ TkpDisplayButton(clientData) if ((butPtr->selectImage != NULL) && (butPtr->flags & SELECTED)) { Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->selectImage, 0, 0, width, height, pixmap, imageXOffset, imageYOffset); - } else if ((butPtr->tristateImage != NULL) && (butPtr->flags & TRISTATED)) { + } else if ((butPtr->tristateImage != NULL) + && (butPtr->flags & TRISTATED)) { Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->tristateImage, 0, 0, width, height, pixmap, imageXOffset, imageYOffset); } else { - Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->image, 0, 0, - width, height, pixmap, imageXOffset, imageYOffset); + Tk_RedrawImage(butPtr->image, 0, 0, width, height, pixmap, + imageXOffset, imageYOffset); } } else { XSetClipOrigin(butPtr->display, gc, imageXOffset, imageYOffset); @@ -547,6 +557,7 @@ TkpDisplayButton(clientData) if ((butPtr->state == STATE_DISABLED) && (butPtr->disabledFg != NULL)) { COLORREF oldFgColor = gc->foreground; + gc->foreground = GetSysColor(COLOR_3DHILIGHT); Tk_DrawTextLayout(butPtr->display, pixmap, gc, butPtr->textLayout, x + textXOffset + 1, @@ -570,7 +581,7 @@ TkpDisplayButton(clientData) TkComputeAnchor(butPtr->anchor, tkwin, 0, 0, butPtr->indicatorSpace + width, height, &x, &y); x += butPtr->indicatorSpace; - + if (relief == TK_RELIEF_SUNKEN) { x += offset; y += offset; @@ -602,7 +613,7 @@ TkpDisplayButton(clientData) butPtr->textHeight, &x, &y); x += butPtr->indicatorSpace; - + if (relief == TK_RELIEF_SUNKEN) { x += offset; y += offset; @@ -629,12 +640,12 @@ TkpDisplayButton(clientData) } /* - * Draw the focus ring. If this is a push button then we need to - * put it around the inner edge of the border, otherwise we put it - * around the text. The text offsets are only non-zero when this - * is a compound button. + * Draw the focus ring. If this is a push button then we need to put it + * around the inner edge of the border, otherwise we put it around the + * text. The text offsets are only non-zero when this is a compound + * button. */ - + if (drawRing && butPtr->flags & GOT_FOCUS && butPtr->type != TYPE_LABEL) { dc = TkWinGetDrawableDC(butPtr->display, pixmap, &state); if (butPtr->type == TYPE_BUTTON || !butPtr->indicatorOn) { @@ -655,11 +666,10 @@ TkpDisplayButton(clientData) } y += height/2; - + /* - * Draw the indicator for check buttons and radio buttons. At this - * point x and y refer to the top-left corner of the text or image - * or bitmap. + * Draw the indicator for check buttons and radio buttons. At this point x + * and y refer to the top-left corner of the text or image or bitmap. */ if ((butPtr->type >= TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON) && butPtr->indicatorOn @@ -677,11 +687,11 @@ TkpDisplayButton(clientData) /* * Update the palette in the boxes bitmap to reflect the current - * button colors. Note that this code relies on the layout of the - * bitmap's palette. Also, all of the colors used to draw the - * bitmap must be in the palette that is selected into the DC of - * the offscreen pixmap. This requires that the static colors - * be placed into the palette. + * button colors. Note that this code relies on the layout of the + * bitmap's palette. Also, all of the colors used to draw the bitmap + * must be in the palette that is selected into the DC of the + * offscreen pixmap. This requires that the static colors be placed + * into the palette. */ if ((butPtr->state == STATE_DISABLED) @@ -712,18 +722,18 @@ TkpDisplayButton(clientData) border, TK_3D_FLAT_GC)); dc = TkWinGetDrawableDC(butPtr->display, pixmap, &state); - StretchDIBits(dc, x, y, tsdPtr->boxWidth, tsdPtr->boxHeight, - xSrc, ySrc, tsdPtr->boxWidth, tsdPtr->boxHeight, - tsdPtr->boxesBits, (LPBITMAPINFO) tsdPtr->boxesPtr, + StretchDIBits(dc, x, y, tsdPtr->boxWidth, tsdPtr->boxHeight, + xSrc, ySrc, tsdPtr->boxWidth, tsdPtr->boxHeight, + tsdPtr->boxesBits, (LPBITMAPINFO) tsdPtr->boxesPtr, DIB_RGB_COLORS, SRCCOPY); TkWinReleaseDrawableDC(pixmap, dc, &state); } /* * If the button is disabled with a stipple rather than a special - * foreground color, generate the stippled effect. If the widget - * is selected and we use a different background color when selected, - * must temporarily modify the GC so the stippling is the right color. + * foreground color, generate the stippled effect. If the widget is + * selected and we use a different background color when selected, must + * temporarily modify the GC so the stippling is the right color. */ if ((butPtr->state == STATE_DISABLED) @@ -733,10 +743,12 @@ TkpDisplayButton(clientData) XSetForeground(butPtr->display, butPtr->stippleGC, Tk_3DBorderColor(butPtr->selectBorder)->pixel); } + /* - * Stipple the whole button if no disabledFg was specified, - * otherwise restrict stippling only to displayed image + * Stipple the whole button if no disabledFg was specified, otherwise + * restrict stippling only to displayed image */ + if (butPtr->disabledFg == NULL) { XFillRectangle(butPtr->display, pixmap, butPtr->stippleGC, 0, 0, (unsigned) Tk_Width(tkwin), (unsigned) Tk_Height(tkwin)); @@ -753,8 +765,8 @@ TkpDisplayButton(clientData) } /* - * Draw the border and traversal highlight last. This way, if the - * button's contents overflow they'll be covered up by the border. + * Draw the border and traversal highlight last. This way, if the button's + * contents overflow they'll be covered up by the border. */ if (relief != TK_RELIEF_FLAT) { @@ -784,8 +796,8 @@ TkpDisplayButton(clientData) } /* - * Copy the information from the off-screen pixmap onto the screen, - * then delete the pixmap. + * Copy the information from the off-screen pixmap onto the screen, then + * delete the pixmap. */ XCopyArea(butPtr->display, pixmap, Tk_WindowId(tkwin), @@ -799,9 +811,9 @@ TkpDisplayButton(clientData) * * TkpComputeButtonGeometry -- * - * After changes in a button's text or bitmap, this procedure - * recomputes the button's geometry and passes this information - * along to the geometry manager for the window. + * After changes in a button's text or bitmap, this procedure recomputes + * the button's geometry and passes this information along to the + * geometry manager for the window. * * Results: * None. @@ -813,21 +825,21 @@ TkpDisplayButton(clientData) */ void -TkpComputeButtonGeometry(butPtr) - register TkButton *butPtr; /* Button whose geometry may have changed. */ +TkpComputeButtonGeometry( + register TkButton *butPtr) /* Button whose geometry may have changed. */ { - int txtWidth, txtHeight; /* Width and height of text */ - int imgWidth, imgHeight; /* Width and height of image */ - int width = 0, height = 0; /* Width and height of button */ + int txtWidth, txtHeight; /* Width and height of text */ + int imgWidth, imgHeight; /* Width and height of image */ + int width = 0, height = 0; /* Width and height of button */ int haveImage, haveText; int avgWidth; int minWidth; /* Vertical and horizontal dialog units size in pixels. */ double vDLU, hDLU; Tk_FontMetrics fm; - - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) - Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); + + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); if (butPtr->highlightWidth < 0) { butPtr->highlightWidth = 0; @@ -839,13 +851,16 @@ TkpComputeButtonGeometry(butPtr) InitBoxes(); } - /* Figure out image metrics */ + /* + * Figure out image metrics. + */ + if (butPtr->image != NULL) { Tk_SizeOfImage(butPtr->image, &imgWidth, &imgHeight); haveImage = 1; } else if (butPtr->bitmap != None) { Tk_SizeOfBitmap(butPtr->display, butPtr->bitmap, - &imgWidth, &imgHeight); + &imgWidth, &imgHeight); haveImage = 1; } else { imgWidth = 0; @@ -853,10 +868,11 @@ TkpComputeButtonGeometry(butPtr) haveImage = 0; } - /* + /* * Figure out font metrics (even if we don't have text because we need * DLUs (based on font, not text) for some spacing calculations below). */ + Tk_FreeTextLayout(butPtr->textLayout); butPtr->textLayout = Tk_ComputeTextLayout(butPtr->tkfont, Tcl_GetString(butPtr->textPtr), -1, butPtr->wrapLength, @@ -870,7 +886,10 @@ TkpComputeButtonGeometry(butPtr) 52) + 26) / 52; Tk_GetFontMetrics(butPtr->tkfont, &fm); - /* Compute dialog units for layout calculations. */ + /* + * Compute dialog units for layout calculations. + */ + hDLU = avgWidth / 4.0; vDLU = fm.linespace / 8.0; @@ -887,179 +906,197 @@ TkpComputeButtonGeometry(butPtr) /* * Set width and height by button type; See User Experience table, p449. - * These are text-based measurements, even if the text is "". - * If there is an image, height will get set again later. + * These are text-based measurements, even if the text is "". If there is + * an image, height will get set again later. */ + switch (butPtr->type) { - case TYPE_BUTTON: { - /* - * First compute the minimum width of the button in - * characters. MWUE says that the button should be - * 50 DLUs. We allow 6 DLUs padding left and right. - * (There is no rule but this is consistent with the - * fact that button text is 8 DLUs high and buttons - * are 14 DLUs high.) - * - * The width is specified in characters. A character - * is, by definition, 4 DLUs wide. 11 char * 4 DLU - * is 44 DLU + 6 DLU padding = 50 DLU. Therefore, - * width = -11 -> MWUE compliant buttons. - */ - if (butPtr->width < 0) { - /* Min width in characters */ - minWidth = -(butPtr->width); - /* Allow for characters */ - width = avgWidth * minWidth; - /* Add for padding */ - width += (int)(0.5 + (6 * hDLU)); - } + case TYPE_BUTTON: + /* + * First compute the minimum width of the button in characters. MWUE + * says that the button should be 50 DLUs. We allow 6 DLUs padding + * left and right. (There is no rule but this is consistent with the + * fact that button text is 8 DLUs high and buttons are 14 DLUs high.) + * + * The width is specified in characters. A character is, by + * definition, 4 DLUs wide. 11 char * 4 DLU is 44 DLU + 6 DLU padding + * = 50 DLU. Therefore, width = -11 -> MWUE compliant buttons. + */ - /* - * If shrink-wrapping was requested (width = 0) or - * if the text is wider than the default button width, - * adjust the button width up to suit. - */ - if (butPtr->width == 0 - || (txtWidth + (int)(0.5 + (6 * hDLU)) > width)) { - width = txtWidth + (int)(0.5 + (6 * hDLU)); - } + if (butPtr->width < 0) { + minWidth = -(butPtr->width); /* Min width in chars */ + width = avgWidth * minWidth; /* Allow for characters */ + width += (int)(0.5 + (6 * hDLU)); /* Add for padding */ + } + + /* + * If shrink-wrapping was requested (width = 0) or if the text is + * wider than the default button width, adjust the button width up to + * suit. + */ + + if (butPtr->width == 0 + || (txtWidth + (int)(0.5 + (6 * hDLU)) > width)) { + width = txtWidth + (int)(0.5 + (6 * hDLU)); + } + + /* + * The User Experience says 14 DLUs. Since text is, by definition, 8 + * DLU/line, this allows for multi-line text while working perfectly + * for single-line text. + */ + + height = txtHeight + (int)(0.5 + (6 * vDLU)); + + /* + * The above includes 6 DLUs of padding which should include defaults + * of 1 pixel of highlightwidth, 2 pixels of borderwidth, 1 pixel of + * padding and 1 pixel of extra inset on each side. Those will be + * added later so reduce width and height now to compensate. + */ + + width -= 10; + height -= 10; + if (!haveImage) { /* - * The User Experience says 14 DLUs. Since text is, by - * definition, 8 DLU/line, this allows for multi-line text - * while working perfectly for single-line text. + * Extra inset for the focus ring. */ - height = txtHeight + (int)(0.5 + (6 * vDLU)); + butPtr->inset += 1; + } + break; + + case TYPE_LABEL: + /* + * The User Experience says, "as wide as needed". + */ + + width = txtWidth; + + /* + * The User Experience says, "8 (DLUs) per line of text". Since text + * is, by definition, 8 DLU/line, this allows for multi-line text + * while working perfectly for single-line text. + */ + + if (txtHeight) { + height = txtHeight; + } else { /* - * The above includes 6 DLUs of padding which should include - * defaults of 1 pixel of highlightwidth, 2 pixels of - * borderwidth, 1 pixel of padding and 1 pixel of extra inset - * on each side. Those will be added later so reduce width - * and height now to compensate. + * If there's no text, we want the height to be one linespace. */ - width -= 10; - height -= 10; - - if (!haveImage) { - /* - * Extra inset for the focus ring. - */ - butPtr->inset += 1; - } - break; + height = fm.linespace; } + break; - case TYPE_LABEL: { - /* - * The User Experience says, "as wide as needed". - */ - width = txtWidth; + case TYPE_RADIO_BUTTON: + case TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON: { + /* + * See note for TYPE_LABEL. + */ - /* - * The User Experience says, "8 (DLUs) per line of text." - * Since text is, by definition, 8 DLU/line, this allows - * for multi-line text while working perfectly for single-line - * text. - */ - if (txtHeight) { - height = txtHeight; - } else { - /* - * If there's no text, we want the height to be one linespace. - */ - height = fm.linespace; - } - break; - } + width = txtWidth; - case TYPE_RADIO_BUTTON: - case TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON: { - /* See note for TYPE_LABEL */ - width = txtWidth; - /* - * The User Experience says 10 DLUs. (Is that one DLU above - * and below for the focus ring?) See note above about - * multi-line text and 8 DLU/line. - */ - height = txtHeight + (int)(0.5 + (2.0 * vDLU)); - - /* - * The above includes 2 DLUs of padding which should include - * defaults of 1 pixel of highlightwidth, 0 pixels of - * borderwidth, and 1 pixel of padding on each side. Those - * will be added later so reduce height now to compensate. - */ - height -= 4; - - /* - * Extra inset for the focus ring. - */ - butPtr->inset += 1; - break; - } + /* + * The User Experience says 10 DLUs. (Is that one DLU above and below + * for the focus ring?) See note above about multi-line text and 8 + * DLU/line. + */ + + height = txtHeight + (int)(0.5 + (2.0 * vDLU)); + + /* + * The above includes 2 DLUs of padding which should include defaults + * of 1 pixel of highlightwidth, 0 pixels of borderwidth, and 1 pixel + * of padding on each side. Those will be added later so reduce height + * now to compensate. + */ + + height -= 4; + + /* + * Extra inset for the focus ring. + */ + butPtr->inset += 1; + break; + } }/* switch */ /* - * At this point, the width and height are correct for a Tk text - * button, excluding padding and inset, but we have to allow for - * compound buttons. The image may be above, below, left, or right - * of the text. + * At this point, the width and height are correct for a Tk text button, + * excluding padding and inset, but we have to allow for compound buttons. + * The image may be above, below, left, or right of the text. */ /* - * If the button is compound (i.e., it shows both an image and text), - * the new geometry is a combination of the image and text geometry. - * We only honor the compound bit if the button has both text and an - * image, because otherwise it is not really a compound button. + * If the button is compound (i.e., it shows both an image and text), the + * new geometry is a combination of the image and text geometry. We only + * honor the compound bit if the button has both text and an image, + * because otherwise it is not really a compound button. */ + if (butPtr->compound != COMPOUND_NONE && haveImage && haveText) { switch ((enum compound) butPtr->compound) { - case COMPOUND_TOP: - case COMPOUND_BOTTOM: { - /* Image is above or below text */ - if (imgWidth > width) { - width = imgWidth; - } - height += imgHeight + butPtr->padY; - break; + case COMPOUND_TOP: + case COMPOUND_BOTTOM: + /* + * Image is above or below text. + */ + + if (imgWidth > width) { + width = imgWidth; } - case COMPOUND_LEFT: - case COMPOUND_RIGHT: { - /* Image is left or right of text */ - /* - * Only increase width of button if image doesn't fit in - * slack space of default button width - */ - if ((imgWidth + txtWidth + butPtr->padX) > width) { - width = imgWidth + txtWidth + butPtr->padX; - } + height += imgHeight + butPtr->padY; + break; - if (imgHeight > height) { - height = imgHeight; - } - break; + case COMPOUND_LEFT: + case COMPOUND_RIGHT: + + /* + * Image is left or right of text. + * + * Only increase width of button if image doesn't fit in slack + * space of default button width + */ + + if ((imgWidth + txtWidth + butPtr->padX) > width) { + width = imgWidth + txtWidth + butPtr->padX; } - case COMPOUND_CENTER: { - /* Image and text are superimposed */ - if (imgWidth > width) { - width = imgWidth; - } - if (imgHeight > height) { - height = imgHeight; - } - break; + + if (imgHeight > height) { + height = imgHeight; + } + break; + + case COMPOUND_CENTER: + /* + * Image and text are superimposed. + */ + + if (imgWidth > width) { + width = imgWidth; + } + if (imgHeight > height) { + height = imgHeight; } + break; } /* switch */ - /* Fix up for minimum width */ - if (butPtr->width < 0) { - /* minWidth in pixels (because there's an image */ - minWidth = -(butPtr->width); - if (width < minWidth) { - width = minWidth; - } - } else if (butPtr->width > 0) { + /* + * Fix up for minimum width. + */ + + if (butPtr->width < 0) { + /* + * minWidth in pixels (because there's an image. + */ + + minWidth = -(butPtr->width); + if (width < minWidth) { + width = minWidth; + } + } else if (butPtr->width > 0) { width = butPtr->width; } @@ -1081,68 +1118,76 @@ TkpComputeButtonGeometry(butPtr) height = imgHeight; } } else { - /* No image. May or may not be text. May or may not be compound. */ + /* + * No image. May or may not be text. May or may not be compound. + */ /* - * butPtr->width is in characters. We need to allow for that - * many characters on the face, not in the over-all button width + * butPtr->width is in characters. We need to allow for that many + * characters on the face, not in the over-all button width */ + if (butPtr->width > 0) { width = butPtr->width * avgWidth; } /* - * butPtr->height is in lines of text. We need to allow for - * that many lines on the face, not in the over-all button - * height. + * butPtr->height is in lines of text. We need to allow for that many + * lines on the face, not in the over-all button height. */ + if (butPtr->height > 0) { height = butPtr->height * fm.linespace; /* - * Make the same adjustments as above to get same height for - * e.g. a one line text with -height 0 or 1. [Bug #565485] + * Make the same adjustments as above to get same height for e.g. + * a one line text with -height 0 or 1. [Bug #565485] */ switch (butPtr->type) { - case TYPE_BUTTON: { - height += (int)(0.5 + (6 * vDLU)) - 10; - break; - } - case TYPE_RADIO_BUTTON: - case TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON: { - height += (int)(0.5 + (2.0 * vDLU)) - 4; - break; - } + case TYPE_BUTTON: { + height += (int)(0.5 + (6 * vDLU)) - 10; + break; + } + case TYPE_RADIO_BUTTON: + case TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON: { + height += (int)(0.5 + (2.0 * vDLU)) - 4; + break; + } } } - - width += 2 * butPtr->padX; + + width += 2 * butPtr->padX; height += 2 * butPtr->padY; } - /* Fix up width and height for indicator sizing and spacing */ + /* + * Fix up width and height for indicator sizing and spacing. + */ + if (butPtr->type == TYPE_RADIO_BUTTON || butPtr->type == TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON) { if (butPtr->indicatorOn) { butPtr->indicatorDiameter = tsdPtr->boxHeight; - /* - * Make sure we can see the whole indicator, even if the text - * or image is very small. + /* + * Make sure we can see the whole indicator, even if the text or + * image is very small. */ + if (height < butPtr->indicatorDiameter) { height = butPtr->indicatorDiameter; } /* - * There is no rule for space between the indicator and - * the text (the two are atomic on 'Windows) but the User - * Experience page 451 says leave 3 hDLUs between "text - * labels and their associated controls". + * There is no rule for space between the indicator and the text + * (the two are atomic on 'Windows) but the User Experience page + * 451 says leave 3 hDLUs between "text labels and their + * associated controls". */ + butPtr->indicatorSpace = butPtr->indicatorDiameter + - (int)(0.5 + (3.0 * hDLU)); + (int)(0.5 + (3.0 * hDLU)); width += butPtr->indicatorSpace; } } @@ -1150,7 +1195,8 @@ TkpComputeButtonGeometry(butPtr) /* * Inset is always added to the size. */ - width += 2 * butPtr->inset; + + width += 2 * butPtr->inset; height += 2 * butPtr->inset; Tk_GeometryRequest(butPtr->tkwin, width, height); @@ -1162,8 +1208,8 @@ TkpComputeButtonGeometry(butPtr) * * ButtonProc -- * - * This function is call by Windows whenever an event occurs on - * a button control created by Tk. + * This function is call by Windows whenever an event occurs on a button + * control created by Tk. * * Results: * Standard Windows return value. @@ -1175,11 +1221,11 @@ TkpComputeButtonGeometry(butPtr) */ static LRESULT CALLBACK -ButtonProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) - HWND hwnd; - UINT message; - WPARAM wParam; - LPARAM lParam; +ButtonProc( + HWND hwnd, + UINT message, + WPARAM wParam, + LPARAM lParam) { LRESULT result; WinButton *butPtr; @@ -1191,70 +1237,80 @@ ButtonProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) butPtr = (WinButton *)((TkWindow*)tkwin)->instanceData; switch(message) { - case WM_ERASEBKGND: - return 0; - - case BM_GETCHECK: - if (((butPtr->info.type == TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON) - || (butPtr->info.type == TYPE_RADIO_BUTTON)) - && butPtr->info.indicatorOn) { - return (butPtr->info.flags & SELECTED) - ? BST_CHECKED : BST_UNCHECKED; - } - return 0; - - case BM_GETSTATE: { - DWORD state = 0; - if (((butPtr->info.type == TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON) - || (butPtr->info.type == TYPE_RADIO_BUTTON)) - && butPtr->info.indicatorOn) { - state = (butPtr->info.flags & SELECTED) + case WM_ERASEBKGND: + return 0; + + case BM_GETCHECK: + if (((butPtr->info.type == TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON) + || (butPtr->info.type == TYPE_RADIO_BUTTON)) + && butPtr->info.indicatorOn) { + return (butPtr->info.flags & SELECTED) ? BST_CHECKED : BST_UNCHECKED; - } - if (butPtr->info.flags & GOT_FOCUS) { - state |= BST_FOCUS; - } - return state; } - case WM_ENABLE: - break; + return 0; - case WM_PAINT: { - PAINTSTRUCT ps; - BeginPaint(hwnd, &ps); - EndPaint(hwnd, &ps); - TkpDisplayButton((ClientData)butPtr); + case BM_GETSTATE: { + DWORD state = 0; - /* - * Special note: must cancel any existing idle handler - * for TkpDisplayButton; it's no longer needed, and - * TkpDisplayButton cleared the REDRAW_PENDING flag. - */ - - Tcl_CancelIdleCall(TkpDisplayButton, (ClientData)butPtr); - return 0; + if (((butPtr->info.type == TYPE_CHECK_BUTTON) + || (butPtr->info.type == TYPE_RADIO_BUTTON)) + && butPtr->info.indicatorOn) { + state = (butPtr->info.flags & SELECTED) + ? BST_CHECKED : BST_UNCHECKED; } - case BN_CLICKED: { - int code; - Tcl_Interp *interp = butPtr->info.interp; - if (butPtr->info.state != STATE_DISABLED) { - Tcl_Preserve((ClientData)interp); - code = TkInvokeButton((TkButton*)butPtr); - if (code != TCL_OK && code != TCL_CONTINUE - && code != TCL_BREAK) { - Tcl_AddErrorInfo(interp, "\n (button invoke)"); - Tcl_BackgroundError(interp); - } - Tcl_Release((ClientData)interp); - } - Tcl_ServiceAll(); - return 0; + if (butPtr->info.flags & GOT_FOCUS) { + state |= BST_FOCUS; } + return state; + } + case WM_ENABLE: + break; + + case WM_PAINT: { + PAINTSTRUCT ps; + BeginPaint(hwnd, &ps); + EndPaint(hwnd, &ps); + TkpDisplayButton((ClientData)butPtr); - default: - if (Tk_TranslateWinEvent(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam, &result)) { - return result; + /* + * Special note: must cancel any existing idle handler for + * TkpDisplayButton; it's no longer needed, and TkpDisplayButton + * cleared the REDRAW_PENDING flag. + */ + + Tcl_CancelIdleCall(TkpDisplayButton, (ClientData)butPtr); + return 0; + } + case BN_CLICKED: { + int code; + Tcl_Interp *interp = butPtr->info.interp; + + if (butPtr->info.state != STATE_DISABLED) { + Tcl_Preserve((ClientData)interp); + code = TkInvokeButton((TkButton*)butPtr); + if (code != TCL_OK && code != TCL_CONTINUE + && code != TCL_BREAK) { + Tcl_AddErrorInfo(interp, "\n (button invoke)"); + Tcl_BackgroundError(interp); } + Tcl_Release((ClientData)interp); + } + Tcl_ServiceAll(); + return 0; + } + + default: + if (Tk_TranslateWinEvent(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam, &result)) { + return result; + } } return DefWindowProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam); } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWinClipboard.c b/win/tkWinClipboard.c index b08147a..bb91f4d 100644 --- a/win/tkWinClipboard.c +++ b/win/tkWinClipboard.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* +/* * tkWinClipboard.c -- * * This file contains functions for managing the clipboard. @@ -6,30 +6,30 @@ * Copyright (c) 1995-1997 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * Copyright (c) 1998-2000 by Scriptics Corporation. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinClipboard.c,v 1.7 2000/04/12 18:51:11 hobbs Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinClipboard.c,v 1.8 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkWinInt.h" #include "tkSelect.h" -static void UpdateClipboard _ANSI_ARGS_((HWND hwnd)); +static void UpdateClipboard(HWND hwnd); /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkSelGetSelection -- * - * Retrieve the specified selection from another process. For - * now, only fetching XA_STRING from CLIPBOARD is supported. - * Eventually other types should be allowed. - * + * Retrieve the specified selection from another process. For now, only + * fetching XA_STRING from CLIPBOARD is supported. Eventually other types + * should be allowed. + * * Results: - * The return value is a standard Tcl return value. - * If an error occurs (such as no selection exists) - * then an error message is left in the interp's result. + * The return value is a standard Tcl return value. If an error occurs + * (such as no selection exists) then an error message is left in the + * interp's result. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -38,18 +38,17 @@ static void UpdateClipboard _ANSI_ARGS_((HWND hwnd)); */ int -TkSelGetSelection(interp, tkwin, selection, target, proc, clientData) - Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Interpreter to use for reporting - * errors. */ - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Window on whose behalf to retrieve - * the selection (determines display - * from which to retrieve). */ - Atom selection; /* Selection to retrieve. */ - Atom target; /* Desired form in which selection - * is to be returned. */ - Tk_GetSelProc *proc; /* Procedure to call to process the - * selection, once it has been retrieved. */ - ClientData clientData; /* Arbitrary value to pass to proc. */ +TkSelGetSelection( + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Interpreter to use for reporting errors. */ + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Window on whose behalf to retrieve the + * selection (determines display from which to + * retrieve). */ + Atom selection, /* Selection to retrieve. */ + Atom target, /* Desired form in which selection is to be + * returned. */ + Tk_GetSelProc *proc, /* Procedure to call to process the selection, + * once it has been retrieved. */ + ClientData clientData) /* Arbitrary value to pass to proc. */ { char *data, *destPtr; Tcl_DString ds; @@ -64,8 +63,8 @@ TkSelGetSelection(interp, tkwin, selection, target, proc, clientData) } /* - * Attempt to get the data in Unicode form if available as this is - * less work that CF_TEXT. + * Attempt to get the data in Unicode form if available as this is less + * work that CF_TEXT. */ result = TCL_ERROR; @@ -93,19 +92,17 @@ TkSelGetSelection(interp, tkwin, selection, target, proc, clientData) } /* - * Get the locale identifier, determine the proper code page - * to use, and find the corresponding encoding. + * Get the locale identifier, determine the proper code page to + * use, and find the corresponding encoding. */ Tcl_DStringInit(&ds); Tcl_DStringAppend(&ds, "cp######", -1); data = GlobalLock(handle); - /* - * Even though the documentation claims that GetLocaleInfo - * expects an LCID, on Windows 9x it really seems to expect - * a LanguageID. + * Even though the documentation claims that GetLocaleInfo expects + * an LCID, on Windows 9x it really seems to expect a LanguageID. */ locale = LANGIDFROMLCID(*((int*)data)); @@ -146,7 +143,7 @@ TkSelGetSelection(interp, tkwin, selection, target, proc, clientData) /* * Translate CR/LF to LF. */ - + data = destPtr = Tcl_DStringValue(&ds); while (*data) { if (data[0] == '\r' && data[1] == '\n') { @@ -165,12 +162,11 @@ TkSelGetSelection(interp, tkwin, selection, target, proc, clientData) Tcl_DStringFree(&ds); CloseClipboard(); return result; - -error: + + error: Tcl_AppendResult(interp, Tk_GetAtomName(tkwin, selection), " selection doesn't exist or form \"", - Tk_GetAtomName(tkwin, target), - "\" not defined", (char *) NULL); + Tk_GetAtomName(tkwin, target), "\" not defined", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } @@ -179,9 +175,8 @@ error: * * TkSetSelectionOwner -- * - * This function claims ownership of the specified selection. - * If the selection is CLIPBOARD, then we empty the system - * clipboard. + * This function claims ownership of the specified selection. If the + * selection is CLIPBOARD, then we empty the system clipboard. * * Results: * None. @@ -193,27 +188,26 @@ error: */ void -XSetSelectionOwner(display, selection, owner, time) - Display* display; - Atom selection; - Window owner; - Time time; +XSetSelectionOwner( + Display *display, + Atom selection, + Window owner, + Time time) { HWND hwnd = owner ? TkWinGetHWND(owner) : NULL; Tk_Window tkwin; /* - * This is a gross hack because the Tk_InternAtom interface is broken. - * It expects a Tk_Window, even though it only needs a Tk_Display. + * This is a gross hack because the Tk_InternAtom interface is broken. It + * expects a Tk_Window, even though it only needs a Tk_Display. */ tkwin = (Tk_Window) TkGetMainInfoList()->winPtr; if (selection == Tk_InternAtom(tkwin, "CLIPBOARD")) { - /* - * Only claim and empty the clipboard if we aren't already the - * owner of the clipboard. + * Only claim and empty the clipboard if we aren't already the owner + * of the clipboard. */ if (GetClipboardOwner() != hwnd) { @@ -227,8 +221,8 @@ XSetSelectionOwner(display, selection, owner, time) * * TkWinClipboardRender -- * - * This function supplies the contents of the clipboard in - * response to a WM_RENDERFORMAT message. + * This function supplies the contents of the clipboard in response to a + * WM_RENDERFORMAT message. * * Results: * None. @@ -240,9 +234,9 @@ XSetSelectionOwner(display, selection, owner, time) */ void -TkWinClipboardRender(dispPtr, format) - TkDisplay *dispPtr; - UINT format; +TkWinClipboardRender( + TkDisplay *dispPtr, + UINT format) { TkClipboardTarget *targetPtr; TkClipboardBuffer *cbPtr; @@ -253,13 +247,14 @@ TkWinClipboardRender(dispPtr, format) for (targetPtr = dispPtr->clipTargetPtr; targetPtr != NULL; targetPtr = targetPtr->nextPtr) { - if (targetPtr->type == XA_STRING) + if (targetPtr->type == XA_STRING) { break; + } } /* - * Count the number of newlines so we can add space for them in - * the resulting string. + * Count the number of newlines so we can add space for them in the + * resulting string. */ length = 0; @@ -296,8 +291,8 @@ TkWinClipboardRender(dispPtr, format) *buffer = '\0'; /* - * Depending on the platform, turn the data into Unicode or the - * system encoding before placing it on the clipboard. + * Depending on the platform, turn the data into Unicode or the system + * encoding before placing it on the clipboard. */ if (TkWinGetPlatformId() == VER_PLATFORM_WIN32_NT) { @@ -330,8 +325,6 @@ TkWinClipboardRender(dispPtr, format) Tcl_DStringFree(&ds); SetClipboardData(CF_TEXT, handle); } - - return; } /* @@ -339,8 +332,8 @@ TkWinClipboardRender(dispPtr, format) * * TkSelUpdateClipboard -- * - * This function is called to force the clipboard to be updated - * after new data is added. + * This function is called to force the clipboard to be updated after new + * data is added. * * Results: * None. @@ -352,9 +345,9 @@ TkWinClipboardRender(dispPtr, format) */ void -TkSelUpdateClipboard(winPtr, targetPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; - TkClipboardTarget *targetPtr; +TkSelUpdateClipboard( + TkWindow *winPtr, + TkClipboardTarget *targetPtr) { HWND hwnd = TkWinGetHWND(winPtr->window); UpdateClipboard(hwnd); @@ -365,8 +358,8 @@ TkSelUpdateClipboard(winPtr, targetPtr) * * UpdateClipboard -- * - * Take ownership of the clipboard, clear it, and indicate to the - * system the supported formats. + * Take ownership of the clipboard, clear it, and indicate to the system + * the supported formats. * * Results: * None. @@ -378,16 +371,16 @@ TkSelUpdateClipboard(winPtr, targetPtr) */ static void -UpdateClipboard(hwnd) - HWND hwnd; +UpdateClipboard( + HWND hwnd) { TkWinUpdatingClipboard(TRUE); OpenClipboard(hwnd); EmptyClipboard(); /* - * CF_UNICODETEXT is only supported on NT, but it it is prefered - * when possible. + * CF_UNICODETEXT is only supported on NT, but it it is prefered when + * possible. */ if (TkWinGetPlatformId() == VER_PLATFORM_WIN32_NT) { @@ -404,25 +397,22 @@ UpdateClipboard(hwnd) * * TkSelEventProc -- * - * This procedure is invoked whenever a selection-related - * event occurs. + * This procedure is invoked whenever a selection-related event occurs. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * Lots: depends on the type of event. + * Lots: depends on the type of event. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -TkSelEventProc(tkwin, eventPtr) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Window for which event was - * targeted. */ - register XEvent *eventPtr; /* X event: either SelectionClear, - * SelectionRequest, or - * SelectionNotify. */ +TkSelEventProc( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Window for which event was targeted. */ + register XEvent *eventPtr) /* X event: either SelectionClear, + * SelectionRequest, or SelectionNotify. */ { if (eventPtr->type == SelectionClear) { TkSelClearSelection(tkwin, eventPtr); @@ -434,9 +424,8 @@ TkSelEventProc(tkwin, eventPtr) * * TkSelPropProc -- * - * This procedure is invoked when property-change events - * occur on windows not known to the toolkit. This is a stub - * function under Windows. + * This procedure is invoked when property-change events occur on windows + * not known to the toolkit. This is a stub function under Windows. * * Results: * None. @@ -448,7 +437,15 @@ TkSelEventProc(tkwin, eventPtr) */ void -TkSelPropProc(eventPtr) - register XEvent *eventPtr; /* X PropertyChange event. */ +TkSelPropProc( + register XEvent *eventPtr) /* X PropertyChange event. */ { } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWinColor.c b/win/tkWinColor.c index 134176f..ee033f3 100644 --- a/win/tkWinColor.c +++ b/win/tkWinColor.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* +/* * tkWinColor.c -- * * Functions to map color names to system color values. @@ -6,10 +6,10 @@ * Copyright (c) 1995 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * Copyright (c) 1994 Software Research Associates, Inc. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinColor.c,v 1.7 2004/01/13 02:06:01 davygrvy Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinColor.c,v 1.8 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkWinInt.h" @@ -22,15 +22,14 @@ typedef struct WinColor { TkColor info; /* Generic color information. */ - int index; /* Index for GetSysColor(), -1 if color - * is not a "live" system color. */ + int index; /* Index for GetSysColor(), -1 if color is not + * a "live" system color. */ } WinColor; /* - * The sysColors array contains the names and index values for the - * Windows indirect system color names. In use, all of the names - * will have the string "System" prepended, but we omit it in the table - * to save space. + * The sysColors array contains the names and index values for the Windows + * indirect system color names. In use, all of the names will have the string + * "System" prepended, but we omit it in the table to save space. */ typedef struct { @@ -38,7 +37,6 @@ typedef struct { int index; } SystemColorEntry; - static SystemColorEntry sysColors[] = { "3dDarkShadow", COLOR_3DDKSHADOW, "3dLight", COLOR_3DLIGHT, @@ -69,7 +67,7 @@ static SystemColorEntry sysColors[] = { NULL, 0 }; -typedef struct ThreadSpecificData { +typedef struct ThreadSpecificData { int ncolors; } ThreadSpecificData; static Tcl_ThreadDataKey dataKey; @@ -78,20 +76,20 @@ static Tcl_ThreadDataKey dataKey; * Forward declarations for functions defined later in this file. */ -static int FindSystemColor _ANSI_ARGS_((const char *name, - XColor *colorPtr, int *indexPtr)); +static int FindSystemColor(const char *name, XColor *colorPtr, + int *indexPtr); /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * FindSystemColor -- * - * This routine finds the color entry that corresponds to the - * specified color. + * This routine finds the color entry that corresponds to the specified + * color. * * Results: - * Returns non-zero on success. The RGB values of the XColor - * will be initialized to the proper values on success. + * Returns non-zero on success. The RGB values of the XColor will be + * initialized to the proper values on success. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -100,18 +98,18 @@ static int FindSystemColor _ANSI_ARGS_((const char *name, */ static int -FindSystemColor(name, colorPtr, indexPtr) - const char *name; /* Color name. */ - XColor *colorPtr; /* Where to store results. */ - int *indexPtr; /* Out parameter to store color index. */ +FindSystemColor( + const char *name, /* Color name. */ + XColor *colorPtr, /* Where to store results. */ + int *indexPtr) /* Out parameter to store color index. */ { int l, u, r, i; - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); /* - * Count the number of elements in the color array if we haven't - * done so yet. + * Count the number of elements in the color array if we haven't done so + * yet. */ if (tsdPtr->ncolors == 0) { @@ -154,10 +152,12 @@ FindSystemColor(name, colorPtr, indexPtr) *indexPtr = sysColors[i].index; colorPtr->pixel = GetSysColor(sysColors[i].index); + /* - * x257 is (value<<8 + value) to get the properly bit shifted - * and padded value. [Bug: 4919] + * x257 is (value<<8 + value) to get the properly bit shifted and padded + * value. [Bug: 4919] */ + colorPtr->red = GetRValue(colorPtr->pixel) * 257; colorPtr->green = GetGValue(colorPtr->pixel) * 257; colorPtr->blue = GetBValue(colorPtr->pixel) * 257; @@ -178,27 +178,26 @@ FindSystemColor(name, colorPtr, indexPtr) * * Side effects: * May invalidate the colormap cache associated with tkwin upon - * allocating a new colormap entry. Allocates a new TkColor - * structure. + * allocating a new colormap entry. Allocates a new TkColor structure. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ TkColor * -TkpGetColor(tkwin, name) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Window in which color will be used. */ - Tk_Uid name; /* Name of color to allocated (in form +TkpGetColor( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Window in which color will be used. */ + Tk_Uid name) /* Name of color to allocated (in form * suitable for passing to XParseColor). */ { WinColor *winColPtr; XColor color; int index = -1; /* -1 indicates that this is not an indirect - * sytem color. */ + * system color. */ /* - * Check to see if it is a system color or an X color string. If the - * color is found, allocate a new WinColor and store the XColor and the - * system color index. + * Check to see if it is a system color or an X color string. If the color + * is found, allocate a new WinColor and store the XColor and the system + * color index. */ if (((strncasecmp(name, "system", 6) == 0) @@ -211,7 +210,7 @@ TkpGetColor(tkwin, name) XAllocColor(Tk_Display(tkwin), Tk_Colormap(tkwin), &winColPtr->info.color); - return (TkColor *) winColPtr; + return (TkColor *) winColPtr; } return (TkColor *) NULL; } @@ -221,27 +220,26 @@ TkpGetColor(tkwin, name) * * TkpGetColorByValue -- * - * Given a desired set of red-green-blue intensities for a color, - * locate a pixel value to use to draw that color in a given - * window. + * Given a desired set of red-green-blue intensities for a color, locate + * a pixel value to use to draw that color in a given window. * * Results: - * The return value is a pointer to an TkColor structure that - * indicates the closest red, blue, and green intensities available - * to those specified in colorPtr, and also specifies a pixel - * value to use to draw in that color. + * The return value is a pointer to an TkColor structure that indicates + * the closest red, blue, and green intensities available to those + * specified in colorPtr, and also specifies a pixel value to use to draw + * in that color. * * Side effects: - * May invalidate the colormap cache for the specified window. - * Allocates a new TkColor structure. + * May invalidate the colormap cache for the specified window. Allocates + * a new TkColor structure. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ TkColor * -TkpGetColorByValue(tkwin, colorPtr) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Window in which color will be used. */ - XColor *colorPtr; /* Red, green, and blue fields indicate +TkpGetColorByValue( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Window in which color will be used. */ + XColor *colorPtr) /* Red, green, and blue fields indicate * desired color. */ { WinColor *tkColPtr = (WinColor *) ckalloc(sizeof(WinColor)); @@ -266,15 +264,15 @@ TkpGetColorByValue(tkwin, colorPtr) * None * * Side effects: - * Invalidates the colormap cache for the colormap associated with - * the given color. + * Invalidates the colormap cache for the colormap associated with the + * given color. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -TkpFreeColor(tkColPtr) - TkColor *tkColPtr; /* Color to be released. Must have been +TkpFreeColor( + TkColor *tkColPtr) /* Color to be released. Must have been * allocated by TkpGetColor or * TkpGetColorByValue. */ { @@ -289,13 +287,13 @@ TkpFreeColor(tkColPtr) * * TkWinIndexOfColor -- * - * Given a color, return the system color index that was used - * to create the color. + * Given a color, return the system color index that was used to create + * the color. * * Results: - * If the color was allocated using a system indirect color name, - * then the corresponding GetSysColor() index is returned. - * Otherwise, -1 is returned. + * If the color was allocated using a system indirect color name, then + * the corresponding GetSysColor() index is returned. Otherwise, -1 is + * returned. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -304,13 +302,13 @@ TkpFreeColor(tkColPtr) */ int -TkWinIndexOfColor(colorPtr) - XColor *colorPtr; +TkWinIndexOfColor( + XColor *colorPtr) { register WinColor *winColPtr = (WinColor *) colorPtr; if (winColPtr->info.magic == COLOR_MAGIC) { return winColPtr->index; - } + } return -1; } @@ -322,8 +320,8 @@ TkWinIndexOfColor(colorPtr) * Find the closest available color to the specified XColor. * * Results: - * Updates the color argument and returns 1 on success. Otherwise - * returns 0. + * Updates the color argument and returns 1 on success. Otherwise returns + * 0. * * Side effects: * Allocates a new color in the palette. @@ -332,10 +330,10 @@ TkWinIndexOfColor(colorPtr) */ int -XAllocColor(display, colormap, color) - Display* display; - Colormap colormap; - XColor* color; +XAllocColor( + Display *display, + Colormap colormap, + XColor *color) { TkWinColormap *cmap = (TkWinColormap *) colormap; PALETTEENTRY entry, closeEntry; @@ -356,7 +354,7 @@ XAllocColor(display, colormap, color) /* * Find the nearest existing palette entry. */ - + newPixel = RGB(entry.peRed, entry.peGreen, entry.peBlue); index = GetNearestPaletteIndex(cmap->palette, newPixel); GetPaletteEntries(cmap->palette, index, 1, &closeEntry); @@ -364,15 +362,14 @@ XAllocColor(display, colormap, color) closeEntry.peBlue); /* - * If this is not a duplicate, allocate a new entry. Note that - * we may get values for index that are above the current size - * of the palette. This happens because we don't shrink the size of - * the palette object when we deallocate colors so there may be - * stale values that match in the upper slots. We should ignore - * those values and just put the new color in as if the colors - * had not matched. + * If this is not a duplicate, allocate a new entry. Note that we may + * get values for index that are above the current size of the + * palette. This happens because we don't shrink the size of the + * palette object when we deallocate colors so there may be stale + * values that match in the upper slots. We should ignore those values + * and just put the new color in as if the colors had not matched. */ - + if ((index >= cmap->size) || (newPixel != closePixel)) { if (cmap->size == sizePalette) { color->red = closeEntry.peRed * 257; @@ -399,11 +396,10 @@ XAllocColor(display, colormap, color) } Tcl_SetHashValue(entryPtr, (ClientData)refCount); } else { - /* * Determine what color will actually be used on non-colormap systems. */ - + color->pixel = GetNearestColor(dc, RGB(entry.peRed, entry.peGreen, entry.peBlue)); color->red = GetRValue(color->pixel) * 257; @@ -426,19 +422,19 @@ XAllocColor(display, colormap, color) * None. * * Side effects: - * Removes entries for the current palette and compacts the - * remaining set. + * Removes entries for the current palette and compacts the remaining + * set. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -XFreeColors(display, colormap, pixels, npixels, planes) - Display* display; - Colormap colormap; - unsigned long* pixels; - int npixels; - unsigned long planes; +XFreeColors( + Display *display, + Colormap colormap;, + unsigned long *pixels, + int npixels, + unsigned long planes) { TkWinColormap *cmap = (TkWinColormap *) colormap; COLORREF cref; @@ -451,16 +447,14 @@ XFreeColors(display, colormap, pixels, npixels, planes) /* * We don't have to do anything for non-palette devices. */ - - if (GetDeviceCaps(dc, RASTERCAPS) & RC_PALETTE) { + if (GetDeviceCaps(dc, RASTERCAPS) & RC_PALETTE) { /* * This is really slow for large values of npixels. */ for (i = 0; i < npixels; i++) { - entryPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(&cmap->refCounts, - (char *) pixels[i]); + entryPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(&cmap->refCounts, (char *) pixels[i]); if (!entryPtr) { Tcl_Panic("Tried to free a color that isn't allocated."); } @@ -471,8 +465,8 @@ XFreeColors(display, colormap, pixels, npixels, planes) GetPaletteEntries(cmap->palette, index, 1, &entry); if (cref == RGB(entry.peRed, entry.peGreen, entry.peBlue)) { count = cmap->size - index; - entries = (PALETTEENTRY *) ckalloc(sizeof(PALETTEENTRY) - * count); + entries = (PALETTEENTRY *) + ckalloc(sizeof(PALETTEENTRY) * count); GetPaletteEntries(cmap->palette, index+1, count, entries); SetPaletteEntries(cmap->palette, index, count, entries); ckfree((char *) entries); @@ -506,11 +500,11 @@ XFreeColors(display, colormap, pixels, npixels, planes) */ Colormap -XCreateColormap(display, w, visual, alloc) - Display* display; - Window w; - Visual* visual; - int alloc; +XCreateColormap( + Display *display, + Window w, + Visual *visual, + int alloc) { char logPalBuf[sizeof(LOGPALETTE) + 256 * sizeof(PALETTEENTRY)]; LOGPALETTE *logPalettePtr; @@ -544,7 +538,7 @@ XCreateColormap(display, w, visual, alloc) for (i = 0; i < logPalettePtr->palNumEntries; i++) { entryPtr = logPalettePtr->palPalEntry + i; hashPtr = Tcl_CreateHashEntry(&cmap->refCounts, (char*) PALETTERGB( - entryPtr->peRed, entryPtr->peGreen, entryPtr->peBlue), &new); + entryPtr->peRed, entryPtr->peGreen, entryPtr->peBlue), &new); Tcl_SetHashValue(hashPtr, (ClientData)1); } @@ -562,19 +556,19 @@ XCreateColormap(display, w, visual, alloc) * None. * * Side effects: - * Deletes the palette associated with the colormap. Note that - * the palette must not be selected into a device context when - * this occurs. + * Deletes the palette associated with the colormap. Note that the + * palette must not be selected into a device context when this occurs. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -XFreeColormap(display, colormap) - Display* display; - Colormap colormap; +XFreeColormap( + Display *display, + Colormap colormap) { TkWinColormap *cmap = (TkWinColormap *) colormap; + if (!DeleteObject(cmap->palette)) { Tcl_Panic("Unable to free colormap, palette is still selected."); } @@ -587,10 +581,9 @@ XFreeColormap(display, colormap) * * TkWinSelectPalette -- * - * This function sets up the specified device context with a - * given palette. If the palette is stale, it realizes it in - * the background unless the palette is the current global - * palette. + * This function sets up the specified device context with a given + * palette. If the palette is stale, it realizes it in the background + * unless the palette is the current global palette. * * Results: * Returns the previous palette selected into the device context. @@ -602,9 +595,9 @@ XFreeColormap(display, colormap) */ HPALETTE -TkWinSelectPalette(dc, colormap) - HDC dc; - Colormap colormap; +TkWinSelectPalette( + HDC dc, + Colormap colormap) { TkWinColormap *cmap = (TkWinColormap *) colormap; HPALETTE oldPalette; @@ -614,3 +607,11 @@ TkWinSelectPalette(dc, colormap) RealizePalette(dc); return oldPalette; } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWinConfig.c b/win/tkWinConfig.c index 0e12ba2..967ee86 100644 --- a/win/tkWinConfig.c +++ b/win/tkWinConfig.c @@ -1,15 +1,15 @@ -/* +/* * tkWinConfig.c -- * - * This module implements the Windows system defaults for - * the configuration package. + * This module implements the Windows system defaults for the + * configuration package. * * Copyright (c) 1997 by Sun Microsystems, Inc. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinConfig.c,v 1.3 2002/08/05 04:30:41 dgp Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinConfig.c,v 1.4 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tk.h" @@ -22,13 +22,13 @@ * * TkpGetSystemDefault -- * - * Given a dbName and className for a configuration option, - * return a string representation of the option. + * Given a dbName and className for a configuration option, return a + * string representation of the option. * * Results: - * Returns a Tk_Uid that is the string identifier that identifies - * this option. Returns NULL if there are no system defaults - * that match this pair. + * Returns a Tk_Uid that is the string identifier that identifies this + * option. Returns NULL if there are no system defaults that match this + * pair. * * Side effects: * None, once the package is initialized. @@ -40,7 +40,7 @@ Tcl_Obj * TkpGetSystemDefault( Tk_Window tkwin, /* A window to use. */ CONST char *dbName, /* The option database name. */ - CONST char *className) /* The name of the option class. */ + CONST char *className) /* The name of the option class. */ { Tcl_Obj *valueObjPtr; Tk_Uid classUid; @@ -58,3 +58,11 @@ TkpGetSystemDefault( return valueObjPtr; } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWinCursor.c b/win/tkWinCursor.c index 73ae25c..653fbbe 100644 --- a/win/tkWinCursor.c +++ b/win/tkWinCursor.c @@ -1,21 +1,21 @@ -/* +/* * tkWinCursor.c -- * * This file contains Win32 specific cursor related routines. * * Copyright (c) 1995 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinCursor.c,v 1.12 2003/07/24 02:10:01 patthoyts Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinCursor.c,v 1.13 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkWinInt.h" /* - * The following data structure contains the system specific data - * necessary to control Windows cursors. + * The following data structure contains the system specific data necessary to + * control Windows cursors. */ typedef struct { @@ -25,16 +25,17 @@ typedef struct { } TkWinCursor; /* - * The HAND cursor is only present when WINVER >= 0x0500. If this is - * not available at runtime, it will default to the unix-style cursor. + * The HAND cursor is only present when WINVER >= 0x0500. If this is not + * available at runtime, it will default to the unix-style cursor. */ + #ifndef IDC_HAND #define IDC_HAND MAKEINTRESOURCE(32649) #endif /* - * The table below is used to map from the name of a predefined cursor - * to its resource identifier. + * The table below is used to map from the name of a predefined cursor to its + * resource identifier. */ static struct CursorName { @@ -76,10 +77,10 @@ static struct CursorName { * * TkGetCursorByName -- * - * Retrieve a system cursor by name. + * Retrieve a system cursor by name. * * Results: - * Returns a new cursor, or NULL on errors. + * Returns a new cursor, or NULL on errors. * * Side effects: * Allocates a new cursor. @@ -88,11 +89,11 @@ static struct CursorName { */ TkCursor * -TkGetCursorByName(interp, tkwin, string) - Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Interpreter to use for error reporting. */ - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Window in which cursor will be used. */ - Tk_Uid string; /* Description of cursor. See manual entry - * for details on legal syntax. */ +TkGetCursorByName( + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Interpreter to use for error reporting. */ + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Window in which cursor will be used. */ + Tk_Uid string) /* Description of cursor. See manual entry for + * details on legal syntax. */ { struct CursorName *namePtr; TkWinCursor *cursorPtr; @@ -118,8 +119,8 @@ TkGetCursorByName(interp, tkwin, string) if (argv[0][0] == '@') { /* - * Check for system cursor of type @<filename>, where only - * the name is allowed. This accepts any of: + * Check for system cursor of type @<filename>, where only the name is + * allowed. This accepts any of: * -cursor @/winnt/cursors/globe.ani * -cursor @C:/Winnt/cursors/E_arrow.cur * -cursor {@C:/Program\ Files/Cursors/bart.ani} @@ -129,7 +130,7 @@ TkGetCursorByName(interp, tkwin, string) if (Tcl_IsSafe(interp)) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't get cursor from a file in", - " a safe interpreter", (char *) NULL); + " a safe interpreter", NULL); ckfree((char *) argv); ckfree((char *) cursorPtr); return NULL; @@ -139,6 +140,7 @@ TkGetCursorByName(interp, tkwin, string) /* * Check for the cursor in the system cursor set. */ + for (namePtr = cursorNames; namePtr->name != NULL; namePtr++) { if (strcmp(namePtr->name, argv[0]) == 0) { cursorPtr->winCursor = LoadCursor(NULL, namePtr->id); @@ -148,9 +150,10 @@ TkGetCursorByName(interp, tkwin, string) if (cursorPtr->winCursor == NULL) { /* - * Hmm, it is not in the system cursor set. Check to see - * if it is one of our application resources. + * Hmm, it is not in the system cursor set. Check to see if it is + * one of our application resources. */ + cursorPtr->winCursor = LoadCursor(Tk_GetHINSTANCE(), argv[0]); } else { cursorPtr->system = 1; @@ -161,8 +164,7 @@ TkGetCursorByName(interp, tkwin, string) ckfree((char *) cursorPtr); badCursorSpec: ckfree((char *) argv); - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad cursor spec \"", string, "\"", - (char *) NULL); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad cursor spec \"", string, "\"", NULL); return NULL; } else { ckfree((char *) argv); @@ -187,15 +189,14 @@ TkGetCursorByName(interp, tkwin, string) */ TkCursor * -TkCreateCursorFromData(tkwin, source, mask, width, height, xHot, yHot, - fgColor, bgColor) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Window in which cursor will be used. */ - CONST char *source; /* Bitmap data for cursor shape. */ - CONST char *mask; /* Bitmap data for cursor mask. */ - int width, height; /* Dimensions of cursor. */ - int xHot, yHot; /* Location of hot-spot in cursor. */ - XColor fgColor; /* Foreground color for cursor. */ - XColor bgColor; /* Background color for cursor. */ +TkCreateCursorFromData( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Window in which cursor will be used. */ + CONST char *source, /* Bitmap data for cursor shape. */ + CONST char *mask, /* Bitmap data for cursor mask. */ + int width, int height, /* Dimensions of cursor. */ + int xHot, int yHot, /* Location of hot-spot in cursor. */ + XColor fgColor, /* Foreground color for cursor. */ + XColor bgColor) /* Background color for cursor. */ { return NULL; } @@ -218,8 +219,8 @@ TkCreateCursorFromData(tkwin, source, mask, width, height, xHot, yHot, */ void -TkpFreeCursor(cursorPtr) - TkCursor *cursorPtr; +TkpFreeCursor( + TkCursor *cursorPtr) { TkWinCursor *winCursorPtr = (TkWinCursor *) cursorPtr; } @@ -229,8 +230,8 @@ TkpFreeCursor(cursorPtr) * * TkpSetCursor -- * - * Set the global cursor. If the cursor is None, then use the - * default Tk cursor. + * Set the global cursor. If the cursor is None, then use the default Tk + * cursor. * * Results: * None. @@ -242,8 +243,8 @@ TkpFreeCursor(cursorPtr) */ void -TkpSetCursor(cursor) - TkpCursor cursor; +TkpSetCursor( + TkpCursor cursor) { HCURSOR hcursor; TkWinCursor *winCursor = (TkWinCursor *) cursor; @@ -258,3 +259,11 @@ TkpSetCursor(cursor) SetCursor(hcursor); } } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWinDialog.c b/win/tkWinDialog.c index 2664351..9183f20 100644 --- a/win/tkWinDialog.c +++ b/win/tkWinDialog.c @@ -8,7 +8,7 @@ * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinDialog.c,v 1.42 2005/11/11 05:13:44 chengyemao Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinDialog.c,v 1.43 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ * */ @@ -121,6 +121,26 @@ static const struct {int type; int btnIds[3];} allowedTypes[] = { #define NUM_TYPES (sizeof(allowedTypes) / sizeof(allowedTypes[0])) /* + * Abstract trivial differences between Win32 and Win64. + */ + +#ifdef _WIN64 +#define TkWinGetHInstance(from) \ + ((HINSTANCE) GetWindowLongPtr((from), GWLP_HINSTANCE)) +#define TkWinGetUserData(from) \ + GetWindowLongPtr((from), GWLP_USERDATA) +#define TkWinSetUserData(to,what) \ + SetWindowLongPtr((to), GWLP_USERDATA, (LPARAM)(what)) +#else +#define TkWinGetHInstance(from) \ + ((HINSTANCE) GetWindowLong((from), GWL_HINSTANCE)) +#define TkWinGetUserData(from) \ + GetWindowLong((from), GWL_USERDATA) +#define TkWinSetUserData(to,what) \ + SetWindowLong((to), GWL_USERDATA, (LPARAM)(what)) +#endif + +/* * The value of TK_MULTI_MAX_PATH dictactes how many files can be retrieved * with tk_get*File -multiple 1. It must be allocated on the stack, so make it * large enough but not too large. - hobbs @@ -697,11 +717,7 @@ GetFileNameW( ZeroMemory(&ofn, sizeof(OPENFILENAMEW)); ofn.lStructSize = sizeof(OPENFILENAMEW); ofn.hwndOwner = hWnd; -#ifdef _WIN64 - ofn.hInstance = (HINSTANCE) GetWindowLongPtr(ofn.hwndOwner,GWLP_HINSTANCE); -#else - ofn.hInstance = (HINSTANCE) GetWindowLong(ofn.hwndOwner, GWL_HINSTANCE); -#endif + ofn.hInstance = TkWinGetHInstance(ofn.hwndOwner); ofn.lpstrFile = (WCHAR *) file; ofn.nMaxFile = TK_MULTI_MAX_PATH; ofn.Flags = OFN_HIDEREADONLY | OFN_PATHMUSTEXIST | OFN_NOCHANGEDIR @@ -935,11 +951,7 @@ OFNHookProcW( OPENFILENAMEW *ofnPtr; if (uMsg == WM_INITDIALOG) { -#ifdef _WIN64 - SetWindowLongPtr(hdlg, GWLP_USERDATA, lParam); -#else - SetWindowLong(hdlg, GWL_USERDATA, lParam); -#endif + TkWinSetUserData(hdlg, lParam); } else if (uMsg == WM_WINDOWPOSCHANGED) { /* * This message is delivered at the right time to enable Tk to set the @@ -947,20 +959,12 @@ OFNHookProcW( * information every time it gets a WM_WINDOWPOSCHANGED message. */ -#ifdef _WIN64 - ofnPtr = (OPENFILENAMEW *) GetWindowLongPtr(hdlg, GWLP_USERDATA); -#else - ofnPtr = (OPENFILENAMEW *) GetWindowLong(hdlg, GWL_USERDATA); -#endif + ofnPtr = (OPENFILENAMEW *) TkWinGetUserData(hdlg); if (ofnPtr != NULL) { hdlg = GetParent(hdlg); tsdPtr->debugInterp = (Tcl_Interp *) ofnPtr->lCustData; Tcl_DoWhenIdle(SetTkDialog, (ClientData) hdlg); -#ifdef _WIN64 - SetWindowLongPtr(hdlg, GWLP_USERDATA, (LPARAM) NULL); -#else - SetWindowLong(hdlg, GWL_USERDATA, (LPARAM) NULL); -#endif + TkWinSetUserData(hdlg, NULL); } } return 0; @@ -1132,11 +1136,7 @@ GetFileNameA( ofn.lStructSize = sizeof(ofn); ofn.hwndOwner = hWnd; -#ifdef _WIN64 - ofn.hInstance = (HINSTANCE) GetWindowLongPtr(ofn.hwndOwner,GWLP_HINSTANCE); -#else - ofn.hInstance = (HINSTANCE) GetWindowLong(ofn.hwndOwner, GWL_HINSTANCE); -#endif + ofn.hInstance = TkWinGetHInstance(ofn.hwndOwner); ofn.lpstrFilter = NULL; ofn.lpstrCustomFilter = NULL; ofn.nMaxCustFilter = 0; @@ -1379,11 +1379,7 @@ OFNHookProc( OPENFILENAME *ofnPtr; if (uMsg == WM_INITDIALOG) { -#ifdef _WIN64 - SetWindowLongPtr(hdlg, GWLP_USERDATA, lParam); -#else - SetWindowLong(hdlg, GWL_USERDATA, lParam); -#endif + TkWinSetUserData(hdlg, lParam); } else if (uMsg == WM_WINDOWPOSCHANGED) { /* * This message is delivered at the right time to both old-style and @@ -1392,22 +1388,14 @@ OFNHookProc( * every time it gets a WM_WINDOWPOSCHANGED message. */ -#ifdef _WIN64 - ofnPtr = (OPENFILENAME *) GetWindowLongPtr(hdlg, GWLP_USERDATA); -#else - ofnPtr = (OPENFILENAME *) GetWindowLong(hdlg, GWL_USERDATA); -#endif + ofnPtr = (OPENFILENAME *) TkWinGetUserData(hdlg); if (ofnPtr != NULL) { if (ofnPtr->Flags & OFN_EXPLORER) { hdlg = GetParent(hdlg); } tsdPtr->debugInterp = (Tcl_Interp *) ofnPtr->lCustData; Tcl_DoWhenIdle(SetTkDialog, (ClientData) hdlg); -#ifdef _WIN64 - SetWindowLongPtr(hdlg, GWLP_USERDATA, (LPARAM) NULL); -#else - SetWindowLong(hdlg, GWL_USERDATA, (LPARAM) NULL); -#endif + TkWinSetUserData(hdlg, NULL); } } return 0; @@ -1859,11 +1847,7 @@ ChooseDirectoryValidateProc( chooseDirSharedData = (CHOOSEDIRDATA *)lpData; -#ifdef _WIN64 - SetWindowLongPtr(hwnd, GWLP_USERDATA, lpData); -#else - SetWindowLong(hwnd, GWL_USERDATA, lpData); -#endif + TkWinSetUserData(hwnd, lpData); if (tsdPtr->debugFlag) { tsdPtr->debugInterp = (Tcl_Interp *) chooseDirSharedData->interp; @@ -2264,6 +2248,7 @@ ConvertExternalFilename( * Change the pathname to the Tcl "normalized" pathname, where back * slashes are used instead of forward slashes */ + if (*p == '\\') { *p = '/'; } diff --git a/win/tkWinDraw.c b/win/tkWinDraw.c index e1ef315..cf97f8f 100644 --- a/win/tkWinDraw.c +++ b/win/tkWinDraw.c @@ -1,16 +1,16 @@ -/* +/* * tkWinDraw.c -- * - * This file contains the Xlib emulation functions pertaining to - * actually drawing objects on a window. + * This file contains the Xlib emulation functions pertaining to actually + * drawing objects on a window. * * Copyright (c) 1995 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * Copyright (c) 1994 Software Research Associates, Inc. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinDraw.c,v 1.15 2005/08/09 07:39:23 das Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinDraw.c,v 1.16 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkWinInt.h" @@ -46,9 +46,9 @@ int tkpWinRopModes[] = { }; /* - * Translation table between X gc functions and Win32 BitBlt op modes. Some - * of the operations defined in X don't have names, so we have to construct - * new opcodes for those functions. This is arcane and probably not all that + * Translation table between X gc functions and Win32 BitBlt op modes. Some of + * the operations defined in X don't have names, so we have to construct new + * opcodes for those functions. This is arcane and probably not all that * useful, but at least it's accurate. */ @@ -77,9 +77,9 @@ int tkpWinBltModes[] = { }; /* - * The following raster op uses the source bitmap as a mask for the - * pattern. This is used to draw in a foreground color but leave the - * background color transparent. + * The following raster op uses the source bitmap as a mask for the pattern. + * This is used to draw in a foreground color but leave the background color + * transparent. */ #define MASKPAT 0x00E20746 /* dest = (src & pat) | (!src & dst) */ @@ -103,29 +103,27 @@ int tkpWinBltModes[] = { * The followng typedef is used to pass Windows GDI drawing functions. */ -typedef BOOL (CALLBACK *WinDrawFunc) _ANSI_ARGS_((HDC dc, - CONST POINT* points, int npoints)); +typedef BOOL (CALLBACK *WinDrawFunc)(HDC dc, CONST POINT* points, int npoints); typedef struct ThreadSpecificData { - POINT *winPoints; /* Array of points that is reused. */ - int nWinPoints; /* Current size of point array. */ + POINT *winPoints; /* Array of points that is reused. */ + int nWinPoints; /* Current size of point array. */ } ThreadSpecificData; static Tcl_ThreadDataKey dataKey; /* - * Forward declarations for procedures defined in this file: + * Forward declarations for functions defined in this file: */ -static POINT * ConvertPoints _ANSI_ARGS_((XPoint *points, int npoints, - int mode, RECT *bbox)); -static void DrawOrFillArc _ANSI_ARGS_((Display *display, - Drawable d, GC gc, int x, int y, - unsigned int width, unsigned int height, - int start, int extent, int fill)); -static void RenderObject _ANSI_ARGS_((HDC dc, GC gc, - XPoint* points, int npoints, int mode, HPEN pen, - WinDrawFunc func)); -static HPEN SetUpGraphicsPort _ANSI_ARGS_((GC gc)); +static POINT * ConvertPoints(XPoint *points, int npoints, int mode, + RECT *bbox); +static void DrawOrFillArc(Display *display, Drawable d, GC gc, + int x, int y, unsigned int width, + unsigned int height, int start, int extent, + int fill); +static void RenderObject(HDC dc, GC gc, XPoint* points, + int npoints, int mode, HPEN pen, WinDrawFunc func); +static HPEN SetUpGraphicsPort(GC gc); /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -135,21 +133,21 @@ static HPEN SetUpGraphicsPort _ANSI_ARGS_((GC gc)); * Retrieve the DC from a drawable. * * Results: - * Returns the window DC for windows. Returns a new memory DC - * for pixmaps. + * Returns the window DC for windows. Returns a new memory DC for + * pixmaps. * * Side effects: - * Sets up the palette for the device context, and saves the old - * device context state in the passed in TkWinDCState structure. + * Sets up the palette for the device context, and saves the old device + * context state in the passed in TkWinDCState structure. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ HDC -TkWinGetDrawableDC(display, d, state) - Display *display; - Drawable d; - TkWinDCState* state; +TkWinGetDrawableDC( + Display *display, + Drawable d, + TkWinDCState *state) { HDC dc; TkWinDrawable *twdPtr = (TkWinDrawable *)d; @@ -157,7 +155,7 @@ TkWinGetDrawableDC(display, d, state) if (twdPtr->type == TWD_WINDOW) { TkWindow *winPtr = twdPtr->window.winPtr; - + dc = GetDC(twdPtr->window.handle); if (winPtr == NULL) { cmap = DefaultColormap(display, DefaultScreen(display)); @@ -194,12 +192,13 @@ TkWinGetDrawableDC(display, d, state) */ void -TkWinReleaseDrawableDC(d, dc, state) - Drawable d; - HDC dc; - TkWinDCState *state; +TkWinReleaseDrawableDC( + Drawable d, + HDC dc, + TkWinDCState *state) { TkWinDrawable *twdPtr = (TkWinDrawable *)d; + SetBkMode(dc, state->bkmode); SelectPalette(dc, state->palette, TRUE); RealizePalette(dc); @@ -221,26 +220,26 @@ TkWinReleaseDrawableDC(d, dc, state) * Returns the converted array of POINTs. * * Side effects: - * Allocates a block of memory in thread local storage that - * should not be freed. + * Allocates a block of memory in thread local storage that should not be + * freed. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static POINT * -ConvertPoints(points, npoints, mode, bbox) - XPoint *points; - int npoints; - int mode; /* CoordModeOrigin or CoordModePrevious. */ - RECT *bbox; /* Bounding box of points. */ +ConvertPoints( + XPoint *points, + int npoints, + int mode, /* CoordModeOrigin or CoordModePrevious. */ + RECT *bbox) /* Bounding box of points. */ { - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); int i; /* - * To avoid paying the cost of a malloc on every drawing routine, - * we reuse the last array if it is large enough. + * To avoid paying the cost of a malloc on every drawing routine, we reuse + * the last array if it is large enough. */ if (npoints > tsdPtr->nWinPoints) { @@ -257,7 +256,7 @@ ConvertPoints(points, npoints, mode, bbox) bbox->left = bbox->right = points[0].x; bbox->top = bbox->bottom = points[0].y; - + if (mode == CoordModeOrigin) { for (i = 0; i < npoints; i++) { tsdPtr->winPoints[i].x = points[i].x; @@ -294,21 +293,20 @@ ConvertPoints(points, npoints, mode, bbox) * None. * * Side effects: - * Data is moved from a window or bitmap to a second window or - * bitmap. + * Data is moved from a window or bitmap to a second window or bitmap. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -XCopyArea(display, src, dest, gc, src_x, src_y, width, height, dest_x, dest_y) - Display* display; - Drawable src; - Drawable dest; - GC gc; - int src_x, src_y; - unsigned int width, height; - int dest_x, dest_y; +XCopyArea( + Display *display, + Drawable src, + Drawable dest, + GC gc, + int src_x, int src_y, + unsigned int width, unsigned int height, + int dest_x, int dest_y) { HDC srcDC, destDC; TkWinDCState srcState, destState; @@ -343,10 +341,9 @@ XCopyArea(display, src, dest, gc, src_x, src_y, width, height, dest_x, dest_y) * * XCopyPlane -- * - * Copies a bitmap from a source drawable to a destination - * drawable. The plane argument specifies which bit plane of - * the source contains the bitmap. Note that this implementation - * ignores the gc->function. + * Copies a bitmap from a source drawable to a destination drawable. The + * plane argument specifies which bit plane of the source contains the + * bitmap. Note that this implementation ignores the gc->function. * * Results: * None. @@ -358,16 +355,15 @@ XCopyArea(display, src, dest, gc, src_x, src_y, width, height, dest_x, dest_y) */ void -XCopyPlane(display, src, dest, gc, src_x, src_y, width, height, dest_x, - dest_y, plane) - Display* display; - Drawable src; - Drawable dest; - GC gc; - int src_x, src_y; - unsigned int width, height; - int dest_x, dest_y; - unsigned long plane; +XCopyPlane( + Display *display, + Drawable src, + Drawable dest, + GC gc, + int src_x, int src_y, + unsigned int width, unsigned int height, + int dest_x, int dest_y, + unsigned long plane) { HDC srcDC, destDC; TkWinDCState srcState, destState; @@ -389,12 +385,10 @@ XCopyPlane(display, src, dest, gc, src_x, src_y, width, height, dest_x, } if (clipPtr == NULL || clipPtr->type == TKP_CLIP_REGION) { - /* - * Case 1: opaque bitmaps. Windows handles the conversion - * from one bit to multiple bits by setting 0 to the - * foreground color, and 1 to the background color (seems - * backwards, but there you are). + * Case 1: opaque bitmaps. Windows handles the conversion from one bit + * to multiple bits by setting 0 to the foreground color, and 1 to the + * background color (seems backwards, but there you are). */ if (clipPtr && clipPtr->type == TKP_CLIP_REGION) { @@ -414,8 +408,8 @@ XCopyPlane(display, src, dest, gc, src_x, src_y, width, height, dest_x, /* * Case 2: transparent bitmaps are handled by setting the - * destination to the foreground color whenever the source - * pixel is set. + * destination to the foreground color whenever the source pixel + * is set. */ fgBrush = CreateSolidBrush(gc->foreground); @@ -427,9 +421,9 @@ XCopyPlane(display, src, dest, gc, src_x, src_y, width, height, dest_x, } else { /* - * Case 3: two arbitrary bitmaps. Copy the source rectangle - * into a color pixmap. Use the result as a brush when - * copying the clip mask into the destination. + * Case 3: two arbitrary bitmaps. Copy the source rectangle into a + * color pixmap. Use the result as a brush when copying the clip + * mask into the destination. */ HDC memDC, maskDC; @@ -445,9 +439,9 @@ XCopyPlane(display, src, dest, gc, src_x, src_y, width, height, dest_x, SelectObject(memDC, bitmap); /* - * Set foreground bits. We create a new bitmap containing - * (source AND mask), then use it to set the foreground color - * into the destination. + * Set foreground bits. We create a new bitmap containing (source + * AND mask), then use it to set the foreground color into the + * destination. */ BitBlt(memDC, 0, 0, width, height, srcDC, src_x, src_y, SRCCOPY); @@ -459,8 +453,8 @@ XCopyPlane(display, src, dest, gc, src_x, src_y, width, height, dest_x, MASKPAT); /* - * Set background bits. Same as foreground, except we use - * ((NOT source) AND mask) and the background brush. + * Set background bits. Same as foreground, except we use ((NOT + * source) AND mask) and the background brush. */ BitBlt(memDC, 0, 0, width, height, srcDC, src_x, src_y, @@ -491,8 +485,8 @@ XCopyPlane(display, src, dest, gc, src_x, src_y, width, height, dest_x, * * TkPutImage -- * - * Copies a subimage from an in-memory image to a rectangle of - * of the specified drawable. + * Copies a subimage from an in-memory image to a rectangle of of the + * specified drawable. * * Results: * None. @@ -504,19 +498,18 @@ XCopyPlane(display, src, dest, gc, src_x, src_y, width, height, dest_x, */ void -TkPutImage(colors, ncolors, display, d, gc, image, src_x, src_y, dest_x, - dest_y, width, height) - unsigned long *colors; /* Array of pixel values used by this - * image. May be NULL. */ - int ncolors; /* Number of colors used, or 0. */ - Display* display; - Drawable d; /* Destination drawable. */ - GC gc; - XImage* image; /* Source image. */ - int src_x, src_y; /* Offset of subimage. */ - int dest_x, dest_y; /* Position of subimage origin in - * drawable. */ - unsigned int width, height; /* Dimensions of subimage. */ +TkPutImage( + unsigned long *colors, /* Array of pixel values used by this image. + * May be NULL. */ + int ncolors, /* Number of colors used, or 0. */ + Display *display, + Drawable d, /* Destination drawable. */ + GC gc, + XImage *image, /* Source image. */ + int src_x, int src_y, /* Offset of subimage. */ + int dest_x, int dest_y, /* Position of subimage origin in drawable. */ + unsigned int width, unsigned int height) + /* Dimensions of subimage. */ { HDC dc, dcMem; TkWinDCState state; @@ -532,8 +525,8 @@ TkPutImage(colors, ncolors, display, d, gc, image, src_x, src_y, dest_x, if (image->bits_per_pixel == 1) { /* - * If the image isn't in the right format, we have to copy - * it into a new buffer in MSBFirst and word-aligned format. + * If the image isn't in the right format, we have to copy it into a + * new buffer in MSBFirst and word-aligned format. */ if ((image->bitmap_bit_order != MSBFirst) @@ -547,22 +540,22 @@ TkPutImage(colors, ncolors, display, d, gc, image, src_x, src_y, dest_x, } SetTextColor(dc, gc->foreground); SetBkColor(dc, gc->background); - } else { + } else { int i, usePalette; /* * Do not use a palette for TrueColor images. */ - + usePalette = (image->bits_per_pixel < 16); - + if (usePalette) { - infoPtr = (BITMAPINFO*) ckalloc(sizeof(BITMAPINFOHEADER) + infoPtr = (BITMAPINFO *) ckalloc(sizeof(BITMAPINFOHEADER) + sizeof(RGBQUAD)*ncolors); } else { - infoPtr = (BITMAPINFO*) ckalloc(sizeof(BITMAPINFOHEADER)); + infoPtr = (BITMAPINFO *) ckalloc(sizeof(BITMAPINFOHEADER)); } - + infoPtr->bmiHeader.biSize = sizeof(BITMAPINFOHEADER); infoPtr->bmiHeader.biWidth = image->width; infoPtr->bmiHeader.biHeight = -image->height; /* Top-down order */ @@ -589,7 +582,7 @@ TkPutImage(colors, ncolors, display, d, gc, image, src_x, src_y, dest_x, image->data, infoPtr, DIB_RGB_COLORS); ckfree((char *) infoPtr); } - if(!bitmap) { + if (!bitmap) { Tcl_Panic("Fail to allocate bitmap\n"); DeleteDC(dcMem); TkWinReleaseDrawableDC(d, dc, &state); @@ -619,12 +612,12 @@ TkPutImage(colors, ncolors, display, d, gc, image, src_x, src_y, dest_x, */ void -XFillRectangles(display, d, gc, rectangles, nrectangles) - Display* display; - Drawable d; - GC gc; - XRectangle* rectangles; - int nrectangles; +XFillRectangles( + Display *display, + Drawable d, + GC gc, + XRectangle *rectangles, + int nrectangles) { HDC dc; int i; @@ -656,7 +649,7 @@ XFillRectangles(display, d, gc, rectangles, nrectangles) /* * Select stipple pattern into destination dc. */ - + stipple = CreatePatternBrush(twdPtr->bitmap.handle); SetBrushOrgEx(dc, gc->ts_x_origin, gc->ts_y_origin, NULL); oldBrush = SelectObject(dc, stipple); @@ -664,7 +657,7 @@ XFillRectangles(display, d, gc, rectangles, nrectangles) /* * For each rectangle, create a drawing surface which is the size of - * the rectangle and fill it with the background color. Then merge the + * the rectangle and fill it with the background color. Then merge the * result with the stipple pattern. */ @@ -688,7 +681,7 @@ XFillRectangles(display, d, gc, rectangles, nrectangles) SelectObject(dcMem, oldBitmap); DeleteObject(bitmap); } - + DeleteDC(dcMem); SelectObject(dc, oldBrush); DeleteObject(stipple); @@ -706,7 +699,7 @@ XFillRectangles(display, d, gc, rectangles, nrectangles) HPEN newPen = CreatePen(PS_NULL, 0, gc->foreground); HPEN oldPen = SelectObject(dc, newPen); oldBrush = SelectObject(dc, brush); - + for (i = 0; i < nrectangles; i++) { Rectangle(dc, rectangles[i].x, rectangles[i].y, rectangles[i].x + rectangles[i].width + 1, @@ -727,8 +720,8 @@ XFillRectangles(display, d, gc, rectangles, nrectangles) * * RenderObject -- * - * This function draws a shape using a list of points, a - * stipple pattern, and the specified drawing function. + * This function draws a shape using a list of points, a stipple pattern, + * and the specified drawing function. * * Results: * None. @@ -740,20 +733,20 @@ XFillRectangles(display, d, gc, rectangles, nrectangles) */ static void -RenderObject(dc, gc, points, npoints, mode, pen, func) - HDC dc; - GC gc; - XPoint* points; - int npoints; - int mode; - HPEN pen; - WinDrawFunc func; +RenderObject( + HDC dc, + GC gc, + XPoint *points, + int npoints, + int mode, + HPEN pen, + WinDrawFunc func) { RECT rect; HPEN oldPen; HBRUSH oldBrush; POINT *winPoints = ConvertPoints(points, npoints, mode, &rect); - + if ((gc->fill_style == FillStippled || gc->fill_style == FillOpaqueStippled) && gc->stipple != None) { @@ -764,7 +757,7 @@ RenderObject(dc, gc, points, npoints, mode, pen, func) HBITMAP oldBitmap; int i; HBRUSH oldMemBrush; - + if (twdPtr->type != TWD_BITMAP) { Tcl_Panic("unexpected drawable type in stipple"); } @@ -784,7 +777,7 @@ RenderObject(dc, gc, points, npoints, mode, pen, func) /* * Select stipple pattern into destination dc. */ - + SetBrushOrgEx(dc, gc->ts_x_origin, gc->ts_y_origin, NULL); oldBrush = SelectObject(dc, CreatePatternBrush(twdPtr->bitmap.handle)); @@ -792,7 +785,7 @@ RenderObject(dc, gc, points, npoints, mode, pen, func) * Create temporary drawing surface containing a copy of the * destination equal in size to the bounding box of the object. */ - + dcMem = CreateCompatibleDC(dc); oldBitmap = SelectObject(dcMem, CreateCompatibleBitmap(dc, width, height)); @@ -801,7 +794,7 @@ RenderObject(dc, gc, points, npoints, mode, pen, func) /* * Translate the object for rendering in the temporary drawing - * surface. + * surface. */ for (i = 0; i < npoints; i++) { @@ -822,8 +815,8 @@ RenderObject(dc, gc, points, npoints, mode, pen, func) /* * If we are rendering an opaque stipple, then draw the polygon in the - * background color and copy it to the destination wherever the pattern - * is clear. + * background color and copy it to the destination wherever the + * pattern is clear. */ if (gc->fill_style == FillOpaqueStippled) { @@ -870,18 +863,18 @@ RenderObject(dc, gc, points, npoints, mode, pen, func) */ void -XDrawLines(display, d, gc, points, npoints, mode) - Display* display; - Drawable d; - GC gc; - XPoint* points; - int npoints; - int mode; +XDrawLines( + Display *display, + Drawable d, + GC gc, + XPoint *points, + int npoints, + int mode) { HPEN pen; TkWinDCState state; HDC dc; - + if (d == None) { return; } @@ -892,7 +885,7 @@ XDrawLines(display, d, gc, points, npoints, mode) SetBkMode(dc, TRANSPARENT); RenderObject(dc, gc, points, npoints, mode, pen, Polyline); DeleteObject(pen); - + TkWinReleaseDrawableDC(d, dc, &state); } @@ -913,14 +906,14 @@ XDrawLines(display, d, gc, points, npoints, mode) */ void -XFillPolygon(display, d, gc, points, npoints, shape, mode) - Display* display; - Drawable d; - GC gc; - XPoint* points; - int npoints; - int shape; - int mode; +XFillPolygon( + Display *display, + Drawable d, + GC gc, + XPoint *points, + int npoints, + int shape, + int mode) { HPEN pen; TkWinDCState state; @@ -955,14 +948,12 @@ XFillPolygon(display, d, gc, points, npoints, shape, mode) */ void -XDrawRectangle(display, d, gc, x, y, width, height) - Display* display; - Drawable d; - GC gc; - int x; - int y; - unsigned int width; - unsigned int height; +XDrawRectangle( + Display *display, + Drawable d, + GC gc, + int x, int y, + unsigned int width, unsigned int height) { HPEN pen, oldPen; TkWinDCState state; @@ -1005,16 +996,13 @@ XDrawRectangle(display, d, gc, x, y, width, height) */ void -XDrawArc(display, d, gc, x, y, width, height, start, extent) - Display* display; - Drawable d; - GC gc; - int x; - int y; - unsigned int width; - unsigned int height; - int start; - int extent; +XDrawArc( + Display *display, + Drawable d, + GC gc, + int x, int y, + unsigned int width, unsigned int height, + int start, int extent) { display->request++; @@ -1038,16 +1026,13 @@ XDrawArc(display, d, gc, x, y, width, height, start, extent) */ void -XFillArc(display, d, gc, x, y, width, height, start, extent) - Display* display; - Drawable d; - GC gc; - int x; - int y; - unsigned int width; - unsigned int height; - int start; - int extent; +XFillArc( + Display *display, + Drawable d, + GC gc, + int x, int y, + unsigned int width, unsigned int height, + int start, int extent) { display->request++; @@ -1059,8 +1044,8 @@ XFillArc(display, d, gc, x, y, width, height, start, extent) * * DrawOrFillArc -- * - * This procedure handles the rendering of drawn or filled - * arcs and chords. + * This function handles the rendering of drawn or filled arcs and + * chords. * * Results: * None. @@ -1072,15 +1057,15 @@ XFillArc(display, d, gc, x, y, width, height, start, extent) */ static void -DrawOrFillArc(display, d, gc, x, y, width, height, start, extent, fill) - Display *display; - Drawable d; - GC gc; - int x, y; /* left top */ - unsigned int width, height; - int start; /* start: three-o'clock (deg*64) */ - int extent; /* extent: relative (deg*64) */ - int fill; /* ==0 draw, !=0 fill */ +DrawOrFillArc( + Display *display, + Drawable d, + GC gc, + int x, int y, /* left top */ + unsigned int width, unsigned int height, + int start, /* start: three-o'clock (deg*64) */ + int extent, /* extent: relative (deg*64) */ + int fill) /* ==0 draw, !=0 fill */ { HDC dc; HBRUSH brush, oldBrush; @@ -1121,7 +1106,7 @@ DrawOrFillArc(display, d, gc, x, y, width, height, start, extent, fill) /* * Now compute points on the radial lines that define the starting and - * ending angles. Be sure to take into account that the y-coordinate + * ending angles. Be sure to take into account that the y-coordinate * system is inverted. */ @@ -1133,18 +1118,18 @@ DrawOrFillArc(display, d, gc, x, y, width, height, start, extent, fill) yend = (int)((yr + sin(-radian_end)*height/2.0) + 0.5); /* - * Now draw a filled or open figure. Note that we have to - * increase the size of the bounding box by one to account for the - * difference in pixel definitions between X and Windows. + * Now draw a filled or open figure. Note that we have to increase the + * size of the bounding box by one to account for the difference in pixel + * definitions between X and Windows. */ pen = SetUpGraphicsPort(gc); oldPen = SelectObject(dc, pen); if (!fill) { /* - * Note that this call will leave a gap of one pixel at the - * end of the arc for thin arcs. We can't use ArcTo because - * it's only supported under Windows NT. + * Note that this call will leave a gap of one pixel at the end of the + * arc for thin arcs. We can't use ArcTo because it's only supported + * under Windows NT. */ SetBkMode(dc, TRANSPARENT); @@ -1180,8 +1165,8 @@ DrawOrFillArc(display, d, gc, x, y, width, height, start, extent, fill) */ static HPEN -SetUpGraphicsPort(gc) - GC gc; +SetUpGraphicsPort( + GC gc) { DWORD style; @@ -1190,10 +1175,9 @@ SetUpGraphicsPort(gc) /* pointer to the dash-list */ /* - * Below is a simple translation of serveral dash patterns - * to valid windows pen types. Far from complete, - * but I don't know how to do it better. - * Any ideas: <mailto:j.nijtmans@chello.nl> + * Below is a simple translation of serveral dash patterns to valid + * windows pen types. Far from complete, but I don't know how to do it + * better. Any ideas: <mailto:j.nijtmans@chello.nl> */ if (p[1] && p[2]) { @@ -1223,27 +1207,27 @@ SetUpGraphicsPort(gc) style |= PS_GEOMETRIC; switch (gc->cap_style) { - case CapNotLast: - case CapButt: - style |= PS_ENDCAP_FLAT; - break; - case CapRound: - style |= PS_ENDCAP_ROUND; - break; - default: - style |= PS_ENDCAP_SQUARE; - break; + case CapNotLast: + case CapButt: + style |= PS_ENDCAP_FLAT; + break; + case CapRound: + style |= PS_ENDCAP_ROUND; + break; + default: + style |= PS_ENDCAP_SQUARE; + break; } switch (gc->join_style) { - case JoinMiter: - style |= PS_JOIN_MITER; - break; - case JoinRound: - style |= PS_JOIN_ROUND; - break; - default: - style |= PS_JOIN_BEVEL; - break; + case JoinMiter: + style |= PS_JOIN_MITER; + break; + case JoinRound: + style |= PS_JOIN_ROUND; + break; + default: + style |= PS_JOIN_BEVEL; + break; } return ExtCreatePen(style, gc->line_width, &lb, 0, NULL); } @@ -1254,13 +1238,13 @@ SetUpGraphicsPort(gc) * * TkScrollWindow -- * - * Scroll a rectangle of the specified window and accumulate - * a damage region. + * Scroll a rectangle of the specified window and accumulate a damage + * region. * * Results: - * Returns 0 if the scroll genereated no additional damage. - * Otherwise, sets the region that needs to be repainted after - * scrolling and returns 1. + * Returns 0 if the scroll genereated no additional damage. Otherwise, + * sets the region that needs to be repainted after scrolling and returns + * 1. * * Side effects: * Scrolls the bits in the window. @@ -1269,12 +1253,13 @@ SetUpGraphicsPort(gc) */ int -TkScrollWindow(tkwin, gc, x, y, width, height, dx, dy, damageRgn) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* The window to be scrolled. */ - GC gc; /* GC for window to be scrolled. */ - int x, y, width, height; /* Position rectangle to be scrolled. */ - int dx, dy; /* Distance rectangle should be moved. */ - TkRegion damageRgn; /* Region to accumulate damage in. */ +TkScrollWindow( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* The window to be scrolled. */ + GC gc, /* GC for window to be scrolled. */ + int x, int y, int width, int height, + /* Position rectangle to be scrolled. */ + int dx, int dy, /* Distance rectangle should be moved. */ + TkRegion damageRgn) /* Region to accumulate damage in. */ { HWND hwnd = TkWinGetHWND(Tk_WindowId(tkwin)); RECT scrollRect; @@ -1292,9 +1277,9 @@ TkScrollWindow(tkwin, gc, x, y, width, height, dx, dy, damageRgn) * * TkWinFillRect -- * - * This routine fills a rectangle with the foreground color - * from the specified GC ignoring all other GC values. This - * is the fastest way to fill a drawable with a solid color. + * This routine fills a rectangle with the foreground color from the + * specified GC ignoring all other GC values. This is the fastest way to + * fill a drawable with a solid color. * * Results: * None. @@ -1306,10 +1291,10 @@ TkScrollWindow(tkwin, gc, x, y, width, height, dx, dy, damageRgn) */ void -TkWinFillRect(dc, x, y, width, height, pixel) - HDC dc; - int x, y, width, height; - int pixel; +TkWinFillRect( + HDC dc, + int x, int y, int width, int height, + int pixel) { RECT rect; COLORREF oldColor; @@ -1329,30 +1314,30 @@ TkWinFillRect(dc, x, y, width, height, pixel) * * TkpDrawHighlightBorder -- * - * This procedure draws a rectangular ring around the outside of - * a widget to indicate that it has received the input focus. + * This function draws a rectangular ring around the outside of a widget + * to indicate that it has received the input focus. * - * On Windows, we just draw the simple inset ring. On other sytems, - * e.g. the Mac, the focus ring is a little more complicated, so we - * need this abstraction. + * On Windows, we just draw the simple inset ring. On other sytems, e.g. + * the Mac, the focus ring is a little more complicated, so we need this + * abstraction. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * A rectangle "width" pixels wide is drawn in "drawable", - * corresponding to the outer area of "tkwin". + * A rectangle "width" pixels wide is drawn in "drawable", corresponding + * to the outer area of "tkwin". * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -void -TkpDrawHighlightBorder(tkwin, fgGC, bgGC, highlightWidth, drawable) - Tk_Window tkwin; - GC fgGC; - GC bgGC; - int highlightWidth; - Drawable drawable; +void +TkpDrawHighlightBorder( + Tk_Window tkwin, + GC fgGC, + GC bgGC, + int highlightWidth, + Drawable drawable) { TkDrawInsetFocusHighlight(tkwin, fgGC, highlightWidth, drawable, 0); } @@ -1362,7 +1347,7 @@ TkpDrawHighlightBorder(tkwin, fgGC, bgGC, highlightWidth, drawable) * * TkpDrawFrame -- * - * This procedure draws the rectangular frame area. + * This function draws the rectangular frame area. * * Results: * None. @@ -1374,12 +1359,22 @@ TkpDrawHighlightBorder(tkwin, fgGC, bgGC, highlightWidth, drawable) */ void -TkpDrawFrame (Tk_Window tkwin, Tk_3DBorder border, - int highlightWidth, int borderWidth, int relief) +TkpDrawFrame( + Tk_Window tkwin, + Tk_3DBorder border, + int highlightWidth, + int borderWidth, + int relief) { - Tk_Fill3DRectangle(tkwin, Tk_WindowId(tkwin), - border, highlightWidth, highlightWidth, - Tk_Width(tkwin) - 2 * highlightWidth, - Tk_Height(tkwin) - 2 * highlightWidth, - borderWidth, relief); + Tk_Fill3DRectangle(tkwin, Tk_WindowId(tkwin), border, highlightWidth, + highlightWidth, Tk_Width(tkwin) - 2 * highlightWidth, + Tk_Height(tkwin) - 2 * highlightWidth, borderWidth, relief); } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWinEmbed.c b/win/tkWinEmbed.c index 40cbd3a..9b5150c 100644 --- a/win/tkWinEmbed.c +++ b/win/tkWinEmbed.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* +/* * tkWinEmbed.c -- * * This file contains platform specific procedures for Windows platforms @@ -8,52 +8,50 @@ * * Copyright (c) 1996-1997 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinEmbed.c,v 1.28 2005/01/27 15:29:22 chengyemao Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinEmbed.c,v 1.29 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkWinInt.h" /* * One of the following structures exists for each container in this - * application. It keeps track of the container window and its - * associated embedded window. + * application. It keeps track of the container window and its associated + * embedded window. */ typedef struct Container { - HWND parentHWnd; /* Windows HWND to the parent window */ - TkWindow *parentPtr; /* Tk's information about the container - * or NULL if the container isn't - * in this process. */ - HWND embeddedHWnd; /* Windows HWND to the embedded window - */ - TkWindow *embeddedPtr; /* Tk's information about the embedded - * window, or NULL if the - * embedded application isn't in - * this process. */ - HWND embeddedMenuHWnd; /* Tk's embedded menu window handler */ - struct Container *nextPtr; /* Next in list of all containers in - * this process. */ + HWND parentHWnd; /* Windows HWND to the parent window */ + TkWindow *parentPtr; /* Tk's information about the container or + * NULL if the container isn't in this + * process. */ + HWND embeddedHWnd; /* Windows HWND to the embedded window. */ + TkWindow *embeddedPtr; /* Tk's information about the embedded window, + * or NULL if the embedded application isn't + * in this process. */ + HWND embeddedMenuHWnd; /* Tk's embedded menu window handler. */ + struct Container *nextPtr; /* Next in list of all containers in this + * process. */ } Container; typedef struct ThreadSpecificData { - Container *firstContainerPtr; /* First in list of all containers - * managed by this process. */ + Container *firstContainerPtr; + /* First in list of all containers managed by + * this process. */ } ThreadSpecificData; static Tcl_ThreadDataKey dataKey; -static void ContainerEventProc _ANSI_ARGS_((ClientData clientData, - XEvent *eventPtr)); -static void EmbeddedEventProc _ANSI_ARGS_(( - ClientData clientData, XEvent *eventPtr)); -static void EmbedGeometryRequest _ANSI_ARGS_(( - Container*containerPtr, int width, int height)); -static void EmbedWindowDeleted _ANSI_ARGS_((TkWindow *winPtr)); -static void Tk_MapEmbeddedWindow _ANSI_ARGS_((TkWindow* winPtr)); -HWND Tk_GetEmbeddedHWnd _ANSI_ARGS_((TkWindow* winPtr)); - +static void ContainerEventProc(ClientData clientData, + XEvent *eventPtr); +static void EmbeddedEventProc(ClientData clientData, + XEvent *eventPtr); +static void EmbedGeometryRequest(Container *containerPtr, + int width, int height); +static void EmbedWindowDeleted(TkWindow *winPtr); +static void Tk_MapEmbeddedWindow(TkWindow* winPtr); +HWND Tk_GetEmbeddedHWnd(TkWindow* winPtr); /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -71,15 +69,15 @@ HWND Tk_GetEmbeddedHWnd _ANSI_ARGS_((TkWindow* winPtr)); *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -void TkWinCleanupContainerList(void) +void +TkWinCleanupContainerList(void) { Container *nextPtr; - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); - - for (; - tsdPtr->firstContainerPtr != (Container *) NULL; - tsdPtr->firstContainerPtr = nextPtr) { + + for (; tsdPtr->firstContainerPtr != (Container *) NULL; + tsdPtr->firstContainerPtr = nextPtr) { nextPtr = tsdPtr->firstContainerPtr->nextPtr; ckfree((char *) tsdPtr->firstContainerPtr); } @@ -104,11 +102,11 @@ void TkWinCleanupContainerList(void) /* ARGSUSED */ int -TkpTestembedCmd(clientData, interp, argc, argv) - ClientData clientData; - Tcl_Interp *interp; - int argc; - CONST char **argv; +TkpTestembedCmd( + ClientData clientData, + Tcl_Interp *interp, + int argc, + CONST char **argv) { return TCL_OK; } @@ -128,14 +126,15 @@ TkpTestembedCmd(clientData, interp, argc, argv) * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -static -void Tk_DetachEmbeddedWindow(winPtr, detachFlag) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* an embedded window */ - BOOL detachFlag; /* a flag of truely detaching */ + +static +void +Tk_DetachEmbeddedWindow( + TkWindow *winPtr, /* an embedded window */ + BOOL detachFlag) /* a flag of truely detaching */ { TkpWinToplevelDetachWindow(winPtr); - if(detachFlag) - { + if(detachFlag) { TkpWinToplevelOverrideRedirect(winPtr, 0); } } @@ -145,9 +144,9 @@ void Tk_DetachEmbeddedWindow(winPtr, detachFlag) * * Tk_MapEmbeddedWindow -- * - * This function is required for mapping an embedded window during - * idle. The input winPtr must be preserved using Tcl_Preserve before - * call this function and will be released by this function. + * This function is required for mapping an embedded window during idle. + * The input winPtr must be preserved using Tcl_Preserve before call this + * function and will be released by this function. * * Results: * No return value. Map the embedded window if it is not dead. @@ -157,66 +156,71 @@ void Tk_DetachEmbeddedWindow(winPtr, detachFlag) * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -static -void Tk_MapEmbeddedWindow(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Top-level window that's about to - * be mapped. */ + +static +void Tk_MapEmbeddedWindow( + TkWindow *winPtr) /* Top-level window that's about to be + * mapped. */ { if(!(winPtr->flags & TK_ALREADY_DEAD)) { HWND hwnd = (HWND)winPtr->privatePtr; int state = SendMessage(hwnd, TK_STATE, -1, -1) - 1; - if(state < 0 || state > 3) { + + if (state < 0 || state > 3) { state = NormalState; - } - while(Tcl_DoOneEvent(TCL_IDLE_EVENTS)); - TkpWmSetState(winPtr, state); + } + + while (Tcl_DoOneEvent(TCL_IDLE_EVENTS)) { + /* empty body */ + } + + TkpWmSetState(winPtr, state); TkWmMapWindow(winPtr); } Tcl_Release((ClientData)winPtr); } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkpUseWindow -- * - * This procedure causes a Tk window to use a given Windows handle - * for a window as its underlying window, rather than a new Windows - * window being created automatically. It is invoked by an embedded - * application to specify the window in which the application is - * embedded. + * This procedure causes a Tk window to use a given Windows handle for a + * window as its underlying window, rather than a new Windows window + * being created automatically. It is invoked by an embedded application + * to specify the window in which the application is embedded. * - * This procedure uses a simple attachment protocol by sending - * TK_INFO messages to the window to use with two sub messages: + * This procedure uses a simple attachment protocol by sending TK_INFO + * messages to the window to use with two sub messages: * - * TK_CONTAINER_VERIFY - if a window handles this message, - * it should return either a (long)hwnd for a container or - * a -(long)hwnd for a non-container. + * TK_CONTAINER_VERIFY - if a window handles this message, it should + * return either a (long)hwnd for a container or a -(long)hwnd + * for a non-container. * - * TK_CONTAINER_ISAVAILABLE - a container window should return - * either a TRUE (non-zero) if it is available for use or - * a FALSE (zero) othersize. + * TK_CONTAINER_ISAVAILABLE - a container window should return either + * a TRUE (non-zero) if it is available for use or a FALSE (zero) + * othersize. * - * The TK_INFO messages are required in order to verify if the window - * to use is a valid container. Without an id verification, an invalid + * The TK_INFO messages are required in order to verify if the window to + * use is a valid container. Without an id verification, an invalid * window attachment may cause unexpected crashes/panics (bug 1096074). - * Additional sub messages may be definded/used in future for other + * Additional sub messages may be definded/used in future for other * needs. - * - * We do not enforce the above protocol for the reason of backward - * compatibility. If the window to use is unable to handle TK_INFO - * messages (e.g., legacy Tk container applications before 8.5), - * a dialog box with a warning message pops up and the user is asked - * to confirm if the attachment should proceed. However, we may have - * to enforce it in future. - * + * + * We do not enforce the above protocol for the reason of backward + * compatibility. If the window to use is unable to handle TK_INFO + * messages (e.g., legacy Tk container applications before 8.5), a dialog + * box with a warning message pops up and the user is asked to confirm if + * the attachment should proceed. However, we may have to enforce it in + * future. + * * Results: - * The return value is normally TCL_OK. If an error occurred (such as - * if the argument does not identify a legal Windows window handle or - * it is already in use or a cancel button is pressed by a user in - * confirming the use window as a Tk container) the return value is - * TCL_ERROR and an error message is left in the the interp's result - * if interp is not NULL. + * The return value is normally TCL_OK. If an error occurred (such as if + * the argument does not identify a legal Windows window handle or it is + * already in use or a cancel button is pressed by a user in confirming + * the use window as a Tk container) the return value is TCL_ERROR and an + * error message is left in the the interp's result if interp is not + * NULL. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -224,28 +228,30 @@ void Tk_MapEmbeddedWindow(winPtr) *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -int -TkpUseWindow(interp, tkwin, string) - Tcl_Interp *interp; /* If not NULL, used for error reporting - * if string is bogus. */ - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Tk window that does not yet have an +int +TkpUseWindow( + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* If not NULL, used for error reporting if + * string is bogus. */ + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Tk window that does not yet have an * associated X window. */ - CONST char *string; /* String identifying an X window to use - * for tkwin; must be an integer value. */ + CONST char *string) /* String identifying an X window to use for + * tkwin; must be an integer value. */ { TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) tkwin; int id; HWND hwnd; - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); + /* - if(winPtr->window != None) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't modify container after widget is created", (char *) NULL); + if (winPtr->window != None) { + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't modify container after widget is created", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } */ - if(strcmp(string, "") == 0) { - if(winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED) { + + if (strcmp(string, "") == 0) { + if (winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED) { Tk_DetachEmbeddedWindow(winPtr, TRUE); } return TCL_OK; @@ -255,7 +261,9 @@ TkpUseWindow(interp, tkwin, string) return TCL_ERROR; } hwnd = (HWND) id; - if((HWND)winPtr->privatePtr == hwnd) return TCL_OK; + if ((HWND)winPtr->privatePtr == hwnd) { + return TCL_OK; + } /* * Check if the window is a valid handle. If it is invalid, return @@ -264,32 +272,35 @@ TkpUseWindow(interp, tkwin, string) */ if (!IsWindow(hwnd)) { - if (interp != (Tcl_Interp *) NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "window \"", string, - "\" doesn't exist", (char *) NULL); + if (interp != NULL) { + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "window \"", string, + "\" doesn't exist", NULL); } return TCL_ERROR; } id = SendMessage(hwnd, TK_INFO, TK_CONTAINER_VERIFY, 0); - if(id == (long)hwnd) { - if(!SendMessage(hwnd, TK_INFO, TK_CONTAINER_ISAVAILABLE, 0)) { + if (id == (long)hwnd) { + if (!SendMessage(hwnd, TK_INFO, TK_CONTAINER_ISAVAILABLE, 0)) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "The container is already in use", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } - } else if(id == -(long)hwnd) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "the window to use is not a Tk container", NULL); - return TCL_ERROR; + } else if (id == -(long)hwnd) { + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "the window to use is not a Tk container", + NULL); + return TCL_ERROR; } else { /* - * Proceed if the user decide to do so because it can be a legacy - * container application. However we may have to return a TCL_ERROR - * in order to avoid bug 1096074 in future. + * Proceed if the user decide to do so because it can be a legacy + * container application. However we may have to return a TCL_ERROR in + * order to avoid bug 1096074 in future. */ + char msg[256]; sprintf(msg, "Unable to get information of window \"%s\". Attach to this\nwindow may have unpredictable results if it is not a valid container.\n\nPress Ok to proceed or Cancel to abort attaching.", string); - if(IDCANCEL == MessageBox(hwnd, msg, "Tk Warning", MB_OKCANCEL | MB_ICONWARNING)) { - Tcl_SetResult(interp, "Operation has been canceled", TCL_STATIC); + if (IDCANCEL == MessageBox(hwnd, msg, "Tk Warning", + MB_OKCANCEL | MB_ICONWARNING)) { + Tcl_SetResult(interp, "Operation has been canceled", TCL_STATIC); return TCL_ERROR; } } @@ -306,9 +317,10 @@ TkpUseWindow(interp, tkwin, string) winPtr->flags &= (~(TK_MAPPED)); /* - * Preserve the winPtr and create an idle handler to - * map the embedded window - */ + * Preserve the winPtr and create an idle handler to map the embedded + * window. + */ + Tcl_Preserve((ClientData)winPtr); Tcl_DoWhenIdle(Tk_MapEmbeddedWindow,(ClientData)winPtr); @@ -320,10 +332,10 @@ TkpUseWindow(interp, tkwin, string) * * TkpMakeContainer -- * - * This procedure is called to indicate that a particular window will - * be a container for an embedded application. This changes certain - * aspects of the window's behavior, such as whether it will receive - * events anymore. + * This procedure is called to indicate that a particular window will be + * a container for an embedded application. This changes certain aspects + * of the window's behavior, such as whether it will receive events + * anymore. * * Results: * None. @@ -335,17 +347,17 @@ TkpUseWindow(interp, tkwin, string) */ void -TkpMakeContainer(tkwin) - Tk_Window tkwin; +TkpMakeContainer( + Tk_Window tkwin) { TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) tkwin; Container *containerPtr; - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); - + /* - * Register the window as a container so that, for example, we can - * find out later if the embedded app. is in the same process. + * Register the window as a container so that, for example, we can find + * out later if the embedded app. is in the same process. */ Tk_MakeWindowExist(tkwin); @@ -360,18 +372,17 @@ TkpMakeContainer(tkwin) winPtr->flags |= TK_CONTAINER; /* - * Unlike in tkUnixEmbed.c, we don't make any requests for events - * in the embedded window here. Now we just allow the embedding - * of another TK application into TK windows. When the embedded - * window makes a request, that will be done by sending to the - * container window a WM_USER message, which will be intercepted - * by TkWinContainerProc. + * Unlike in tkUnixEmbed.c, we don't make any requests for events in the + * embedded window here. Now we just allow the embedding of another TK + * application into TK windows. When the embedded window makes a request, + * that will be done by sending to the container window a WM_USER message, + * which will be intercepted by TkWinContainerProc. * * We need to get structure events of the container itself, though. */ Tk_CreateEventHandler(tkwin, StructureNotifyMask, - ContainerEventProc, (ClientData) containerPtr); + ContainerEventProc, (ClientData) containerPtr); } /* @@ -380,8 +391,8 @@ TkpMakeContainer(tkwin) * EmbeddedEventProc -- * * This procedure is invoked by the Tk event dispatcher when various - * useful events are received for a window that is embedded in - * another application. + * useful events are received for a window that is embedded in another + * application. * * Results: * None. @@ -394,9 +405,9 @@ TkpMakeContainer(tkwin) */ static void -EmbeddedEventProc(clientData, eventPtr) - ClientData clientData; /* Token for container window. */ - XEvent *eventPtr; /* ResizeRequest event. */ +EmbeddedEventProc( + ClientData clientData, /* Token for container window. */ + XEvent *eventPtr) /* ResizeRequest event. */ { TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) clientData; @@ -410,32 +421,31 @@ EmbeddedEventProc(clientData, eventPtr) * * TkWinEmbeddedEventProc -- * - * This procedure is invoked by the Tk event dispatcher when - * various useful events are received for the *children* of a - * container window. It forwards relevant information, such as - * geometry requests, from the events into the container's - * application. + * This procedure is invoked by the Tk event dispatcher when various + * useful events are received for the *children* of a container window. + * It forwards relevant information, such as geometry requests, from the + * events into the container's application. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * Depends on the event. For example, when ConfigureRequest events - * occur, geometry information gets set for the container window. + * Depends on the event. For example, when ConfigureRequest events occur, + * geometry information gets set for the container window. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ LRESULT -TkWinEmbeddedEventProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) - HWND hwnd; - UINT message; - WPARAM wParam; - LPARAM lParam; +TkWinEmbeddedEventProc( + HWND hwnd, + UINT message, + WPARAM wParam, + LPARAM lParam) { int result = 1; Container *containerPtr; - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); /* @@ -454,76 +464,80 @@ TkWinEmbeddedEventProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) topwinPtr = containerPtr->parentPtr; } switch (message) { - case TK_INFO: - /* An embedded window may send this message for container - * verification and availability before attach. + case TK_INFO: + /* + * An embedded window may send this message for container + * verification and availability before attach. * * wParam - a sub message * - * TK_CONTAINER_ISAVAILABLE - if the container is - * available for use? + * TK_CONTAINER_ISAVAILABLE - if the container is available + * for use? * result = 1 for yes and 0 for no; * - * TK_CONTAINER_VERIFY - request the container to - * verify its identification + * TK_CONTAINER_VERIFY - request the container to verify its + * identification * result = (long)hwnd if this window is a container * -(long)hwnd otherwise * * lParam - N/A */ + switch(wParam) { - case TK_CONTAINER_ISAVAILABLE: + case TK_CONTAINER_ISAVAILABLE: result = containerPtr->embeddedHWnd == NULL? 1:0; break; - - case TK_CONTAINER_VERIFY: + case TK_CONTAINER_VERIFY: result = (long)containerPtr->parentHWnd; break; - - default: + default: result = 0; } break; - case TK_ATTACHWINDOW: - /* An embedded window (either from this application or from - * another application) is trying to attach to this container. - * We attach it only if this container is not yet containing any + case TK_ATTACHWINDOW: + /* + * An embedded window (either from this application or from + * another application) is trying to attach to this container. We + * attach it only if this container is not yet containing any * window. * * wParam - a handle of an embedded window * lParam - N/A * * An embedded window may send this message with a wParam of NULL - * to test if a window is able to provide embedding service. The - * container returns its window handle for accepting the attachment - * and identifying itself or a zero for being already in use. + * to test if a window is able to provide embedding service. The + * container returns its window handle for accepting the + * attachment and identifying itself or a zero for being already + * in use. * * Return value: * 0 - the container is unable to be used. - * hwnd - the container is ready to be used. + * hwnd - the container is ready to be used. */ if (containerPtr->embeddedHWnd == NULL) { - if(wParam) { - TkWindow* winPtr = (TkWindow*)Tk_HWNDToWindow((HWND)wParam); - if(winPtr) { + if (wParam) { + TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) + Tk_HWNDToWindow((HWND) wParam); + if (winPtr) { winPtr->flags |= TK_BOTH_HALVES; containerPtr->embeddedPtr = winPtr; containerPtr->parentPtr->flags |= TK_BOTH_HALVES; } containerPtr->embeddedHWnd = (HWND)wParam; } - result = (long)containerPtr->parentHWnd; + result = (long)containerPtr->parentHWnd; } else { result = 0; } break; - case TK_DETACHWINDOW: - /* An embedded window notifies the container that it is detached. + case TK_DETACHWINDOW: + /* + * An embedded window notifies the container that it is detached. * The container should clearn the related variables and redraw * its window. - * + * * wParam - N/A * lParam - N/A * @@ -531,15 +545,19 @@ TkWinEmbeddedEventProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) * 0 - the message is not processed. * others - the message is processed. */ + containerPtr->embeddedMenuHWnd = NULL; containerPtr->embeddedHWnd = NULL; containerPtr->parentPtr->flags &= ~TK_BOTH_HALVES; - if(topwinPtr) TkWinSetMenu((Tk_Window)topwinPtr, 0); + if (topwinPtr) { + TkWinSetMenu((Tk_Window) topwinPtr, 0); + } InvalidateRect(hwnd, NULL, TRUE); break; - case TK_GEOMETRYREQ: - /* An embedded window requests a window size change. + case TK_GEOMETRYREQ: + /* + * An embedded window requests a window size change. * * wParam - window width * lParam - window height @@ -548,41 +566,46 @@ TkWinEmbeddedEventProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) * 0 - the message is not processed. * others - the message is processed. */ + EmbedGeometryRequest(containerPtr, (int)wParam, lParam); break; - case TK_RAISEWINDOW: - /* An embedded window requests to change its Z-order - * - * wParam - a window handle as a z-order stack reference + case TK_RAISEWINDOW: + /* + * An embedded window requests to change its Z-order. + * + * wParam - a window handle as a z-order stack reference * lParam - a flag of above-below: 0 - above; 1 or others: - below - * + * * Return value: * 0 - the message is not processed. * others - the message is processed. */ - TkWinSetWindowPos(GetParent(containerPtr->parentHWnd), (HWND)wParam, (int)lParam); + + TkWinSetWindowPos(GetParent(containerPtr->parentHWnd), + (HWND)wParam, (int)lParam); break; - case TK_GETFRAMEWID: - /* An embedded window requests to get the frame window's id + case TK_GETFRAMEWID: + /* + * An embedded window requests to get the frame window's id. * * wParam - N/A * lParam - N/A * * Return vlaue: * - * A handle of the frame window. If it is not availble, a - * zeor is returned. + * A handle of the frame window. If it is not availble, a zero is + * returned. */ - if(topwinPtr) { + if (topwinPtr) { result = (long)GetParent(containerPtr->parentHWnd); } else { topwinPtr = containerPtr->parentPtr; while (!(topwinPtr->flags & TK_TOP_HIERARCHY)) { topwinPtr = topwinPtr->parentPtr; } - if(topwinPtr && topwinPtr->window) { + if (topwinPtr && topwinPtr->window) { result = (long)GetParent(Tk_GetHWND(topwinPtr->window)); } else { result = 0; @@ -590,26 +613,29 @@ TkWinEmbeddedEventProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) } break; - case TK_CLAIMFOCUS: - /* An embedded window requests a focus - * - * wParam - a flag of forcing focus + case TK_CLAIMFOCUS: + /* + * An embedded window requests a focus. + * + * wParam - a flag of forcing focus * lParam - N/A * * Return value: * 0 - the message is not processed * 1 - the message is processed */ - if(!SetFocus(containerPtr->embeddedHWnd) && wParam) { + + if (!SetFocus(containerPtr->embeddedHWnd) && wParam) { /* * forcing focus TBD */ } break; - case TK_WITHDRAW: - /* An embedded window requests withdraw - * + case TK_WITHDRAW: + /* + * An embedded window requests withdraw. + * * wParam - N/A * lParam - N/A * @@ -617,15 +643,18 @@ TkWinEmbeddedEventProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) * 0 - the message is not processed * 1 - the message is processed */ - if(topwinPtr) + + if (topwinPtr) { TkpWinToplevelWithDraw(topwinPtr); - else + } else { result = 0; + } break; - case TK_ICONIFY: - /* An embedded window requests iconification - * + case TK_ICONIFY: + /* + * An embedded window requests iconification. + * * wParam - N/A * lParam - N/A * @@ -633,15 +662,18 @@ TkWinEmbeddedEventProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) * 0 - the message is not processed * 1 - the message is processed */ - if(topwinPtr) + + if (topwinPtr) { TkpWinToplevelIconify(topwinPtr); - else + } else { result = 0; + } break; - case TK_DEICONIFY: - /* An embedded window requests deiconification - * + case TK_DEICONIFY: + /* + * An embedded window requests deiconification. + * * wParam - N/A * lParam - N/A * @@ -649,31 +681,35 @@ TkWinEmbeddedEventProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) * 0 - the message is not processed * 1 - the message is processed */ - if(topwinPtr) + if (topwinPtr) { TkpWinToplevelDeiconify(topwinPtr); - else + } else { result = 0; + } break; - case TK_MOVEWINDOW: - /* An embedded window requests to move position if - * both wParam and lParam are greater or equal to 0. + case TK_MOVEWINDOW: + /* + * An embedded window requests to move position if both wParam and + * lParam are greater or equal to 0. * wParam - x value of the frame's upper left * lParam - y value of the frame's upper left * - * Otherwise an embedded window requests the current - * position + * Otherwise an embedded window requests the current position + * + * Return value: an encoded window position in a 32bit long, i.e, + * ((x << 16) & 0xffff0000) | (y & 0xffff) * - * Return value: an encoded window position in a 32bit long, - * i.e, ((x << 16) & 0xffff0000) | (y & 0xffff) - * * Only a toplevel container may move the embedded. */ - result = TkpWinToplevelMove(containerPtr->parentPtr, wParam, lParam); + + result = TkpWinToplevelMove(containerPtr->parentPtr, + wParam, lParam); break; - case TK_OVERRIDEREDIRECT: - /* An embedded window request overrideredirect. + case TK_OVERRIDEREDIRECT: + /* + * An embedded window request overrideredirect. * * wParam * 0 - add a frame if there is no one @@ -683,18 +719,19 @@ TkWinEmbeddedEventProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) * lParam - N/A * * Return value: - * 1 + the current value of overrideredirect if the container is - * a toplevel. Otherwise 0. + * 1 + the current value of overrideredirect if the container is a + * toplevel. Otherwise 0. */ - if(topwinPtr) { - result = 1+TkpWinToplevelOverrideRedirect(topwinPtr, wParam); + if (topwinPtr) { + result = 1 + TkpWinToplevelOverrideRedirect(topwinPtr, wParam); } else { result = 0; } break; - case TK_SETMENU: - /* An embedded requests to set a menu + case TK_SETMENU: + /* + * An embedded requests to set a menu. * * wParam - a menu handle * lParam - a menu window handle @@ -703,7 +740,7 @@ TkWinEmbeddedEventProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) * 1 - the message is processed * 0 - the message is not processed */ - if(topwinPtr) { + if (topwinPtr) { containerPtr->embeddedMenuHWnd = (HWND)lParam; TkWinSetMenu((Tk_Window)topwinPtr, (HMENU)wParam); } else { @@ -711,8 +748,9 @@ TkWinEmbeddedEventProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) } break; - case TK_STATE: - /* An embedded window request set/get state services + case TK_STATE: + /* + * An embedded window request set/get state services. * * wParam - service directive * 0 - 3 for setting state @@ -727,8 +765,9 @@ TkWinEmbeddedEventProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) * Return value * 1 + the current state or 0 if the container is not a toplevel */ - if(topwinPtr) { - if(wParam >= 0 && wParam <= 3) { + + if (topwinPtr) { + if (wParam >= 0 && wParam <= 3) { TkpWmSetState(topwinPtr, wParam); } result = 1+TkpWmGetState(topwinPtr); @@ -738,19 +777,19 @@ TkWinEmbeddedEventProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) break; /* - * Return 0 since the current Tk container implementation - * is unable to provide following services. - * + * Return 0 since the current Tk container implementation is + * unable to provide following services. */ - default: - result = 0; + default: + result = 0; break; } } else { - if(message == TK_INFO && wParam == TK_CONTAINER_VERIFY) { + if ((message == TK_INFO) && (wParam == TK_CONTAINER_VERIFY)) { /* * Reply the message sender: this is not a Tk container */ + return -(long)hwnd; } else { result = 0; @@ -765,39 +804,40 @@ TkWinEmbeddedEventProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) * * EmbedGeometryRequest -- * - * This procedure is invoked when an embedded application requests - * a particular size. It processes the request (which may or may - * not actually resize the window) and reflects the results back - * to the embedded application. + * This procedure is invoked when an embedded application requests a + * particular size. It processes the request (which may or may not + * actually resize the window) and reflects the results back to the + * embedded application. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * If we deny the child's size change request, a Configure event - * is synthesized to let the child know that the size is the same - * as it used to be. Events get processed while we're waiting for - * the geometry managers to do their thing. + * If we deny the child's size change request, a Configure event is + * synthesized to let the child know that the size is the same as it used + * to be. Events get processed while we're waiting for the geometry + * managers to do their thing. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -EmbedGeometryRequest(containerPtr, width, height) - Container *containerPtr; /* Information about the container window. */ - int width, height; /* Size that the child has requested. */ +EmbedGeometryRequest( + Container *containerPtr, /* Information about the container window. */ + int width, int height) /* Size that the child has requested. */ { - TkWindow * winPtr = containerPtr->parentPtr; - + TkWindow *winPtr = containerPtr->parentPtr; + /* - * Forward the requested size into our geometry management hierarchy - * via the container window. We need to send a Configure event back - * to the embedded application even if we decide not to resize - * the window; to make this happen, process all idle event handlers - * synchronously here (so that the geometry managers have had a - * chance to do whatever they want to do), and if the window's size - * didn't change then generate a configure event. + * Forward the requested size into our geometry management hierarchy via + * the container window. We need to send a Configure event back to the + * embedded application even if we decide not to resize the window; to + * make this happen, process all idle event handlers synchronously here + * (so that the geometry managers have had a chance to do whatever they + * want to do), and if the window's size didn't change then generate a + * configure event. */ + Tk_GeometryRequest((Tk_Window)winPtr, width, height); if (containerPtr->embeddedHWnd != NULL) { @@ -805,8 +845,8 @@ EmbedGeometryRequest(containerPtr, width, height) /* Empty loop body. */ } - SetWindowPos(containerPtr->embeddedHWnd, NULL, - 0, 0, winPtr->changes.width, winPtr->changes.height, SWP_NOZORDER); + SetWindowPos(containerPtr->embeddedHWnd, NULL, 0, 0, + winPtr->changes.width, winPtr->changes.height, SWP_NOZORDER); } } @@ -815,35 +855,41 @@ EmbedGeometryRequest(containerPtr, width, height) * * ContainerEventProc -- * - * This procedure is invoked by the Tk event dispatcher when - * various useful events are received for the container window. + * This procedure is invoked by the Tk event dispatcher when various + * useful events are received for the container window. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * Depends on the event. For example, when ConfigureRequest events - * occur, geometry information gets set for the container window. + * Depends on the event. For example, when ConfigureRequest events occur, + * geometry information gets set for the container window. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void -ContainerEventProc(clientData, eventPtr) - ClientData clientData; /* Token for container window. */ - XEvent *eventPtr; /* ResizeRequest event. */ +ContainerEventProc( + ClientData clientData, /* Token for container window. */ + XEvent *eventPtr) /* ResizeRequest event. */ { Container *containerPtr = (Container *)clientData; Tk_Window tkwin = (Tk_Window)containerPtr->parentPtr; if (eventPtr->type == ConfigureNotify) { - /* Resize the embedded window, if there is any */ + /* + * Resize the embedded window, if there is any. + */ + if (containerPtr->embeddedHWnd) { - SetWindowPos(containerPtr->embeddedHWnd, NULL, - 0, 0, Tk_Width(tkwin), Tk_Height(tkwin), SWP_NOZORDER); + SetWindowPos(containerPtr->embeddedHWnd, NULL, 0, 0, + Tk_Width(tkwin), Tk_Height(tkwin), SWP_NOZORDER); } } else if (eventPtr->type == DestroyNotify) { - /* The container is gone, remove it from the list */ + /* + * The container is gone, remove it from the list. + */ + EmbedWindowDeleted(containerPtr->parentPtr); } } @@ -853,13 +899,13 @@ ContainerEventProc(clientData, eventPtr) * * TkpGetOtherWindow -- * - * If both the container and embedded window are in the same - * process, this procedure will return either one, given the other. + * If both the container and embedded window are in the same process, + * this procedure will return either one, given the other. * * Results: * If winPtr is a container, the return value is the token for the - * embedded window, and vice versa. If the "other" window isn't in - * this process, NULL is returned. + * embedded window, and vice versa. If the "other" window isn't in this + * process, NULL is returned. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -868,12 +914,12 @@ ContainerEventProc(clientData, eventPtr) */ TkWindow * -TkpGetOtherWindow(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Tk's structure for a container or - * embedded window. */ +TkpGetOtherWindow( + TkWindow *winPtr) /* Tk's structure for a container or embedded + * window. */ { Container *containerPtr; - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); for (containerPtr = tsdPtr->firstContainerPtr; containerPtr != NULL; @@ -906,11 +952,11 @@ TkpGetOtherWindow(winPtr) */ HWND -Tk_GetEmbeddedHWnd(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; +Tk_GetEmbeddedHWnd( + TkWindow *winPtr) { Container *containerPtr; - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); for (containerPtr = tsdPtr->firstContainerPtr; containerPtr != NULL; @@ -940,12 +986,12 @@ Tk_GetEmbeddedHWnd(winPtr) */ HWND -Tk_GetEmbeddedMenuHWND(tkwin) - Tk_Window tkwin; +Tk_GetEmbeddedMenuHWND( + Tk_Window tkwin) { TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow*)tkwin; Container *containerPtr; - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); for (containerPtr = tsdPtr->firstContainerPtr; containerPtr != NULL; @@ -962,10 +1008,10 @@ Tk_GetEmbeddedMenuHWND(tkwin) * * TkpClaimFocus -- * - * This procedure is invoked when someone asks or the input focus - * to be put on a window in an embedded application, but the - * application doesn't currently have the focus. It requests the - * input focus from the container application. + * This procedure is invoked when someone asks or the input focus to be + * put on a window in an embedded application, but the application + * doesn't currently have the focus. It requests the input focus from the + * container application. * * Results: * None. @@ -977,12 +1023,12 @@ Tk_GetEmbeddedMenuHWND(tkwin) */ void -TkpClaimFocus(topLevelPtr, force) - TkWindow *topLevelPtr; /* Top-level window containing desired - * focus window; should be embedded. */ - int force; /* One means that the container should - * claim the focus if it doesn't - * currently have it. */ +TkpClaimFocus( + TkWindow *topLevelPtr, /* Top-level window containing desired focus + * window; should be embedded. */ + int force) /* One means that the container should claim + * the focus if it doesn't currently have + * it. */ { HWND hwnd = GetParent(Tk_GetHWND(topLevelPtr->window)); SendMessage(hwnd, TK_CLAIMFOCUS, (WPARAM) force, 0); @@ -993,13 +1039,13 @@ TkpClaimFocus(topLevelPtr, force) * * TkpRedirectKeyEvent -- * - * This procedure is invoked when a key press or release event - * arrives for an application that does not believe it owns the - * input focus. This can happen because of embedding; for example, - * X can send an event to an embedded application when the real - * focus window is in the container application and is an ancestor - * of the container. This procedure's job is to forward the event - * back to the application where it really belongs. + * This procedure is invoked when a key press or release event arrives + * for an application that does not believe it owns the input focus. + * This can happen because of embedding; for example, X can send an event + * to an embedded application when the real focus window is in the + * container application and is an ancestor of the container. This + * procedure's job is to forward the event back to the application where + * it really belongs. * * Results: * None. @@ -1011,11 +1057,11 @@ TkpClaimFocus(topLevelPtr, force) */ void -TkpRedirectKeyEvent(winPtr, eventPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Window to which the event was originally +TkpRedirectKeyEvent( + TkWindow *winPtr, /* Window to which the event was originally * reported. */ - XEvent *eventPtr; /* X event to redirect (should be KeyPress - * or KeyRelease). */ + XEvent *eventPtr) /* X event to redirect (should be KeyPress or + * KeyRelease). */ { /* not implemented */ } @@ -1025,9 +1071,9 @@ TkpRedirectKeyEvent(winPtr, eventPtr) * * EmbedWindowDeleted -- * - * This procedure is invoked when a window involved in embedding - * (as either the container or the embedded application) is - * destroyed. It cleans up the Container structure for the window. + * This procedure is invoked when a window involved in embedding (as + * either the container or the embedded application) is destroyed. It + * cleans up the Container structure for the window. * * Results: * None. @@ -1039,19 +1085,18 @@ TkpRedirectKeyEvent(winPtr, eventPtr) */ static void -EmbedWindowDeleted(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Tk's information about window that - * was deleted. */ +EmbedWindowDeleted( + TkWindow *winPtr) /* Tk's information about window that was + * deleted. */ { Container *containerPtr, *prevPtr; - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); /* - * Find the Container structure for this window work. Delete the + * Find the Container structure for this window work. Delete the * information about the embedded application and free the container's - * record. - * The main container may be null. [Bug #476176] + * record. The main container may be null. [Bug #476176] */ prevPtr = NULL; @@ -1085,3 +1130,11 @@ EmbedWindowDeleted(winPtr) ckfree((char *) containerPtr); } } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWinFont.c b/win/tkWinFont.c index 98b24eb..35619c7 100644 --- a/win/tkWinFont.c +++ b/win/tkWinFont.c @@ -1,29 +1,29 @@ -/* +/* * tkWinFont.c -- * - * Contains the Windows implementation of the platform-independant - * font package interface. + * Contains the Windows implementation of the platform-independant font + * package interface. * - * Copyright (c) 1994 Software Research Associates, Inc. + * Copyright (c) 1994 Software Research Associates, Inc. * Copyright (c) 1995-1997 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * Copyright (c) 1998-1999 by Scriptics Corporation. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinFont.c,v 1.25 2004/08/09 23:45:58 mdejong Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinFont.c,v 1.26 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkWinInt.h" #include "tkFont.h" /* - * The following structure represents a font family. It is assumed that - * all screen fonts constructed from the same "font family" share certain - * properties; all screen fonts with the same "font family" point to a - * shared instance of this structure. The most important shared property - * is the character existence metrics, used to determine if a screen font - * can display a given Unicode character. + * The following structure represents a font family. It is assumed that all + * screen fonts constructed from the same "font family" share certain + * properties; all screen fonts with the same "font family" point to a shared + * instance of this structure. The most important shared property is the + * character existence metrics, used to determine if a screen font can display + * a given Unicode character. * * Under Windows, a "font family" is uniquely identified by its face name. */ @@ -36,69 +36,69 @@ typedef struct FontFamily { struct FontFamily *nextPtr; /* Next in list of all known font families. */ int refCount; /* How many SubFonts are referring to this - * FontFamily. When the refCount drops to + * FontFamily. When the refCount drops to * zero, this FontFamily may be freed. */ /* * Key. */ - + Tk_Uid faceName; /* Face name key for this FontFamily. */ /* * Derived properties. */ - + Tcl_Encoding encoding; /* Encoding for this font family. */ int isSymbolFont; /* Non-zero if this is a symbol font. */ - int isWideFont; /* 1 if this is a double-byte font, 0 + int isWideFont; /* 1 if this is a double-byte font, 0 * otherwise. */ BOOL (WINAPI *textOutProc)(HDC, int, int, TCHAR *, int); - /* The procedure to use to draw text after - * it has been converted from UTF-8 to the + /* The procedure to use to draw text after it + * has been converted from UTF-8 to the * encoding of this font. */ BOOL (WINAPI *getTextExtentPoint32Proc)(HDC, TCHAR *, int, LPSIZE); /* The procedure to use to measure text after - * it has been converted from UTF-8 to the + * it has been converted from UTF-8 to the * encoding of this font. */ char *fontMap[FONTMAP_PAGES]; /* Two-level sparse table used to determine * quickly if the specified character exists. * As characters are encountered, more pages - * in this table are dynamically added. The + * in this table are dynamically added. The * contents of each page is a bitmask * consisting of FONTMAP_BITSPERPAGE bits, * representing whether this font can be used * to display the given character at the - * corresponding bit position. The high bits + * corresponding bit position. The high bits * of the character are used to pick which * page of the table is used. */ /* * Cached Truetype font info. */ - + int segCount; /* The length of the following arrays. */ USHORT *startCount; /* Truetype information about the font, */ - USHORT *endCount; /* indicating which characters this font - * can display (malloced). The format of - * this information is (relatively) compact, - * but would take longer to search than - * indexing into the fontMap[][] table. */ + USHORT *endCount; /* indicating which characters this font can + * display (malloced). The format of this + * information is (relatively) compact, but + * would take longer to search than indexing + * into the fontMap[][] table. */ } FontFamily; /* - * The following structure encapsulates an individual screen font. A font + * The following structure encapsulates an individual screen font. A font * object is made up of however many SubFonts are necessary to display a * stream of multilingual characters. */ typedef struct SubFont { - char **fontMap; /* Pointer to font map from the FontFamily, + char **fontMap; /* Pointer to font map from the FontFamily, * cached here to save a dereference. */ - HFONT hFont; /* The specific screen font that will be - * used when displaying/measuring chars - * belonging to the FontFamily. */ + HFONT hFont; /* The specific screen font that will be used + * when displaying/measuring chars belonging + * to the FontFamily. */ FontFamily *familyPtr; /* The FontFamily for this SubFont. */ } SubFont; @@ -111,18 +111,18 @@ typedef struct SubFont { #define BASE_CHARS 128 typedef struct WinFont { - TkFont font; /* Stuff used by generic font package. Must - * be first in structure. */ + TkFont font; /* Stuff used by generic font package. Must be + * first in structure. */ SubFont staticSubFonts[SUBFONT_SPACE]; /* Builtin space for a limited number of * SubFonts. */ int numSubFonts; /* Length of following array. */ - SubFont *subFontArray; /* Array of SubFonts that have been loaded - * in order to draw/measure all the characters - * encountered by this font so far. All fonts + SubFont *subFontArray; /* Array of SubFonts that have been loaded in + * order to draw/measure all the characters + * encountered by this font so far. All fonts * start off with one SubFont initialized by * AllocFont() from the original set of font - * attributes. Usually points to + * attributes. Usually points to * staticSubFonts, but may point to malloced * space if there are lots of SubFonts. */ @@ -131,10 +131,10 @@ typedef struct WinFont { * offscreen measurements. */ int pixelSize; /* Original pixel size used when font was * constructed. */ - int widths[BASE_CHARS]; /* Widths of first 128 chars in the base - * font, for handling common case. The base - * font is always used to draw characters - * between 0x0000 and 0x007f. */ + int widths[BASE_CHARS]; /* Widths of first 128 chars in the base font, + * for handling common case. The base font is + * always used to draw characters between + * 0x0000 and 0x007f. */ } WinFont; /* @@ -168,11 +168,11 @@ static TkStateMap systemMap[] = { }; typedef struct ThreadSpecificData { - FontFamily *fontFamilyList; /* The list of font families that are - * currently loaded. As screen fonts - * are loaded, this list grows to hold - * information about what characters - * exist in each font family. */ + FontFamily *fontFamilyList; /* The list of font families that are + * currently loaded. As screen fonts are + * loaded, this list grows to hold information + * about what characters exist in each font + * family. */ Tcl_HashTable uidTable; } ThreadSpecificData; static Tcl_ThreadDataKey dataKey; @@ -180,7 +180,7 @@ static Tcl_ThreadDataKey dataKey; /* * Information cached about the system at startup time. */ - + static Tcl_Encoding systemEncoding; /* @@ -188,10 +188,10 @@ static Tcl_Encoding systemEncoding; */ static FontFamily * AllocFontFamily(HDC hdc, HFONT hFont, int base); -static SubFont * CanUseFallback(HDC hdc, WinFont *fontPtr, +static SubFont * CanUseFallback(HDC hdc, WinFont *fontPtr, char *fallbackName, int ch, SubFont **subFontPtrPtr); -static SubFont * CanUseFallbackWithAliases(HDC hdc, WinFont *fontPtr, +static SubFont * CanUseFallbackWithAliases(HDC hdc, WinFont *fontPtr, char *faceName, int ch, Tcl_DString *nameTriedPtr, SubFont **subFontPtrPtr); static int FamilyExists(HDC hdc, CONST char *faceName); @@ -204,44 +204,44 @@ static int FontMapLookup(SubFont *subFontPtr, int ch); static void FreeFontFamily(FontFamily *familyPtr); static HFONT GetScreenFont(CONST TkFontAttributes *faPtr, CONST char *faceName, int pixelSize); -static void InitFont(Tk_Window tkwin, HFONT hFont, +static void InitFont(Tk_Window tkwin, HFONT hFont, int overstrike, WinFont *tkFontPtr); -static void InitSubFont(HDC hdc, HFONT hFont, int base, +static void InitSubFont(HDC hdc, HFONT hFont, int base, SubFont *subFontPtr); -static int LoadFontRanges(HDC hdc, HFONT hFont, +static int LoadFontRanges(HDC hdc, HFONT hFont, USHORT **startCount, USHORT **endCount, int *symbolPtr); -static void MultiFontTextOut(HDC hdc, WinFont *fontPtr, +static void MultiFontTextOut(HDC hdc, WinFont *fontPtr, CONST char *source, int numBytes, int x, int y); static void ReleaseFont(WinFont *fontPtr); static void ReleaseSubFont(SubFont *subFontPtr); static int SeenName(CONST char *name, Tcl_DString *dsPtr); static void SwapLong(PULONG p); static void SwapShort(USHORT *p); -static int CALLBACK WinFontCanUseProc(ENUMLOGFONT *lfPtr, - NEWTEXTMETRIC *tmPtr, int fontType, +static int CALLBACK WinFontCanUseProc(ENUMLOGFONT *lfPtr, + NEWTEXTMETRIC *tmPtr, int fontType, LPARAM lParam); -static int CALLBACK WinFontExistProc(ENUMLOGFONT *lfPtr, - NEWTEXTMETRIC *tmPtr, int fontType, +static int CALLBACK WinFontExistProc(ENUMLOGFONT *lfPtr, + NEWTEXTMETRIC *tmPtr, int fontType, LPARAM lParam); -static int CALLBACK WinFontFamilyEnumProc(ENUMLOGFONT *lfPtr, - NEWTEXTMETRIC *tmPtr, int fontType, +static int CALLBACK WinFontFamilyEnumProc(ENUMLOGFONT *lfPtr, + NEWTEXTMETRIC *tmPtr, int fontType, LPARAM lParam); /* *------------------------------------------------------------------------- - * + * * TkpFontPkgInit -- * - * This procedure is called when an application is created. It - * initializes all the structures that are used by the - * platform-dependent code on a per application basis. + * This procedure is called when an application is created. It + * initializes all the structures that are used by the platform-dependent + * code on a per application basis. * * Results: - * None. + * None. * * Side effects: - * + * * None. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -253,9 +253,9 @@ TkpFontPkgInit( { if (TkWinGetPlatformId() == VER_PLATFORM_WIN32_NT) { /* - * If running NT, then we will be calling some Unicode functions - * explictly. So, even if the Tcl system encoding isn't Unicode, - * make sure we convert to/from the Unicode char set. + * If running NT, then we will be calling some Unicode functions + * explictly. So, even if the Tcl system encoding isn't Unicode, make + * sure we convert to/from the Unicode char set. */ systemEncoding = TkWinGetUnicodeEncoding(); @@ -270,17 +270,18 @@ TkpFontPkgInit( * Map a platform-specific native font name to a TkFont. * * Results: - * The return value is a pointer to a TkFont that represents the - * native font. If a native font by the given name could not be - * found, the return value is NULL. + + * The return value is a pointer to a TkFont that represents the native + * font. If a native font by the given name could not be found, the + * return value is NULL. * - * Every call to this procedure returns a new TkFont structure, - * even if the name has already been seen before. The caller should - * call TkpDeleteFont() when the font is no longer needed. + * Every call to this procedure returns a new TkFont structure, even if + * the name has already been seen before. The caller should call + * TkpDeleteFont() when the font is no longer needed. * - * The caller is responsible for initializing the memory associated - * with the generic TkFont when this function returns and releasing - * the contents of the generic TkFont before calling TkpDeleteFont(). + * The caller is responsible for initializing the memory associated with + * the generic TkFont when this function returns and releasing the + * contents of the generic TkFont before calling TkpDeleteFont(). * * Side effects: * Memory allocated. @@ -311,25 +312,25 @@ TkpGetNativeFont( /* *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- * - * TkpGetFontFromAttributes -- + * TkpGetFontFromAttributes -- * - * Given a desired set of attributes for a font, find a font with - * the closest matching attributes. + * Given a desired set of attributes for a font, find a font with the + * closest matching attributes. * * Results: - * The return value is a pointer to a TkFont that represents the - * font with the desired attributes. If a font with the desired - * attributes could not be constructed, some other font will be - * substituted automatically. NULL is never returned. + * The return value is a pointer to a TkFont that represents the font + * with the desired attributes. If a font with the desired attributes + * could not be constructed, some other font will be substituted + * automatically. NULL is never returned. * - * Every call to this procedure returns a new TkFont structure, - * even if the specified attributes have already been seen before. - * The caller should call TkpDeleteFont() to free the platform- - * specific data when the font is no longer needed. + * Every call to this procedure returns a new TkFont structure, even if + * the specified attributes have already been seen before. The caller + * should call TkpDeleteFont() to free the platform- specific data when + * the font is no longer needed. * - * The caller is responsible for initializing the memory associated - * with the generic TkFont when this function returns and releasing - * the contents of the generic TkFont before calling TkpDeleteFont(). + * The caller is responsible for initializing the memory associated with + * the generic TkFont when this function returns and releasing the + * contents of the generic TkFont before calling TkpDeleteFont(). * * Side effects: * Memory allocated. @@ -339,11 +340,11 @@ TkpGetNativeFont( TkFont * TkpGetFontFromAttributes( - TkFont *tkFontPtr, /* If non-NULL, store the information in - * this existing TkFont structure, rather than + TkFont *tkFontPtr, /* If non-NULL, store the information in this + * existing TkFont structure, rather than * allocating a new structure to hold the * font; the existing contents of the font - * will be released. If NULL, a new TkFont + * will be released. If NULL, a new TkFont * structure is allocated. */ Tk_Window tkwin, /* For display where font will be used. */ CONST TkFontAttributes *faPtr) @@ -399,10 +400,11 @@ TkpGetFontFromAttributes( } } - found: + found: ReleaseDC(hwnd, hdc); - hFont = GetScreenFont(faPtr, faceName, TkFontGetPixels(tkwin, faPtr->size)); + hFont = GetScreenFont(faPtr, faceName, + TkFontGetPixels(tkwin, faPtr->size)); if (tkFontPtr == NULL) { fontPtr = (WinFont *) ckalloc(sizeof(WinFont)); } else { @@ -420,9 +422,9 @@ TkpGetFontFromAttributes( * TkpDeleteFont -- * * Called to release a font allocated by TkpGetNativeFont() or - * TkpGetFontFromAttributes(). The caller should have already - * released the fields of the TkFont that are used exclusively by - * the generic TkFont code. + * TkpGetFontFromAttributes(). The caller should have already released + * the fields of the TkFont that are used exclusively by the generic + * TkFont code. * * Results: * None. @@ -448,8 +450,8 @@ TkpDeleteFont( * * TkpGetFontFamilies, WinFontFamilyEnumProc -- * - * Return information about the font families that are available - * on the display of the given window. + * Return information about the font families that are available on the + * display of the given window. * * Results: * Modifies interp's result object to hold a list of all the available @@ -460,12 +462,12 @@ TkpDeleteFont( * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ - + void TkpGetFontFamilies( Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Interp to hold result. */ Tk_Window tkwin) /* For display to query. */ -{ +{ HDC hdc; HWND hwnd; Window window; @@ -475,18 +477,18 @@ TkpGetFontFamilies( hdc = GetDC(hwnd); /* - * On any version NT, there may fonts with international names. - * Use the NT-only Unicode version of EnumFontFamilies to get the - * font names. If we used the ANSI version on a non-internationalized - * version of NT, we would get font names with '?' replacing all - * the international characters. + * On any version NT, there may fonts with international names. Use the + * NT-only Unicode version of EnumFontFamilies to get the font names. If + * we used the ANSI version on a non-internationalized version of NT, we + * would get font names with '?' replacing all the international + * characters. * - * On a non-internationalized verson of 95, fonts with international - * names are not allowed, so the ANSI version of EnumFontFamilies will - * work. On an internationalized version of 95, there may be fonts with - * international names; the ANSI version will work, fetching the - * name in the system code page. Can't use the Unicode version of - * EnumFontFamilies because it only exists under NT. + * On a non-internationalized verson of 95, fonts with international names + * are not allowed, so the ANSI version of EnumFontFamilies will work. On + * an internationalized version of 95, there may be fonts with + * international names; the ANSI version will work, fetching the name in + * the system code page. Can't use the Unicode version of EnumFontFamilies + * because it only exists under NT. */ if (TkWinGetPlatformId() == VER_PLATFORM_WIN32_NT) { @@ -495,10 +497,10 @@ TkpGetFontFamilies( } else { EnumFontFamiliesA(hdc, NULL, (FONTENUMPROCA) WinFontFamilyEnumProc, (LPARAM) interp); - } + } ReleaseDC(hwnd, hdc); } - + static int CALLBACK WinFontFamilyEnumProc( ENUMLOGFONT *lfPtr, /* Logical-font data. */ @@ -526,19 +528,19 @@ WinFontFamilyEnumProc( * * TkpGetSubFonts -- * - * A function used by the testing package for querying the actual - * screen fonts that make up a font object. + * A function used by the testing package for querying the actual screen + * fonts that make up a font object. * * Results: - * Modifies interp's result object to hold a list containing the - * names of the screen fonts that make up the given font object. + * Modifies interp's result object to hold a list containing the names of + * the screen fonts that make up the given font object. * * Side effects: * None. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ - + void TkpGetSubFonts( Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Interp to hold result. */ @@ -549,7 +551,7 @@ TkpGetSubFonts( FontFamily *familyPtr; Tcl_Obj *resultPtr, *strPtr; - resultPtr = Tcl_GetObjResult(interp); + resultPtr = Tcl_GetObjResult(interp); fontPtr = (WinFont *) tkfont; for (i = 0; i < fontPtr->numSubFonts; i++) { familyPtr = fontPtr->subFontArray[i].familyPtr; @@ -563,16 +565,14 @@ TkpGetSubFonts( * * Tk_MeasureChars -- * - * Determine the number of bytes from the string that will fit - * in the given horizontal span. The measurement is done under the - * assumption that Tk_DrawChars() will be used to actually display - * the characters. + * Determine the number of bytes from the string that will fit in the + * given horizontal span. The measurement is done under the assumption + * that Tk_DrawChars() will be used to actually display the characters. * * Results: - * The return value is the number of bytes from source that - * fit into the span that extends from 0 to maxLength. *lengthPtr is - * filled with the x-coordinate of the right edge of the last - * character that did fit. + * The return value is the number of bytes from source that fit into the + * span that extends from 0 to maxLength. *lengthPtr is filled with the + * x-coordinate of the right edge of the last character that did fit. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -583,25 +583,25 @@ TkpGetSubFonts( int Tk_MeasureChars( Tk_Font tkfont, /* Font in which characters will be drawn. */ - CONST char *source, /* UTF-8 string to be displayed. Need not be + CONST char *source, /* UTF-8 string to be displayed. Need not be * '\0' terminated. */ - int numBytes, /* Maximum number of bytes to consider - * from source string. */ + int numBytes, /* Maximum number of bytes to consider from + * source string. */ int maxLength, /* If >= 0, maxLength specifies the longest * permissible line length in pixels; don't * consider any character that would cross - * this x-position. If < 0, then line length + * this x-position. If < 0, then line length * is unbounded and the flags argument is * ignored. */ int flags, /* Various flag bits OR-ed together: * TK_PARTIAL_OK means include the last char * which only partially fits on this line. * TK_WHOLE_WORDS means stop on a word - * boundary, if possible. - * TK_AT_LEAST_ONE means return at least one - * character (or at least the first partial - * word in case TK_WHOLE_WORDS is also set) - * even if no characters (words) fit. */ + * boundary, if possible. TK_AT_LEAST_ONE + * means return at least one character (or at + * least the first partial word in case + * TK_WHOLE_WORDS is also set) even if no + * characters (words) fit. */ int *lengthPtr) /* Filled with x-location just after the * terminating character. */ { @@ -618,10 +618,9 @@ Tk_MeasureChars( SubFont *lastSubFontPtr; CONST char *p, *end, *next, *start; - if (numBytes == 0) { - *lengthPtr = 0; - return 0; + *lengthPtr = 0; + return 0; } fontPtr = (WinFont *) tkfont; @@ -632,8 +631,8 @@ Tk_MeasureChars( /* * A three step process: - * 1. Find a contiguous range of characters that can all be - * represented by a single screen font. + * 1. Find a contiguous range of characters that can all be represented by + * a single screen font. * 2. Convert those chars to the encoding of that font. * 3. Measure converted chars. */ @@ -643,107 +642,103 @@ Tk_MeasureChars( start = source; end = start + numBytes; for (p = start; p < end; ) { - next = p + Tcl_UtfToUniChar(p, &ch); - thisSubFontPtr = FindSubFontForChar(fontPtr, ch, &lastSubFontPtr); - if (thisSubFontPtr != lastSubFontPtr) { - familyPtr = lastSubFontPtr->familyPtr; - Tcl_UtfToExternalDString(familyPtr->encoding, start, - (int) (p - start), &runString); - size.cx = 0; - (*familyPtr->getTextExtentPoint32Proc)(hdc, - Tcl_DStringValue(&runString), - Tcl_DStringLength(&runString) >> familyPtr->isWideFont, - &size); - Tcl_DStringFree(&runString); - if (maxLength >= 0 && (curX+size.cx) > maxLength) { - moretomeasure = 1; - break; - } - curX += size.cx; - lastSubFontPtr = thisSubFontPtr; - start = p; - - SelectObject(hdc, lastSubFontPtr->hFont); - } - p = next; + next = p + Tcl_UtfToUniChar(p, &ch); + thisSubFontPtr = FindSubFontForChar(fontPtr, ch, &lastSubFontPtr); + if (thisSubFontPtr != lastSubFontPtr) { + familyPtr = lastSubFontPtr->familyPtr; + Tcl_UtfToExternalDString(familyPtr->encoding, start, + (int) (p - start), &runString); + size.cx = 0; + (*familyPtr->getTextExtentPoint32Proc)(hdc, + Tcl_DStringValue(&runString), + Tcl_DStringLength(&runString) >> familyPtr->isWideFont, + &size); + Tcl_DStringFree(&runString); + if (maxLength >= 0 && (curX+size.cx) > maxLength) { + moretomeasure = 1; + break; + } + curX += size.cx; + lastSubFontPtr = thisSubFontPtr; + start = p; + + SelectObject(hdc, lastSubFontPtr->hFont); + } + p = next; } if (!moretomeasure) { - /* - * We get here if the previous loop was just finished - * normally, without a break. Just measure the last run and - * that's it. - */ + /* + * We get here if the previous loop was just finished normally, + * without a break. Just measure the last run and that's it. + */ familyPtr = lastSubFontPtr->familyPtr; - Tcl_UtfToExternalDString(familyPtr->encoding, start, - (int) (p - start), &runString); - size.cx = 0; + Tcl_UtfToExternalDString(familyPtr->encoding, start, + (int) (p - start), &runString); + size.cx = 0; (*familyPtr->getTextExtentPoint32Proc)(hdc, Tcl_DStringValue(&runString), - Tcl_DStringLength(&runString) >> familyPtr->isWideFont, + Tcl_DStringLength(&runString) >> familyPtr->isWideFont, &size); - Tcl_DStringFree(&runString); - if (maxLength >= 0 && (curX+size.cx) > maxLength) { - moretomeasure = 1; - } else { + Tcl_DStringFree(&runString); + if (maxLength >= 0 && (curX+size.cx) > maxLength) { + moretomeasure = 1; + } else { curX += size.cx; - p = end; - } + p = end; + } } if (moretomeasure) { /* - * We get here if the measurement of the last run was over the - * maxLength limit. We need to restart this run and do it - * char by char, but always in context with the previous text - * to account for kerning (especially italics). + * We get here if the measurement of the last run was over the + * maxLength limit. We need to restart this run and do it char by + * char, but always in context with the previous text to account for + * kerning (especially italics). */ - char buf[16]; - int dstWrote; - int lastSize = 0; + char buf[16]; + int dstWrote; + int lastSize = 0; familyPtr = lastSubFontPtr->familyPtr; - Tcl_DStringInit(&runString); - for (p = start; p < end; ) { - next = p + Tcl_UtfToUniChar(p, &ch); - Tcl_UtfToExternal(NULL, familyPtr->encoding, p, - (int) (next - p), 0, NULL, buf, sizeof(buf), NULL, - &dstWrote, NULL); - Tcl_DStringAppend(&runString,buf,dstWrote); - size.cx = 0; - (*familyPtr->getTextExtentPoint32Proc)(hdc, - Tcl_DStringValue(&runString), - Tcl_DStringLength(&runString) >> familyPtr->isWideFont, - &size); - if ((curX+size.cx) > maxLength) { + Tcl_DStringInit(&runString); + for (p = start; p < end; ) { + next = p + Tcl_UtfToUniChar(p, &ch); + Tcl_UtfToExternal(NULL, familyPtr->encoding, p, + (int) (next - p), 0, NULL, buf, sizeof(buf), NULL, + &dstWrote, NULL); + Tcl_DStringAppend(&runString,buf,dstWrote); + size.cx = 0; + (*familyPtr->getTextExtentPoint32Proc)(hdc, + Tcl_DStringValue(&runString), + Tcl_DStringLength(&runString) >> familyPtr->isWideFont, + &size); + if ((curX+size.cx) > maxLength) { break; } - lastSize = size.cx; + lastSize = size.cx; p = next; } - Tcl_DStringFree(&runString); - - /* - * "p" points to the first character that doesn't fit in the - * desired span. Look at the flags to figure out whether to - * include this next character. - */ - - if ((p < end) - && (((flags & TK_PARTIAL_OK) && (curX != maxLength)) - || ((p == source) && (flags & TK_AT_LEAST_ONE) - && (curX == 0)))) { - - /* - * Include the first character that didn't quite fit in - * the desired span. The width returned will include the - * width of that extra character. - */ - - p = next; - curX += size.cx; + Tcl_DStringFree(&runString); + + /* + * "p" points to the first character that doesn't fit in the desired + * span. Look at the flags to figure out whether to include this next + * character. + */ + + if ((p < end) && (((flags & TK_PARTIAL_OK) && (curX != maxLength)) + || ((p==source) && (flags&TK_AT_LEAST_ONE) && (curX==0)))) { + /* + * Include the first character that didn't quite fit in the + * desired span. The width returned will include the width of that + * extra character. + */ + + p = next; + curX += size.cx; } else { curX += lastSize; } @@ -753,38 +748,36 @@ Tk_MeasureChars( ReleaseDC(fontPtr->hwnd, hdc); if ((flags & TK_WHOLE_WORDS) && (p < end)) { + /* + * Scan the string for the last word break and than repeat the whole + * procedure without the maxLength limit or any flags. + */ - /* - * Scan the string for the last word break and than repeat the - * whole procedure without the maxLength limit or any flags. - */ - - CONST char *lastWordBreak = NULL; - Tcl_UniChar ch2; - - end = p; - p = source; - ch = ' '; - while (p < end) { - next = p + Tcl_UtfToUniChar(p, &ch2); - if ((ch != ' ') && (ch2 == ' ')) { - lastWordBreak = p; - } - p = next; - ch = ch2; - } - - if (lastWordBreak != NULL) { - return Tk_MeasureChars( - tkfont, source, lastWordBreak-source, -1, 0, lengthPtr); - } else { - if (flags & TK_AT_LEAST_ONE) { - p = end; - } else { - p = source; - curX = 0; - } - } + CONST char *lastWordBreak = NULL; + Tcl_UniChar ch2; + + end = p; + p = source; + ch = ' '; + while (p < end) { + next = p + Tcl_UtfToUniChar(p, &ch2); + if ((ch != ' ') && (ch2 == ' ')) { + lastWordBreak = p; + } + p = next; + ch = ch2; + } + + if (lastWordBreak != NULL) { + return Tk_MeasureChars(tkfont, source, lastWordBreak-source, + -1, 0, lengthPtr); + } + if (flags & TK_AT_LEAST_ONE) { + p = end; + } else { + p = source; + curX = 0; + } } *lengthPtr = curX; @@ -796,7 +789,7 @@ Tk_MeasureChars( * * Tk_DrawChars -- * - * Draw a string of characters on the screen. + * Draw a string of characters on the screen. * * Results: * None. @@ -814,12 +807,12 @@ Tk_DrawChars( GC gc, /* Graphics context for drawing characters. */ Tk_Font tkfont, /* Font in which characters will be drawn; * must be the same as font used in GC. */ - CONST char *source, /* UTF-8 string to be displayed. Need not be - * '\0' terminated. All Tk meta-characters + CONST char *source, /* UTF-8 string to be displayed. Need not be + * '\0' terminated. All Tk meta-characters * (tabs, control characters, and newlines) * should be stripped out of the string that - * is passed to this function. If they are - * not stripped out, they will be displayed as + * is passed to this function. If they are not + * stripped out, they will be displayed as * regular printing characters. */ int numBytes, /* Number of bytes in string. */ int x, int y) /* Coordinates at which to place origin of @@ -839,10 +832,10 @@ Tk_DrawChars( dc = TkWinGetDrawableDC(display, drawable, &state); SetROP2(dc, tkpWinRopModes[gc->function]); - - if ((gc->clip_mask != None) && - ((TkpClipMask*)gc->clip_mask)->type == TKP_CLIP_REGION) { - SelectClipRgn(dc, (HRGN)((TkpClipMask*)gc->clip_mask)->value.region); + + if ((gc->clip_mask != None) && + ((TkpClipMask*)gc->clip_mask)->type == TKP_CLIP_REGION) { + SelectClipRgn(dc, (HRGN)((TkpClipMask*)gc->clip_mask)->value.region); } if ((gc->fill_style == FillStippled @@ -862,7 +855,7 @@ Tk_DrawChars( /* * Select stipple pattern into destination dc. */ - + dcMem = CreateCompatibleDC(dc); stipple = CreatePatternBrush(twdPtr->bitmap.handle); @@ -886,8 +879,8 @@ Tk_DrawChars( /* * The following code is tricky because fonts are rendered in multiple - * colors. First we draw onto a black background and copy the white - * bits. Then we draw onto a white background and copy the black bits. + * colors. First we draw onto a black background and copy the white + * bits. Then we draw onto a white background and copy the black bits. * Both the foreground and background bits of the font are ANDed with * the stipple pattern as they are copied. */ @@ -958,18 +951,17 @@ Tk_DrawChars( * * MultiFontTextOut -- * - * Helper function for Tk_DrawChars. Draws characters, using the - * various screen fonts in fontPtr to draw multilingual characters. - * Note: No bidirectional support. + * Helper function for Tk_DrawChars. Draws characters, using the various + * screen fonts in fontPtr to draw multilingual characters. Note: No + * bidirectional support. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * Information gets drawn on the screen. - * Contents of fontPtr may be modified if more subfonts were loaded - * in order to draw all the multilingual characters in the given - * string. + * Information gets drawn on the screen. Contents of fontPtr may be + * modified if more subfonts were loaded in order to draw all the + * multilingual characters in the given string. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -981,8 +973,8 @@ MultiFontTextOut( * following string. */ CONST char *source, /* Potentially multilingual UTF-8 string. */ int numBytes, /* Length of string in bytes. */ - int x, int y) /* Coordinates at which to place origin * - * of string when drawing. */ + int x, int y) /* Coordinates at which to place origin of + * string when drawing. */ { Tcl_UniChar ch; SIZE size; @@ -999,27 +991,27 @@ MultiFontTextOut( end = source + numBytes; for (p = source; p < end; ) { - next = p + Tcl_UtfToUniChar(p, &ch); - thisSubFontPtr = FindSubFontForChar(fontPtr, ch, &lastSubFontPtr); - if (thisSubFontPtr != lastSubFontPtr) { - if (p > source) { + next = p + Tcl_UtfToUniChar(p, &ch); + thisSubFontPtr = FindSubFontForChar(fontPtr, ch, &lastSubFontPtr); + if (thisSubFontPtr != lastSubFontPtr) { + if (p > source) { familyPtr = lastSubFontPtr->familyPtr; Tcl_UtfToExternalDString(familyPtr->encoding, source, (int) (p - source), &runString); - (*familyPtr->textOutProc)(hdc, x-(tm.tmOverhang/2), y, + (*familyPtr->textOutProc)(hdc, x-(tm.tmOverhang/2), y, Tcl_DStringValue(&runString), - Tcl_DStringLength(&runString) >> familyPtr->isWideFont); - (*familyPtr->getTextExtentPoint32Proc)(hdc, + Tcl_DStringLength(&runString)>>familyPtr->isWideFont); + (*familyPtr->getTextExtentPoint32Proc)(hdc, Tcl_DStringValue(&runString), - Tcl_DStringLength(&runString) >> familyPtr->isWideFont, + Tcl_DStringLength(&runString) >> familyPtr->isWideFont, &size); x += size.cx; Tcl_DStringFree(&runString); } - lastSubFontPtr = thisSubFontPtr; - source = p; + lastSubFontPtr = thisSubFontPtr; + source = p; SelectObject(hdc, lastSubFontPtr->hFont); - GetTextMetrics(hdc, &tm); + GetTextMetrics(hdc, &tm); } p = next; } @@ -1028,7 +1020,7 @@ MultiFontTextOut( Tcl_UtfToExternalDString(familyPtr->encoding, source, (int) (p - source), &runString); (*familyPtr->textOutProc)(hdc, x-(tm.tmOverhang/2), y, - Tcl_DStringValue(&runString), + Tcl_DStringValue(&runString), Tcl_DStringLength(&runString) >> familyPtr->isWideFont); Tcl_DStringFree(&runString); } @@ -1041,12 +1033,12 @@ MultiFontTextOut( * InitFont -- * * Helper for TkpGetNativeFont() and TkpGetFontFromAttributes(). - * Initializes the memory for a new WinFont that wraps the + * Initializes the memory for a new WinFont that wraps the * platform-specific data. * - * The caller is responsible for initializing the fields of the - * WinFont that are used exclusively by the generic TkFont code, and - * for releasing those fields before calling TkpDeleteFont(). + * The caller is responsible for initializing the fields of the WinFont + * that are used exclusively by the generic TkFont code, and for + * releasing those fields before calling TkpDeleteFont(). * * Results: * Fills the WinFont structure. @@ -1055,17 +1047,17 @@ MultiFontTextOut( * Memory allocated. * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- - */ + */ static void InitFont( - Tk_Window tkwin, /* Main window of interp in which font will - * be used, for getting HDC. */ + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Main window of interp in which font will be + * used, for getting HDC. */ HFONT hFont, /* Windows token for font. */ - int overstrike, /* The overstrike attribute of logfont used - * to allocate this font. For some reason, - * the TEXTMETRICs may contain incorrect info - * in the tmStruckOut field. */ + int overstrike, /* The overstrike attribute of logfont used to + * allocate this font. For some reason, the + * TEXTMETRICs may contain incorrect info in + * the tmStruckOut field. */ WinFont *fontPtr) /* Filled with information constructed from * the above arguments. */ { @@ -1079,7 +1071,7 @@ InitFont( Tcl_DString faceString; TkFontAttributes *faPtr; char buf[LF_FACESIZE * sizeof(WCHAR)]; - + window = Tk_WindowId(tkwin); hwnd = (window == None) ? NULL : TkWinGetHWND(window); hdc = GetDC(hwnd); @@ -1088,18 +1080,18 @@ InitFont( GetTextMetrics(hdc, &tm); /* - * On any version NT, there may fonts with international names. - * Use the NT-only Unicode version of GetTextFace to get the font's - * name. If we used the ANSI version on a non-internationalized - * version of NT, we would get a font name with '?' replacing all - * the international characters. + * On any version NT, there may fonts with international names. Use the + * NT-only Unicode version of GetTextFace to get the font's name. If we + * used the ANSI version on a non-internationalized version of NT, we + * would get a font name with '?' replacing all the international + * characters. * - * On a non-internationalized verson of 95, fonts with international - * names are not allowed, so the ANSI version of GetTextFace will work. - * On an internationalized version of 95, there may be fonts with - * international names; the ANSI version will work, fetching the - * name in the international system code page. Can't use the Unicode - * version of GetTextFace because it only exists under NT. + * On a non-internationalized verson of 95, fonts with international names + * are not allowed, so the ANSI version of GetTextFace will work. On an + * internationalized version of 95, there may be fonts with international + * names; the ANSI version will work, fetching the name in the + * international system code page. Can't use the Unicode version of + * GetTextFace because it only exists under NT. */ if (TkWinGetPlatformId() == VER_PLATFORM_WIN32_NT) { @@ -1113,12 +1105,14 @@ InitFont( faPtr = &fontPtr->font.fa; faPtr->family = Tk_GetUid(Tcl_DStringValue(&faceString)); - faPtr->size = TkFontGetPoints(tkwin, -(tm.tmHeight - tm.tmInternalLeading)); - faPtr->weight = (tm.tmWeight > FW_MEDIUM) ? TK_FW_BOLD : TK_FW_NORMAL; + faPtr->size = + TkFontGetPoints(tkwin, -(tm.tmHeight - tm.tmInternalLeading)); + faPtr->weight = + (tm.tmWeight > FW_MEDIUM) ? TK_FW_BOLD : TK_FW_NORMAL; faPtr->slant = (tm.tmItalic != 0) ? TK_FS_ITALIC : TK_FS_ROMAN; faPtr->underline = (tm.tmUnderlined != 0) ? 1 : 0; faPtr->overstrike = overstrike; - + fmPtr = &fontPtr->font.fm; fmPtr->ascent = tm.tmAscent; fmPtr->descent = tm.tmDescent; @@ -1137,7 +1131,7 @@ InitFont( GetCharWidthW(hdc, 0, BASE_CHARS - 1, fontPtr->widths); } else { GetCharWidthA(hdc, 0, BASE_CHARS - 1, fontPtr->widths); - } + } Tcl_DStringFree(&faceString); SelectObject(hdc, oldFont); @@ -1148,10 +1142,9 @@ InitFont( *------------------------------------------------------------------------- * * ReleaseFont -- - * - * Called to release the windows-specific contents of a TkFont. - * The caller is responsible for freeing the memory used by the - * font itself. + * + * Called to release the windows-specific contents of a TkFont. The + * caller is responsible for freeing the memory used by the font itself. * * Results: * None. @@ -1161,7 +1154,7 @@ InitFont( * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ - + static void ReleaseFont( WinFont *fontPtr) /* The font to delete. */ @@ -1181,9 +1174,9 @@ ReleaseFont( * * InitSubFont -- * - * Wrap a screen font and load the FontFamily that represents - * it. Used to prepare a SubFont so that characters can be mapped - * from UTF-8 to the charset of the font. + * Wrap a screen font and load the FontFamily that represents it. Used to + * prepare a SubFont so that characters can be mapped from UTF-8 to the + * charset of the font. * * Results: * The subFontPtr is filled with information about the font. @@ -1198,10 +1191,10 @@ static void InitSubFont( HDC hdc, /* HDC in which font can be selected. */ HFONT hFont, /* The screen font. */ - int base, /* Non-zero if this SubFont is being used - * as the base font for a font object. */ - SubFont *subFontPtr) /* Filled with SubFont constructed from - * above attributes. */ + int base, /* Non-zero if this SubFont is being used as + * the base font for a font object. */ + SubFont *subFontPtr) /* Filled with SubFont constructed from above + * attributes. */ { subFontPtr->hFont = hFont; subFontPtr->familyPtr = AllocFontFamily(hdc, hFont, base); @@ -1213,8 +1206,8 @@ InitSubFont( * * ReleaseSubFont -- * - * Called to release the contents of a SubFont. The caller is - * responsible for freeing the memory used by the SubFont itself. + * Called to release the contents of a SubFont. The caller is responsible + * for freeing the memory used by the SubFont itself. * * Results: * None. @@ -1238,26 +1231,24 @@ ReleaseSubFont( * * AllocFontFamily -- * - * Find the FontFamily structure associated with the given font - * name. The information should be stored by the caller in a - * SubFont and used when determining if that SubFont supports a - * character. + * Find the FontFamily structure associated with the given font name. + * The information should be stored by the caller in a SubFont and used + * when determining if that SubFont supports a character. * - * Cannot use the string name used to construct the font as the - * key, because the capitalization may not be canonical. Therefore - * use the face name actually retrieved from the font metrics as - * the key. + * Cannot use the string name used to construct the font as the key, + * because the capitalization may not be canonical. Therefore use the + * face name actually retrieved from the font metrics as the key. * * Results: - * A pointer to a FontFamily. The reference count in the FontFamily - * is automatically incremented. When the SubFont is released, the - * reference count is decremented. When no SubFont is using this - * FontFamily, it may be deleted. + * A pointer to a FontFamily. The reference count in the FontFamily is + * automatically incremented. When the SubFont is released, the reference + * count is decremented. When no SubFont is using this FontFamily, it may + * be deleted. * * Side effects: - * A new FontFamily structure will be allocated if this font family - * has not been seen. TrueType character existence metrics are - * loaded into the FontFamily structure. + * A new FontFamily structure will be allocated if this font family has + * not been seen. TrueType character existence metrics are loaded into + * the FontFamily structure. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -1267,16 +1258,16 @@ AllocFontFamily( HDC hdc, /* HDC in which font can be selected. */ HFONT hFont, /* Screen font whose FontFamily is to be * returned. */ - int base) /* Non-zero if this font family is to be - * used in the base font of a font object. */ + int base) /* Non-zero if this font family is to be used + * in the base font of a font object. */ { Tk_Uid faceName; FontFamily *familyPtr; Tcl_DString faceString; Tcl_Encoding encoding; char buf[LF_FACESIZE * sizeof(WCHAR)]; - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) - Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); hFont = SelectObject(hdc, hFont); if (TkWinGetPlatformId() == VER_PLATFORM_WIN32_NT) { @@ -1289,7 +1280,7 @@ AllocFontFamily( Tcl_DStringFree(&faceString); hFont = SelectObject(hdc, hFont); - familyPtr = tsdPtr->fontFamilyList; + familyPtr = tsdPtr->fontFamilyList; for ( ; familyPtr != NULL; familyPtr = familyPtr->nextPtr) { if (familyPtr->faceName == faceName) { familyPtr->refCount++; @@ -1302,38 +1293,38 @@ AllocFontFamily( familyPtr->nextPtr = tsdPtr->fontFamilyList; tsdPtr->fontFamilyList = familyPtr; - /* - * Set key for this FontFamily. + /* + * Set key for this FontFamily. */ familyPtr->faceName = faceName; - /* - * An initial refCount of 2 means that FontFamily information will - * persist even when the SubFont that loaded the FontFamily is released. - * Change it to 1 to cause FontFamilies to be unloaded when not in use. + /* + * An initial refCount of 2 means that FontFamily information will persist + * even when the SubFont that loaded the FontFamily is released. Change it + * to 1 to cause FontFamilies to be unloaded when not in use. */ familyPtr->refCount = 2; - familyPtr->segCount = LoadFontRanges(hdc, hFont, &familyPtr->startCount, + familyPtr->segCount = LoadFontRanges(hdc, hFont, &familyPtr->startCount, &familyPtr->endCount, &familyPtr->isSymbolFont); encoding = NULL; if (familyPtr->isSymbolFont != 0) { /* - * Symbol fonts are handled specially. For instance, Unicode 0393 + * Symbol fonts are handled specially. For instance, Unicode 0393 * (GREEK CAPITAL GAMMA) must be mapped to Symbol character 0047 - * (GREEK CAPITAL GAMMA), because the Symbol font doesn't have a - * GREEK CAPITAL GAMMA at location 0393. If Tk interpreted the - * Symbol font using the Unicode encoding, it would decide that - * the Symbol font has no GREEK CAPITAL GAMMA, because the Symbol - * encoding (of course) reports that character 0393 doesn't exist. + * (GREEK CAPITAL GAMMA), because the Symbol font doesn't have a GREEK + * CAPITAL GAMMA at location 0393. If Tk interpreted the Symbol font + * using the Unicode encoding, it would decide that the Symbol font + * has no GREEK CAPITAL GAMMA, because the Symbol encoding (of course) + * reports that character 0393 doesn't exist. * - * With non-symbol Windows fonts, such as Times New Roman, if the - * font has a GREEK CAPITAL GAMMA, it will be found in the correct - * Unicode location (0393); the GREEK CAPITAL GAMMA will not be off - * hiding at some other location. + * With non-symbol Windows fonts, such as Times New Roman, if the font + * has a GREEK CAPITAL GAMMA, it will be found in the correct Unicode + * location (0393); the GREEK CAPITAL GAMMA will not be off hiding at + * some other location. */ encoding = Tcl_GetEncoding(NULL, faceName); @@ -1343,16 +1334,16 @@ AllocFontFamily( encoding = Tcl_GetEncoding(NULL, "unicode"); familyPtr->textOutProc = (BOOL (WINAPI *)(HDC, int, int, TCHAR *, int)) TextOutW; - familyPtr->getTextExtentPoint32Proc = + familyPtr->getTextExtentPoint32Proc = (BOOL (WINAPI *)(HDC, TCHAR *, int, LPSIZE)) GetTextExtentPoint32W; familyPtr->isWideFont = 1; } else { - familyPtr->textOutProc = + familyPtr->textOutProc = (BOOL (WINAPI *)(HDC, int, int, TCHAR *, int)) TextOutA; - familyPtr->getTextExtentPoint32Proc = + familyPtr->getTextExtentPoint32Proc = (BOOL (WINAPI *)(HDC, TCHAR *, int, LPSIZE)) GetTextExtentPoint32A; familyPtr->isWideFont = 0; - } + } familyPtr->encoding = encoding; @@ -1376,27 +1367,27 @@ AllocFontFamily( * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ - + static void FreeFontFamily( FontFamily *familyPtr) /* The FontFamily to delete. */ { int i; FontFamily **familyPtrPtr; - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) - Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); if (familyPtr == NULL) { - return; + return; } familyPtr->refCount--; if (familyPtr->refCount > 0) { return; } for (i = 0; i < FONTMAP_PAGES; i++) { - if (familyPtr->fontMap[i] != NULL) { - ckfree(familyPtr->fontMap[i]); - } + if (familyPtr->fontMap[i] != NULL) { + ckfree(familyPtr->fontMap[i]); + } } if (familyPtr->startCount != NULL) { ckfree((char *) familyPtr->startCount); @@ -1407,19 +1398,19 @@ FreeFontFamily( if (familyPtr->encoding != TkWinGetUnicodeEncoding()) { Tcl_FreeEncoding(familyPtr->encoding); } - - /* - * Delete from list. + + /* + * Delete from list. */ - + for (familyPtrPtr = &tsdPtr->fontFamilyList; ; ) { - if (*familyPtrPtr == familyPtr) { + if (*familyPtrPtr == familyPtr) { *familyPtrPtr = familyPtr->nextPtr; break; } familyPtrPtr = &(*familyPtrPtr)->nextPtr; } - + ckfree((char *) familyPtr); } @@ -1428,19 +1419,17 @@ FreeFontFamily( * * FindSubFontForChar -- * - * Determine which screen font is necessary to use to display the - * given character. If the font object does not have a screen font - * that can display the character, another screen font may be loaded - * into the font object, following a set of preferred fallback rules. + * Determine which screen font is necessary to use to display the given + * character. If the font object does not have a screen font that can + * display the character, another screen font may be loaded into the font + * object, following a set of preferred fallback rules. * * Results: - * The return value is the SubFont to use to display the given - * character. + * The return value is the SubFont to use to display the given character. * * Side effects: - * The contents of fontPtr are modified to cache the results - * of the lookup and remember any SubFonts that were dynamically - * loaded. + * The contents of fontPtr are modified to cache the results of the + * lookup and remember any SubFonts that were dynamically loaded. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -1461,7 +1450,7 @@ FindSubFontForChar( char *fallbackName; SubFont *subFontPtr; Tcl_DString ds; - + if (ch < BASE_CHARS) { return &fontPtr->subFontArray[0]; } @@ -1473,13 +1462,13 @@ FindSubFontForChar( } /* - * Keep track of all face names that we check, so we don't check some - * name multiple times if it can be reached by multiple paths. + * Keep track of all face names that we check, so we don't check some name + * multiple times if it can be reached by multiple paths. */ - + Tcl_DStringInit(&ds); hdc = GetDC(fontPtr->hwnd); - + aliases = TkFontGetAliasList(fontPtr->font.fa.family); fontFallbacks = TkFontGetFallbacks(); @@ -1493,25 +1482,25 @@ FindSubFontForChar( goto tryfallbacks; } else if (aliases != NULL) { - /* + /* * Or if an alias for the base font has a fallback... */ for (k = 0; aliases[k] != NULL; k++) { if (strcasecmp(aliases[k], fallbackName) == 0) { - goto tryfallbacks; + goto tryfallbacks; } } } } continue; - /* - * ...then see if we can use one of the fallbacks, or an - * alias for one of the fallbacks. + /* + * ...then see if we can use one of the fallbacks, or an alias for one + * of the fallbacks. */ - tryfallbacks: + tryfallbacks: for (j = 0; fontFallbacks[i][j] != NULL; j++) { fallbackName = fontFallbacks[i][j]; subFontPtr = CanUseFallbackWithAliases(hdc, fontPtr, fallbackName, @@ -1523,13 +1512,13 @@ FindSubFontForChar( } /* - * See if we can use something from the global fallback list. + * See if we can use something from the global fallback list. */ anyFallbacks = TkFontGetGlobalClass(); for (i = 0; anyFallbacks[i] != NULL; i++) { fallbackName = anyFallbacks[i]; - subFontPtr = CanUseFallbackWithAliases(hdc, fontPtr, fallbackName, + subFontPtr = CanUseFallbackWithAliases(hdc, fontPtr, fallbackName, ch, &ds, subFontPtrPtr); if (subFontPtr != NULL) { goto end; @@ -1537,8 +1526,8 @@ FindSubFontForChar( } /* - * Try all face names available in the whole system until we - * find one that can be used. + * Try all face names available in the whole system until we find one that + * can be used. */ canUse.hdc = hdc; @@ -1556,22 +1545,22 @@ FindSubFontForChar( } subFontPtr = canUse.subFontPtr; - end: + end: Tcl_DStringFree(&ds); - + if (subFontPtr == NULL) { - /* - * No font can display this character. We will use the base font - * and have it display the "unknown" character. - */ + /* + * No font can display this character. We will use the base font and + * have it display the "unknown" character. + */ subFontPtr = &fontPtr->subFontArray[0]; - FontMapInsert(subFontPtr, ch); + FontMapInsert(subFontPtr, ch); } ReleaseDC(fontPtr->hwnd, hdc); return subFontPtr; } - + static int CALLBACK WinFontCanUseProc( ENUMLOGFONT *lfPtr, /* Logical-font data. */ @@ -1619,15 +1608,14 @@ WinFontCanUseProc( * See if the screen font can display the given character. * * Results: - * The return value is 0 if the screen font cannot display the - * character, non-zero otherwise. + * The return value is 0 if the screen font cannot display the character, + * non-zero otherwise. * * Side effects: - * New pages are added to the font mapping cache whenever the - * character belongs to a page that hasn't been seen before. - * When a page is loaded, information about all the characters on - * that page is stored, not just for the single character in - * question. + * New pages are added to the font mapping cache whenever the character + * belongs to a page that hasn't been seen before. When a page is loaded, + * information about all the characters on that page is stored, not just + * for the single character in question. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -1653,29 +1641,28 @@ FontMapLookup( * * FontMapInsert -- * - * Tell the font mapping cache that the given screen font should be - * used to display the specified character. This is called when no - * font on the system can be be found that can display that - * character; we lie to the font and tell it that it can display - * the character, otherwise we would end up re-searching the entire - * fallback hierarchy every time that character was seen. + * Tell the font mapping cache that the given screen font should be used + * to display the specified character. This is called when no font on the + * system can be be found that can display that character; we lie to the + * font and tell it that it can display the character, otherwise we would + * end up re-searching the entire fallback hierarchy every time that + * character was seen. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * New pages are added to the font mapping cache whenever the - * character belongs to a page that hasn't been seen before. - * When a page is loaded, information about all the characters on - * that page is stored, not just for the single character in - * question. + * New pages are added to the font mapping cache whenever the character + * belongs to a page that hasn't been seen before. When a page is loaded, + * information about all the characters on that page is stored, not just + * for the single character in question. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void FontMapInsert( - SubFont *subFontPtr, /* Contains font mapping cache to be + SubFont *subFontPtr, /* Contains font mapping cache to be * updated. */ int ch) /* Character to be added to cache. */ { @@ -1694,10 +1681,10 @@ FontMapInsert( * * FontMapLoadPage -- * - * Load information about all the characters on a given page. - * This information consists of one bit per character that indicates - * whether the associated HFONT can (1) or cannot (0) display the - * characters on the page. + * Load information about all the characters on a given page. This + * information consists of one bit per character that indicates whether + * the associated HFONT can (1) or cannot (0) display the characters on + * the page. * * Results: * None. @@ -1707,12 +1694,13 @@ FontMapInsert( * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -static void + +static void FontMapLoadPage( - SubFont *subFontPtr, /* Contains font mapping cache to be + SubFont *subFontPtr, /* Contains font mapping cache to be * updated. */ - int row) /* Index of the page to be loaded into - * the cache. */ + int row) /* Index of the page to be loaded into the + * cache. */ { FontFamily *familyPtr; Tcl_Encoding encoding; @@ -1728,9 +1716,9 @@ FontMapLoadPage( if (familyPtr->encoding == TkWinGetUnicodeEncoding()) { /* - * Font is Unicode. Few fonts are going to have all characters, so - * examine the TrueType character existence metrics to determine - * what characters actually exist in this font. + * Font is Unicode. Few fonts are going to have all characters, so + * examine the TrueType character existence metrics to determine what + * characters actually exist in this font. */ segCount = familyPtr->segCount; @@ -1752,24 +1740,23 @@ FontMapLoadPage( } } else if (familyPtr->isSymbolFont) { /* - * Assume that a symbol font with a known encoding has all the - * characters that its encoding claims it supports. - * - * The test for "encoding == unicodeEncoding" - * must occur before this case, to catch all symbol fonts (such - * as {Comic Sans MS} or Wingdings) for which we don't have - * encoding information; those symbol fonts are treated as if - * they were in the Unicode encoding and their symbolic - * character existence metrics are treated as if they were Unicode - * character existence metrics. This way, although we don't know - * the proper Unicode -> symbol font mapping, we can install the - * symbol font as the base font and access its glyphs. + * Assume that a symbol font with a known encoding has all the + * characters that its encoding claims it supports. + * + * The test for "encoding == unicodeEncoding" must occur before this + * case, to catch all symbol fonts (such as {Comic Sans MS} or + * Wingdings) for which we don't have encoding information; those + * symbol fonts are treated as if they were in the Unicode encoding + * and their symbolic character existence metrics are treated as if + * they were Unicode character existence metrics. This way, although + * we don't know the proper Unicode -> symbol font mapping, we can + * install the symbol font as the base font and access its glyphs. */ - end = (row + 1) << FONTMAP_SHIFT; + end = (row + 1) << FONTMAP_SHIFT; for (i = row << FONTMAP_SHIFT; i < end; i++) { - if (Tcl_UtfToExternal(NULL, encoding, src, - Tcl_UniCharToUtf(i, src), TCL_ENCODING_STOPONERROR, NULL, + if (Tcl_UtfToExternal(NULL, encoding, src, + Tcl_UniCharToUtf(i, src), TCL_ENCODING_STOPONERROR, NULL, buf, sizeof(buf), NULL, NULL, NULL) != TCL_OK) { continue; } @@ -1784,18 +1771,16 @@ FontMapLoadPage( * * CanUseFallbackWithAliases -- * - * Helper function for FindSubFontForChar. Determine if the - * specified face name (or an alias of the specified face name) - * can be used to construct a screen font that can display the - * given character. + * Helper function for FindSubFontForChar. Determine if the specified + * face name (or an alias of the specified face name) can be used to + * construct a screen font that can display the given character. * * Results: * See CanUseFallback(). * * Side effects: - * If the name and/or one of its aliases was rejected, the - * rejected string is recorded in nameTriedPtr so that it won't - * be tried again. + * If the name and/or one of its aliases was rejected, the rejected + * string is recorded in nameTriedPtr so that it won't be tried again. * *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -1806,11 +1791,11 @@ CanUseFallbackWithAliases( WinFont *fontPtr, /* The font object that will own the new * screen font. */ char *faceName, /* Desired face name for new screen font. */ - int ch, /* The Unicode character that the new - * screen font must be able to display. */ - Tcl_DString *nameTriedPtr, /* Records face names that have already - * been tried. It is possible for the same - * face name to be queried multiple times when + int ch, /* The Unicode character that the new screen + * font must be able to display. */ + Tcl_DString *nameTriedPtr, /* Records face names that have already been + * tried. It is possible for the same face + * name to be queried multiple times when * trying to find a suitable screen font. */ SubFont **subFontPtrPtr) /* Variable to fixup if we reallocate the * array of subfonts. */ @@ -1818,7 +1803,7 @@ CanUseFallbackWithAliases( int i; char **aliases; SubFont *subFontPtr; - + if (SeenName(faceName, nameTriedPtr) == 0) { subFontPtr = CanUseFallback(hdc, fontPtr, faceName, ch, subFontPtrPtr); if (subFontPtr != NULL) { @@ -1845,9 +1830,9 @@ CanUseFallbackWithAliases( * * SeenName -- * - * Used to determine we have already tried and rejected the given - * face name when looking for a screen font that can support some - * Unicode character. + * Used to determine we have already tried and rejected the given face + * name when looking for a screen font that can support some Unicode + * character. * * Results: * The return value is 0 if this face name has not already been seen, @@ -1884,21 +1869,21 @@ SeenName( * * CanUseFallback -- * - * If the specified screen font has not already been loaded into - * the font object, determine if it can display the given character. + * If the specified screen font has not already been loaded into the font + * object, determine if it can display the given character. * * Results: - * The return value is a pointer to a newly allocated SubFont, owned - * by the font object. This SubFont can be used to display the given - * character. The SubFont represents the screen font with the base set - * of font attributes from the font object, but using the specified - * font name. NULL is returned if the font object already holds - * a reference to the specified physical font or if the specified - * physical font cannot display the given character. - * - * Side effects: - * The font object's subFontArray is updated to contain a reference - * to the newly allocated SubFont. + * The return value is a pointer to a newly allocated SubFont, owned by + * the font object. This SubFont can be used to display the given + * character. The SubFont represents the screen font with the base set of + * font attributes from the font object, but using the specified font + * name. NULL is returned if the font object already holds a reference to + * the specified physical font or if the specified physical font cannot + * display the given character. + * + * Side effects: + * The font object's subFontArray is updated to contain a reference to + * the newly allocated SubFont. * *------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ @@ -1909,8 +1894,8 @@ CanUseFallback( WinFont *fontPtr, /* The font object that will own the new * screen font. */ char *faceName, /* Desired face name for new screen font. */ - int ch, /* The Unicode character that the new - * screen font must be able to display. */ + int ch, /* The Unicode character that the new screen + * font must be able to display. */ SubFont **subFontPtrPtr) /* Variable to fix-up if we realloc the array * of subfonts. */ { @@ -1922,10 +1907,10 @@ CanUseFallback( return NULL; } - /* + /* * Skip all fonts we've already used. */ - + for (i = 0; i < fontPtr->numSubFonts; i++) { if (faceName == fontPtr->subFontArray[i].familyPtr->faceName) { return NULL; @@ -1938,7 +1923,7 @@ CanUseFallback( hFont = GetScreenFont(&fontPtr->font.fa, faceName, fontPtr->pixelSize); InitSubFont(hdc, hFont, 0, &subFont); - if (((ch < 256) && (subFont.familyPtr->isSymbolFont)) + if (((ch < 256) && (subFont.familyPtr->isSymbolFont)) || (FontMapLookup(&subFont, ch) == 0)) { /* * Don't use a symbol font as a fallback font for characters below @@ -1952,17 +1937,19 @@ CanUseFallback( if (fontPtr->numSubFonts >= SUBFONT_SPACE) { SubFont *newPtr; - newPtr = (SubFont *) ckalloc(sizeof(SubFont) + newPtr = (SubFont *) ckalloc(sizeof(SubFont) * (fontPtr->numSubFonts + 1)); memcpy((char *) newPtr, fontPtr->subFontArray, fontPtr->numSubFonts * sizeof(SubFont)); if (fontPtr->subFontArray != fontPtr->staticSubFonts) { ckfree((char *) fontPtr->subFontArray); } + /* - * Fix up the variable pointed to by subFontPtrPtr so it still - * points into the live array. [Bug 618872] + * Fix up the variable pointed to by subFontPtrPtr so it still points + * into the live array. [Bug 618872] */ + *subFontPtrPtr = newPtr + (*subFontPtrPtr - fontPtr->subFontArray); fontPtr->subFontArray = newPtr; } @@ -1976,9 +1963,8 @@ CanUseFallback( * * GetScreenFont -- * - * Given the name and other attributes, construct an HFONT. - * This is where all the alias and fallback substitution bottoms - * out. + * Given the name and other attributes, construct an HFONT. This is where + * all the alias and fallback substitution bottoms out. * * Results: * The screen font that corresponds to the attributes. @@ -1989,13 +1975,13 @@ CanUseFallback( *--------------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -static HFONT +static HFONT GetScreenFont( CONST TkFontAttributes *faPtr, /* Desired font attributes for new HFONT. */ CONST char *faceName, /* Overrides font family specified in font * attributes. */ - int pixelSize) /* Overrides size specified in font + int pixelSize) /* Overrides size specified in font * attributes. */ { Tcl_DString ds; @@ -2007,7 +1993,7 @@ GetScreenFont( lf.lfWidth = 0; lf.lfEscapement = 0; lf.lfOrientation = 0; - lf.lfWeight = (faPtr->weight == TK_FW_NORMAL) ? FW_NORMAL : FW_BOLD; + lf.lfWeight = (faPtr->weight == TK_FW_NORMAL) ? FW_NORMAL : FW_BOLD; lf.lfItalic = faPtr->slant; lf.lfUnderline = faPtr->underline; lf.lfStrikeOut = faPtr->overstrike; @@ -2025,6 +2011,7 @@ GetScreenFont( /* * We can only store up to LF_FACESIZE wide characters */ + if (Tcl_DStringLength(&ds) >= (LF_FACESIZE * sizeof(WCHAR))) { Tcl_DStringSetLength(&ds, LF_FACESIZE); } @@ -2039,6 +2026,7 @@ GetScreenFont( /* * We can only store up to LF_FACESIZE characters */ + if (Tcl_DStringLength(&ds) >= LF_FACESIZE) { Tcl_DStringSetLength(&ds, LF_FACESIZE); } @@ -2054,10 +2042,9 @@ GetScreenFont( * * FamilyExists, FamilyOrAliasExists, WinFontExistsProc -- * - * Determines if any physical screen font exists on the system with - * the given family name. If the family exists, then it should be - * possible to construct some physical screen font with that family - * name. + * Determines if any physical screen font exists on the system with the + * given family name. If the family exists, then it should be possible to + * construct some physical screen font with that family name. * * Results: * The return value is 0 if the specified font family does not exist, @@ -2079,7 +2066,7 @@ FamilyExists( /* * Just immediately rule out the following fonts, because they look so - * ugly on windows. The caller's fallback mechanism will cause the + * ugly on windows. The caller's fallback mechanism will cause the * corresponding appropriate TrueType fonts to be selected. */ @@ -2092,18 +2079,18 @@ FamilyExists( if (strcasecmp(faceName, "Helvetica") == 0) { return 0; } - + Tcl_UtfToExternalDString(systemEncoding, faceName, -1, &faceString); /* - * If the family exists, WinFontExistProc() will be called and - * EnumFontFamilies() will return whatever WinFontExistProc() returns. - * If the family doesn't exist, EnumFontFamilies() will just return a + * If the family exists, WinFontExistProc() will be called and + * EnumFontFamilies() will return whatever WinFontExistProc() returns. If + * the family doesn't exist, EnumFontFamilies() will just return a * non-zero value. */ if (TkWinGetPlatformId() == VER_PLATFORM_WIN32_NT) { - result = EnumFontFamiliesW(hdc, (WCHAR *) Tcl_DStringValue(&faceString), + result = EnumFontFamiliesW(hdc, (WCHAR*) Tcl_DStringValue(&faceString), (FONTENUMPROCW) WinFontExistProc, 0); } else { result = EnumFontFamiliesA(hdc, (char *) Tcl_DStringValue(&faceString), @@ -2112,10 +2099,10 @@ FamilyExists( Tcl_DStringFree(&faceString); return (result == 0); } - + static char * FamilyOrAliasExists( - HDC hdc, + HDC hdc, CONST char *faceName) { char **aliases; @@ -2134,7 +2121,7 @@ FamilyOrAliasExists( } return NULL; } - + static int CALLBACK WinFontExistProc( ENUMLOGFONT *lfPtr, /* Logical-font data. */ @@ -2160,25 +2147,25 @@ typedef struct CMAPTABLE { } CMAPTABLE; typedef struct ENCODINGTABLE { - USHORT platform; /* Platform for which data is targeted. - * 3 means data is for Windows. */ - USHORT encoding; /* How characters in font are encoded. - * 1 means that the following subtable is - * keyed based on Unicode. */ - ULONG offset; /* Byte offset from beginning of CMAPTABLE - * to the subtable for this encoding. */ + USHORT platform; /* Platform for which data is targeted. 3 + * means data is for Windows. */ + USHORT encoding; /* How characters in font are encoded. 1 means + * that the following subtable is keyed based + * on Unicode. */ + ULONG offset; /* Byte offset from beginning of CMAPTABLE to + * the subtable for this encoding. */ } ENCODINGTABLE; typedef struct ANYTABLE { USHORT format; /* Format number. */ - USHORT length; /* The actual length in bytes of this + USHORT length; /* The actual length in bytes of this * subtable. */ USHORT version; /* Version number (starts at 0). */ } ANYTABLE; typedef struct BYTETABLE { USHORT format; /* Format number is set to 0. */ - USHORT length; /* The actual length in bytes of this + USHORT length; /* The actual length in bytes of this * subtable. */ USHORT version; /* Version number (starts at 0). */ BYTE glyphIdArray[256]; /* Array that maps up to 256 single-byte char @@ -2189,7 +2176,7 @@ typedef struct SUBHEADER { USHORT firstCode; /* First valid low byte for subHeader. */ USHORT entryCount; /* Number valid low bytes for subHeader. */ SHORT idDelta; /* Constant adder to get base glyph index. */ - USHORT idRangeOffset; /* Byte offset from here to appropriate + USHORT idRangeOffset; /* Byte offset from here to appropriate * glyphIndexArray. */ } SUBHEADER; @@ -2198,12 +2185,12 @@ typedef struct HIBYTETABLE { USHORT length; /* The actual length in bytes of this * subtable. */ USHORT version; /* Version number (starts at 0). */ - USHORT subHeaderKeys[256]; /* Maps high bytes to subHeaders: value is + USHORT subHeaderKeys[256]; /* Maps high bytes to subHeaders: value is * subHeader index * 8. */ #if 0 SUBHEADER subHeaders[]; /* Variable-length array of SUBHEADERs. */ - USHORT glyphIndexArray[]; /* Variable-length array containing subarrays - * used for mapping the low byte of 2-byte + USHORT glyphIndexArray[]; /* Variable-length array containing subarrays + * used for mapping the low byte of 2-byte * characters. */ #endif } HIBYTETABLE; @@ -2235,8 +2222,8 @@ typedef struct TRIMMEDTABLE { USHORT firstCode; /* First character code of subrange. */ USHORT entryCount; /* Number of character codes in subrange. */ #if 0 - USHORT glyphIdArray[]; /* Array of glyph index values for - character codes in the range. */ + USHORT glyphIdArray[]; /* Array of glyph index values for + * character codes in the range. */ #endif } TRIMMEDTABLE; @@ -2255,16 +2242,16 @@ typedef union SUBTABLE { * * LoadFontRanges -- * - * Given an HFONT, get the information about the characters that - * this font can display. + * Given an HFONT, get the information about the characters that this + * font can display. * * Results: - * If the font has no Unicode character information, the return value - * is 0 and *startCountPtr and *endCountPtr are filled with NULL. - * Otherwise, *startCountPtr and *endCountPtr are set to pointers to - * arrays of TrueType character existence information and the return - * value is the length of the arrays (the two arrays are always the - * same length as each other). + * If the font has no Unicode character information, the return value is + * 0 and *startCountPtr and *endCountPtr are filled with NULL. Otherwise, + * *startCountPtr and *endCountPtr are set to pointers to arrays of + * TrueType character existence information and the return value is the + * length of the arrays (the two arrays are always the same length as + * each other). * * Side effects: * None. @@ -2276,10 +2263,10 @@ static int LoadFontRanges( HDC hdc, /* HDC into which font can be selected. */ HFONT hFont, /* HFONT to query. */ - USHORT **startCountPtr, /* Filled with malloced pointer to - * character range information. */ - USHORT **endCountPtr, /* Filled with malloced pointer to - * character range information. */ + USHORT **startCountPtr, /* Filled with malloced pointer to character + * range information. */ + USHORT **endCountPtr, /* Filled with malloced pointer to character + * range information. */ int *symbolPtr) { int n, i, swapped, offset, cbData, segCount; @@ -2325,7 +2312,7 @@ LoadFontRanges( SwapLong(&encTable.offset); } if (encTable.platform != 3) { - /* + /* * Not Microsoft encoding. */ @@ -2337,7 +2324,7 @@ LoadFontRanges( continue; } - GetFontData(hdc, cmapKey, encTable.offset, &subTable, + GetFontData(hdc, cmapKey, encTable.offset, &subTable, sizeof(subTable)); if (swapped) { SwapShort(&subTable.any.format); @@ -2364,16 +2351,15 @@ LoadFontRanges( } if (*symbolPtr != 0) { /* - * Empirically determined: When a symbol font is - * loaded, the character existence metrics obtained - * from the system are mildly wrong. If the real range - * of the symbol font is from 0020 to 00FE, then the - * metrics are reported as F020 to F0FE. When we load - * a symbol font, we must fix the character existence - * metrics. + * Empirically determined: When a symbol font is loaded, + * the character existence metrics obtained from the + * system are mildly wrong. If the real range of the + * symbol font is from 0020 to 00FE, then the metrics are + * reported as F020 to F0FE. When we load a symbol font, + * we must fix the character existence metrics. * - * Symbol fonts should only use the symbol encoding - * for 8-bit characters [note Bug: 2406] + * Symbol fonts should only use the symbol encoding for + * 8-bit characters [note Bug: 2406] */ for (i = 0; i < segCount; i++) { @@ -2388,9 +2374,10 @@ LoadFontRanges( } } else if (GetTextCharset(hdc) == ANSI_CHARSET) { /* - * Bitmap font. We should also support ranges for the other - * *_CHARSET values. + * Bitmap font. We should also support ranges for the other *_CHARSET + * values. */ + segCount = 1; cbData = segCount * sizeof(USHORT); startCount = (USHORT *) ckalloc(cbData); @@ -2407,11 +2394,11 @@ LoadFontRanges( /* *------------------------------------------------------------------------- - * + * * SwapShort, SwapLong -- * - * Helper functions to convert the data loaded from TrueType font - * files to Intel byte ordering. + * Helper functions to convert the data loaded from TrueType font files + * to Intel byte ordering. * * Results: * Bytes of input value are swapped and stored back in argument. @@ -2423,14 +2410,16 @@ LoadFontRanges( */ static void -SwapShort(PUSHORT p) +SwapShort( + PUSHORT p) { *p = (SHORT)(HIBYTE(*p) + (LOBYTE(*p) << 8)); } -static void -SwapLong(PULONG p) -{ +static void +SwapLong( + PULONG p) +{ ULONG temp; temp = (LONG) ((BYTE) *p); @@ -2448,3 +2437,11 @@ SwapLong(PULONG p) temp += (LONG) ((BYTE) *p); *p = temp; } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWinImage.c b/win/tkWinImage.c index 70d937c..e07fcdf 100644 --- a/win/tkWinImage.c +++ b/win/tkWinImage.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* +/* * tkWinImage.c -- * * This file contains routines for manipulation full-color images. @@ -8,23 +8,23 @@ * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinImage.c,v 1.8 2003/10/28 22:52:01 hobbs Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinImage.c,v 1.9 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkWinInt.h" -static int DestroyImage _ANSI_ARGS_((XImage* data)); -static unsigned long ImageGetPixel _ANSI_ARGS_((XImage *image, int x, int y)); -static int PutPixel _ANSI_ARGS_((XImage *image, int x, int y, - unsigned long pixel)); +static int DestroyImage(XImage* data); +static unsigned long ImageGetPixel(XImage *image, int x, int y); +static int PutPixel(XImage *image, int x, int y, + unsigned long pixel); /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * DestroyImage -- * - * This is a trivial wrapper around ckfree to make it possible to - * pass ckfree as a pointer. + * This is a trivial wrapper around ckfree to make it possible to pass + * ckfree as a pointer. * * Results: * None. @@ -36,8 +36,8 @@ static int PutPixel _ANSI_ARGS_((XImage *image, int x, int y, */ static int -DestroyImage(imagePtr) - XImage *imagePtr; /* image to free */ +DestroyImage( + XImage *imagePtr) /* Image to free. */ { if (imagePtr) { if (imagePtr->data) { @@ -65,33 +65,33 @@ DestroyImage(imagePtr) */ static unsigned long -ImageGetPixel(image, x, y) - XImage *image; - int x, y; +ImageGetPixel( + XImage *image, + int x, int y) { unsigned long pixel = 0; unsigned char *srcPtr = &(image->data[(y * image->bytes_per_line) + ((x * image->bits_per_pixel) / NBBY)]); switch (image->bits_per_pixel) { - case 32: - case 24: - pixel = RGB(srcPtr[2], srcPtr[1], srcPtr[0]); - break; - case 16: - pixel = RGB(((((WORD*)srcPtr)[0]) >> 7) & 0xf8, - ((((WORD*)srcPtr)[0]) >> 2) & 0xf8, - ((((WORD*)srcPtr)[0]) << 3) & 0xf8); - break; - case 8: - pixel = srcPtr[0]; - break; - case 4: - pixel = ((x%2) ? (*srcPtr) : ((*srcPtr) >> 4)) & 0x0f; - break; - case 1: - pixel = ((*srcPtr) & (0x80 >> (x%8))) ? 1 : 0; - break; + case 32: + case 24: + pixel = RGB(srcPtr[2], srcPtr[1], srcPtr[0]); + break; + case 16: + pixel = RGB(((((WORD*)srcPtr)[0]) >> 7) & 0xf8, + ((((WORD*)srcPtr)[0]) >> 2) & 0xf8, + ((((WORD*)srcPtr)[0]) << 3) & 0xf8); + break; + case 8: + pixel = srcPtr[0]; + break; + case 4: + pixel = ((x%2) ? (*srcPtr) : ((*srcPtr) >> 4)) & 0x0f; + break; + case 1: + pixel = ((*srcPtr) & (0x80 >> (x%8))) ? 1 : 0; + break; } return pixel; } @@ -113,73 +113,74 @@ ImageGetPixel(image, x, y) */ static int -PutPixel(image, x, y, pixel) - XImage *image; - int x, y; - unsigned long pixel; +PutPixel( + XImage *image, + int x, int y, + unsigned long pixel) { unsigned char *destPtr = &(image->data[(y * image->bytes_per_line) + ((x * image->bits_per_pixel) / NBBY)]); switch (image->bits_per_pixel) { - case 32: - /* - * Pixel is DWORD: 0x00BBGGRR - */ + case 32: + /* + * Pixel is DWORD: 0x00BBGGRR + */ - destPtr[3] = 0; - case 24: - /* - * Pixel is triplet: 0xBBGGRR. - */ + destPtr[3] = 0; + case 24: + /* + * Pixel is triplet: 0xBBGGRR. + */ - destPtr[0] = (unsigned char) GetBValue(pixel); - destPtr[1] = (unsigned char) GetGValue(pixel); - destPtr[2] = (unsigned char) GetRValue(pixel); - break; - case 16: - /* - * Pixel is WORD: 5-5-5 (R-G-B) - */ + destPtr[0] = (unsigned char) GetBValue(pixel); + destPtr[1] = (unsigned char) GetGValue(pixel); + destPtr[2] = (unsigned char) GetRValue(pixel); + break; + case 16: + /* + * Pixel is WORD: 5-5-5 (R-G-B) + */ - (*(WORD*)destPtr) = - ((GetRValue(pixel) & 0xf8) << 7) + (*(WORD*)destPtr) = ((GetRValue(pixel) & 0xf8) << 7) | ((GetGValue(pixel) & 0xf8) <<2) | ((GetBValue(pixel) & 0xf8) >> 3); - break; - case 8: - /* - * Pixel is 8-bit index into color table. - */ + break; + case 8: + /* + * Pixel is 8-bit index into color table. + */ - (*destPtr) = (unsigned char) pixel; - break; - case 4: - /* - * Pixel is 4-bit index in MSBFirst order. - */ - if (x%2) { - (*destPtr) = (unsigned char) (((*destPtr) & 0xf0) + (*destPtr) = (unsigned char) pixel; + break; + case 4: + /* + * Pixel is 4-bit index in MSBFirst order. + */ + + if (x%2) { + (*destPtr) = (unsigned char) (((*destPtr) & 0xf0) | (pixel & 0x0f)); - } else { - (*destPtr) = (unsigned char) (((*destPtr) & 0x0f) + } else { + (*destPtr) = (unsigned char) (((*destPtr) & 0x0f) | ((pixel << 4) & 0xf0)); - } - break; - case 1: { - /* - * Pixel is bit in MSBFirst order. - */ + } + break; + case 1: { + /* + * Pixel is bit in MSBFirst order. + */ - int mask = (0x80 >> (x%8)); - if (pixel) { - (*destPtr) |= mask; - } else { - (*destPtr) &= ~mask; - } + int mask = (0x80 >> (x%8)); + + if (pixel) { + (*destPtr) |= mask; + } else { + (*destPtr) &= ~mask; } break; } + } return 0; } @@ -200,18 +201,17 @@ PutPixel(image, x, y, pixel) */ XImage * -XCreateImage(display, visual, depth, format, offset, data, width, height, - bitmap_pad, bytes_per_line) - Display* display; - Visual* visual; - unsigned int depth; - int format; - int offset; - char* data; - unsigned int width; - unsigned int height; - int bitmap_pad; - int bytes_per_line; +XCreateImage( + Display *display, + Visual *visual, + unsigned int depth, + int format, + int offset, + char *data, + unsigned int width, + unsigned int height, + int bitmap_pad, + int bytes_per_line) { XImage* imagePtr = (XImage *) ckalloc(sizeof(XImage)); imagePtr->width = width; @@ -255,40 +255,39 @@ XCreateImage(display, visual, depth, format, offset, data, width, height, imagePtr->f.create_image = NULL; imagePtr->f.sub_image = NULL; imagePtr->f.add_pixel = NULL; - + return imagePtr; } /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- + * * XGetImageZPixmap -- * - * This function copies data from a pixmap or window into an - * XImage. This handles the ZPixmap case only. + * This function copies data from a pixmap or window into an XImage. This + * handles the ZPixmap case only. * * Results: - * Returns a newly allocated image containing the data from the - * given rectangle of the given drawable. + * Returns a newly allocated image containing the data from the given + * rectangle of the given drawable. * * Side effects: * None. * - * This procedure is adapted from the XGetImage implementation in TkNT. - * That code is Copyright (c) 1994 Software Research Associates, Inc. + * This procedure is adapted from the XGetImage implementation in TkNT. That + * code is Copyright (c) 1994 Software Research Associates, Inc. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static XImage * -XGetImageZPixmap(display, d, x, y, width, height, plane_mask, format) - Display* display; - Drawable d; - int x; - int y; - unsigned int width; - unsigned int height; - unsigned long plane_mask; - int format; +XGetImageZPixmap( + Display *display, + Drawable d, + int x, int y, + unsigned int width, unsigned int height, + unsigned long plane_mask, + int format) { TkWinDrawable *twdPtr = (TkWinDrawable *)d; XImage *ret_image; @@ -305,29 +304,32 @@ XGetImageZPixmap(display, d, x, y, width, height, plane_mask, format) if (format != ZPixmap) { TkpDisplayWarning( - "XGetImageZPixmap: only ZPixmap types are implemented", - "XGetImageZPixmap Failure"); + "XGetImageZPixmap: only ZPixmap types are implemented", + "XGetImageZPixmap Failure"); return NULL; } hdc = TkWinGetDrawableDC(display, d, &state); - /* Need to do a Blt operation to copy into a new bitmap */ + /* + * Need to do a Blt operation to copy into a new bitmap. + */ + hbmp = CreateCompatibleBitmap(hdc, width, height); hdcMem = CreateCompatibleDC(hdc); hbmpPrev = SelectObject(hdcMem, hbmp); hPal = state.palette; if (hPal) { - hPalPrev1 = SelectPalette(hdcMem, hPal, FALSE); - n = RealizePalette(hdcMem); - if (n > 0) { - UpdateColors (hdcMem); - } + hPalPrev1 = SelectPalette(hdcMem, hPal, FALSE); + n = RealizePalette(hdcMem); + if (n > 0) { + UpdateColors (hdcMem); + } hPalPrev2 = SelectPalette(hdc, hPal, FALSE); - n = RealizePalette(hdc); - if (n > 0) { - UpdateColors (hdc); - } + n = RealizePalette(hdc); + if (n > 0) { + UpdateColors (hdc); + } } ret = BitBlt(hdcMem, 0, 0, width, height, hdc, x, y, SRCCOPY); @@ -351,20 +353,21 @@ XGetImageZPixmap(display, d, x, y, width, height, plane_mask, format) } bmInfo = (BITMAPINFO *) ckalloc(size); - bmInfo->bmiHeader.biSize = sizeof(BITMAPINFOHEADER); - bmInfo->bmiHeader.biWidth = width; - bmInfo->bmiHeader.biHeight = -(int) height; - bmInfo->bmiHeader.biPlanes = 1; - bmInfo->bmiHeader.biBitCount = depth; - bmInfo->bmiHeader.biCompression = BI_RGB; - bmInfo->bmiHeader.biSizeImage = 0; - bmInfo->bmiHeader.biXPelsPerMeter = 0; - bmInfo->bmiHeader.biYPelsPerMeter = 0; - bmInfo->bmiHeader.biClrUsed = 0; - bmInfo->bmiHeader.biClrImportant = 0; + bmInfo->bmiHeader.biSize = sizeof(BITMAPINFOHEADER); + bmInfo->bmiHeader.biWidth = width; + bmInfo->bmiHeader.biHeight = -(int) height; + bmInfo->bmiHeader.biPlanes = 1; + bmInfo->bmiHeader.biBitCount = depth; + bmInfo->bmiHeader.biCompression = BI_RGB; + bmInfo->bmiHeader.biSizeImage = 0; + bmInfo->bmiHeader.biXPelsPerMeter = 0; + bmInfo->bmiHeader.biYPelsPerMeter = 0; + bmInfo->bmiHeader.biClrUsed = 0; + bmInfo->bmiHeader.biClrImportant = 0; if (depth == 1) { unsigned char *p, *pend; + GetDIBits(hdcMem, hbmp, 0, height, NULL, bmInfo, DIB_PAL_COLORS); data = ckalloc(bmInfo->bmiHeader.biSizeImage); if (!data) { @@ -379,7 +382,10 @@ XGetImageZPixmap(display, d, x, y, width, height, plane_mask, format) goto cleanup; } - /* Get the BITMAP info into the Image. */ + /* + * Get the BITMAP info into the Image. + */ + if (GetDIBits(hdcMem, hbmp, 0, height, data, bmInfo, DIB_PAL_COLORS) == 0) { ckfree((char *) ret_image->data); @@ -412,7 +418,10 @@ XGetImageZPixmap(display, d, x, y, width, height, plane_mask, format) goto cleanup; } - /* Get the BITMAP info into the Image. */ + /* + * Get the BITMAP info into the Image. + */ + if (GetDIBits(hdcMem, hbmp, 0, height, data, bmInfo, DIB_PAL_COLORS) == 0) { ckfree((char *) ret_image->data); @@ -440,7 +449,10 @@ XGetImageZPixmap(display, d, x, y, width, height, plane_mask, format) goto cleanup; } - /* Get the BITMAP info directly into the Image. */ + /* + * Get the BITMAP info directly into the Image. + */ + if (GetDIBits(hdcMem, hbmp, 0, height, ret_image->data, bmInfo, DIB_RGB_COLORS) == 0) { ckfree((char *) ret_image->data); @@ -465,9 +477,10 @@ XGetImageZPixmap(display, d, x, y, width, height, plane_mask, format) if (depth <= 24) { /* - * This used to handle 16 and 24 bpp, but now just handles 24. - * It can likely be optimized for that. -- hobbs + * This used to handle 16 and 24 bpp, but now just handles 24. It + * can likely be optimized for that. -- hobbs */ + unsigned char *smallBitData, *smallBitBase, *bigBitData; unsigned int byte_width, h, w; @@ -481,7 +494,10 @@ XGetImageZPixmap(display, d, x, y, width, height, plane_mask, format) } smallBitData = smallBitBase; - /* Get the BITMAP info into the Image. */ + /* + * Get the BITMAP info into the Image. + */ + if (GetDIBits(hdcMem, hbmp, 0, height, smallBitData, bmInfo, DIB_RGB_COLORS) == 0) { ckfree((char *) ret_image->data); @@ -491,11 +507,14 @@ XGetImageZPixmap(display, d, x, y, width, height, plane_mask, format) goto cleanup; } - /* Copy the 24 Bit Pixmap to a 32-Bit one. */ + /* + * Copy the 24 Bit Pixmap to a 32-Bit one. + */ + for (h = 0; h < height; h++) { bigBitData = ret_image->data + h * ret_image->bytes_per_line; smallBitData = smallBitBase + h * byte_width; - + for (w = 0; w < width; w++) { *bigBitData++ = ((*smallBitData++)); *bigBitData++ = ((*smallBitData++)); @@ -503,10 +522,17 @@ XGetImageZPixmap(display, d, x, y, width, height, plane_mask, format) *bigBitData++ = 0; } } - /* Free the Device contexts, and the Bitmap */ + + /* + * Free the Device contexts, and the Bitmap. + */ + ckfree((char *) smallBitBase); } else { - /* Get the BITMAP info directly into the Image. */ + /* + * Get the BITMAP info directly into the Image. + */ + if (GetDIBits(hdcMem, hbmp, 0, height, ret_image->data, bmInfo, DIB_RGB_COLORS) == 0) { ckfree((char *) ret_image->data); @@ -535,12 +561,11 @@ XGetImageZPixmap(display, d, x, y, width, height, plane_mask, format) * * XGetImage -- * - * This function copies data from a pixmap or window into an - * XImage. + * This function copies data from a pixmap or window into an XImage. * * Results: - * Returns a newly allocated image containing the data from the - * given rectangle of the given drawable. + * Returns a newly allocated image containing the data from the given + * rectangle of the given drawable. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -549,15 +574,13 @@ XGetImageZPixmap(display, d, x, y, width, height, plane_mask, format) */ XImage * -XGetImage(display, d, x, y, width, height, plane_mask, format) - Display* display; - Drawable d; - int x; - int y; - unsigned int width; - unsigned int height; - unsigned long plane_mask; - int format; +XGetImage( + Display* display, + Drawable d, + int x, int y, + unsigned int width, unsigned int height, + unsigned long plane_mask, + int format) { TkWinDrawable *twdPtr = (TkWinDrawable *)d; XImage *imagePtr; @@ -569,26 +592,28 @@ XGetImage(display, d, x, y, width, height, plane_mask, format) /* * Avoid unmapped windows or bad drawables */ + return NULL; } if (twdPtr->type != TWD_BITMAP) { /* * This handles TWD_WINDOW or TWD_WINDC, always creating a 32bit - * image. If the window being copied isn't visible (unmapped or - * obscured), we quietly stop copying (no user error). - * The user will see black where the widget should be. - * This branch is likely followed in favor of XGetImageZPixmap as - * postscript printed widgets require RGB data. + * image. If the window being copied isn't visible (unmapped or + * obscured), we quietly stop copying (no user error). The user will + * see black where the widget should be. This branch is likely + * followed in favor of XGetImageZPixmap as postscript printed widgets + * require RGB data. */ + TkWinDCState state; unsigned int xx, yy, size; COLORREF pixel; dc = TkWinGetDrawableDC(display, d, &state); - imagePtr = XCreateImage(display, NULL, 32, - format, 0, NULL, width, height, 32, 0); + imagePtr = XCreateImage(display, NULL, 32, format, 0, NULL, + width, height, 32, 0); size = imagePtr->bytes_per_line * imagePtr->height; imagePtr->data = ckalloc(size); ZeroMemory(imagePtr->data, size); @@ -606,11 +631,12 @@ XGetImage(display, d, x, y, width, height, plane_mask, format) TkWinReleaseDrawableDC(d, dc, &state); } else if (format == ZPixmap) { /* - * This actually handles most TWD_WINDOW requests, but it varies - * from the above in that it really does a screen capture of - * an area, which is consistent with the Unix behavior, but does - * not appear to handle all bit depths correctly. -- hobbs + * This actually handles most TWD_WINDOW requests, but it varies from + * the above in that it really does a screen capture of an area, which + * is consistent with the Unix behavior, but does not appear to handle + * all bit depths correctly. -- hobbs */ + imagePtr = XGetImageZPixmap(display, d, x, y, width, height, plane_mask, format); } else { @@ -629,6 +655,7 @@ XGetImage(display, d, x, y, width, height, plane_mask, format) /* * Do a soft warning for the unsupported XGetImage types. */ + TkpDisplayWarning(errMsg, "XGetImage Failure"); return NULL; } @@ -661,3 +688,11 @@ XGetImage(display, d, x, y, width, height, plane_mask, format) return imagePtr; } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWinInit.c b/win/tkWinInit.c index bdedb2b..71c98af 100644 --- a/win/tkWinInit.c +++ b/win/tkWinInit.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* +/* * tkWinInit.c -- * * This file contains Windows-specific interpreter initialization @@ -9,17 +9,17 @@ * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinInit.c,v 1.11 2003/02/18 19:18:33 hobbs Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinInit.c,v 1.12 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkWinInt.h" /* - * The Init script (common to Windows and Unix platforms) is - * defined in tkInitScript.h + * The Init script (common to Windows and Unix platforms) is defined in + * tkInitScript.h */ -#include "tkInitScript.h" +#include "tkInitScript.h" /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -30,8 +30,8 @@ * tk_library variable. * * Results: - * A standard Tcl completion code (TCL_OK or TCL_ERROR). Also - * leaves information in the interp's result. + * A standard Tcl completion code (TCL_OK or TCL_ERROR). Also leaves + * information in the interp's result. * * Side effects: * Sets "tk_library" Tcl variable, runs "tk.tcl" script. @@ -40,13 +40,14 @@ */ int -TkpInit(interp) - Tcl_Interp *interp; +TkpInit( + Tcl_Interp *interp) { /* * This is necessary for static initialization, and is ok otherwise * because TkWinXInit flips a static bit to do its work just once. */ + TkWinXInit(Tk_GetHINSTANCE()); return Tcl_Eval(interp, initScript); } @@ -56,9 +57,9 @@ TkpInit(interp) * * TkpGetAppName -- * - * Retrieves the name of the current application from a platform - * specific location. For Windows, the application name is the - * root of the tail of the path contained in the tcl variable argv0. + * Retrieves the name of the current application from a platform specific + * location. For Windows, the application name is the root of the tail of + * the path contained in the tcl variable argv0. * * Results: * Returns the application name in the given Tcl_DString. @@ -70,9 +71,9 @@ TkpInit(interp) */ void -TkpGetAppName(interp, namePtr) - Tcl_Interp *interp; - Tcl_DString *namePtr; /* A previously initialized Tcl_DString. */ +TkpGetAppName( + Tcl_Interp *interp, + Tcl_DString *namePtr) /* A previously initialized Tcl_DString. */ { int argc, namelength; CONST char **argv = NULL, *name, *p; @@ -106,8 +107,8 @@ TkpGetAppName(interp, namePtr) * * TkpDisplayWarning -- * - * This routines is called from Tk_Main to display warning - * messages that occur during startup. + * This routines is called from Tk_Main to display warning messages that + * occur during startup. * * Results: * None. @@ -119,17 +120,18 @@ TkpGetAppName(interp, namePtr) */ void -TkpDisplayWarning(msg, title) - CONST char *msg; /* Message to be displayed. */ - CONST char *title; /* Title of warning. */ +TkpDisplayWarning( + CONST char *msg, /* Message to be displayed. */ + CONST char *title) /* Title of warning. */ { Tcl_DString msgString, titleString; Tcl_Encoding unicodeEncoding = TkWinGetUnicodeEncoding(); /* - * Truncate MessageBox string if it is too long to not overflow - * the screen and cause possible oversized window error. + * Truncate MessageBox string if it is too long to not overflow the screen + * and cause possible oversized window error. */ + #define TK_MAX_WARN_LEN (1024 * sizeof(WCHAR)) Tcl_UtfToExternalDString(unicodeEncoding, msg, -1, &msgString); Tcl_UtfToExternalDString(unicodeEncoding, title, -1, &titleString); @@ -144,3 +146,11 @@ TkpDisplayWarning(msg, title) Tcl_DStringFree(&msgString); Tcl_DStringFree(&titleString); } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWinInt.h b/win/tkWinInt.h index 50bbd52..eb04dec 100644 --- a/win/tkWinInt.h +++ b/win/tkWinInt.h @@ -2,16 +2,15 @@ * tkWinInt.h -- * * This file contains declarations that are shared among the - * Windows-specific parts of Tk, but aren't used by the rest of - * Tk. + * Windows-specific parts of Tk, but aren't used by the rest of Tk. * * Copyright (c) 1995-1997 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * Copyright (c) 1998-2000 by Scriptics Corporation. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinInt.h,v 1.24 2005/06/01 17:54:16 hobbs Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinInt.h,v 1.25 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #ifndef _TKWININT @@ -33,18 +32,17 @@ #include "tkPort.h" #endif - /* * Define constants missing from older Win32 SDK header files. */ #ifndef WS_EX_TOOLWINDOW -#define WS_EX_TOOLWINDOW 0x00000080L +#define WS_EX_TOOLWINDOW 0x00000080L #endif /* - * The TkWinDCState is used to save the state of a device context - * so that it can be restored later. + * The TkWinDCState is used to save the state of a device context so that it + * can be restored later. */ typedef struct TkWinDCState { @@ -53,8 +51,8 @@ typedef struct TkWinDCState { } TkWinDCState; /* - * The TkWinDrawable is the internal implementation of an X Drawable (either - * a Window or a Pixmap). The following constants define the valid Drawable + * The TkWinDrawable is the internal implementation of an X Drawable (either a + * Window or a Pixmap). The following constants define the valid Drawable * types. */ @@ -105,11 +103,11 @@ typedef struct { HPALETTE palette; /* Palette handle used when drawing. */ UINT size; /* Number of entries in the palette. */ int stale; /* 1 if palette needs to be realized, - * otherwise 0. If the palette is stale, - * then an idle handler is scheduled to - * realize the palette. */ - Tcl_HashTable refCounts; /* Hash table of palette entry reference counts - * indexed by pixel value. */ + * otherwise 0. If the palette is stale, then + * an idle handler is scheduled to realize the + * palette. */ + Tcl_HashTable refCounts; /* Hash table of palette entry reference + * counts indexed by pixel value. */ } TkWinColormap; /* @@ -135,8 +133,8 @@ extern int tkpWinRopModes[]; extern int tkpWinBltModes[]; /* - * The following defines are used with TkWinGetBorderPixels to get the - * extra 2 border colors from a Tk_3DBorder. + * The following defines are used with TkWinGetBorderPixels to get the extra 2 + * border colors from a Tk_3DBorder. */ #define TK_3D_LIGHT2 TK_3D_DARK_GC+1 @@ -152,46 +150,51 @@ extern int tkpWinBltModes[]; * We need to specially add the TkWinChildProc because of the special * prototype it has (doesn't fit into stubs schema) */ + #ifdef BUILD_tk #undef TCL_STORAGE_CLASS #define TCL_STORAGE_CLASS DLLEXPORT #endif -EXTERN LRESULT CALLBACK TkWinChildProc _ANSI_ARGS_((HWND hwnd, UINT message, - WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam)); +EXTERN LRESULT CALLBACK TkWinChildProc(HWND hwnd, UINT message, + WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam); /* * Special proc needed as tsd accessor function between * tkWinX.c:GenerateXEvent and tkWinClipboard.c:UpdateClipboard */ -EXTERN void TkWinUpdatingClipboard(int mode); + +EXTERN void TkWinUpdatingClipboard(int mode); /* * Used by tkWinDialog.c to associate the right icon with tk_messageBox */ -EXTERN HICON TkWinGetIcon(Tk_Window tkw, DWORD iconsize); + +EXTERN HICON TkWinGetIcon(Tk_Window tkw, DWORD iconsize); /* - * Used by tkWinX.c on for certain system display change messages - * and cleanup up containers + * Used by tkWinX.c on for certain system display change messages and cleanup + * up containers */ -EXTERN void TkWinDisplayChanged(Display *display); -void TkWinCleanupContainerList(void); + +EXTERN void TkWinDisplayChanged(Display *display); +void TkWinCleanupContainerList(void); /* - * Used by tkWinWm.c for embedded menu handling. May become public. + * Used by tkWinWm.c for embedded menu handling. May become public. */ -EXTERN HWND Tk_GetMenuHWND(Tk_Window tkwin); -EXTERN HWND Tk_GetEmbeddedMenuHWND(Tk_Window tkwin); + +EXTERN HWND Tk_GetMenuHWND(Tk_Window tkwin); +EXTERN HWND Tk_GetEmbeddedMenuHWND(Tk_Window tkwin); /* - * The following structure keeps track of whether we are using the - * multi-byte or the wide-character interfaces to the operating system. - * System calls should be made through the following function table. + * The following structure keeps track of whether we are using the multi-byte + * or the wide-character interfaces to the operating system. System calls + * should be made through the following function table. * * While some system calls need to use this A/W jump-table, it is not - * necessary for all calls to do it, which is why you won't see this - * used throughout the Tk code, but only in key areas. -- hobbs + * necessary for all calls to do it, which is why you won't see this used + * throughout the Tk code, but only in key areas. -- hobbs */ typedef struct TkWinProcs { @@ -221,24 +224,28 @@ EXTERN TkWinProcs *tkWinProcs; */ -extern Tcl_Encoding TkWinGetKeyInputEncoding _ANSI_ARGS_((void)); -extern Tcl_Encoding TkWinGetUnicodeEncoding _ANSI_ARGS_((void)); +extern Tcl_Encoding TkWinGetKeyInputEncoding(void); +extern Tcl_Encoding TkWinGetUnicodeEncoding(void); /* * Values returned by TkWinGetPlatformTheme. */ + #define TK_THEME_WIN_CLASSIC 1 #define TK_THEME_WIN_XP 2 /* - * The following is implemented in tkWinWm and used by tkWinEmbed.c + * The following is implemented in tkWinWm and used by tkWinEmbed.c */ -void TkpWinToplevelWithDraw _ANSI_ARGS_((TkWindow *winPtr)); -void TkpWinToplevelIconify _ANSI_ARGS_((TkWindow *winPtr)); -void TkpWinToplevelDeiconify _ANSI_ARGS_((TkWindow *winPtr)); -long TkpWinToplevelIsControlledByWm _ANSI_ARGS_((TkWindow *winPtr)); -long TkpWinToplevelMove _ANSI_ARGS_((TkWindow *winPtr, int x, int y)); -long TkpWinToplevelOverrideRedirect _ANSI_ARGS_((TkWindow *winPtr, int reqValue)); -void TkpWinToplevelDetachWindow _ANSI_ARGS_((TkWindow *winPtr)); -int TkpWmGetState _ANSI_ARGS_((TkWindow *winPtr)); + +void TkpWinToplevelWithDraw(TkWindow *winPtr); +void TkpWinToplevelIconify(TkWindow *winPtr); +void TkpWinToplevelDeiconify(TkWindow *winPtr); +long TkpWinToplevelIsControlledByWm(TkWindow *winPtr); +long TkpWinToplevelMove(TkWindow *winPtr, int x, int y); +long TkpWinToplevelOverrideRedirect(TkWindow *winPtr, + int reqValue); +void TkpWinToplevelDetachWindow(TkWindow *winPtr); +int TkpWmGetState(TkWindow *winPtr); + #endif /* _TKWININT */ diff --git a/win/tkWinKey.c b/win/tkWinKey.c index 7f5a338..f43c6e9 100644 --- a/win/tkWinKey.c +++ b/win/tkWinKey.c @@ -9,58 +9,60 @@ * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinKey.c,v 1.14 2001/05/30 22:41:11 hobbs Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinKey.c,v 1.15 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkWinInt.h" + /* - * The keymap table holds mappings of Windows keycodes to X keysyms. - * If Windows ever comes along and changes the value of their keycodes, - * this will break all kinds of things. However, this table lookup is much - * faster than the alternative, in which we walked a list of keycodes looking - * for a match. Since this lookup is performed for every Windows keypress - * event, it seems like a worthwhile improvement to use the table. + * The keymap table holds mappings of Windows keycodes to X keysyms. If + * Windows ever comes along and changes the value of their keycodes, this will + * break all kinds of things. However, this table lookup is much faster than + * the alternative, in which we walked a list of keycodes looking for a match. + * Since this lookup is performed for every Windows keypress event, it seems + * like a worthwhile improvement to use the table. */ + #define MAX_KEYCODE 145 /* VK_SCROLL is the last entry in our table below */ static KeySym keymap[] = { NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, XK_Cancel, NoSymbol, - NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, XK_BackSpace, XK_Tab, - NoSymbol, NoSymbol, XK_Clear, XK_Return, NoSymbol, - NoSymbol, XK_Shift_L, XK_Control_L, XK_Alt_L, XK_Pause, - XK_Caps_Lock, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, - NoSymbol, NoSymbol, XK_Escape, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, - NoSymbol, NoSymbol, XK_space, XK_Prior, XK_Next, - XK_End, XK_Home, XK_Left, XK_Up, XK_Right, - XK_Down, XK_Select, XK_Print, XK_Execute, NoSymbol, - XK_Insert, XK_Delete, XK_Help, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, - NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, - NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, - NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, - NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, - NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, - NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, - NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, - NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, - NoSymbol, XK_Win_L, XK_Win_R, XK_App, NoSymbol, - NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, - NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, - NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, - NoSymbol, NoSymbol, XK_F1, XK_F2, XK_F3, - XK_F4, XK_F5, XK_F6, XK_F7, XK_F8, - XK_F9, XK_F10, XK_F11, XK_F12, XK_F13, - XK_F14, XK_F15, XK_F16, XK_F17, XK_F18, - XK_F19, XK_F20, XK_F21, XK_F22, XK_F23, - XK_F24, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, - NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, XK_Num_Lock, - XK_Scroll_Lock + NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, XK_BackSpace, XK_Tab, + NoSymbol, NoSymbol, XK_Clear, XK_Return, NoSymbol, + NoSymbol, XK_Shift_L, XK_Control_L, XK_Alt_L, XK_Pause, + XK_Caps_Lock, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, + NoSymbol, NoSymbol, XK_Escape, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, + NoSymbol, NoSymbol, XK_space, XK_Prior, XK_Next, + XK_End, XK_Home, XK_Left, XK_Up, XK_Right, + XK_Down, XK_Select, XK_Print, XK_Execute, NoSymbol, + XK_Insert, XK_Delete, XK_Help, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, + NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, + NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, + NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, + NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, + NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, + NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, + NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, + NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, + NoSymbol, XK_Win_L, XK_Win_R, XK_App, NoSymbol, + NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, + NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, + NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, + NoSymbol, NoSymbol, XK_F1, XK_F2, XK_F3, + XK_F4, XK_F5, XK_F6, XK_F7, XK_F8, + XK_F9, XK_F10, XK_F11, XK_F12, XK_F13, + XK_F14, XK_F15, XK_F16, XK_F17, XK_F18, + XK_F19, XK_F20, XK_F21, XK_F22, XK_F23, + XK_F24, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, + NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, NoSymbol, XK_Num_Lock, + XK_Scroll_Lock }; /* * Prototypes for local procedures defined in this file: */ -static KeySym KeycodeToKeysym _ANSI_ARGS_((unsigned int keycode, - int state, int noascii)); +static KeySym KeycodeToKeysym(unsigned int keycode, + int state, int noascii); /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -79,11 +81,11 @@ static KeySym KeycodeToKeysym _ANSI_ARGS_((unsigned int keycode, */ char * -TkpGetString(winPtr, eventPtr, dsPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Window where event occurred: needed to - * get input context. */ - XEvent *eventPtr; /* X keyboard event. */ - Tcl_DString *dsPtr; /* Uninitialized or empty string to hold +TkpGetString( + TkWindow *winPtr, /* Window where event occurred: needed to get + * input context. */ + XEvent *eventPtr, /* X keyboard event. */ + Tcl_DString *dsPtr) /* Uninitialized or empty string to hold * result. */ { KeySym keysym; @@ -97,7 +99,7 @@ TkpGetString(winPtr, eventPtr, dsPtr) } } else if (eventPtr->xkey.send_event == -2) { /* - * Special case for win2000 multi-lingal IME input. + * Special case for win2000 multi-lingal IME input. * xkey.trans_chars[] already contains a UNICODE char. */ @@ -112,19 +114,20 @@ TkpGetString(winPtr, eventPtr, dsPtr) len = Tcl_UniCharToUtf((Tcl_UniChar) unichar, buf); Tcl_DStringAppend(dsPtr, buf, len); - } else { + } else { /* - * This is an event generated from generic code. It has no - * nchars or trans_chars members. + * This is an event generated from generic code. It has no nchars or + * trans_chars members. */ keysym = KeycodeToKeysym(eventPtr->xkey.keycode, eventPtr->xkey.state, 0); - if (((keysym != NoSymbol) && (keysym > 0) && (keysym < 256)) - || (keysym == XK_Return) - || (keysym == XK_Tab)) { + if (((keysym != NoSymbol) && (keysym > 0) && (keysym < 256)) + || (keysym == XK_Return) || (keysym == XK_Tab)) { char buf[TCL_UTF_MAX]; - int len = Tcl_UniCharToUtf((Tcl_UniChar) (keysym & 255), buf); + int len; + + len = Tcl_UniCharToUtf((Tcl_UniChar) (keysym & 255), buf); Tcl_DStringAppend(dsPtr, buf, len); } } @@ -136,8 +139,8 @@ TkpGetString(winPtr, eventPtr, dsPtr) * * XKeycodeToKeysym -- * - * Translate from a system-dependent keycode to a - * system-independent keysym. + * Translate from a system-dependent keycode to a system-independent + * keysym. * * Results: * Returns the translated keysym, or NoSymbol on failure. @@ -149,10 +152,10 @@ TkpGetString(winPtr, eventPtr, dsPtr) */ KeySym -XKeycodeToKeysym(display, keycode, index) - Display* display; - unsigned int keycode; - int index; +XKeycodeToKeysym( + Display *display, + unsigned int keycode, + int index) { int state = 0; @@ -161,32 +164,30 @@ XKeycodeToKeysym(display, keycode, index) } return KeycodeToKeysym(keycode, state, 0); } - - /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * KeycodeToKeysym -- * - * Translate from a system-dependent keycode to a - * system-independent keysym. + * Translate from a system-dependent keycode to a system-independent + * keysym. * * Results: * Returns the translated keysym, or NoSymbol on failure. * * Side effects: - * It may affect the internal state of the keyboard, such as - * remembered dead key or lock indicator lamps. + * It may affect the internal state of the keyboard, such as remembered + * dead key or lock indicator lamps. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static KeySym -KeycodeToKeysym(keycode, state, noascii) - unsigned int keycode; - int state; - int noascii; +KeycodeToKeysym( + unsigned int keycode, + int state, + int noascii) { BYTE keys[256]; int result, deadkey, shift; @@ -194,14 +195,15 @@ KeycodeToKeysym(keycode, state, noascii) unsigned int scancode = MapVirtualKey(keycode, 0); /* - * Do not run keycodes of lock keys through ToAscii(). - * One of ToAscii()'s side effects is to handle the lights - * on the keyboard, and we don't want to mess that up. + * Do not run keycodes of lock keys through ToAscii(). One of ToAscii()'s + * side effects is to handle the lights on the keyboard, and we don't want + * to mess that up. */ if (noascii || keycode == VK_CAPITAL || keycode == VK_SCROLL || - keycode == VK_NUMLOCK) + keycode == VK_NUMLOCK) { goto skipToAscii; + } /* * Use MapVirtualKey() to detect some dead keys. @@ -222,27 +224,28 @@ KeycodeToKeysym(keycode, state, noascii) if (state & Mod2Mask) keys[VK_MENU] = 0x80; - /* + /* * Make sure all lock button info is correct so we don't mess up the - * lights + * lights. */ - if (state & LockMask) + if (state & LockMask) { keys[VK_CAPITAL] = 1; - if (state & Mod3Mask) + } + if (state & Mod3Mask) { keys[VK_SCROLL] = 1; - if (state & Mod1Mask) + } + if (state & Mod1Mask) { keys[VK_NUMLOCK] = 1; + } result = ToAscii(keycode, scancode, keys, (LPWORD) buf, 0); if (result < 0) { /* - * Win95/98: - * This was a dead char, which is now remembered by the keyboard. - * Call ToAscii() again to forget it. - * WinNT: - * This was a dead char, overwriting any previously remembered + * Win95/98: This was a dead char, which is now remembered by the + * keyboard. Call ToAscii() again to forget it. + * WinNT: This was a dead char, overwriting any previously remembered * key. Calling ToAscii() again does not affect anything. */ @@ -251,12 +254,10 @@ KeycodeToKeysym(keycode, state, noascii) } if (result == 2) { /* - * This was a dead char, and there were one previously remembered - * by the keyboard. - * Call ToAscii() again with proper parameters to restore it. - */ - - /* + * This was a dead char, and there were one previously remembered by + * the keyboard. Call ToAscii() again with proper parameters to + * restore it. + * * Get information about the old char */ @@ -270,39 +271,42 @@ KeycodeToKeysym(keycode, state, noascii) */ memset(keys, 0, 256); - if (shift & 1) + if (shift & 1) { keys[VK_SHIFT] = 0x80; - if (shift & 2) + } + if (shift & 2) { keys[VK_CONTROL] = 0x80; - if (shift & 4) + } + if (shift & 4) { keys[VK_MENU] = 0x80; + } ToAscii(deadkey, scancode, keys, (LPWORD) buf, 0); return XK_Multi_key; } /* - * Keycode mapped to a valid Latin-1 character. Since the keysyms - * for alphanumeric characters map onto Latin-1, we just return it. + * Keycode mapped to a valid Latin-1 character. Since the keysyms for + * alphanumeric characters map onto Latin-1, we just return it. * - * We treat 0x7F as a special case mostly for backwards compatibility. - * In versions of Tk<=8.2, Control-Backspace returned "XK_BackSpace" - * as the X Keysym. This was due to the fact that we did not - * initialize the keys array properly when we passed it to ToAscii, above. - * We had previously not been setting the state bit for the Control key. - * When we fixed that, we found that Control-Backspace on Windows is - * interpreted as ASCII-127 (0x7F), which corresponds to the Delete key. + * We treat 0x7F as a special case mostly for backwards compatibility. In + * versions of Tk<=8.2, Control-Backspace returned "XK_BackSpace" as the X + * Keysym. This was due to the fact that we did not initialize the keys + * array properly when we passed it to ToAscii, above. We had previously + * not been setting the state bit for the Control key. When we fixed that, + * we found that Control-Backspace on Windows is interpreted as ASCII-127 + * (0x7F), which corresponds to the Delete key. * - * Upon discovering this, we realized we had two choices: return XK_Delete - * or return XK_BackSpace. If we returned XK_Delete, that could be + * Upon discovering this, we realized we had two choices: return XK_Delete + * or return XK_BackSpace. If we returned XK_Delete, that could be * considered "more correct" (although the correctness would be dependant * on whether you believe that ToAscii is doing the right thing in that - * case); however, this would break backwards compatibility, and worse, - * it would limit application programmers -- they would effectively be - * unable to bind to <Control-Backspace> on Windows. We therefore chose - * instead to return XK_BackSpace (handled here by letting the code - * "fall-through" to the return statement below, which works because the - * keycode for this event is VK_BACKSPACE, and the keymap table maps that - * keycode to XK_BackSpace). + * case); however, this would break backwards compatibility, and worse, it + * would limit application programmers -- they would effectively be unable + * to bind to <Control-Backspace> on Windows. We therefore chose instead + * to return XK_BackSpace (handled here by letting the code "fall-through" + * to the return statement below, which works because the keycode for this + * event is VK_BACKSPACE, and the keymap table maps that keycode to + * XK_BackSpace). */ if (result == 1 && UCHAR(buf[0]) >= 0x20 && UCHAR(buf[0]) != 0x7F) { @@ -313,69 +317,63 @@ KeycodeToKeysym(keycode, state, noascii) * Keycode is a non-alphanumeric key, so we have to do the lookup. */ - skipToAscii: + skipToAscii: if (keycode < 0 || keycode > MAX_KEYCODE) { return NoSymbol; } switch (keycode) { /* - * Windows only gives us an undifferentiated VK_CONTROL - * code (for example) when either Control key is pressed. - * To distinguish between left and right, we have to query the - * state of one of the two to determine which was actually - * pressed. So if the keycode indicates Control, Shift, or Menu - * (the key that everybody else calls Alt), do this extra test. - * If the right-side key was pressed, return the appropriate - * keycode. Otherwise, we fall through and rely on the + * Windows only gives us an undifferentiated VK_CONTROL code (for + * example) when either Control key is pressed. To distinguish between + * left and right, we have to query the state of one of the two to + * determine which was actually pressed. So if the keycode indicates + * Control, Shift, or Menu (the key that everybody else calls Alt), do + * this extra test. If the right-side key was pressed, return the + * appropriate keycode. Otherwise, we fall through and rely on the * keymap table to hold the correct keysym value. */ - case VK_CONTROL: { - if (GetKeyState(VK_RCONTROL) & 0x80) { - return XK_Control_R; - } - break; + case VK_CONTROL: + if (GetKeyState(VK_RCONTROL) & 0x80) { + return XK_Control_R; } - case VK_SHIFT: { - if (GetKeyState(VK_RSHIFT) & 0x80) { - return XK_Shift_R; - } - break; + break; + case VK_SHIFT: + if (GetKeyState(VK_RSHIFT) & 0x80) { + return XK_Shift_R; } - case VK_MENU: { - if (GetKeyState(VK_RMENU) & 0x80) { - return XK_Alt_R; - } - break; + break; + case VK_MENU: + if (GetKeyState(VK_RMENU) & 0x80) { + return XK_Alt_R; } + break; } return keymap[keycode]; } - /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkpGetKeySym -- * - * Given an X KeyPress or KeyRelease event, map the - * keycode in the event into a KeySym. + * Given an X KeyPress or KeyRelease event, map the keycode in the event + * into a KeySym. * * Results: - * The return value is the KeySym corresponding to - * eventPtr, or NoSymbol if no matching Keysym could be - * found. + * The return value is the KeySym corresponding to eventPtr, or NoSymbol + * if no matching Keysym could be found. * * Side effects: - * In the first call for a given display, keycode-to- - * KeySym maps get loaded. + * In the first call for a given display, keycode-to-KeySym maps get + * loaded. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ KeySym -TkpGetKeySym(dispPtr, eventPtr) - TkDisplay *dispPtr; /* Display in which to map keycode. */ - XEvent *eventPtr; /* Description of X event. */ +TkpGetKeySym( + TkDisplay *dispPtr, /* Display in which to map keycode. */ + XEvent *eventPtr) /* Description of X event. */ { KeySym sym; int state = eventPtr->xkey.state; @@ -391,16 +389,16 @@ TkpGetKeySym(dispPtr, eventPtr) sym = KeycodeToKeysym(eventPtr->xkey.keycode, state, 0); /* - * Special handling: if this is a ctrl-alt or shifted key, and there - * is no keysym defined, try without the modifiers. + * Special handling: if this is a ctrl-alt or shifted key, and there is no + * keysym defined, try without the modifiers. */ if ((sym == NoSymbol) && ((state & ControlMask) || (state & Mod2Mask))) { - state &= ~(ControlMask | Mod2Mask); + state &= ~(ControlMask | Mod2Mask); sym = KeycodeToKeysym(eventPtr->xkey.keycode, state, 0); } if ((sym == NoSymbol) && (state & ShiftMask)) { - state &= ~ShiftMask; + state &= ~ShiftMask; sym = KeycodeToKeysym(eventPtr->xkey.keycode, state, 0); } return sym; @@ -411,10 +409,9 @@ TkpGetKeySym(dispPtr, eventPtr) * * TkpInitKeymapInfo -- * - * This procedure is invoked to scan keymap information - * to recompute stuff that's important for binding, such - * as the modifier key (if any) that corresponds to "mode - * switch". + * This procedure is invoked to scan keymap information to recompute + * stuff that's important for binding, such as the modifier key (if any) + * that corresponds to "mode switch". * * Results: * None. @@ -426,8 +423,8 @@ TkpGetKeySym(dispPtr, eventPtr) */ void -TkpInitKeymapInfo(dispPtr) - TkDisplay *dispPtr; /* Display for which to recompute keymap +TkpInitKeymapInfo( + TkDisplay *dispPtr) /* Display for which to recompute keymap * information. */ { XModifierKeymap *modMapPtr; @@ -440,9 +437,9 @@ TkpInitKeymapInfo(dispPtr) modMapPtr = XGetModifierMapping(dispPtr->display); /* - * Check the keycodes associated with the Lock modifier. If - * any of them is associated with the XK_Shift_Lock modifier, - * then Lock has to be interpreted as Shift Lock, not Caps Lock. + * Check the keycodes associated with the Lock modifier. If any of them is + * associated with the XK_Shift_Lock modifier, then Lock has to be + * interpreted as Shift Lock, not Caps Lock. */ dispPtr->lockUsage = LU_IGNORE; @@ -463,9 +460,9 @@ TkpInitKeymapInfo(dispPtr) } /* - * Look through the keycodes associated with modifiers to see if - * the the "mode switch", "meta", or "alt" keysyms are associated - * with any modifiers. If so, remember their modifier mask bits. + * Look through the keycodes associated with modifiers to see if the the + * "mode switch", "meta", or "alt" keysyms are associated with any + * modifiers. If so, remember their modifier mask bits. */ dispPtr->modeModMask = 0; @@ -518,7 +515,7 @@ TkpInitKeymapInfo(dispPtr) KeyCode *new; /* - * Ran out of space in the array; grow it. + * Ran out of space in the array; grow it. */ arraySize *= 2; @@ -537,34 +534,32 @@ TkpInitKeymapInfo(dispPtr) } /* - * When mapping from a keysym to a keycode, need - * information about the modifier state that should be used - * so that when they call XKeycodeToKeysym taking into - * account the xkey.state, they will get back the original - * keysym. + * When mapping from a keysym to a keycode, need information about the + * modifier state that should be used so that when they call XKeycodeToKeysym + * taking into account the xkey.state, they will get back the original keysym. */ void -TkpSetKeycodeAndState(tkwin, keySym, eventPtr) - Tk_Window tkwin; - KeySym keySym; - XEvent *eventPtr; +TkpSetKeycodeAndState( + Tk_Window tkwin, + KeySym keySym, + XEvent *eventPtr) { int i; SHORT result; int shift; - + eventPtr->xkey.keycode = 0; if (keySym == NoSymbol) { return; } /* - * We check our private map first for a virtual keycode, - * as VkKeyScan will return values that don't map to X - * for the "extended" Syms. This may be due to just casting - * problems below, but this works. + * We check our private map first for a virtual keycode, as VkKeyScan will + * return values that don't map to X for the "extended" Syms. This may be + * due to just casting problems below, but this works. */ + for (i = 0; i <= MAX_KEYCODE; i++) { if (keymap[i] == keySym) { eventPtr->xkey.keycode = i; @@ -603,19 +598,19 @@ TkpSetKeycodeAndState(tkwin, keySym, eventPtr) */ KeyCode -XKeysymToKeycode(display, keysym) - Display* display; - KeySym keysym; +XKeysymToKeycode( + Display *display, + KeySym keysym) { int i; SHORT result; /* - * We check our private map first for a virtual keycode, - * as VkKeyScan will return values that don't map to X - * for the "extended" Syms. This may be due to just casting - * problems below, but this works. + * We check our private map first for a virtual keycode, as VkKeyScan will + * return values that don't map to X for the "extended" Syms. This may be + * due to just casting problems below, but this works. */ + if (keysym == NoSymbol) { return 0; } @@ -651,10 +646,11 @@ XKeysymToKeycode(display, keysym) */ XModifierKeymap * -XGetModifierMapping(display) - Display* display; +XGetModifierMapping( + Display *display) { - XModifierKeymap *map = (XModifierKeymap *)ckalloc(sizeof(XModifierKeymap)); + XModifierKeymap *map = (XModifierKeymap *) + ckalloc(sizeof(XModifierKeymap)); map->max_keypermod = 1; map->modifiermap = (KeyCode *) ckalloc(sizeof(KeyCode)*8); @@ -674,8 +670,7 @@ XGetModifierMapping(display) * * XFreeModifiermap -- * - * Deallocate a modifier map that was created by - * XGetModifierMapping. + * Deallocate a modifier map that was created by XGetModifierMapping. * * Results: * None. @@ -687,8 +682,8 @@ XGetModifierMapping(display) */ void -XFreeModifiermap(modmap) - XModifierKeymap* modmap; +XFreeModifiermap( + XModifierKeymap *modmap) { ckfree((char *) modmap->modifiermap); ckfree((char *) modmap); @@ -699,11 +694,11 @@ XFreeModifiermap(modmap) * * XStringToKeysym -- * - * Translate a keysym name to the matching keysym. + * Translate a keysym name to the matching keysym. * * Results: - * Returns the keysym. Since this is already handled by - * Tk's StringToKeysym function, we just return NoSymbol. + * Returns the keysym. Since this is already handled by Tk's + * StringToKeysym function, we just return NoSymbol. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -712,8 +707,8 @@ XFreeModifiermap(modmap) */ KeySym -XStringToKeysym(string) - _Xconst char *string; +XStringToKeysym( + _Xconst char *string) { return NoSymbol; } @@ -735,8 +730,16 @@ XStringToKeysym(string) */ char * -XKeysymToString(keysym) - KeySym keysym; +XKeysymToString( + KeySym keysym) { return NULL; } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWinPixmap.c b/win/tkWinPixmap.c index d1fc569..73882b1 100644 --- a/win/tkWinPixmap.c +++ b/win/tkWinPixmap.c @@ -1,15 +1,15 @@ -/* +/* * tkWinPixmap.c -- * - * This file contains the Xlib emulation functions pertaining to - * creating and destroying pixmaps. + * This file contains the Xlib emulation functions pertaining to creating + * and destroying pixmaps. * * Copyright (c) 1995 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinPixmap.c,v 1.4 2004/01/13 02:06:02 davygrvy Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinPixmap.c,v 1.5 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkWinInt.h" @@ -32,17 +32,17 @@ */ Pixmap -Tk_GetPixmap(display, d, width, height, depth) - Display* display; - Drawable d; - int width; - int height; - int depth; +Tk_GetPixmap( + Display *display, + Drawable d, + int width, + int height, + int depth) { TkWinDrawable *newTwdPtr, *twdPtr; int planes; Screen *screen; - + display->request++; newTwdPtr = (TkWinDrawable*) ckalloc(sizeof(TkWinDrawable)); @@ -65,13 +65,14 @@ Tk_GetPixmap(display, d, width, height, depth) planes = (int) screen->ext_data; depth /= planes; } - newTwdPtr->bitmap.handle = CreateBitmap(width, height, planes, depth, NULL); + newTwdPtr->bitmap.handle = + CreateBitmap(width, height, planes, depth, NULL); if (newTwdPtr->bitmap.handle == NULL) { ckfree((char *) newTwdPtr); return None; } - + return (Pixmap)newTwdPtr; } @@ -92,9 +93,9 @@ Tk_GetPixmap(display, d, width, height, depth) */ void -Tk_FreePixmap(display, pixmap) - Display* display; - Pixmap pixmap; +Tk_FreePixmap( + Display *display, + Pixmap pixmap) { TkWinDrawable *twdPtr = (TkWinDrawable *) pixmap; @@ -123,9 +124,9 @@ Tk_FreePixmap(display, pixmap) */ void -TkSetPixmapColormap(pixmap, colormap) - Pixmap pixmap; - Colormap colormap; +TkSetPixmapColormap( + Pixmap pixmap, + Colormap colormap) { TkWinDrawable *twdPtr = (TkWinDrawable *)pixmap; twdPtr->bitmap.colormap = colormap; @@ -136,9 +137,9 @@ TkSetPixmapColormap(pixmap, colormap) * * XGetGeometry -- * - * Retrieve the geometry of the given drawable. Note that - * this is a degenerate implementation that only returns the - * size of a pixmap or window. + * Retrieve the geometry of the given drawable. Note that this is a + * degenerate implementation that only returns the size of a pixmap or + * window. * * Results: * Returns 0. @@ -150,17 +151,16 @@ TkSetPixmapColormap(pixmap, colormap) */ int -XGetGeometry(display, d, root_return, x_return, y_return, width_return, - height_return, border_width_return, depth_return) - Display* display; - Drawable d; - Window* root_return; - int* x_return; - int* y_return; - unsigned int* width_return; - unsigned int* height_return; - unsigned int* border_width_return; - unsigned int* depth_return; +XGetGeometry( + Display *display, + Drawable d, + Window *root_return, + int *x_return, + int *y_return, + unsigned int *width_return, + unsigned int *height_return, + unsigned int *border_width_return, + unsigned int *depth_return) { TkWinDrawable *twdPtr = (TkWinDrawable *)d; @@ -196,3 +196,11 @@ XGetGeometry(display, d, root_return, x_return, y_return, width_return, } return 1; } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWinPointer.c b/win/tkWinPointer.c index 28591cd..6788c71 100644 --- a/win/tkWinPointer.c +++ b/win/tkWinPointer.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* +/* * tkWinPointer.c -- * * Windows specific mouse tracking code. @@ -6,10 +6,10 @@ * Copyright (c) 1995-1997 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * Copyright (c) 1998-1999 by Scriptics Corporation. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinPointer.c,v 1.9 2004/01/13 02:06:02 davygrvy Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinPointer.c,v 1.10 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkWinInt.h" @@ -33,7 +33,7 @@ static int mouseTimerSet = 0; /* 1 if the mouse timer is active. */ * Forward declarations of procedures used in this file. */ -static void MouseTimerProc _ANSI_ARGS_((ClientData clientData)); +static void MouseTimerProc(ClientData clientData); /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -52,7 +52,7 @@ static void MouseTimerProc _ANSI_ARGS_((ClientData clientData)); */ int -TkWinGetModifierState() +TkWinGetModifierState(void) { int state = 0; @@ -91,10 +91,9 @@ TkWinGetModifierState() * * Tk_PointerEvent -- * - * This procedure is called for each pointer-related event. - * It converts the position to root coords and updates the - * global pointer state machine. It also ensures that the - * mouse timer is scheduled. + * This procedure is called for each pointer-related event. It converts + * the position to root coords and updates the global pointer state + * machine. It also ensures that the mouse timer is scheduled. * * Results: * None. @@ -106,11 +105,11 @@ TkWinGetModifierState() */ void -Tk_PointerEvent(hwnd, x, y) - HWND hwnd; /* Window for coords, or NULL for - * the root window. */ - int x, y; /* Coords relative to hwnd, or screen - * if hwnd is NULL. */ +Tk_PointerEvent( + HWND hwnd, /* Window for coords, or NULL for the root + * window. */ + int x, int y) /* Coords relative to hwnd, or screen if hwnd + * is NULL. */ { POINT pos; int state; @@ -128,11 +127,11 @@ Tk_PointerEvent(hwnd, x, y) } /* - * If the mouse is captured, Windows will report all pointer - * events to the capture window. So, we need to determine which - * window the mouse is really over and change the event. Note - * that the computed hwnd may point to a window not owned by Tk, - * or a toplevel decorative frame, so tkwin can be NULL. + * If the mouse is captured, Windows will report all pointer events to the + * capture window. So, we need to determine which window the mouse is + * really over and change the event. Note that the computed hwnd may point + * to a window not owned by Tk, or a toplevel decorative frame, so tkwin + * can be NULL. */ if (captured || hwnd == NULL) { @@ -168,14 +167,13 @@ Tk_PointerEvent(hwnd, x, y) */ int -XGrabKeyboard(display, grab_window, owner_events, pointer_mode, - keyboard_mode, time) - Display* display; - Window grab_window; - Bool owner_events; - int pointer_mode; - int keyboard_mode; - Time time; +XGrabKeyboard( + Display *display, + Window grab_window, + Bool owner_events, + int pointer_mode, + int keyboard_mode, + Time time) { keyboardWinPtr = TkWinGetWinPtr(grab_window); return GrabSuccess; @@ -198,9 +196,9 @@ XGrabKeyboard(display, grab_window, owner_events, pointer_mode, */ void -XUngrabKeyboard(display, time) - Display* display; - Time time; +XUngrabKeyboard( + Display *display, + Time time) { keyboardWinPtr = NULL; } @@ -210,8 +208,7 @@ XUngrabKeyboard(display, time) * * MouseTimerProc -- * - * Check the current mouse position and look for enter/leave - * events. + * Check the current mouse position and look for enter/leave events. * * Results: * None. @@ -223,16 +220,16 @@ XUngrabKeyboard(display, time) */ void -MouseTimerProc(clientData) - ClientData clientData; +MouseTimerProc( + ClientData clientData) { POINT pos; mouseTimerSet = 0; /* - * Get the current mouse position and window. Don't do anything - * if the mouse hasn't moved since the last time we looked. + * Get the current mouse position and window. Don't do anything if the + * mouse hasn't moved since the last time we looked. */ GetCursorPos(&pos); @@ -256,7 +253,7 @@ MouseTimerProc(clientData) */ void -TkWinCancelMouseTimer() +TkWinCancelMouseTimer(void) { if (mouseTimerSet) { Tcl_DeleteTimerHandler(mouseTimer); @@ -272,8 +269,8 @@ TkWinCancelMouseTimer() * Fetch the position of the mouse pointer. * * Results: - * *xPtr and *yPtr are filled in with the root coordinates - * of the mouse pointer for the display. + * *xPtr and *yPtr are filled in with the root coordinates of the mouse + * pointer for the display. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -282,10 +279,10 @@ TkWinCancelMouseTimer() */ void -TkGetPointerCoords(tkwin, xPtr, yPtr) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Window that identifies screen on which +TkGetPointerCoords( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Window that identifies screen on which * lookup is to be done. */ - int *xPtr, *yPtr; /* Store pointer coordinates here. */ + int *xPtr, int *yPtr) /* Store pointer coordinates here. */ { POINT point; @@ -299,13 +296,13 @@ TkGetPointerCoords(tkwin, xPtr, yPtr) * * XQueryPointer -- * - * Check the current state of the mouse. This is not a complete - * implementation of this function. It only computes the root - * coordinates and the current mask. + * Check the current state of the mouse. This is not a complete + * implementation of this function. It only computes the root coordinates + * and the current mask. * * Results: - * Sets root_x_return, root_y_return, and mask_return. Returns - * true on success. + * Sets root_x_return, root_y_return, and mask_return. Returns true on + * success. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -314,17 +311,16 @@ TkGetPointerCoords(tkwin, xPtr, yPtr) */ Bool -XQueryPointer(display, w, root_return, child_return, root_x_return, - root_y_return, win_x_return, win_y_return, mask_return) - Display* display; - Window w; - Window* root_return; - Window* child_return; - int* root_x_return; - int* root_y_return; - int* win_x_return; - int* win_y_return; - unsigned int* mask_return; +XQueryPointer( + Display *display, + Window w, + Window *root_return, + Window *child_return, + int *root_x_return, + int *root_y_return, + int *win_x_return, + int *win_y_return, + unsigned int *mask_return) { display->request++; TkGetPointerCoords(NULL, root_x_return, root_y_return); @@ -337,8 +333,8 @@ XQueryPointer(display, w, root_return, child_return, root_x_return, * * XWarpPointer -- * - * Move pointer to new location. This is not a complete - * implementation of this function. + * Move pointer to new location. This is not a complete implementation of + * this function. * * Results: * None. @@ -350,22 +346,21 @@ XQueryPointer(display, w, root_return, child_return, root_x_return, */ void -XWarpPointer(display, src_w, dest_w, src_x, src_y, src_width, - src_height, dest_x, dest_y) - Display* display; - Window src_w; - Window dest_w; - int src_x; - int src_y; - unsigned int src_width; - unsigned int src_height; - int dest_x; - int dest_y; +XWarpPointer( + Display *display, + Window src_w, + Window dest_w, + int src_x, + int src_y, + unsigned int src_width, + unsigned int src_height, + int dest_x, + int dest_y) { RECT r; GetWindowRect(Tk_GetHWND(dest_w), &r); - SetCursorPos(r.left+dest_x, r.top+dest_y); + SetCursorPos(r.left+dest_x, r.top+dest_y); } /* @@ -385,12 +380,13 @@ XWarpPointer(display, src_w, dest_w, src_x, src_y, src_width, */ void -XGetInputFocus(display, focus_return, revert_to_return) - Display *display; - Window *focus_return; - int *revert_to_return; +XGetInputFocus( + Display *display, + Window *focus_return, + int *revert_to_return) { Tk_Window tkwin = Tk_HWNDToWindow(GetFocus()); + *focus_return = tkwin ? Tk_WindowId(tkwin) : None; *revert_to_return = RevertToParent; display->request++; @@ -414,11 +410,11 @@ XGetInputFocus(display, focus_return, revert_to_return) */ void -XSetInputFocus(display, focus, revert_to, time) - Display* display; - Window focus; - int revert_to; - Time time; +XSetInputFocus( + Display *display, + Window focus, + int revert_to, + Time time) { display->request++; if (focus != None) { @@ -431,29 +427,28 @@ XSetInputFocus(display, focus, revert_to, time) * * TkpChangeFocus -- * - * This procedure is invoked to move the system focus from - * one window to another. + * This procedure is invoked to move the system focus from one window to + * another. * * Results: - * The return value is the serial number of the command that - * changed the focus. It may be needed by the caller to filter - * out focus change events that were queued before the command. - * If the procedure doesn't actually change the focus then - * it returns 0. + * The return value is the serial number of the command that changed the + * focus. It may be needed by the caller to filter out focus change + * events that were queued before the command. If the procedure doesn't + * actually change the focus then it returns 0. * * Side effects: - * The official Windows focus window changes; the application's focus + * The official Windows focus window changes; the application's focus * window isn't changed by this procedure. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ int -TkpChangeFocus(winPtr, force) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Window that is to receive the X focus. */ - int force; /* Non-zero means claim the focus even - * if it didn't originally belong to - * topLevelPtr's application. */ +TkpChangeFocus( + TkWindow *winPtr, /* Window that is to receive the X focus. */ + int force) /* Non-zero means claim the focus even if it + * didn't originally belong to topLevelPtr's + * application. */ { TkDisplay *dispPtr = winPtr->dispPtr; Window focusWindow; @@ -471,10 +466,10 @@ TkpChangeFocus(winPtr, force) if (winPtr->window == None) { Tcl_Panic("ChangeXFocus got null X window"); } - + /* - * Change the foreground window so the focus window is raised to the top of - * the system stacking order and gets the keyboard focus. + * Change the foreground window so the focus window is raised to the top + * of the system stacking order and gets the keyboard focus. */ if (force) { @@ -484,10 +479,10 @@ TkpChangeFocus(winPtr, force) CurrentTime); /* - * Remember the current serial number for the X server and issue - * a dummy server request. This marks the position at which we - * changed the focus, so we can distinguish FocusIn and FocusOut - * events on either side of the mark. + * Remember the current serial number for the X server and issue a dummy + * server request. This marks the position at which we changed the focus, + * so we can distinguish FocusIn and FocusOut events on either side of the + * mark. */ serial = NextRequest(winPtr->display); @@ -500,10 +495,9 @@ TkpChangeFocus(winPtr, force) * * TkpSetCapture -- * - * This function captures the mouse so that all future events - * will be reported to this window, even if the mouse is outside - * the window. If the specified window is NULL, then the mouse - * is released. + * This function captures the mouse so that all future events will be + * reported to this window, even if the mouse is outside the window. If + * the specified window is NULL, then the mouse is released. * * Results: * None. @@ -515,8 +509,8 @@ TkpChangeFocus(winPtr, force) */ void -TkpSetCapture(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Capture window, or NULL. */ +TkpSetCapture( + TkWindow *winPtr) /* Capture window, or NULL. */ { if (winPtr) { SetCapture(Tk_GetHWND(Tk_WindowId(winPtr))); @@ -526,3 +520,11 @@ TkpSetCapture(winPtr) ReleaseCapture(); } } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWinRegion.c b/win/tkWinRegion.c index c3914e2..7cbdb9d 100644 --- a/win/tkWinRegion.c +++ b/win/tkWinRegion.c @@ -1,14 +1,14 @@ -/* +/* * tkWinRegion.c -- * * Tk Region emulation code. * * Copyright (c) 1995 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinRegion.c,v 1.5 2004/10/26 14:07:57 patthoyts Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinRegion.c,v 1.6 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkWinInt.h" @@ -31,7 +31,7 @@ */ TkRegion -TkCreateRegion() +TkCreateRegion(void) { RECT rect; memset(&rect, 0, sizeof(RECT)); @@ -55,8 +55,8 @@ TkCreateRegion() */ void -TkDestroyRegion(r) - TkRegion r; +TkDestroyRegion( + TkRegion r) { DeleteObject((HRGN) r); } @@ -78,11 +78,12 @@ TkDestroyRegion(r) */ void -TkClipBox(r, rect_return) - TkRegion r; - XRectangle* rect_return; +TkClipBox( + TkRegion r, + XRectangle* rect_return) { RECT rect; + GetRgnBox((HRGN)r, &rect); rect_return->x = (short) rect.left; rect_return->y = (short) rect.top; @@ -107,10 +108,10 @@ TkClipBox(r, rect_return) */ void -TkIntersectRegion(sra, srb, dr_return) - TkRegion sra; - TkRegion srb; - TkRegion dr_return; +TkIntersectRegion( + TkRegion sra, + TkRegion srb, + TkRegion dr_return) { CombineRgn((HRGN) dr_return, (HRGN) sra, (HRGN) srb, RGN_AND); } @@ -132,13 +133,14 @@ TkIntersectRegion(sra, srb, dr_return) */ void -TkUnionRectWithRegion(rectangle, src_region, dest_region_return) - XRectangle* rectangle; - TkRegion src_region; - TkRegion dest_region_return; +TkUnionRectWithRegion( + XRectangle *rectangle, + TkRegion src_region, + TkRegion dest_region_return) { HRGN rectRgn = CreateRectRgn(rectangle->x, rectangle->y, rectangle->x + rectangle->width, rectangle->y + rectangle->height); + CombineRgn((HRGN) dest_region_return, (HRGN) src_region, (HRGN) rectRgn, RGN_OR); DeleteObject(rectRgn); @@ -149,8 +151,8 @@ TkUnionRectWithRegion(rectangle, src_region, dest_region_return) * * TkpBuildRegionFromAlphaData -- * - * Set up a rectangle of the given region based on the supplied - * alpha data. + * Set up a rectangle of the given region based on the supplied alpha + * data. * * Results: * None @@ -162,16 +164,17 @@ TkUnionRectWithRegion(rectangle, src_region, dest_region_return) */ void -TkpBuildRegionFromAlphaData(region, x, y, width, height, dataPtr, - pixelStride, lineStride) - TkRegion region; - unsigned int x, y; /* Where in region to update. */ - unsigned int width, height; /* Size of rectangle to update. */ - unsigned char *dataPtr; /* Data to read from. */ - unsigned int pixelStride; /* num bytes from one piece of alpha - * data to the next in the line. */ - unsigned int lineStride; /* num bytes from one line of alpha - * data to the next line. */ +TkpBuildRegionFromAlphaData( + TkRegion region, + unsigned int x, unsigned int y, + /* Where in region to update. */ + unsigned int width, unsigned int height, + /* Size of rectangle to update. */ + unsigned char *dataPtr, /* Data to read from. */ + unsigned int pixelStride, /* Num bytes from one piece of alpha data to + * the next in the line. */ + unsigned int lineStride) /* Num bytes from one line of alpha data to + * the next line. */ { unsigned char *lineDataPtr; unsigned int x1, y1, end; @@ -180,13 +183,20 @@ TkpBuildRegionFromAlphaData(region, x, y, width, height, dataPtr, for (y1 = 0; y1 < height; y1++) { lineDataPtr = dataPtr; for (x1 = 0; x1 < width; x1 = end) { - /* search for first non-transparent pixel */ + /* + * Search for first non-transparent pixel. + */ + while ((x1 < width) && !*lineDataPtr) { x1++; lineDataPtr += pixelStride; } end = x1; - /* search for first transparent pixel */ + + /* + * Search for first transparent pixel. + */ + while ((end < width) && *lineDataPtr) { end++; lineDataPtr += pixelStride; @@ -195,6 +205,7 @@ TkpBuildRegionFromAlphaData(region, x, y, width, height, dataPtr, /* * Manipulate Win32 regions directly; it's more efficient. */ + SetRectRgn(rectRgn, x+x1, y+y1, x+end, y+y1+1); CombineRgn((HRGN) region, (HRGN) region, rectRgn, RGN_OR); } @@ -213,9 +224,8 @@ TkpBuildRegionFromAlphaData(region, x, y, width, height, dataPtr, * Test whether a given rectangle overlaps with a region. * * Results: - * Returns RectanglePart or RectangleOut. Note that this is - * not a complete implementation since it doesn't test for - * RectangleIn. + * Returns RectanglePart or RectangleOut. Note that this is not a + * complete implementation since it doesn't test for RectangleIn. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -224,12 +234,11 @@ TkpBuildRegionFromAlphaData(region, x, y, width, height, dataPtr, */ int -TkRectInRegion(r, x, y, width, height) - TkRegion r; - int x; - int y; - unsigned int width; - unsigned int height; +TkRectInRegion( + TkRegion r, /* Region to inspect */ + int x, int y, /* Top-left of rectangle */ + unsigned int width, /* Width of rectangle */ + unsigned int height) /* Height of rectangle */ { RECT rect; rect.top = y; @@ -256,10 +265,18 @@ TkRectInRegion(r, x, y, width, height) */ void -TkSubtractRegion(sra, srb, dr_return) - TkRegion sra; - TkRegion srb; - TkRegion dr_return; +TkSubtractRegion( + TkRegion sra, + TkRegion srb, + TkRegion dr_return) { CombineRgn((HRGN) dr_return, (HRGN) sra, (HRGN) srb, RGN_DIFF); } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWinScrlbr.c b/win/tkWinScrlbr.c index 7ad61d8..e76a299 100644 --- a/win/tkWinScrlbr.c +++ b/win/tkWinScrlbr.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* +/* * tkWinScrollbar.c -- * * This file implements the Windows specific portion of the scrollbar @@ -6,21 +6,20 @@ * * Copyright (c) 1996 by Sun Microsystems, Inc. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinScrlbr.c,v 1.10 2004/01/13 02:06:02 davygrvy Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinScrlbr.c,v 1.11 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkWinInt.h" #include "tkScrollbar.h" - /* - * The following constant is used to specify the maximum scroll position. - * This value is limited by the Win32 API to either 16-bits or 32-bits, - * depending on the context. For now we'll just use a value small - * enough to fit in 16-bits, but which gives us 4-digits of precision. + * The following constant is used to specify the maximum scroll position. This + * value is limited by the Win32 API to either 16-bits or 32-bits, depending + * on the context. For now we'll just use a value small enough to fit in + * 16-bits, but which gives us 4-digits of precision. */ #define MAX_SCROLL 10000 @@ -39,7 +38,7 @@ typedef struct WinScrollbar { /* * Flag bits for native scrollbars: - * + * * IN_MODAL_LOOP: Non-zero means this scrollbar is in the middle * of a modal loop. * ALREADY_DEAD: Non-zero means this scrollbar has been @@ -60,8 +59,8 @@ static int vArrowWidth, vArrowHeight, vThumb; /* Vertical control metrics. */ TCL_DECLARE_MUTEX(winScrlbrMutex) /* - * This variable holds the default width for a scrollbar in string - * form for use in a Tk_ConfigSpec. + * This variable holds the default width for a scrollbar in string form for + * use in a Tk_ConfigSpec. */ static char defWidth[TCL_INTEGER_SPACE]; @@ -70,18 +69,16 @@ static char defWidth[TCL_INTEGER_SPACE]; * Declarations for functions defined in this file. */ -static Window CreateProc _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - Window parent, ClientData instanceData)); -static void ModalLoopProc _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, - XEvent *eventPtr)); -static int ScrollbarBindProc _ANSI_ARGS_((ClientData clientData, +static Window CreateProc(Tk_Window tkwin, Window parent, + ClientData instanceData); +static void ModalLoopProc(Tk_Window tkwin, XEvent *eventPtr); +static int ScrollbarBindProc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp *interp, XEvent *eventPtr, - Tk_Window tkwin, KeySym keySym)); -static LRESULT CALLBACK ScrollbarProc _ANSI_ARGS_((HWND hwnd, UINT message, - WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam)); -static void UpdateScrollbar _ANSI_ARGS_(( - WinScrollbar *scrollPtr)); -static void UpdateScrollbarMetrics _ANSI_ARGS_((void)); + Tk_Window tkwin, KeySym keySym); +static LRESULT CALLBACK ScrollbarProc(HWND hwnd, UINT message, WPARAM wParam, + LPARAM lParam); +static void UpdateScrollbar(WinScrollbar *scrollPtr); +static void UpdateScrollbarMetrics(void); /* * The class procedure table for the scrollbar widget. @@ -112,12 +109,12 @@ Tk_ClassProcs tkpScrollbarProcs = { */ TkScrollbar * -TkpCreateScrollbar(tkwin) - Tk_Window tkwin; +TkpCreateScrollbar( + Tk_Window tkwin) { WinScrollbar *scrollPtr; TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *)tkwin; - + if (!initialized) { Tcl_MutexLock(&winScrlbrMutex); UpdateScrollbarMetrics(); @@ -142,7 +139,7 @@ TkpCreateScrollbar(tkwin) ScrollbarBindProc, NULL, NULL); } - return (TkScrollbar*) scrollPtr; + return (TkScrollbar *) scrollPtr; } /* @@ -150,8 +147,8 @@ TkpCreateScrollbar(tkwin) * * UpdateScrollbar -- * - * This function updates the position and size of the scrollbar - * thumb based on the current settings. + * This function updates the position and size of the scrollbar thumb + * based on the current settings. * * Results: * None. @@ -163,8 +160,8 @@ TkpCreateScrollbar(tkwin) */ static void -UpdateScrollbar(scrollPtr) - WinScrollbar *scrollPtr; +UpdateScrollbar( + WinScrollbar *scrollPtr) { SCROLLINFO scrollInfo; double thumbSize; @@ -181,15 +178,17 @@ UpdateScrollbar(scrollPtr) scrollInfo.nPage = ((UINT) (thumbSize * (double) MAX_SCROLL)) + 1; if (thumbSize < 1.0) { scrollInfo.nPos = (int) - ((scrollPtr->info.firstFraction / (1.0-thumbSize)) - * (MAX_SCROLL - (scrollInfo.nPage - 1))); + ((scrollPtr->info.firstFraction / (1.0-thumbSize)) + * (MAX_SCROLL - (scrollInfo.nPage - 1))); } else { scrollInfo.nPos = 0; + /* - * Disable the scrollbar when there is nothing to scroll. - * This is standard Windows style (see eg Notepad). - * Also prevents possible crash on XP+ systems [Bug #624116]. + * Disable the scrollbar when there is nothing to scroll. This is + * standard Windows style (see eg Notepad). Also prevents possible + * crash on XP+ systems [Bug #624116]. */ + scrollInfo.fMask |= SIF_DISABLENOSCROLL; } SetScrollInfo(scrollPtr->hwnd, SB_CTL, &scrollInfo, TRUE); @@ -200,8 +199,8 @@ UpdateScrollbar(scrollPtr) * * CreateProc -- * - * This function creates a new Scrollbar control, subclasses - * the instance, and generates a new Window object. + * This function creates a new Scrollbar control, subclasses the + * instance, and generates a new Window object. * * Results: * Returns the newly allocated Window object, or None on failure. @@ -213,10 +212,10 @@ UpdateScrollbar(scrollPtr) */ static Window -CreateProc(tkwin, parentWin, instanceData) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Token for window. */ - Window parentWin; /* Parent of new window. */ - ClientData instanceData; /* Scrollbar instance data. */ +CreateProc( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Token for window. */ + Window parentWin, /* Parent of new window. */ + ClientData instanceData) /* Scrollbar instance data. */ { DWORD style; Window window; @@ -228,10 +227,10 @@ CreateProc(tkwin, parentWin, instanceData) if (scrollPtr->info.vertical) { style = WS_CHILD | WS_VISIBLE | WS_CLIPCHILDREN | WS_CLIPSIBLINGS - | SBS_VERT | SBS_RIGHTALIGN; + | SBS_VERT | SBS_RIGHTALIGN; } else { style = WS_CHILD | WS_VISIBLE | WS_CLIPCHILDREN | WS_CLIPSIBLINGS - | SBS_HORZ | SBS_BOTTOMALIGN; + | SBS_HORZ | SBS_BOTTOMALIGN; } scrollPtr->hwnd = CreateWindow("SCROLLBAR", NULL, style, @@ -240,14 +239,14 @@ CreateProc(tkwin, parentWin, instanceData) /* * Ensure new window is inserted into the stacking order at the correct - * place. + * place. */ SetWindowPos(scrollPtr->hwnd, HWND_TOP, 0, 0, 0, 0, SWP_NOACTIVATE | SWP_NOMOVE | SWP_NOSIZE); for (winPtr = ((TkWindow*)tkwin)->nextPtr; winPtr != NULL; - winPtr = winPtr->nextPtr) { + winPtr = winPtr->nextPtr) { if ((winPtr->window != None) && !(winPtr->flags & TK_TOP_HIERARCHY)) { TkWinSetWindowPos(scrollPtr->hwnd, Tk_GetHWND(winPtr->window), Below); @@ -274,9 +273,9 @@ CreateProc(tkwin, parentWin, instanceData) * * TkpDisplayScrollbar -- * - * This procedure redraws the contents of a scrollbar window. - * It is invoked as a do-when-idle handler, so it only runs - * when there's nothing else for the application to do. + * This procedure redraws the contents of a scrollbar window. It is + * invoked as a do-when-idle handler, so it only runs when there's + * nothing else for the application to do. * * Results: * None. @@ -288,8 +287,8 @@ CreateProc(tkwin, parentWin, instanceData) */ void -TkpDisplayScrollbar(clientData) - ClientData clientData; /* Information about window. */ +TkpDisplayScrollbar( + ClientData clientData) /* Information about window. */ { WinScrollbar *scrollPtr = (WinScrollbar *) clientData; Tk_Window tkwin = scrollPtr->info.tkwin; @@ -300,8 +299,8 @@ TkpDisplayScrollbar(clientData) } /* - * Destroy and recreate the scrollbar control if the orientation - * has changed. + * Destroy and recreate the scrollbar control if the orientation has + * changed. */ if (scrollPtr->lastVertical != scrollPtr->info.vertical) { @@ -338,11 +337,12 @@ TkpDisplayScrollbar(clientData) */ void -TkpDestroyScrollbar(scrollPtr) - TkScrollbar *scrollPtr; +TkpDestroyScrollbar( + TkScrollbar *scrollPtr) { WinScrollbar *winScrollPtr = (WinScrollbar *)scrollPtr; HWND hwnd = winScrollPtr->hwnd; + if (hwnd) { #ifdef _WIN64 SetWindowLongPtr(hwnd, GWLP_WNDPROC, (LONG_PTR) winScrollPtr->oldProc); @@ -362,8 +362,7 @@ TkpDestroyScrollbar(scrollPtr) * * UpdateScrollbarMetrics -- * - * This function retrieves the current system metrics for a - * scrollbar. + * This function retrieves the current system metrics for a scrollbar. * * Results: * None. @@ -375,7 +374,7 @@ TkpDestroyScrollbar(scrollPtr) */ void -UpdateScrollbarMetrics() +UpdateScrollbarMetrics(void) { Tk_ConfigSpec *specPtr; @@ -399,9 +398,9 @@ UpdateScrollbarMetrics() * * TkpComputeScrollbarGeometry -- * - * After changes in a scrollbar's size or configuration, this - * procedure recomputes various geometry information used in - * displaying the scrollbar. + * After changes in a scrollbar's size or configuration, this procedure + * recomputes various geometry information used in displaying the + * scrollbar. * * Results: * None. @@ -413,15 +412,16 @@ UpdateScrollbarMetrics() */ void -TkpComputeScrollbarGeometry(scrollPtr) - register TkScrollbar *scrollPtr; /* Scrollbar whose geometry may - * have changed. */ +TkpComputeScrollbarGeometry( + register TkScrollbar *scrollPtr) + /* Scrollbar whose geometry may have + * changed. */ { int fieldLength, minThumbSize; /* - * Windows doesn't use focus rings on scrollbars, but we still - * perform basic sanity checks to appease backwards compatibility. + * Windows doesn't use focus rings on scrollbars, but we still perform + * basic sanity checks to appease backwards compatibility. */ if (scrollPtr->highlightWidth < 0) { @@ -447,9 +447,9 @@ TkpComputeScrollbarGeometry(scrollPtr) * scrollPtr->lastFraction); /* - * Adjust the slider so that some piece of it is always - * displayed in the scrollbar and so that it has at least - * a minimal width (so it can be grabbed with the mouse). + * Adjust the slider so that some piece of it is always displayed in the + * scrollbar and so that it has at least a minimal width (so it can be + * grabbed with the mouse). */ if (scrollPtr->sliderFirst > fieldLength) { @@ -469,10 +469,9 @@ TkpComputeScrollbarGeometry(scrollPtr) scrollPtr->sliderLast += scrollPtr->arrowLength; /* - * Register the desired geometry for the window (leave enough space - * for the two arrows plus a minimum-size slider, plus border around - * the whole window, if any). Then arrange for the window to be - * redisplayed. + * Register the desired geometry for the window (leave enough space for + * the two arrows plus a minimum-size slider, plus border around the whole + * window, if any). Then arrange for the window to be redisplayed. */ if (scrollPtr->vertical) { @@ -490,8 +489,8 @@ TkpComputeScrollbarGeometry(scrollPtr) * * ScrollbarProc -- * - * This function is call by Windows whenever an event occurs on - * a scrollbar control created by Tk. + * This function is call by Windows whenever an event occurs on a + * scrollbar control created by Tk. * * Results: * Standard Windows return value. @@ -503,11 +502,11 @@ TkpComputeScrollbarGeometry(scrollPtr) */ static LRESULT CALLBACK -ScrollbarProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) - HWND hwnd; - UINT message; - WPARAM wParam; - LPARAM lParam; +ScrollbarProc( + HWND hwnd, + UINT message, + WPARAM wParam, + LPARAM lParam) { LRESULT result; POINT point; @@ -520,85 +519,84 @@ ScrollbarProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) scrollPtr = (WinScrollbar *)((TkWindow*)tkwin)->instanceData; switch(message) { - case WM_HSCROLL: - case WM_VSCROLL: { - Tcl_Interp *interp; - Tcl_DString cmdString; - int command = LOWORD(wParam); - int code; - - GetCursorPos(&point); - Tk_TranslateWinEvent(NULL, WM_MOUSEMOVE, 0, - MAKELPARAM(point.x, point.y), &result); - - if (command == SB_ENDSCROLL) { - return 0; - } - - /* - * Bail out immediately if there isn't a command to invoke. - */ - - if (scrollPtr->info.commandSize == 0) { - Tcl_ServiceAll(); - return 0; - } - - Tcl_DStringInit(&cmdString); - Tcl_DStringAppend(&cmdString, scrollPtr->info.command, - scrollPtr->info.commandSize); - - if (command == SB_LINELEFT || command == SB_LINERIGHT) { - Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&cmdString, "scroll"); - Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&cmdString, - (command == SB_LINELEFT ) ? "-1" : "1"); - Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&cmdString, "units"); - } else if (command == SB_PAGELEFT || command == SB_PAGERIGHT) { - Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&cmdString, "scroll"); - Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&cmdString, - (command == SB_PAGELEFT ) ? "-1" : "1"); - Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&cmdString, "pages"); - } else { - char valueString[TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE]; - double pos = 0.0; - switch (command) { - case SB_THUMBPOSITION: - pos = ((double)HIWORD(wParam)) / MAX_SCROLL; - break; - - case SB_THUMBTRACK: - pos = ((double)HIWORD(wParam)) / MAX_SCROLL; - break; - - case SB_TOP: - pos = 0.0; - break; - - case SB_BOTTOM: - pos = 1.0; - break; - } - sprintf(valueString, "%g", pos); - Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&cmdString, "moveto"); - Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&cmdString, valueString); - } + case WM_HSCROLL: + case WM_VSCROLL: { + Tcl_Interp *interp; + Tcl_DString cmdString; + int command = LOWORD(wParam); + int code; + + GetCursorPos(&point); + Tk_TranslateWinEvent(NULL, WM_MOUSEMOVE, 0, + MAKELPARAM(point.x, point.y), &result); + + if (command == SB_ENDSCROLL) { + return 0; + } - interp = scrollPtr->info.interp; - code = Tcl_GlobalEval(interp, cmdString.string); - if (code != TCL_OK && code != TCL_CONTINUE && code != TCL_BREAK) { - Tcl_AddErrorInfo(interp, "\n (scrollbar command)"); - Tcl_BackgroundError(interp); - } - Tcl_DStringFree(&cmdString); + /* + * Bail out immediately if there isn't a command to invoke. + */ + if (scrollPtr->info.commandSize == 0) { Tcl_ServiceAll(); return 0; } - default: - if (Tk_TranslateWinEvent(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam, &result)) { - return result; + Tcl_DStringInit(&cmdString); + Tcl_DStringAppend(&cmdString, scrollPtr->info.command, + scrollPtr->info.commandSize); + + if (command == SB_LINELEFT || command == SB_LINERIGHT) { + Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&cmdString, "scroll"); + Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&cmdString, + (command == SB_LINELEFT ) ? "-1" : "1"); + Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&cmdString, "units"); + } else if (command == SB_PAGELEFT || command == SB_PAGERIGHT) { + Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&cmdString, "scroll"); + Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&cmdString, + (command == SB_PAGELEFT ) ? "-1" : "1"); + Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&cmdString, "pages"); + } else { + char valueString[TCL_DOUBLE_SPACE]; + double pos = 0.0; + + switch (command) { + case SB_THUMBPOSITION: + pos = ((double)HIWORD(wParam)) / MAX_SCROLL; + break; + case SB_THUMBTRACK: + pos = ((double)HIWORD(wParam)) / MAX_SCROLL; + break; + case SB_TOP: + pos = 0.0; + break; + case SB_BOTTOM: + pos = 1.0; + break; } + + sprintf(valueString, "%g", pos); + Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&cmdString, "moveto"); + Tcl_DStringAppendElement(&cmdString, valueString); + } + + interp = scrollPtr->info.interp; + code = Tcl_GlobalEval(interp, cmdString.string); + if (code != TCL_OK && code != TCL_CONTINUE && code != TCL_BREAK) { + Tcl_AddErrorInfo(interp, "\n (scrollbar command)"); + Tcl_BackgroundError(interp); + } + Tcl_DStringFree(&cmdString); + + Tcl_ServiceAll(); + return 0; + } + + default: + if (Tk_TranslateWinEvent(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam, &result)) { + return result; + } } return CallWindowProc(scrollPtr->oldProc, hwnd, message, wParam, lParam); } @@ -609,8 +607,8 @@ ScrollbarProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) * TkpConfigureScrollbar -- * * This procedure is called after the generic code has finished - * processing configuration options, in order to configure - * platform specific options. + * processing configuration options, in order to configure platform + * specific options. * * Results: * None. @@ -622,10 +620,10 @@ ScrollbarProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) */ void -TkpConfigureScrollbar(scrollPtr) - register TkScrollbar *scrollPtr; /* Information about widget; may or - * may not already have values for - * some fields. */ +TkpConfigureScrollbar( + register TkScrollbar *scrollPtr) + /* Information about widget; may or may not + * already have values for some fields. */ { } @@ -634,8 +632,8 @@ TkpConfigureScrollbar(scrollPtr) * * ScrollbarBindProc -- * - * This procedure is invoked when the default <ButtonPress> - * binding on the Scrollbar bind tag fires. + * This procedure is invoked when the default <ButtonPress> binding on + * the Scrollbar bind tag fires. * * Results: * None. @@ -647,14 +645,15 @@ TkpConfigureScrollbar(scrollPtr) */ static int -ScrollbarBindProc(clientData, interp, eventPtr, tkwin, keySym) - ClientData clientData; - Tcl_Interp *interp; - XEvent *eventPtr; - Tk_Window tkwin; - KeySym keySym; +ScrollbarBindProc( + ClientData clientData, + Tcl_Interp *interp, + XEvent *eventPtr, + Tk_Window tkwin, + KeySym keySym) { - TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow*)tkwin; + TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) tkwin; + if (eventPtr->type == ButtonPress) { winPtr->flags |= TK_DEFER_MODAL; } @@ -666,9 +665,8 @@ ScrollbarBindProc(clientData, interp, eventPtr, tkwin, keySym) * * ModalLoopProc -- * - * This function is invoked at the end of the event processing - * whenever the ScrollbarBindProc has been invoked for a ButtonPress - * event. + * This function is invoked at the end of the event processing whenever + * the ScrollbarBindProc has been invoked for a ButtonPress event. * * Results: * None. @@ -680,9 +678,9 @@ ScrollbarBindProc(clientData, interp, eventPtr, tkwin, keySym) */ static void -ModalLoopProc(tkwin, eventPtr) - Tk_Window tkwin; - XEvent *eventPtr; +ModalLoopProc( + Tk_Window tkwin, + XEvent *eventPtr) { TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow*)tkwin; WinScrollbar *scrollPtr = (WinScrollbar *) winPtr->instanceData; @@ -707,14 +705,12 @@ ModalLoopProc(tkwin, eventPtr) * * TkpScrollbarPosition -- * - * Determine the scrollbar element corresponding to a - * given position. + * Determine the scrollbar element corresponding to a given position. * * Results: - * One of TOP_ARROW, TOP_GAP, etc., indicating which element - * of the scrollbar covers the position given by (x, y). If - * (x,y) is outside the scrollbar entirely, then OUTSIDE is - * returned. + * One of TOP_ARROW, TOP_GAP, etc., indicating which element of the + * scrollbar covers the position given by (x, y). If (x,y) is outside the + * scrollbar entirely, then OUTSIDE is returned. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -723,10 +719,10 @@ ModalLoopProc(tkwin, eventPtr) */ int -TkpScrollbarPosition(scrollPtr, x, y) - register TkScrollbar *scrollPtr; /* Scrollbar widget record. */ - int x, y; /* Coordinates within scrollPtr's - * window. */ +TkpScrollbarPosition( + register TkScrollbar *scrollPtr, + /* Scrollbar widget record. */ + int x, int y) /* Coordinates within scrollPtr's window. */ { int length, width, tmp; @@ -748,7 +744,7 @@ TkpScrollbarPosition(scrollPtr, x, y) /* * All of the calculations in this procedure mirror those in - * TkpDisplayScrollbar. Be sure to keep the two consistent. + * TkpDisplayScrollbar. Be sure to keep the two consistent. */ if (y < (scrollPtr->inset + scrollPtr->arrowLength)) { @@ -765,3 +761,11 @@ TkpScrollbarPosition(scrollPtr, x, y) } return BOTTOM_GAP; } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWinSend.c b/win/tkWinSend.c index 51d947e..2269512 100644 --- a/win/tkWinSend.c +++ b/win/tkWinSend.c @@ -1,114 +1,120 @@ -/* +/* * tkWinSend.c -- * - * This file provides procedures that implement the "send" - * command, allowing commands to be passed from interpreter - * to interpreter. + * This file provides functions that implement the "send" command, + * allowing commands to be passed from interpreter to interpreter. * * Copyright (c) 1997 by Sun Microsystems, Inc. * Copyright (c) 2003 Pat Thoyts <patthoyts@users.sourceforge.net> * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinSend.c,v 1.10 2005/10/14 11:59:19 patthoyts Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinSend.c,v 1.11 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkWinSendCom.h" -/* Should be defined in WTypes.h but mingw 1.0 is missing them */ +/* + * Should be defined in WTypes.h but mingw 1.0 is missing them. + */ + #ifndef _ROTFLAGS_DEFINED #define _ROTFLAGS_DEFINED -#define ROTFLAGS_REGISTRATIONKEEPSALIVE 0x01 -#define ROTFLAGS_ALLOWANYCLIENT 0x02 +#define ROTFLAGS_REGISTRATIONKEEPSALIVE 0x01 +#define ROTFLAGS_ALLOWANYCLIENT 0x02 #endif /* ! _ROTFLAGS_DEFINED */ -#define TKWINSEND_CLASS_NAME "TclEval" -#define TKWINSEND_REGISTRATION_BASE L"TclEval" +#define TKWINSEND_CLASS_NAME "TclEval" +#define TKWINSEND_REGISTRATION_BASE L"TclEval" #define MK_E_MONIKERALREADYREGISTERED \ - MAKE_HRESULT(SEVERITY_ERROR, FACILITY_ITF, 0x02A1) + MAKE_HRESULT(SEVERITY_ERROR, FACILITY_ITF, 0x02A1) /* - * Package information structure. - * This is used to keep interpreter specific details for use when releasing - * the package resources upon interpreter deletion or package removal. + * Package information structure. This is used to keep interpreter specific + * details for use when releasing the package resources upon interpreter + * deletion or package removal. */ + typedef struct { - char *name; /* the registered application name */ - DWORD cookie; /* ROT cookie returned on registration */ - LPUNKNOWN obj; /* Interface for the registration object */ + char *name; /* The registered application name */ + DWORD cookie; /* ROT cookie returned on registration */ + LPUNKNOWN obj; /* Interface for the registration object */ Tcl_Interp *interp; - Tcl_Command token; /* Winsend command token */ + Tcl_Command token; /* Winsend command token */ } RegisteredInterp; typedef struct SendEvent { - Tcl_Event header; - Tcl_Interp *interp; - Tcl_Obj *cmdPtr; + Tcl_Event header; + Tcl_Interp *interp; + Tcl_Obj *cmdPtr; } SendEvent; typedef struct { - int initialized; + int initialized; } ThreadSpecificData; static Tcl_ThreadDataKey dataKey; -static void CmdDeleteProc(ClientData clientData); -static void InterpDeleteProc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp *interp); -static void RevokeObjectRegistration(RegisteredInterp *riPtr); -static HRESULT BuildMoniker(CONST char *name, LPMONIKER *pmk); -static HRESULT RegisterInterp(CONST char *name, RegisteredInterp *riPtr); -static int FindInterpreterObject(Tcl_Interp *interp, CONST char *name, - LPDISPATCH *ppdisp); -static int Send(LPDISPATCH pdispInterp, Tcl_Interp *interp, int async, - ClientData clientData, int objc, Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); -static Tcl_Obj* Win32ErrorObj(HRESULT hrError); -static void SendTrace(const char *format, ...); - -static Tcl_EventProc SendEventProc; +/* + * Functions internal to this file. + */ +static void CmdDeleteProc(ClientData clientData); +static void InterpDeleteProc(ClientData clientData, + Tcl_Interp *interp); +static void RevokeObjectRegistration(RegisteredInterp *riPtr); +static HRESULT BuildMoniker(CONST char *name, LPMONIKER *pmk); +static HRESULT RegisterInterp(CONST char *name, + RegisteredInterp *riPtr); +static int FindInterpreterObject(Tcl_Interp *interp, + CONST char *name, LPDISPATCH *ppdisp); +static int Send(LPDISPATCH pdispInterp, Tcl_Interp *interp, + int async, ClientData clientData, int objc, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static Tcl_Obj * Win32ErrorObj(HRESULT hrError); +static void SendTrace(const char *format, ...); +static Tcl_EventProc SendEventProc; #if defined(DEBUG) || defined(_DEBUG) #define TRACE SendTrace #else #define TRACE 1 ? ((void)0) : SendTrace #endif - /* *-------------------------------------------------------------- * * Tk_SetAppName -- * - * This procedure is called to associate an ASCII name with a Tk - * application. If the application has already been named, the - * name replaces the old one. + * This function is called to associate an ASCII name with a Tk + * application. If the application has already been named, the name + * replaces the old one. * * Results: - * The return value is the name actually given to the application. - * This will normally be the same as name, but if name was already - * in use for an application then a name of the form "name #2" will - * be chosen, with a high enough number to make the name unique. + * The return value is the name actually given to the application. This + * will normally be the same as name, but if name was already in use for + * an application then a name of the form "name #2" will be chosen, with + * a high enough number to make the name unique. * * Side effects: - * Registration info is saved, thereby allowing the "send" command - * to be used later to invoke commands in the application. In - * addition, the "send" command is created in the application's - * interpreter. The registration will be removed automatically - * if the interpreter is deleted or the "send" command is removed. + * Registration info is saved, thereby allowing the "send" command to be + * used later to invoke commands in the application. In addition, the + * "send" command is created in the application's interpreter. The + * registration will be removed automatically if the interpreter is + * deleted or the "send" command is removed. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ CONST char * -Tk_SetAppName(tkwin, name) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Token for any window in the application - * to be named: it is just used to identify - * the application and the display. */ - CONST char *name; /* The name that will be used to - * refer to the interpreter in later - * "send" commands. Must be globally - * unique. */ +Tk_SetAppName( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Token for any window in the application to + * be named: it is just used to identify the + * application and the display. */ + CONST char *name) /* The name that will be used to refer to the + * interpreter in later "send" commands. Must + * be globally unique. */ { ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = NULL; TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *)tkwin; @@ -118,59 +124,61 @@ Tk_SetAppName(tkwin, name) interp = winPtr->mainPtr->interp; +#ifndef TK_SEND_ENABLED_ON_WINDOWS /* * Temporarily disabled for bug #858822 */ + return name; +#else /* TK_SEND_ENABLED_ON_WINDOWS */ tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) - Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); + Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); - /* + /* * Initialise the COM library for this interpreter just once. */ + if (tsdPtr->initialized == 0) { - hr = CoInitialize(0); - if (FAILED(hr)) { - Tcl_SetResult(interp, - "failed to initialize the COM library", TCL_STATIC); - return ""; - } - tsdPtr->initialized = 1; - TRACE("Initialized COM library for interp 0x%08X\n", (long)interp); + hr = CoInitialize(0); + if (FAILED(hr)) { + Tcl_SetResult(interp, + "failed to initialize the COM library", TCL_STATIC); + return ""; + } + tsdPtr->initialized = 1; + TRACE("Initialized COM library for interp 0x%08X\n", (long)interp); } - - /* - * If the interp hasn't been registered before then we need to create - * the registration structure and the COM object. If it has been - * registered already then we can reuse all and just register the new - * name. + + /* + * If the interp hasn't been registered before then we need to create the + * registration structure and the COM object. If it has been registered + * already then we can reuse all and just register the new name. */ - + riPtr = Tcl_GetAssocData(interp, "tkWinSend::ri", NULL); if (riPtr == NULL) { - - riPtr = (RegisteredInterp *)ckalloc(sizeof(RegisteredInterp)); - memset(riPtr, 0, sizeof(RegisteredInterp)); - riPtr->interp = interp; - - hr = TkWinSendCom_CreateInstance(interp, &IID_IUnknown, - (void **)&riPtr->obj); - - Tcl_CreateObjCommand(interp, "send", Tk_SendObjCmd, - (ClientData)riPtr, CmdDeleteProc); - if (Tcl_IsSafe(interp)) { - Tcl_HideCommand(interp, "send", "send"); - } - Tcl_SetAssocData(interp, "tkWinSend::ri", NULL, (ClientData)riPtr); - + + riPtr = (RegisteredInterp *)ckalloc(sizeof(RegisteredInterp)); + memset(riPtr, 0, sizeof(RegisteredInterp)); + riPtr->interp = interp; + + hr = TkWinSendCom_CreateInstance(interp, &IID_IUnknown, + (void **)&riPtr->obj); + + Tcl_CreateObjCommand(interp, "send", Tk_SendObjCmd, + (ClientData)riPtr, CmdDeleteProc); + if (Tcl_IsSafe(interp)) { + Tcl_HideCommand(interp, "send", "send"); + } + Tcl_SetAssocData(interp, "tkWinSend::ri", NULL, (ClientData)riPtr); } else { - - RevokeObjectRegistration(riPtr); + RevokeObjectRegistration(riPtr); } - + RegisterInterp(name, riPtr); - return (CONST char *)riPtr->name; + return (CONST char *) riPtr->name; +#endif /* TK_SEND_ENABLED_ON_WINDOWS */ } /* @@ -178,15 +186,14 @@ Tk_SetAppName(tkwin, name) * * TkGetInterpNames -- * - * This procedure is invoked to fetch a list of all the - * interpreter names currently registered for the display - * of a particular window. + * This function is invoked to fetch a list of all the interpreter names + * currently registered for the display of a particular window. * * Results: - * A standard Tcl return value. Interp->result will be set - * to hold a list of all the interpreter names defined for - * tkwin's display. If an error occurs, then TCL_ERROR - * is returned and interp->result will hold an error message. + * A standard Tcl return value. Interp->result will be set to hold a list + * of all the interpreter names defined for tkwin's display. If an error + * occurs, then TCL_ERROR is returned and interp->result will hold an + * error message. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -195,49 +202,56 @@ Tk_SetAppName(tkwin, name) */ int -TkGetInterpNames(interp, tkwin) - Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Interpreter for returning a result. */ - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Window whose display is to be used - * for the lookup. */ +TkGetInterpNames( + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Interpreter for returning a result. */ + Tk_Window tkwin) /* Window whose display is to be used for the + * lookup. */ { LPRUNNINGOBJECTTABLE pROT = NULL; LPCOLESTR oleszStub = TKWINSEND_REGISTRATION_BASE; HRESULT hr = S_OK; Tcl_Obj *objList = NULL; int result = TCL_OK; - + +#ifndef TK_SEND_ENABLED_ON_WINDOWS /* * Temporarily disabled for bug #858822 */ + return TCL_OK; +#else /* TK_SEND_ENABLED_ON_WINDOWS */ hr = GetRunningObjectTable(0, &pROT); - if(SUCCEEDED(hr)) { + if (SUCCEEDED(hr)) { IBindCtx* pBindCtx = NULL; objList = Tcl_NewListObj(0, NULL); hr = CreateBindCtx(0, &pBindCtx); + if (SUCCEEDED(hr)) { - IEnumMoniker* pEnum; + hr = pROT->lpVtbl->EnumRunning(pROT, &pEnum); - if(SUCCEEDED(hr)) { + if (SUCCEEDED(hr)) { IMoniker* pmk = NULL; - while (pEnum->lpVtbl->Next(pEnum, 1, &pmk, (ULONG*)NULL) - == S_OK) { + + while (pEnum->lpVtbl->Next(pEnum, 1, &pmk, NULL) == S_OK) { LPOLESTR olestr; - hr = pmk->lpVtbl->GetDisplayName(pmk, pBindCtx, - NULL, &olestr); + + hr = pmk->lpVtbl->GetDisplayName(pmk, pBindCtx, NULL, + &olestr); if (SUCCEEDED(hr)) { IMalloc *pMalloc = NULL; - - if (wcsncmp(olestr, oleszStub, wcslen(oleszStub)) == 0) { + + if (wcsncmp(olestr, oleszStub, + wcslen(oleszStub)) == 0) { LPOLESTR p = olestr + wcslen(oleszStub); + if (*p) { - result = Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, - objList, Tcl_NewUnicodeObj(p + 1, -1)); + result = Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, + objList, Tcl_NewUnicodeObj(p + 1, -1)); } } - + hr = CoGetMalloc(1, &pMalloc); if (SUCCEEDED(hr)) { pMalloc->lpVtbl->Free(pMalloc, (void*)olestr); @@ -254,19 +268,23 @@ TkGetInterpNames(interp, tkwin) } if (FAILED(hr)) { - /* expire the list if set */ - if (objList != NULL) { - Tcl_DecrRefCount(objList); - } - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, Win32ErrorObj(hr)); - result = TCL_ERROR; + /* + * Expire the list if set. + */ + + if (objList != NULL) { + Tcl_DecrRefCount(objList); + } + Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, Win32ErrorObj(hr)); + result = TCL_ERROR; } - + if (result == TCL_OK) { - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objList); + Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, objList); } - + return result; +#endif /* TK_SEND_ENABLED_ON_WINDOWS */ } /* @@ -274,8 +292,8 @@ TkGetInterpNames(interp, tkwin) * * Tk_SendCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "send" Tcl command. - * See the user documentation for details on what it does. + * This function is invoked to process the "send" Tcl command. See the + * user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -287,24 +305,27 @@ TkGetInterpNames(interp, tkwin) */ int -Tk_SendObjCmd(clientData, interp, objc, objv) - ClientData clientData; /* Information about sender (only - * dispPtr field is used). */ - Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Current interpreter. */ - int objc; /* Number of arguments. */ - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument strings. */ +Tk_SendObjCmd( + ClientData clientData, /* Information about sender (only dispPtr + * field is used). */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Current interpreter. */ + int objc, /* Number of arguments. */ + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]) /* Argument strings. */ { enum { SEND_ASYNC, SEND_DISPLAYOF, SEND_LAST }; static CONST char *sendOptions[] = { - "-async", "-displayof", "--", (CONST char *)NULL + "-async", "-displayof", "--", NULL }; int result = TCL_OK; int i, optind, async = 0; Tcl_Obj *displayPtr = NULL; - /* process the command options */ + /* + * Process the command options. + */ + for (i = 1; i < objc; i++) { if (Tcl_GetIndexFromObj(interp, objv[i], sendOptions, "option", 0, &optind) != TCL_OK) { @@ -319,12 +340,15 @@ Tk_SendObjCmd(clientData, interp, objc, objv) break; } } - - /* ensure we still have a valid command */ + + /* + * Ensure we still have a valid command. + */ + if ((objc - i) < 2) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 1, objv, + Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 1, objv, "?-async? ?-displayof? ?--? interpName arg ?arg ...?"); - result = TCL_ERROR; + result = TCL_ERROR; } /* @@ -333,24 +357,25 @@ Tk_SendObjCmd(clientData, interp, objc, objv) if (displayPtr) { Tcl_SetStringObj(Tcl_GetObjResult(interp), - "option not implemented: \"displayof\" is not available " - "for this platform.", -1); + "option not implemented: \"displayof\" is not available " + "for this platform.", -1); result = TCL_ERROR; } - - /* send the arguments to the foreign interp */ + + /* + * Send the arguments to the foreign interp. + */ /* FIX ME: we need to check for local interp */ if (result == TCL_OK) { LPDISPATCH pdisp; result = FindInterpreterObject(interp, Tcl_GetString(objv[i]), &pdisp); if (result == TCL_OK) { i++; - result = Send(pdisp, interp, async, clientData, - (objc - i), &objv[i]); + result = Send(pdisp, interp, async, clientData, objc-i, objv+i); pdisp->lpVtbl->Release(pdisp); } } - + return result; } @@ -359,16 +384,14 @@ Tk_SendObjCmd(clientData, interp, objc, objv) * * FindInterpreterObject -- * - * Search the set of objects currently registered with the - * Running Object Table for one which matches the registered - * name. Tk objects are named using BuildMoniker by always - * prefixing with TclEval. + * Search the set of objects currently registered with the Running Object + * Table for one which matches the registered name. Tk objects are named + * using BuildMoniker by always prefixing with TclEval. * * Results: - * If a matching object registration is found, then the - * registered IDispatch interface pointer is returned. - * If not, then an error message is placed in the interpreter - * and TCL_ERROR is returned. + * If a matching object registration is found, then the registered + * IDispatch interface pointer is returned. If not, then an error message + * is placed in the interpreter and TCL_ERROR is returned. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -377,19 +400,26 @@ Tk_SendObjCmd(clientData, interp, objc, objv) */ static int -FindInterpreterObject(Tcl_Interp *interp, CONST char *name, LPDISPATCH *ppdisp) +FindInterpreterObject( + Tcl_Interp *interp, + CONST char *name, + LPDISPATCH *ppdisp) { LPRUNNINGOBJECTTABLE pROT = NULL; int result = TCL_OK; HRESULT hr = GetRunningObjectTable(0, &pROT); + if (SUCCEEDED(hr)) { IBindCtx* pBindCtx = NULL; + hr = CreateBindCtx(0, &pBindCtx); if (SUCCEEDED(hr)) { LPMONIKER pmk = NULL; + hr = BuildMoniker(name, &pmk); if (SUCCEEDED(hr)) { IUnknown* punkInterp = NULL; + hr = pROT->lpVtbl->IsRunning(pROT, pmk); hr = pmk->lpVtbl->BindToObject(pmk, pBindCtx, NULL, &IID_IUnknown, (void**)&punkInterp); @@ -401,10 +431,10 @@ FindInterpreterObject(Tcl_Interp *interp, CONST char *name, LPDISPATCH *ppdisp) } else { Tcl_ResetResult(interp); Tcl_AppendResult(interp, - "no application named \"", name, "\"", NULL); + "no application named \"", name, "\"", NULL); result = TCL_ERROR; } - + pmk->lpVtbl->Release(pmk); } pBindCtx->lpVtbl->Release(pBindCtx); @@ -423,38 +453,50 @@ FindInterpreterObject(Tcl_Interp *interp, CONST char *name, LPDISPATCH *ppdisp) * * CmdDeleteProc -- * - * This procedure is invoked by Tcl when the "send" command - * is deleted in an interpreter. It unregisters the interpreter. + * This function is invoked by Tcl when the "send" command is deleted in + * an interpreter. It unregisters the interpreter. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * The interpreter given by riPtr is unregistered, the - * registration structure is free'd and the COM object - * unregistered and released. + * The interpreter given by riPtr is unregistered, the registration + * structure is free'd and the COM object unregistered and released. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void -CmdDeleteProc(ClientData clientData) +CmdDeleteProc( + ClientData clientData) { RegisteredInterp *riPtr = (RegisteredInterp *)clientData; - /* Lock the package structure in memory */ + /* + * Lock the package structure in memory. + */ + Tcl_Preserve(clientData); - /* Revoke the ROT registration */ + /* + * Revoke the ROT registration. + */ + RevokeObjectRegistration(riPtr); - /* Release the registration object */ + /* + * Release the registration object. + */ + riPtr->obj->lpVtbl->Release(riPtr->obj); riPtr->obj = NULL; Tcl_DeleteAssocData(riPtr->interp, "tkWinSend::ri"); - /* unlock the package data structure. */ + /* + * Unlock the package data structure. + */ + Tcl_Release(clientData); ckfree(clientData); @@ -465,37 +507,42 @@ CmdDeleteProc(ClientData clientData) * * RevokeObjectRegistration -- * - * Releases the interpreters registration object from the - * Running Object Table. + * Releases the interpreters registration object from the Running Object + * Table. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * The stored cookie value is zeroed and the name is free'd - * and the pointer set to NULL. + * The stored cookie value is zeroed and the name is free'd and the + * pointer set to NULL. * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void -RevokeObjectRegistration(RegisteredInterp *riPtr) +RevokeObjectRegistration( + RegisteredInterp *riPtr) { LPRUNNINGOBJECTTABLE pROT = NULL; HRESULT hr = S_OK; + if (riPtr->cookie != 0) { - hr = GetRunningObjectTable(0, &pROT); - if (SUCCEEDED(hr)) { - hr = pROT->lpVtbl->Revoke(pROT, riPtr->cookie); - pROT->lpVtbl->Release(pROT); - riPtr->cookie = 0; - } + hr = GetRunningObjectTable(0, &pROT); + if (SUCCEEDED(hr)) { + hr = pROT->lpVtbl->Revoke(pROT, riPtr->cookie); + pROT->lpVtbl->Release(pROT); + riPtr->cookie = 0; + } } - /* release the name storage */ + /* + * Release the name storage. + */ + if (riPtr->name != NULL) { free(riPtr->name); - riPtr->name = NULL; + riPtr->name = NULL; } } @@ -504,8 +551,8 @@ RevokeObjectRegistration(RegisteredInterp *riPtr) * * InterpDeleteProc -- * - * This is called when the interpreter is deleted and used to - * unregister the COM libraries. + * This is called when the interpreter is deleted and used to unregister + * the COM libraries. * * Results: * None. @@ -517,7 +564,9 @@ RevokeObjectRegistration(RegisteredInterp *riPtr) */ static void -InterpDeleteProc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp *interp) +InterpDeleteProc( + ClientData clientData, + Tcl_Interp *interp) { CoUninitialize(); } @@ -526,13 +575,13 @@ InterpDeleteProc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp *interp) * ---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * BuildMoniker -- - * + * * Construct a moniker from the given name. This ensures that all our * monikers have the same prefix. * * Results: - * S_OK. If the name cannot be turned into a moniker then a - * COM error code is returned. + * S_OK. If the name cannot be turned into a moniker then a COM error + * code is returned. * * Side effects: * The moniker created is stored at the address given by ppmk. @@ -541,23 +590,26 @@ InterpDeleteProc(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp *interp) */ static HRESULT -BuildMoniker(CONST char *name, LPMONIKER *ppmk) +BuildMoniker( + CONST char *name, + LPMONIKER *ppmk) { LPMONIKER pmkClass = NULL; HRESULT hr = CreateFileMoniker(TKWINSEND_REGISTRATION_BASE, &pmkClass); + if (SUCCEEDED(hr)) { - LPMONIKER pmkItem = NULL; + LPMONIKER pmkItem = NULL; Tcl_DString dString; Tcl_DStringInit(&dString); Tcl_UtfToUniCharDString(name, -1, &dString); - hr = CreateFileMoniker((LPOLESTR)Tcl_DStringValue(&dString), &pmkItem); + hr = CreateFileMoniker((LPOLESTR)Tcl_DStringValue(&dString), &pmkItem); Tcl_DStringFree(&dString); - if (SUCCEEDED(hr)) { - hr = pmkClass->lpVtbl->ComposeWith(pmkClass, pmkItem, FALSE, ppmk); + if (SUCCEEDED(hr)) { + hr = pmkClass->lpVtbl->ComposeWith(pmkClass, pmkItem, FALSE, ppmk); pmkItem->lpVtbl->Release(pmkItem); - } - pmkClass->lpVtbl->Release(pmkClass); + } + pmkClass->lpVtbl->Release(pmkClass); } return hr; } @@ -566,23 +618,25 @@ BuildMoniker(CONST char *name, LPMONIKER *ppmk) * ---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * RegisterInterp -- - * - * Attempts to register the provided name for this interpreter. - * If the given name is already in use, then a numeric suffix is - * appended as " #n" until we identify a unique name. - * + * + * Attempts to register the provided name for this interpreter. If the + * given name is already in use, then a numeric suffix is appended as + * " #n" until we identify a unique name. + * * Results: * Returns S_OK if successful, else a COM error code. * * Side effects: - * Registration returns a cookie value which is stored. We also store - * a copy of the name. + * Registration returns a cookie value which is stored. We also store a + * copy of the name. * * ---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static HRESULT -RegisterInterp(CONST char *name, RegisteredInterp *riPtr) +RegisterInterp( + CONST char *name, + RegisteredInterp *riPtr) { HRESULT hr = S_OK; LPRUNNINGOBJECTTABLE pROT = NULL; @@ -594,9 +648,7 @@ RegisterInterp(CONST char *name, RegisteredInterp *riPtr) hr = GetRunningObjectTable(0, &pROT); if (SUCCEEDED(hr)) { - offset = 0; - for (i = 1; SUCCEEDED(hr); i++) { if (i > 1) { if (i == 2) { @@ -609,11 +661,11 @@ RegisterInterp(CONST char *name, RegisteredInterp *riPtr) } sprintf(Tcl_DStringValue(&dString) + offset, "%d", i); } - + hr = BuildMoniker(actualName, &pmk); if (SUCCEEDED(hr)) { - hr = pROT->lpVtbl->Register(pROT, + hr = pROT->lpVtbl->Register(pROT, ROTFLAGS_REGISTRATIONKEEPSALIVE, riPtr->obj, pmk, &riPtr->cookie); @@ -621,17 +673,17 @@ RegisterInterp(CONST char *name, RegisteredInterp *riPtr) } if (hr == MK_S_MONIKERALREADYREGISTERED) { - pROT->lpVtbl->Revoke(pROT, riPtr->cookie); + pROT->lpVtbl->Revoke(pROT, riPtr->cookie); } else if (hr == S_OK) { break; } } - + pROT->lpVtbl->Release(pROT); } if (SUCCEEDED(hr)) { - riPtr->name = strdup(actualName); + riPtr->name = strdup(actualName); } Tcl_DStringFree(&dString); @@ -643,9 +695,9 @@ RegisterInterp(CONST char *name, RegisteredInterp *riPtr) * * Send -- * - * Perform an interface call to the server object. We convert the - * Tcl arguments into a BSTR using 'concat'. The result should be a - * BSTR that we can set as the interp's result string. + * Perform an interface call to the server object. We convert the Tcl + * arguments into a BSTR using 'concat'. The result should be a BSTR that + * we can set as the interp's result string. * * Results: * None. @@ -654,15 +706,18 @@ RegisterInterp(CONST char *name, RegisteredInterp *riPtr) * None. * * ---------------------------------------------------------------------- - */ + */ static int -Send(LPDISPATCH pdispInterp, /* pointer to the remote interp's COM object */ - Tcl_Interp *interp, /* the local interpreter */ - int async, /* flag for the calling style */ - ClientData clientData, /* the RegisteredInterp structure for this interp */ - int objc, /* number of arguments to be sent */ - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]) /* the arguments to be sent */ +Send( + LPDISPATCH pdispInterp, /* Pointer to the remote interp's COM + * object. */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* The local interpreter. */ + int async, /* Flag for the calling style. */ + ClientData clientData, /* The RegisteredInterp structure for this + * interp. */ + int objc, /* Number of arguments to be sent. */ + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]) /* The arguments to be sent. */ { VARIANT vCmd, vResult; DISPPARAMS dp; @@ -690,8 +745,7 @@ Send(LPDISPATCH pdispInterp, /* pointer to the remote interp's COM object */ dp.rgvarg = &vCmd; /* - * Select the method to use based upon the async flag and - * call the method. + * Select the method to use based upon the async flag and call the method. */ dispid = async ? TKWINSENDCOM_DISPID_ASYNC : TKWINSENDCOM_DISPID_SEND; @@ -703,36 +757,36 @@ Send(LPDISPATCH pdispInterp, /* pointer to the remote interp's COM object */ /* * Convert the result into a string and place in the interps result. */ - + ehr = VariantChangeType(&vResult, &vResult, 0, VT_BSTR); if (SUCCEEDED(ehr)) { - Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, Tcl_NewUnicodeObj(vResult.bstrVal, -1)); + Tcl_SetObjResult(interp, Tcl_NewUnicodeObj(vResult.bstrVal, -1)); } /* * Errors are returned as dispatch exceptions. If an error code was - * returned then we decode the exception and setup the Tcl - * error variables. + * returned then we decode the exception and setup the Tcl error + * variables. */ if (hr == DISP_E_EXCEPTION) { - Tcl_Obj *opError, *opErrorCode, *opErrorInfo; - - if (ei.bstrSource != NULL) { - int len; - char * szErrorInfo; - - opError = Tcl_NewUnicodeObj(ei.bstrSource, -1); - Tcl_ListObjIndex(interp, opError, 0, &opErrorCode); - Tcl_SetObjErrorCode(interp, opErrorCode); - - Tcl_ListObjIndex(interp, opError, 1, &opErrorInfo); - szErrorInfo = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(opErrorInfo, &len); - Tcl_AddObjErrorInfo(interp, szErrorInfo, len); - } + Tcl_Obj *opError, *opErrorCode, *opErrorInfo; + + if (ei.bstrSource != NULL) { + int len; + char *szErrorInfo; + + opError = Tcl_NewUnicodeObj(ei.bstrSource, -1); + Tcl_ListObjIndex(interp, opError, 0, &opErrorCode); + Tcl_SetObjErrorCode(interp, opErrorCode); + + Tcl_ListObjIndex(interp, opError, 1, &opErrorInfo); + szErrorInfo = Tcl_GetStringFromObj(opErrorInfo, &len); + Tcl_AddObjErrorInfo(interp, szErrorInfo, len); + } } - /* + /* * Clean up any COM allocated resources. */ @@ -749,8 +803,7 @@ Send(LPDISPATCH pdispInterp, /* pointer to the remote interp's COM object */ * * Win32ErrorObj -- * - * Returns a string object containing text from a COM or - * Win32 error code + * Returns a string object containing text from a COM or Win32 error code * * Results: * A Tcl_Obj containing the Win32 error message. @@ -762,7 +815,8 @@ Send(LPDISPATCH pdispInterp, /* pointer to the remote interp's COM object */ */ static Tcl_Obj* -Win32ErrorObj(HRESULT hrError) +Win32ErrorObj( + HRESULT hrError) { LPTSTR lpBuffer = NULL, p = NULL; TCHAR sBuffer[30]; @@ -778,7 +832,7 @@ Win32ErrorObj(HRESULT hrError) } if ((p = _tcsrchr(lpBuffer, _T('\r'))) != NULL) { - *p = _T('\0'); + *p = _T('\0'); } #ifdef _UNICODE @@ -788,7 +842,7 @@ Win32ErrorObj(HRESULT hrError) #endif if (lpBuffer != sBuffer) { - LocalFree((HLOCAL)lpBuffer); + LocalFree((HLOCAL)lpBuffer); } return errPtr; @@ -800,8 +854,8 @@ Win32ErrorObj(HRESULT hrError) * SetErrorInfo -- * * Convert the error information from a Tcl interpreter into a COM - * exception structure. This information is then registered with the - * COM thread exception object so that it can be used for rich error + * exception structure. This information is then registered with the COM + * thread exception object so that it can be used for rich error * reporting by COM clients. * * Results: @@ -814,43 +868,47 @@ Win32ErrorObj(HRESULT hrError) */ void -SetExcepInfo(Tcl_Interp* interp, EXCEPINFO *pExcepInfo) +SetExcepInfo( + Tcl_Interp* interp, + EXCEPINFO *pExcepInfo) { if (pExcepInfo) { - Tcl_Obj *opError, *opErrorInfo, *opErrorCode; - ICreateErrorInfo *pCEI; - IErrorInfo *pEI; - HRESULT hr; + Tcl_Obj *opError, *opErrorInfo, *opErrorCode; + ICreateErrorInfo *pCEI; + IErrorInfo *pEI; + HRESULT hr; - opError = Tcl_GetObjResult(interp); - opErrorInfo = Tcl_GetVar2Ex(interp, "errorInfo", NULL, TCL_GLOBAL_ONLY); - opErrorCode = Tcl_GetVar2Ex(interp, "errorCode", NULL, TCL_GLOBAL_ONLY); + opError = Tcl_GetObjResult(interp); + opErrorInfo = Tcl_GetVar2Ex(interp, "errorInfo",NULL, TCL_GLOBAL_ONLY); + opErrorCode = Tcl_GetVar2Ex(interp, "errorCode",NULL, TCL_GLOBAL_ONLY); if (Tcl_IsShared(opErrorCode)) { Tcl_Obj *ec = Tcl_DuplicateObj(opErrorCode); + Tcl_IncrRefCount(ec); Tcl_DecrRefCount(opErrorCode); opErrorCode = ec; } - Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, opErrorCode, opErrorInfo); - - pExcepInfo->bstrDescription = SysAllocString(Tcl_GetUnicode(opError)); - pExcepInfo->bstrSource = SysAllocString(Tcl_GetUnicode(opErrorCode)); - pExcepInfo->scode = E_FAIL; - - hr = CreateErrorInfo(&pCEI); - if (SUCCEEDED(hr)) { - hr = pCEI->lpVtbl->SetGUID(pCEI, &IID_IDispatch); - hr = pCEI->lpVtbl->SetDescription(pCEI, pExcepInfo->bstrDescription); - hr = pCEI->lpVtbl->SetSource(pCEI, pExcepInfo->bstrSource); - hr = pCEI->lpVtbl->QueryInterface(pCEI, &IID_IErrorInfo, - (void**)&pEI); - if (SUCCEEDED(hr)) { - SetErrorInfo(0, pEI); - pEI->lpVtbl->Release(pEI); - } - pCEI->lpVtbl->Release(pCEI); - } + Tcl_ListObjAppendElement(interp, opErrorCode, opErrorInfo); + + pExcepInfo->bstrDescription = SysAllocString(Tcl_GetUnicode(opError)); + pExcepInfo->bstrSource = SysAllocString(Tcl_GetUnicode(opErrorCode)); + pExcepInfo->scode = E_FAIL; + + hr = CreateErrorInfo(&pCEI); + if (SUCCEEDED(hr)) { + hr = pCEI->lpVtbl->SetGUID(pCEI, &IID_IDispatch); + hr = pCEI->lpVtbl->SetDescription(pCEI, + pExcepInfo->bstrDescription); + hr = pCEI->lpVtbl->SetSource(pCEI, pExcepInfo->bstrSource); + hr = pCEI->lpVtbl->QueryInterface(pCEI, &IID_IErrorInfo, + (void**) &pEI); + if (SUCCEEDED(hr)) { + SetErrorInfo(0, pEI); + pEI->lpVtbl->Release(pEI); + } + pCEI->lpVtbl->Release(pCEI); + } } } @@ -859,8 +917,8 @@ SetExcepInfo(Tcl_Interp* interp, EXCEPINFO *pExcepInfo) * * TkWinSend_QueueCommand -- * - * Queue a script for asynchronous evaluation. This is called from - * the COM objects Async method. + * Queue a script for asynchronous evaluation. This is called from the + * COM objects Async method. * * Results: * None. @@ -871,8 +929,10 @@ SetExcepInfo(Tcl_Interp* interp, EXCEPINFO *pExcepInfo) * ---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -int -TkWinSend_QueueCommand(Tcl_Interp *interp, Tcl_Obj *cmdPtr) +int +TkWinSend_QueueCommand( + Tcl_Interp *interp, + Tcl_Obj *cmdPtr) { SendEvent *evPtr; @@ -885,10 +945,10 @@ TkWinSend_QueueCommand(Tcl_Interp *interp, Tcl_Obj *cmdPtr) Tcl_Preserve(evPtr->interp); if (Tcl_IsShared(cmdPtr)) { - evPtr->cmdPtr = Tcl_DuplicateObj(cmdPtr); + evPtr->cmdPtr = Tcl_DuplicateObj(cmdPtr); } else { - evPtr->cmdPtr = cmdPtr; - Tcl_IncrRefCount(evPtr->cmdPtr); + evPtr->cmdPtr = cmdPtr; + Tcl_IncrRefCount(evPtr->cmdPtr); } Tcl_QueueEvent((Tcl_Event *)evPtr, TCL_QUEUE_TAIL); @@ -901,12 +961,12 @@ TkWinSend_QueueCommand(Tcl_Interp *interp, Tcl_Obj *cmdPtr) * * SendEventProc -- * - * Handle a request for an asynchronous send. Nothing is returned - * to the caller so the result is discarded. + * Handle a request for an asynchronous send. Nothing is returned to the + * caller so the result is discarded. * * Results: - * Returns 1 if the event was handled or 0 to indicate it has - * been deferred. + * Returns 1 if the event was handled or 0 to indicate it has been + * deferred. * * Side effects: * The target interpreter's result will be modified. @@ -915,16 +975,18 @@ TkWinSend_QueueCommand(Tcl_Interp *interp, Tcl_Obj *cmdPtr) */ static int -SendEventProc(Tcl_Event *eventPtr, int flags) +SendEventProc( + Tcl_Event *eventPtr, + int flags) { int result = TCL_OK; SendEvent *evPtr = (SendEvent *)eventPtr; TRACE("SendEventProc\n"); - + result = Tcl_EvalObjEx(evPtr->interp, evPtr->cmdPtr, - TCL_EVAL_DIRECT | TCL_EVAL_GLOBAL); - + TCL_EVAL_DIRECT | TCL_EVAL_GLOBAL); + Tcl_DecrRefCount(evPtr->cmdPtr); Tcl_Release(evPtr->interp); @@ -936,9 +998,9 @@ SendEventProc(Tcl_Event *eventPtr, int flags) * * SendTrace -- * - * Provide trace information to the Windows debug stream. - * To use this - use the TRACE macro, which compiles to nothing - * when DEBUG is not defined. + * Provide trace information to the Windows debug stream. To use this - + * use the TRACE macro, which compiles to nothing when DEBUG is not + * defined. * * Results: * None. @@ -950,13 +1012,22 @@ SendEventProc(Tcl_Event *eventPtr, int flags) */ static void -SendTrace(const char *format, ...) +SendTrace( + const char *format, ...) { - va_list args; + va_list args; static char buffer[1024]; - va_start (args, format); + + va_start(args, format); _vsnprintf(buffer, 1023, format, args); OutputDebugString(buffer); va_end(args); } +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWinTest.c b/win/tkWinTest.c index ce7694d..600f490 100644 --- a/win/tkWinTest.c +++ b/win/tkWinTest.c @@ -1,41 +1,40 @@ -/* +/* * tkWinTest.c -- * - * Contains commands for platform specific tests for - * the Windows platform. + * Contains commands for platform specific tests for the Windows + * platform. * * Copyright (c) 1997 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * Copyright (c) 2000 by Scriptics Corporation. * Copyright (c) 2001 by ActiveState Corporation. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinTest.c,v 1.8 2005/11/27 02:36:16 das Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinTest.c,v 1.9 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkWinInt.h" HWND tkWinCurrentDialog; - + /* - * Forward declarations of procedures defined later in this file: + * Forward declarations of functions defined later in this file: */ static int TestclipboardObjCmd(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); -static int TestwineventCmd(ClientData clientData, +static int TestwineventCmd(ClientData clientData, Tcl_Interp *interp, int argc, CONST char **argv); - /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkplatformtestInit -- * - * Defines commands that test platform specific functionality for - * Unix platforms. + * Defines commands that test platform specific functionality for Windows + * platforms. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -53,11 +52,11 @@ TkplatformtestInit( /* * Add commands for platform specific tests on MacOS here. */ - + Tcl_CreateObjCommand(interp, "testclipboard", TestclipboardObjCmd, - (ClientData) Tk_MainWindow(interp), (Tcl_CmdDeleteProc *) NULL); + (ClientData) Tk_MainWindow(interp), NULL); Tcl_CreateCommand(interp, "testwinevent", TestwineventCmd, - (ClientData) Tk_MainWindow(interp), (Tcl_CmdDeleteProc *) NULL); + (ClientData) Tk_MainWindow(interp), NULL); return TCL_OK; } @@ -67,8 +66,8 @@ TkplatformtestInit( * * AppendSystemError -- * - * This routine formats a Windows system error message and places - * it into the interpreter result. Originally from tclWinReg.c. + * This routine formats a Windows system error message and places it into + * the interpreter result. Originally from tclWinReg.c. * * Results: * None. @@ -129,6 +128,7 @@ AppendSystemError( /* * Trim the trailing CR/LF from the system message. */ + if (msg[length-1] == '\n') { msg[--length] = 0; } @@ -151,8 +151,8 @@ AppendSystemError( * * TestclipboardObjCmd -- * - * This procedure implements the testclipboard command. It provides - * a way to determine the actual contents of the Windows clipboard. + * This function implements the testclipboard command. It provides a way + * to determine the actual contents of the Windows clipboard. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -164,11 +164,11 @@ AppendSystemError( */ static int -TestclipboardObjCmd(clientData, interp, objc, objv) - ClientData clientData; /* Main window for application. */ - Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Current interpreter. */ - int objc; /* Number of arguments. */ - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument values. */ +TestclipboardObjCmd( + ClientData clientData, /* Main window for application. */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Current interpreter. */ + int objc, /* Number of arguments. */ + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]) /* Argument values. */ { TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) clientData; HGLOBAL handle; @@ -176,29 +176,29 @@ TestclipboardObjCmd(clientData, interp, objc, objv) int code = TCL_OK; if (objc != 1) { - Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 1, objv, (char *) NULL); + Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 1, objv, NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } if (OpenClipboard(NULL)) { /* - * We could consider using CF_UNICODETEXT on NT, but then we - * would have to convert it from External. Instead we'll just - * take this and do "bytestring" at the Tcl level for Unicode - * inclusive text + * We could consider using CF_UNICODETEXT on NT, but then we would + * have to convert it from External. Instead we'll just take this and + * do "bytestring" at the Tcl level for Unicode inclusive text */ + handle = GetClipboardData(CF_TEXT); if (handle != NULL) { data = GlobalLock(handle); - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, data, (char *) NULL); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, data, NULL); GlobalUnlock(handle); } else { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "null clipboard handle", (char *) NULL); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "null clipboard handle", NULL); code = TCL_ERROR; } CloseClipboard(); return code; } else { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "couldn't open clipboard: ", (char *) NULL); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "couldn't open clipboard: ", NULL); AppendSystemError(interp, GetLastError()); return TCL_ERROR; } @@ -210,8 +210,8 @@ TestclipboardObjCmd(clientData, interp, objc, objv) * * TestwineventCmd -- * - * This procedure implements the testwinevent command. It provides - * a way to send messages to windows dialogs. + * This function implements the testwinevent command. It provides a way + * to send messages to windows dialogs. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -223,11 +223,11 @@ TestclipboardObjCmd(clientData, interp, objc, objv) */ static int -TestwineventCmd(clientData, interp, argc, argv) - ClientData clientData; /* Main window for application. */ - Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Current interpreter. */ - int argc; /* Number of arguments. */ - CONST char **argv; /* Argument strings. */ +TestwineventCmd( + ClientData clientData, /* Main window for application. */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Current interpreter. */ + int argc, /* Number of arguments. */ + CONST char **argv) /* Argument strings. */ { HWND hwnd = 0; int id; @@ -262,9 +262,9 @@ TestwineventCmd(clientData, interp, argc, argv) TkpScanWindowId(interp, argv[1], &id); if ( #ifdef _WIN64 - (sscanf(string, "0x%p", &number) != 1) && -#endif - Tcl_GetInt(interp, string, (int *)&number) != TCL_OK) { + (sscanf(string, "0x%p", &number) != 1) && +#endif /* _WIN64 */ + Tcl_GetInt(interp, string, (int *)&number) != TCL_OK) { return TCL_ERROR; } #endif @@ -311,35 +311,40 @@ TestwineventCmd(clientData, interp, argc, argv) } switch (message) { - case WM_GETTEXT: { - Tcl_DString ds; - char buf[256]; + case WM_GETTEXT: { + Tcl_DString ds; + char buf[256]; - GetDlgItemText(hwnd, id, buf, 256); - Tcl_ExternalToUtfDString(NULL, buf, -1, &ds); - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, Tcl_DStringValue(&ds), NULL); - Tcl_DStringFree(&ds); - break; - } - case WM_SETTEXT: { - Tcl_DString ds; + GetDlgItemText(hwnd, id, buf, 256); + Tcl_ExternalToUtfDString(NULL, buf, -1, &ds); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, Tcl_DStringValue(&ds), NULL); + Tcl_DStringFree(&ds); + break; + } + case WM_SETTEXT: { + Tcl_DString ds; - Tcl_UtfToExternalDString(NULL, argv[4], -1, &ds); - SetDlgItemText(hwnd, id, Tcl_DStringValue(&ds)); - Tcl_DStringFree(&ds); - break; - } - default: { - char buf[TCL_INTEGER_SPACE]; - - sprintf(buf, "%d", - SendDlgItemMessage(hwnd, id, message, wParam, lParam)); - Tcl_SetResult(interp, buf, TCL_VOLATILE); - break; - } + Tcl_UtfToExternalDString(NULL, argv[4], -1, &ds); + SetDlgItemText(hwnd, id, Tcl_DStringValue(&ds)); + Tcl_DStringFree(&ds); + break; + } + default: { + char buf[TCL_INTEGER_SPACE]; + + sprintf(buf, "%d", + SendDlgItemMessage(hwnd, id, message, wParam, lParam)); + Tcl_SetResult(interp, buf, TCL_VOLATILE); + break; + } } return TCL_OK; } - - - + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWinWindow.c b/win/tkWinWindow.c index da871c7..dccfd92 100644 --- a/win/tkWinWindow.c +++ b/win/tkWinWindow.c @@ -1,22 +1,22 @@ -/* +/* * tkWinWindow.c -- * - * Xlib emulation routines for Windows related to creating, - * displaying and destroying windows. + * Xlib emulation routines for Windows related to creating, displaying + * and destroying windows. * * Copyright (c) 1995-1997 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinWindow.c,v 1.10 2002/06/14 22:25:12 jenglish Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinWindow.c,v 1.11 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkWinInt.h" typedef struct ThreadSpecificData { int initialized; /* 0 means table below needs initializing. */ - Tcl_HashTable windowTable; /* The windowTable maps from HWND to + Tcl_HashTable windowTable; /* The windowTable maps from HWND to * Tk_Window handles. */ } ThreadSpecificData; static Tcl_ThreadDataKey dataKey; @@ -25,36 +25,35 @@ static Tcl_ThreadDataKey dataKey; * Forward declarations for procedures defined in this file: */ -static void NotifyVisibility _ANSI_ARGS_((XEvent *eventPtr, - TkWindow *winPtr)); +static void NotifyVisibility(XEvent *eventPtr, TkWindow *winPtr); /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * Tk_AttachHWND -- * - * This function binds an HWND and a reflection procedure to - * the specified Tk_Window. + * This function binds an HWND and a reflection procedure to the + * specified Tk_Window. * * Results: * Returns an X Window that encapsulates the HWND. * * Side effects: - * May allocate a new X Window. Also enters the HWND into the - * global window table. + * May allocate a new X Window. Also enters the HWND into the global + * window table. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ Window -Tk_AttachHWND(tkwin, hwnd) - Tk_Window tkwin; - HWND hwnd; +Tk_AttachHWND( + Tk_Window tkwin, + HWND hwnd) { int new; Tcl_HashEntry *entryPtr; TkWinDrawable *twdPtr = (TkWinDrawable *) Tk_WindowId(tkwin); - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); if (!tsdPtr->initialized) { @@ -63,12 +62,12 @@ Tk_AttachHWND(tkwin, hwnd) } /* - * Allocate a new drawable if necessary. Otherwise, remove the - * previous HWND from from the window table. + * Allocate a new drawable if necessary. Otherwise, remove the previous + * HWND from from the window table. */ if (twdPtr == NULL) { - twdPtr = (TkWinDrawable*) ckalloc(sizeof(TkWinDrawable)); + twdPtr = (TkWinDrawable *) ckalloc(sizeof(TkWinDrawable)); twdPtr->type = TWD_WINDOW; twdPtr->window.winPtr = (TkWindow *) tkwin; } else if (twdPtr->window.handle != NULL) { @@ -93,8 +92,8 @@ Tk_AttachHWND(tkwin, hwnd) * * Tk_HWNDToWindow -- * - * This function retrieves a Tk_Window from the window table - * given an HWND. + * This function retrieves a Tk_Window from the window table given an + * HWND. * * Results: * Returns the matching Tk_Window. @@ -106,11 +105,11 @@ Tk_AttachHWND(tkwin, hwnd) */ Tk_Window -Tk_HWNDToWindow(hwnd) - HWND hwnd; +Tk_HWNDToWindow( + HWND hwnd) { Tcl_HashEntry *entryPtr; - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); if (!tsdPtr->initialized) { @@ -141,8 +140,8 @@ Tk_HWNDToWindow(hwnd) */ HWND -Tk_GetHWND(window) - Window window; +Tk_GetHWND( + Window window) { return ((TkWinDrawable *) window)->window.handle; } @@ -152,9 +151,8 @@ Tk_GetHWND(window) * * TkpPrintWindowId -- * - * This routine stores the string representation of the - * platform dependent window handle for an X Window in the - * given buffer. + * This routine stores the string representation of the platform + * dependent window handle for an X Window in the given buffer. * * Results: * Returns the result in the specified buffer. @@ -166,16 +164,18 @@ Tk_GetHWND(window) */ void -TkpPrintWindowId(buf, window) - char *buf; /* Pointer to string large enough to hold - * the hex representation of a pointer. */ - Window window; /* Window to be printed into buffer. */ +TkpPrintWindowId( + char *buf, /* Pointer to string large enough to hold the + * hex representation of a pointer. */ + Window window) /* Window to be printed into buffer. */ { HWND hwnd = (window) ? Tk_GetHWND(window) : 0; + /* - * Use pointer representation, because Win64 is P64 (*not* LP64). - * Windows doesn't print the 0x for %p, so we do it. + * Use pointer representation, because Win64 is P64 (*not* LP64). Windows + * doesn't print the 0x for %p, so we do it. */ + sprintf(buf, "0x%p", hwnd); } @@ -184,16 +184,15 @@ TkpPrintWindowId(buf, window) * * TkpScanWindowId -- * - * Given a string which represents the platform dependent window - * handle, produce the X Window id for the window. + * Given a string which represents the platform dependent window handle, + * produce the X Window id for the window. * * Results: - * The return value is normally TCL_OK; in this case *idPtr - * will be set to the X Window id equivalent to string. If - * string is improperly formed then TCL_ERROR is returned and - * an error message will be left in the interp's result. If the - * number does not correspond to a Tk Window, then *idPtr will - * be set to None. + * The return value is normally TCL_OK; in this case *idPtr will be set + * to the X Window id equivalent to string. If string is improperly + * formed then TCL_ERROR is returned and an error message will be left in + * the interp's result. If the number does not correspond to a Tk Window, + * then *idPtr will be set to None. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -202,28 +201,29 @@ TkpPrintWindowId(buf, window) */ int -TkpScanWindowId(interp, string, idPtr) - Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Interpreter to use for error reporting. */ - CONST char *string; /* String containing a (possibly signed) +TkpScanWindowId( + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Interpreter to use for error reporting. */ + CONST char *string, /* String containing a (possibly signed) * integer in a form acceptable to strtol. */ - Window *idPtr; /* Place to store converted result. */ + Window *idPtr) /* Place to store converted result. */ { Tk_Window tkwin; Window number; /* - * We want sscanf for the 64-bit check, but if that doesn't work, - * then Tcl_GetInt manages the error correctly. + * We want sscanf for the 64-bit check, but if that doesn't work, then + * Tcl_GetInt manages the error correctly. */ + if ( #ifdef _WIN64 (sscanf(string, "0x%p", &number) != 1) && #endif - Tcl_GetInt(interp, string, (int *)&number) != TCL_OK) { + Tcl_GetInt(interp, string, (int *) &number) != TCL_OK) { return TCL_ERROR; } - tkwin = Tk_HWNDToWindow((HWND)number); + tkwin = Tk_HWNDToWindow((HWND) number); if (tkwin) { *idPtr = Tk_WindowId(tkwin); } else { @@ -237,8 +237,8 @@ TkpScanWindowId(interp, string, idPtr) * * TkpMakeWindow -- * - * Creates a Windows window object based on the current attributes - * of the specified TkWindow. + * Creates a Windows window object based on the current attributes of the + * specified TkWindow. * * Results: * Returns a pointer to a new TkWinDrawable cast to a Window. @@ -250,14 +250,14 @@ TkpScanWindowId(interp, string, idPtr) */ Window -TkpMakeWindow(winPtr, parent) - TkWindow *winPtr; - Window parent; +TkpMakeWindow( + TkWindow *winPtr, + Window parent) { HWND parentWin; int style; HWND hwnd; - + if (parent != None) { parentWin = Tk_GetHWND(parent); style = WS_CHILD | WS_CLIPCHILDREN | WS_CLIPSIBLINGS; @@ -267,15 +267,15 @@ TkpMakeWindow(winPtr, parent) } /* - * Create the window, then ensure that it is at the top of the - * stacking order. + * Create the window, then ensure that it is at the top of the stacking + * order. */ hwnd = CreateWindowEx(WS_EX_NOPARENTNOTIFY, TK_WIN_CHILD_CLASS_NAME, NULL, style, Tk_X(winPtr), Tk_Y(winPtr), Tk_Width(winPtr), Tk_Height(winPtr), parentWin, NULL, Tk_GetHINSTANCE(), NULL); SetWindowPos(hwnd, HWND_TOP, 0, 0, 0, 0, - SWP_NOACTIVATE | SWP_NOMOVE | SWP_NOSIZE); + SWP_NOACTIVATE | SWP_NOMOVE | SWP_NOSIZE); return Tk_AttachHWND((Tk_Window)winPtr, hwnd); } @@ -290,29 +290,29 @@ TkpMakeWindow(winPtr, parent) * None. * * Side effects: - * Sends the WM_DESTROY message to the window and then destroys - * it the Win32 resources associated with the window. + * Sends the WM_DESTROY message to the window and then destroys it the + * Win32 resources associated with the window. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -XDestroyWindow(display, w) - Display* display; - Window w; +XDestroyWindow( + Display *display, + Window w) { Tcl_HashEntry *entryPtr; TkWinDrawable *twdPtr = (TkWinDrawable *)w; TkWindow *winPtr = TkWinGetWinPtr(w); HWND hwnd = Tk_GetHWND(w); - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); display->request++; /* - * Remove references to the window in the pointer module then - * release the drawable. + * Remove references to the window in the pointer module then release the + * drawable. */ TkPointerDeadWindow(winPtr); @@ -325,8 +325,8 @@ XDestroyWindow(display, w) ckfree((char *)twdPtr); /* - * Don't bother destroying the window if we are going to destroy - * the parent later. + * Don't bother destroying the window if we are going to destroy the + * parent later. */ if (hwnd != NULL && !(winPtr->flags & TK_DONT_DESTROY_WINDOW)) { @@ -345,16 +345,15 @@ XDestroyWindow(display, w) * None * * Side effects: - * Causes the window state to change, and generates a MapNotify - * event. + * Causes the window state to change, and generates a MapNotify event. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -XMapWindow(display, w) - Display* display; - Window w; +XMapWindow( + Display *display, + Window w) { XEvent event; TkWindow *parentPtr; @@ -366,9 +365,9 @@ XMapWindow(display, w) winPtr->flags |= TK_MAPPED; /* - * Check to see if this window is visible now. If all of the parent - * windows up to the first toplevel are mapped, then this window and - * its mapped children have just become visible. + * Check to see if this window is visible now. If all of the parent + * windows up to the first toplevel are mapped, then this window and its + * mapped children have just become visible. */ if (!(winPtr->flags & TK_TOP_HIERARCHY)) { @@ -391,7 +390,7 @@ XMapWindow(display, w) event.xmap.override_redirect = winPtr->atts.override_redirect; Tk_QueueWindowEvent(&event, TCL_QUEUE_TAIL); } - + /* * Generate VisibilityNotify events for this window and its mapped * children. @@ -412,10 +411,10 @@ XMapWindow(display, w) * NotifyVisibility -- * * This function recursively notifies the mapped children of the - * specified window of a change in visibility. Note that we don't - * properly report the visibility state, since Windows does not - * provide that info. The eventPtr argument must point to an event - * that has been completely initialized except for the window slot. + * specified window of a change in visibility. Note that we don't + * properly report the visibility state, since Windows does not provide + * that info. The eventPtr argument must point to an event that has been + * completely initialized except for the window slot. * * Results: * None. @@ -427,15 +426,15 @@ XMapWindow(display, w) */ static void -NotifyVisibility(eventPtr, winPtr) - XEvent *eventPtr; /* Initialized VisibilityNotify event. */ - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Window to notify. */ +NotifyVisibility( + XEvent *eventPtr, /* Initialized VisibilityNotify event. */ + TkWindow *winPtr) /* Window to notify. */ { if (winPtr->atts.event_mask & VisibilityChangeMask) { eventPtr->xvisibility.window = winPtr->window; Tk_QueueWindowEvent(eventPtr, TCL_QUEUE_TAIL); } - for (winPtr = winPtr->childList; winPtr != NULL; + for (winPtr = winPtr->childList; winPtr != NULL; winPtr = winPtr->nextPtr) { if (winPtr->flags & TK_MAPPED) { NotifyVisibility(eventPtr, winPtr); @@ -454,16 +453,15 @@ NotifyVisibility(eventPtr, winPtr) * None * * Side effects: - * Causes the window state to change, and generates an UnmapNotify - * event. + * Causes the window state to change, and generates an UnmapNotify event. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -XUnmapWindow(display, w) - Display* display; - Window w; +XUnmapWindow( + Display *display, + Window w) { XEvent event; TkWindow *winPtr = TkWinGetWinPtr(w); @@ -471,8 +469,8 @@ XUnmapWindow(display, w) display->request++; /* - * Bug fix: Don't short circuit this routine based on TK_MAPPED because - * it will be cleared before XUnmapWindow is called. + * Bug fix: Don't short circuit this routine based on TK_MAPPED because it + * will be cleared before XUnmapWindow is called. */ ShowWindow(Tk_GetHWND(w), SW_HIDE); @@ -507,13 +505,11 @@ XUnmapWindow(display, w) */ void -XMoveResizeWindow(display, w, x, y, width, height) - Display* display; - Window w; - int x; /* Position relative to parent. */ - int y; - unsigned int width; - unsigned int height; +XMoveResizeWindow( + Display *display, + Window w, + int x, int y, /* Position relative to parent. */ + unsigned int width, unsigned int height) { display->request++; MoveWindow(Tk_GetHWND(w), x, y, width, height, TRUE); @@ -536,11 +532,10 @@ XMoveResizeWindow(display, w, x, y, width, height) */ void -XMoveWindow(display, w, x, y) - Display* display; - Window w; - int x; - int y; +XMoveWindow( + Display *display, + Window w, + int x, int y) { TkWindow *winPtr = TkWinGetWinPtr(w); @@ -567,11 +562,10 @@ XMoveWindow(display, w, x, y) */ void -XResizeWindow(display, w, width, height) - Display* display; - Window w; - unsigned int width; - unsigned int height; +XResizeWindow( + Display *display, + Window w, + unsigned int width, unsigned int height) { TkWindow *winPtr = TkWinGetWinPtr(w); @@ -598,15 +592,14 @@ XResizeWindow(display, w, width, height) */ void -XRaiseWindow(display, w) - Display* display; - Window w; +XRaiseWindow( + Display *display, + Window w) { HWND window = Tk_GetHWND(w); display->request++; - SetWindowPos(window, HWND_TOPMOST, 0, 0, 0, 0, - SWP_NOMOVE | SWP_NOSIZE); + SetWindowPos(window, HWND_TOPMOST, 0, 0, 0, 0, SWP_NOMOVE | SWP_NOSIZE); } /* @@ -621,19 +614,19 @@ XRaiseWindow(display, w) * None. * * Side effects: - * Changes the attributes of the specified window. Note that we - * ignore the passed in values and use the values stored in the - * TkWindow data structure. + * Changes the attributes of the specified window. Note that we ignore + * the passed in values and use the values stored in the TkWindow data + * structure. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -XConfigureWindow(display, w, value_mask, values) - Display* display; - Window w; - unsigned int value_mask; - XWindowChanges* values; +XConfigureWindow( + Display *display, + Window w, + unsigned int value_mask, + XWindowChanges *values) { TkWindow *winPtr = TkWinGetWinPtr(w); HWND hwnd = Tk_GetHWND(w); @@ -681,9 +674,9 @@ XConfigureWindow(display, w, value_mask, values) */ void -XClearWindow(display, w) - Display* display; - Window w; +XClearWindow( + Display *display, + Window w) { RECT rc; HBRUSH brush; @@ -715,9 +708,9 @@ XClearWindow(display, w) * * XChangeWindowAttributes -- * - * This function is called when the attributes on a window are - * updated. Since Tk maintains all of the window state, the only - * relevant value is the cursor. + * This function is called when the attributes on a window are updated. + * Since Tk maintains all of the window state, the only relevant value is + * the cursor. * * Results: * None. @@ -729,11 +722,11 @@ XClearWindow(display, w) */ void -XChangeWindowAttributes(display, w, valueMask, attributes) - Display* display; - Window w; - unsigned long valueMask; - XSetWindowAttributes* attributes; +XChangeWindowAttributes( + Display *display, + Window w, + unsigned long valueMask, + XSetWindowAttributes* attributes) { if (valueMask & CWCursor) { XDefineCursor(display, w, attributes->cursor); @@ -745,8 +738,8 @@ XChangeWindowAttributes(display, w, valueMask, attributes) * * TkWinSetWindowPos -- * - * Adjust the stacking order of a window relative to a second - * window (or NULL). + * Adjust the stacking order of a window relative to a second window (or + * NULL). * * Results: * None. @@ -758,16 +751,16 @@ XChangeWindowAttributes(display, w, valueMask, attributes) */ void -TkWinSetWindowPos(hwnd, siblingHwnd, pos) - HWND hwnd; /* Window to restack. */ - HWND siblingHwnd; /* Sibling window. */ - int pos; /* One of Above or Below. */ +TkWinSetWindowPos( + HWND hwnd, /* Window to restack. */ + HWND siblingHwnd, /* Sibling window. */ + int pos) /* One of Above or Below. */ { HWND temp; /* - * Since Windows does not support Above mode, we place the - * specified window below the sibling and then swap them. + * Since Windows does not support Above mode, we place the specified + * window below the sibling and then swap them. */ if (siblingHwnd) { @@ -792,8 +785,8 @@ TkWinSetWindowPos(hwnd, siblingHwnd, pos) * TkpWindowWasRecentlyDeleted -- * * Determines whether we know if the window given as argument was - * recently deleted. Called by the generic code error handler to - * handle BadWindow events. + * recently deleted. Called by the generic code error handler to handle + * BadWindow events. * * Results: * Always 0. We do not keep this information on Windows. @@ -805,9 +798,17 @@ TkWinSetWindowPos(hwnd, siblingHwnd, pos) */ int -TkpWindowWasRecentlyDeleted(win, dispPtr) - Window win; - TkDisplay *dispPtr; +TkpWindowWasRecentlyDeleted( + Window win, + TkDisplay *dispPtr) { return 0; } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWinWm.c b/win/tkWinWm.c index 3fbad34..2873794 100644 --- a/win/tkWinWm.c +++ b/win/tkWinWm.c @@ -2,17 +2,17 @@ * tkWinWm.c -- * * This module takes care of the interactions between a Tk-based - * application and the window manager. Among other things, it - * implements the "wm" command and passes geometry information - * to the window manager. + * application and the window manager. Among other things, it implements + * the "wm" command and passes geometry information to the window + * manager. * * Copyright (c) 1995-1997 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * Copyright (c) 1998-2000 by Scriptics Corporation. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinWm.c,v 1.103 2005/12/01 07:34:20 hobbs Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinWm.c,v 1.104 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include "tkWinInt.h" @@ -21,6 +21,7 @@ /* * These next two defines are only valid on Win2K/XP+. */ + #ifndef WS_EX_LAYERED #define WS_EX_LAYERED 0x00080000 #endif @@ -29,9 +30,8 @@ #endif /* - * Event structure for synthetic activation events. These events are - * placed on the event queue whenever a toplevel gets a WM_MOUSEACTIVATE - * message. + * Event structure for synthetic activation events. These events are placed on + * the event queue whenever a toplevel gets a WM_MOUSEACTIVATE message. */ typedef struct ActivateEvent { @@ -40,25 +40,23 @@ typedef struct ActivateEvent { } ActivateEvent; /* - * A data structure of the following type holds information for - * each window manager protocol (such as WM_DELETE_WINDOW) for - * which a handler (i.e. a Tcl command) has been defined for a - * particular top-level window. + * A data structure of the following type holds information for each window + * manager protocol (such as WM_DELETE_WINDOW) for which a handler (i.e. a Tcl + * command) has been defined for a particular top-level window. */ typedef struct ProtocolHandler { Atom protocol; /* Identifies the protocol. */ struct ProtocolHandler *nextPtr; - /* Next in list of protocol handlers for - * the same top-level window, or NULL for - * end of list. */ + /* Next in list of protocol handlers for the + * same top-level window, or NULL for end of + * list. */ Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Interpreter in which to invoke command. */ - char command[4]; /* Tcl command to invoke when a client - * message for this protocol arrives. - * The actual size of the structure varies - * to accommodate the needs of the actual - * command. THIS MUST BE THE LAST FIELD OF - * THE STRUCTURE. */ + char command[4]; /* Tcl command to invoke when a client message + * for this protocol arrives. The actual size + * of the structure varies to accommodate the + * needs of the actual command. THIS MUST BE + * THE LAST FIELD OF THE STRUCTURE. */ } ProtocolHandler; #define HANDLER_SIZE(cmdLength) \ @@ -67,81 +65,88 @@ typedef struct ProtocolHandler { /* * Helper type passed via lParam to TkWmStackorderToplevelEnumProc */ + typedef struct TkWmStackorderToplevelPair { Tcl_HashTable *table; TkWindow **window_ptr; } TkWmStackorderToplevelPair; /* - * This structure represents the contents of a icon, in terms of its - * image. The HICON is an internal Windows format. Most of these - * icon-specific-structures originated with the Winico extension. - * We stripped out unused parts of that code, and integrated the - * code more naturally with Tcl. + * This structure represents the contents of a icon, in terms of its image. + * The HICON is an internal Windows format. Most of these + * icon-specific-structures originated with the Winico extension. We stripped + * out unused parts of that code, and integrated the code more naturally with + * Tcl. */ + typedef struct { - UINT Width, Height, Colors; /* Width, Height and bpp */ - LPBYTE lpBits; /* ptr to DIB bits */ - DWORD dwNumBytes; /* how many bytes? */ - LPBITMAPINFO lpbi; /* ptr to header */ - LPBYTE lpXOR; /* ptr to XOR image bits */ - LPBYTE lpAND; /* ptr to AND image bits */ - HICON hIcon; /* DAS ICON */ + UINT Width, Height, Colors; /* Width, Height and bpp */ + LPBYTE lpBits; /* Ptr to DIB bits */ + DWORD dwNumBytes; /* How many bytes? */ + LPBITMAPINFO lpbi; /* Ptr to header */ + LPBYTE lpXOR; /* Ptr to XOR image bits */ + LPBYTE lpAND; /* Ptr to AND image bits */ + HICON hIcon; /* DAS ICON */ } ICONIMAGE, *LPICONIMAGE; + /* - * This structure is how we represent a block of the above - * items. We will reallocate these structures according to - * how many images they need to contain. + * This structure is how we represent a block of the above items. We will + * reallocate these structures according to how many images they need to + * contain. */ + typedef struct { - int nNumImages; /* How many images? */ - ICONIMAGE IconImages[1]; /* Image entries */ + int nNumImages; /* How many images? */ + ICONIMAGE IconImages[1]; /* Image entries */ } BlockOfIconImages, *BlockOfIconImagesPtr; + /* - * These two structures are used to read in icons from an - * 'icon directory' (i.e. the contents of a .icr file, say). - * We only use these structures temporarily, since we copy - * the information we want into a BlockOfIconImages. + * These two structures are used to read in icons from an 'icon directory' + * (i.e. the contents of a .icr file, say). We only use these structures + * temporarily, since we copy the information we want into a + * BlockOfIconImages. */ + typedef struct { - BYTE bWidth; /* Width of the image */ - BYTE bHeight; /* Height of the image (times 2) */ - BYTE bColorCount; /* Number of colors in image (0 if >=8bpp) */ - BYTE bReserved; /* Reserved */ - WORD wPlanes; /* Color Planes */ - WORD wBitCount; /* Bits per pixel */ - DWORD dwBytesInRes; /* how many bytes in this resource? */ - DWORD dwImageOffset; /* where in the file is this image */ + BYTE bWidth; /* Width of the image */ + BYTE bHeight; /* Height of the image (times 2) */ + BYTE bColorCount; /* Number of colors in image (0 if >=8bpp) */ + BYTE bReserved; /* Reserved */ + WORD wPlanes; /* Color Planes */ + WORD wBitCount; /* Bits per pixel */ + DWORD dwBytesInRes; /* How many bytes in this resource? */ + DWORD dwImageOffset; /* Where in the file is this image */ } ICONDIRENTRY, *LPICONDIRENTRY; + typedef struct { - WORD idReserved; /* Reserved */ - WORD idType; /* resource type (1 for icons) */ - WORD idCount; /* how many images? */ - ICONDIRENTRY idEntries[1]; /* the entries for each image */ + WORD idReserved; /* Reserved */ + WORD idType; /* Resource type (1 for icons) */ + WORD idCount; /* How many images? */ + ICONDIRENTRY idEntries[1]; /* The entries for each image */ } ICONDIR, *LPICONDIR; /* - * A pointer to one of these strucutures is associated with each - * toplevel. This allows us to free up all memory associated with icon - * resources when a window is deleted or if the window's icon is - * changed. They are simply reference counted according to: + * A pointer to one of these strucutures is associated with each toplevel. + * This allows us to free up all memory associated with icon resources when a + * window is deleted or if the window's icon is changed. They are simply + * reference counted according to: * - * (i) how many WmInfo structures point to this object - * (ii) whether the ThreadSpecificData defined in this file contains - * a pointer to this object. + * (1) How many WmInfo structures point to this object + * (2) Whether the ThreadSpecificData defined in this file contains a pointer + * to this object. * - * The former count is for windows whose icons are individually - * set, and the latter is for the global default icon choice. + * The former count is for windows whose icons are individually set, and the + * latter is for the global default icon choice. * - * Icons loaded from .icr/.icr use the iconBlock field, icons - * loaded from .exe/.dll use the hIcon field. + * Icons loaded from .icr/.icr use the iconBlock field, icons loaded from + * .exe/.dll use the hIcon field. */ + typedef struct WinIconInstance { - int refCount; /* Number of instances that share this - * data structure. */ + int refCount; /* Number of instances that share this data + * structure. */ BlockOfIconImagesPtr iconBlock; - /* Pointer to icon resource data for - * image. */ + /* Pointer to icon resource data for image */ } WinIconInstance; typedef struct WinIconInstance *WinIconPtr; @@ -152,96 +157,95 @@ typedef struct WinIconInstance *WinIconPtr; */ typedef struct TkWmInfo { - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Pointer to main Tk information for - * this window. */ - HWND wrapper; /* This is the decorative frame window - * created by the window manager to wrap - * a toplevel window. This window is - * a direct child of the root window. */ - char *title; /* Title to display in window caption. If - * NULL, use name of widget. Malloced. */ - char *iconName; /* Name to display in icon. Malloced. */ - XWMHints hints; /* Various pieces of information for - * window manager. */ + TkWindow *winPtr; /* Pointer to main Tk information for this + * window. */ + HWND wrapper; /* This is the decorative frame window created + * by the window manager to wrap a toplevel + * window. This window is a direct child of + * the root window. */ + char *title; /* Title to display in window caption. If + * NULL, use name of widget. Malloced. */ + char *iconName; /* Name to display in icon. Malloced. */ + XWMHints hints; /* Various pieces of information for window + * manager. */ char *leaderName; /* Path name of leader of window group * (corresponds to hints.window_group). - * Malloc-ed. Note: this field doesn't - * get updated if leader is destroyed. */ + * Malloc-ed. Note: this field doesn't get + * updated if leader is destroyed. */ TkWindow *masterPtr; /* Master window for TRANSIENT_FOR property, * or NULL. */ - Tk_Window icon; /* Window to use as icon for this window, - * or NULL. */ + Tk_Window icon; /* Window to use as icon for this window, or + * NULL. */ Tk_Window iconFor; /* Window for which this window is icon, or * NULL if this isn't an icon for anyone. */ /* - * Information used to construct an XSizeHints structure for - * the window manager: + * Information used to construct an XSizeHints structure for the window + * manager: */ int defMinWidth, defMinHeight, defMaxWidth, defMaxHeight; /* Default resize limits given by system. */ - int sizeHintsFlags; /* Flags word for XSizeHints structure. - * If the PBaseSize flag is set then the - * window is gridded; otherwise it isn't - * gridded. */ - int minWidth, minHeight; /* Minimum dimensions of window, in - * pixels or grid units. */ - int maxWidth, maxHeight; /* Maximum dimensions of window, in - * pixels or grid units. 0 to default. */ + int sizeHintsFlags; /* Flags word for XSizeHints structure. If the + * PBaseSize flag is set then the window is + * gridded; otherwise it isn't gridded. */ + int minWidth, minHeight; /* Minimum dimensions of window, in pixels or + * grid units. */ + int maxWidth, maxHeight; /* Maximum dimensions of window, in pixels or + * grid units. 0 to default. */ Tk_Window gridWin; /* Identifies the window that controls - * gridding for this top-level, or NULL if - * the top-level isn't currently gridded. */ - int widthInc, heightInc; /* Increments for size changes (# pixels - * per step). */ + * gridding for this top-level, or NULL if the + * top-level isn't currently gridded. */ + int widthInc, heightInc; /* Increments for size changes (# pixels per + * step). */ struct { int x; /* numerator */ int y; /* denominator */ } minAspect, maxAspect; /* Min/max aspect ratios for window. */ int reqGridWidth, reqGridHeight; - /* The dimensions of the window (in - * grid units) requested through - * the geometry manager. */ + /* The dimensions of the window (in grid + * units) requested through the geometry + * manager. */ int gravity; /* Desired window gravity. */ /* * Information used to manage the size and location of a window. */ - int width, height; /* Desired dimensions of window, specified - * in pixels or grid units. These values are - * set by the "wm geometry" command and by - * ConfigureNotify events (for when wm - * resizes window). -1 means user hasn't - * requested dimensions. */ + int width, height; /* Desired dimensions of window, specified in + * pixels or grid units. These values are set + * by the "wm geometry" command and by + * ConfigureNotify events (for when wm resizes + * window). -1 means user hasn't requested + * dimensions. */ int x, y; /* Desired X and Y coordinates for window. - * These values are set by "wm geometry", - * plus by ConfigureNotify events (when wm - * moves window). These numbers are - * different than the numbers stored in - * winPtr->changes because (a) they could be - * measured from the right or bottom edge - * of the screen (see WM_NEGATIVE_X and - * WM_NEGATIVE_Y flags) and (b) if the window - * has been reparented then they refer to the - * parent rather than the window itself. */ + * These values are set by "wm geometry", plus + * by ConfigureNotify events (when wm moves + * window). These numbers are different than + * the numbers stored in winPtr->changes + * because (a) they could be measured from the + * right or bottom edge of the screen (see + * WM_NEGATIVE_X and WM_NEGATIVE_Y flags) and + * (b) if the window has been reparented then + * they refer to the parent rather than the + * window itself. */ int borderWidth, borderHeight; /* Width and height of window dressing, in - * pixels for the current style/exStyle. This + * pixels for the current style/exStyle. This * includes the border on both sides of the * window. */ int configX, configY; /* x,y position of toplevel when window is * switched into fullscreen state, */ int configWidth, configHeight; /* Dimensions passed to last request that we - * issued to change geometry of window. Used - * to eliminate redundant resize operations. */ + * issued to change geometry of window. Used + * to eliminate redundant resize operations */ HMENU hMenu; /* the hMenu associated with this menu */ DWORD style, exStyle; /* Style flags for the wrapper window. */ LONG styleConfig; /* Extra user requested style bits */ LONG exStyleConfig; /* Extra user requested extended style bits */ - double alpha; /* Alpha transparency level - * 0.0 (fully transparent) .. 1.0 (opaque) */ + double alpha; /* Alpha transparency level 0.0 (fully + * transparent) .. 1.0 (opaque) */ /* * List of children of the toplevel which have private colormaps. @@ -254,62 +258,58 @@ typedef struct TkWmInfo { * Miscellaneous information. */ - ProtocolHandler *protPtr; /* First in list of protocol handlers for - * this window (NULL means none). */ + ProtocolHandler *protPtr; /* First in list of protocol handlers for this + * window (NULL means none). */ int cmdArgc; /* Number of elements in cmdArgv below. */ - CONST char **cmdArgv; /* Array of strings to store in the - * WM_COMMAND property. NULL means nothing - * available. */ + CONST char **cmdArgv; /* Array of strings to store in the WM_COMMAND + * property. NULL means nothing available. */ char *clientMachine; /* String to store in WM_CLIENT_MACHINE * property, or NULL. */ int flags; /* Miscellaneous flags, defined below. */ - int numTransients; /* number of transients on this window */ - WinIconPtr iconPtr; /* pointer to titlebar icon structure for - * this window, or NULL. */ + int numTransients; /* Number of transients on this window */ + WinIconPtr iconPtr; /* Pointer to titlebar icon structure for this + * window, or NULL. */ struct TkWmInfo *nextPtr; /* Next in list of all top-level windows. */ } WmInfo; /* * Flag values for WmInfo structures: * - * WM_NEVER_MAPPED - non-zero means window has never been - * mapped; need to update all info when - * window is first mapped. - * WM_UPDATE_PENDING - non-zero means a call to UpdateGeometryInfo - * has already been scheduled for this - * window; no need to schedule another one. - * WM_NEGATIVE_X - non-zero means x-coordinate is measured in - * pixels from right edge of screen, rather - * than from left edge. - * WM_NEGATIVE_Y - non-zero means y-coordinate is measured in + * WM_NEVER_MAPPED - Non-zero means window has never been mapped; + * need to update all info when window is first + * mapped. + * WM_UPDATE_PENDING - Non-zero means a call to UpdateGeometryInfo + * has already been scheduled for this window; + * no need to schedule another one. + * WM_NEGATIVE_X - Non-zero means x-coordinate is measured in + * pixels from right edge of screen, rather than + * from left edge. + * WM_NEGATIVE_Y - Non-zero means y-coordinate is measured in * pixels up from bottom of screen, rather than * down from top. - * WM_UPDATE_SIZE_HINTS - non-zero means that new size hints need to be + * WM_UPDATE_SIZE_HINTS - Non-zero means that new size hints need to be * propagated to window manager. Not used on Win. - * WM_SYNC_PENDING - set to non-zero while waiting for the window + * WM_SYNC_PENDING - Set to non-zero while waiting for the window * manager to respond to some state change. - * WM_MOVE_PENDING - non-zero means the application has requested - * a new position for the window, but it hasn't - * been reflected through the window manager - * yet. - * WM_COLORMAPS_EXPLICIT - non-zero means the colormap windows were - * set explicitly via "wm colormapwindows". - * WM_ADDED_TOPLEVEL_COLORMAP - non-zero means that when "wm colormapwindows" + * WM_MOVE_PENDING - Non-zero means the application has requested a + * new position for the window, but it hasn't + * been reflected through the window manager yet. + * WM_COLORMAPS_EXPLICIT - Non-zero means the colormap windows were set + * explicitly via "wm colormapwindows". + * WM_ADDED_TOPLEVEL_COLORMAP - Non-zero means that when "wm colormapwindows" * was called the top-level itself wasn't - * specified, so we added it implicitly at - * the end of the list. - * WM_WIDTH_NOT_RESIZABLE - non-zero means that we're not supposed to + * specified, so we added it implicitly at the + * end of the list. + * WM_WIDTH_NOT_RESIZABLE - Non-zero means that we're not supposed to * allow the user to change the width of the - * window (controlled by "wm resizable" - * command). - * WM_HEIGHT_NOT_RESIZABLE - non-zero means that we're not supposed to + * window (controlled by "wm resizable" command). + * WM_HEIGHT_NOT_RESIZABLE - Non-zero means that we're not supposed to * allow the user to change the height of the - * window (controlled by "wm resizable" - * command). - * WM_WITHDRAWN - non-zero means that this window has explicitly + * window (controlled by "wm resizable" command). + * WM_WITHDRAWN - Non-zero means that this window has explicitly * been withdrawn. If it's a transient, it should * not mirror state changes in the master. - * WM_FULLSCREEN - non-zero means that this window has been placed + * WM_FULLSCREEN - Non-zero means that this window has been placed * in the full screen mode. It should be mapped at * 0,0 and be the width and height of the screen. */ @@ -347,240 +347,229 @@ typedef struct TkWmInfo { #define EX_TRANSIENT_STYLE (WS_EX_DLGMODALFRAME) /* - * The following structure is the official type record for geometry - * management of top-level windows. + * The following structure is the official type record for geometry management + * of top-level windows. */ static void TopLevelReqProc(ClientData dummy, Tk_Window tkwin); static Tk_GeomMgr wmMgrType = { - "wm", /* name */ - TopLevelReqProc, /* requestProc */ - (Tk_GeomLostSlaveProc *) NULL, /* lostSlaveProc */ + "wm", /* name */ + TopLevelReqProc, /* requestProc */ + NULL, /* lostSlaveProc */ }; typedef struct ThreadSpecificData { - HPALETTE systemPalette; /* System palette; refers to the - * currently installed foreground logical - * palette. */ - TkWindow *createWindow; /* Window that is being constructed. This - * value is set immediately before a - * call to CreateWindowEx, and is used - * by SetLimits. This is a gross hack - * needed to work around Windows brain - * damage where it sends the - * WM_GETMINMAXINFO message before the - * WM_CREATE window. */ - int initialized; /* Flag indicating whether thread- - * specific elements of module have - * been initialized. */ - int firstWindow; /* Flag, cleared when the first window - * is mapped in a non-iconic state. */ - WinIconPtr iconPtr; /* IconPtr being used as default for all - * toplevels, or NULL. */ + HPALETTE systemPalette; /* System palette; refers to the currently + * installed foreground logical palette. */ + TkWindow *createWindow; /* Window that is being constructed. This + * value is set immediately before a call to + * CreateWindowEx, and is used by SetLimits. + * This is a gross hack needed to work around + * Windows brain damage where it sends the + * WM_GETMINMAXINFO message before the + * WM_CREATE window. */ + int initialized; /* Flag indicating whether thread-specific + * elements of module have been + * initialized. */ + int firstWindow; /* Flag, cleared when the first window is + * mapped in a non-iconic state. */ + WinIconPtr iconPtr; /* IconPtr being used as default for all + * toplevels, or NULL. */ } ThreadSpecificData; static Tcl_ThreadDataKey dataKey; /* - * The following variables cannot be placed in thread local storage - * because they must be shared across threads. + * The following variables cannot be placed in thread local storage because + * they must be shared across threads. */ -static int initialized; /* Flag indicating whether module has - * been initialized. */ +static int initialized; /* Flag indicating whether module has been + * initialized. */ -/* - * A pointer to a shell proc which allows us to extract icons from - * any file. We just initialize this when we start up (if we can) - * and then it never changes +/* + * A pointer to a shell proc which allows us to extract icons from any file. + * We just initialize this when we start up (if we can) and then it never + * changes */ + DWORD* (WINAPI *shgetfileinfoProc) (LPCTSTR pszPath, DWORD dwFileAttributes, - SHFILEINFO* psfi, UINT cbFileInfo, UINT uFlags) = NULL; + SHFILEINFO* psfi, UINT cbFileInfo, UINT uFlags) = NULL; /* - * A pointer to SetLayeredWindowAttributes (user32.dll) which we - * retrieve dynamically because it is only valid on Win2K+. + * A pointer to SetLayeredWindowAttributes (user32.dll) which we retrieve + * dynamically because it is only valid on Win2K+. */ + BOOL (WINAPI *setLayeredWindowAttributesProc) (HWND hwnd, COLORREF crKey, BYTE bAlpha, DWORD dwFlags) = NULL; TCL_DECLARE_MUTEX(winWmMutex) /* - * Forward declarations for procedures defined in this file: + * Forward declarations for functions defined in this file: */ -static int ActivateWindow _ANSI_ARGS_((Tcl_Event *evPtr, - int flags)); -static void ConfigureTopLevel _ANSI_ARGS_((WINDOWPOS *pos)); -static void GenerateConfigureNotify _ANSI_ARGS_(( - TkWindow *winPtr)); -static void GetMaxSize _ANSI_ARGS_((WmInfo *wmPtr, - int *maxWidthPtr, int *maxHeightPtr)); -static void GetMinSize _ANSI_ARGS_((WmInfo *wmPtr, - int *minWidthPtr, int *minHeightPtr)); -static TkWindow * GetTopLevel _ANSI_ARGS_((HWND hwnd)); -static void InitWm _ANSI_ARGS_((void)); -static int InstallColormaps _ANSI_ARGS_((HWND hwnd, int message, - int isForemost)); -static void InvalidateSubTree _ANSI_ARGS_((TkWindow *winPtr, - Colormap colormap)); -static void InvalidateSubTreeDepth _ANSI_ARGS_((TkWindow *winPtr)); -static int ParseGeometry _ANSI_ARGS_((Tcl_Interp *interp, - char *string, TkWindow *winPtr)); -static void RefreshColormap _ANSI_ARGS_((Colormap colormap, - TkDisplay *dispPtr)); -static void SetLimits _ANSI_ARGS_((HWND hwnd, MINMAXINFO *info)); -static void TkWmStackorderToplevelWrapperMap _ANSI_ARGS_(( - TkWindow *winPtr, - Display *display, - Tcl_HashTable *table)); -static LRESULT CALLBACK TopLevelProc _ANSI_ARGS_((HWND hwnd, UINT message, - WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam)); -static void TopLevelEventProc _ANSI_ARGS_((ClientData clientData, - XEvent *eventPtr)); -static void TopLevelReqProc _ANSI_ARGS_((ClientData dummy, - Tk_Window tkwin)); -static void UpdateGeometryInfo _ANSI_ARGS_(( - ClientData clientData)); -static void UpdateWrapper _ANSI_ARGS_((TkWindow *winPtr)); -static LRESULT CALLBACK WmProc _ANSI_ARGS_((HWND hwnd, UINT message, - WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam)); -static void WmWaitVisibilityOrMapProc _ANSI_ARGS_(( - ClientData clientData, XEvent *eventPtr)); -static BlockOfIconImagesPtr ReadIconOrCursorFromFile _ANSI_ARGS_(( - Tcl_Interp *interp, Tcl_Obj* fileName, BOOL isIcon)); -static WinIconPtr ReadIconFromFile _ANSI_ARGS_(( - Tcl_Interp *interp, Tcl_Obj *fileName)); -static WinIconPtr GetIconFromPixmap _ANSI_ARGS_((Display *dsPtr, - Pixmap pixmap)); -static int ReadICOHeader _ANSI_ARGS_((Tcl_Channel channel)); -static BOOL AdjustIconImagePointers _ANSI_ARGS_((LPICONIMAGE lpImage)); -static HICON MakeIconOrCursorFromResource - _ANSI_ARGS_((LPICONIMAGE lpIcon, BOOL isIcon)); -static HICON GetIcon _ANSI_ARGS_((WinIconPtr titlebaricon, - int icon_size)); -static int WinSetIcon _ANSI_ARGS_((Tcl_Interp *interp, - WinIconPtr titlebaricon, Tk_Window tkw)); -static void FreeIconBlock _ANSI_ARGS_((BlockOfIconImagesPtr lpIR)); -static void DecrIconRefCount _ANSI_ARGS_((WinIconPtr titlebaricon)); - -static int WmAspectCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, +static int ActivateWindow(Tcl_Event *evPtr, int flags); +static void ConfigureTopLevel(WINDOWPOS *pos); +static void GenerateConfigureNotify(TkWindow *winPtr); +static void GetMaxSize(WmInfo *wmPtr, + int *maxWidthPtr, int *maxHeightPtr); +static void GetMinSize(WmInfo *wmPtr, + int *minWidthPtr, int *minHeightPtr); +static TkWindow * GetTopLevel(HWND hwnd); +static void InitWm(void); +static int InstallColormaps(HWND hwnd, int message, + int isForemost); +static void InvalidateSubTree(TkWindow *winPtr, Colormap colormap); +static void InvalidateSubTreeDepth(TkWindow *winPtr); +static int ParseGeometry(Tcl_Interp *interp, char *string, + TkWindow *winPtr); +static void RefreshColormap(Colormap colormap, TkDisplay *dispPtr); +static void SetLimits(HWND hwnd, MINMAXINFO *info); +static void TkWmStackorderToplevelWrapperMap(TkWindow *winPtr, + Display *display, Tcl_HashTable *table); +static LRESULT CALLBACK TopLevelProc(HWND hwnd, UINT message, + WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam); +static void TopLevelEventProc(ClientData clientData, + XEvent *eventPtr); +static void TopLevelReqProc(ClientData dummy, Tk_Window tkwin); +static void UpdateGeometryInfo(ClientData clientData); +static void UpdateWrapper(TkWindow *winPtr); +static LRESULT CALLBACK WmProc(HWND hwnd, UINT message, + WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam); +static void WmWaitVisibilityOrMapProc(ClientData clientData, + XEvent *eventPtr); +static BlockOfIconImagesPtr ReadIconOrCursorFromFile(Tcl_Interp *interp, + Tcl_Obj* fileName, BOOL isIcon); +static WinIconPtr ReadIconFromFile(Tcl_Interp *interp, + Tcl_Obj *fileName); +static WinIconPtr GetIconFromPixmap(Display *dsPtr, Pixmap pixmap); +static int ReadICOHeader(Tcl_Channel channel); +static BOOL AdjustIconImagePointers(LPICONIMAGE lpImage); +static HICON MakeIconOrCursorFromResource(LPICONIMAGE lpIcon, + BOOL isIcon); +static HICON GetIcon(WinIconPtr titlebaricon, int icon_size); +static int WinSetIcon(Tcl_Interp *interp, + WinIconPtr titlebaricon, Tk_Window tkw); +static void FreeIconBlock(BlockOfIconImagesPtr lpIR); +static void DecrIconRefCount(WinIconPtr titlebaricon); + +static int WmAspectCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmAttributesCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmAttributesCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmClientCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmClientCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmColormapwindowsCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmColormapwindowsCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmCommandCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmCommandCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmDeiconifyCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmDeiconifyCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmFocusmodelCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmFocusmodelCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmFrameCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmFrameCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmGeometryCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmGeometryCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmGridCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmGridCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmGroupCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmGroupCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmIconbitmapCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmIconbitmapCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmIconifyCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmIconifyCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmIconmaskCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmIconmaskCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmIconnameCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmIconnameCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmIconphotoCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmIconphotoCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmIconpositionCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmIconpositionCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmIconwindowCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmIconwindowCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmMaxsizeCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmMaxsizeCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmMinsizeCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmMinsizeCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmOverrideredirectCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmOverrideredirectCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmPositionfromCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmPositionfromCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmProtocolCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmProtocolCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmResizableCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmResizableCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmSizefromCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmSizefromCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmStackorderCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmStackorderCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmStateCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmStateCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmTitleCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmTitleCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmTransientCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmTransientCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static int WmWithdrawCmd _ANSI_ARGS_((Tk_Window tkwin, + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static int WmWithdrawCmd(Tk_Window tkwin, TkWindow *winPtr, Tcl_Interp *interp, int objc, - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[])); -static void WmUpdateGeom _ANSI_ARGS_((WmInfo *wmPtr, - TkWindow *winPtr)); + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]); +static void WmUpdateGeom(WmInfo *wmPtr, TkWindow *winPtr); -/* Used in BytesPerLine */ -#define WIDTHBYTES(bits) ((((bits) + 31)>>5)<<2) +/* + * Used in BytesPerLine + */ +#define WIDTHBYTES(bits) ((((bits) + 31)>>5)<<2) + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * DIBNumColors -- * - * Calculates the number of entries in the color table, given by - * LPSTR lpbi - pointer to the CF_DIB memory block. Used by - * titlebar icon code. + * Calculates the number of entries in the color table, given by LPSTR + * lpbi - pointer to the CF_DIB memory block. Used by titlebar icon code. * * Results: - * * WORD - Number of entries in the color table. * - * Side effects: None. - * - * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -static WORD -DIBNumColors( LPSTR lpbi ) + +static WORD +DIBNumColors( + LPSTR lpbi) { WORD wBitCount; DWORD dwClrUsed; @@ -592,12 +581,15 @@ DIBNumColors( LPSTR lpbi ) wBitCount = ((LPBITMAPINFOHEADER) lpbi)->biBitCount; - switch (wBitCount) - { - case 1: return 2; - case 4: return 16; - case 8: return 256; - default:return 0; + switch (wBitCount) { + case 1: + return 2; + case 4: + return 16; + case 8: + return 256; + default: + return 0; } } @@ -606,22 +598,19 @@ DIBNumColors( LPSTR lpbi ) * * PaletteSize -- * - * Calculates the number of bytes in the color table, as given by - * LPSTR lpbi - pointer to the CF_DIB memory block. Used by - * titlebar icon code. + * Calculates the number of bytes in the color table, as given by LPSTR + * lpbi - pointer to the CF_DIB memory block. Used by titlebar icon code. * * Results: - * number of bytes in the color table - * - * Side effects: None. - * + * Number of bytes in the color table * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -static WORD -PaletteSize( LPSTR lpbi ) +static WORD +PaletteSize( + LPSTR lpbi) { - return ((WORD)( DIBNumColors( lpbi ) * sizeof( RGBQUAD )) ); + return (WORD) (DIBNumColors(lpbi) * sizeof(RGBQUAD)); } /* @@ -629,9 +618,8 @@ PaletteSize( LPSTR lpbi ) * * FindDIBits -- * - * Locate the image bits in a CF_DIB format DIB, as given by - * LPSTR lpbi - pointer to the CF_DIB memory block. Used by - * titlebar icon code. + * Locate the image bits in a CF_DIB format DIB, as given by LPSTR lpbi - + * pointer to the CF_DIB memory block. Used by titlebar icon code. * * Results: * pointer to the image bits @@ -641,10 +629,12 @@ PaletteSize( LPSTR lpbi ) * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -static LPSTR -FindDIBBits( LPSTR lpbi ) + +static LPSTR +FindDIBBits( + LPSTR lpbi) { - return ( lpbi + *(LPDWORD)lpbi + PaletteSize( lpbi ) ); + return lpbi + *(LPDWORD)lpbi + PaletteSize(lpbi); } /* @@ -653,19 +643,18 @@ FindDIBBits( LPSTR lpbi ) * BytesPerLine -- * * Calculates the number of bytes in one scan line, as given by - * LPBITMAPINFOHEADER lpBMIH - pointer to the BITMAPINFOHEADER - * that begins the CF_DIB block. Used by titlebar icon code. + * LPBITMAPINFOHEADER lpBMIH - pointer to the BITMAPINFOHEADER that + * begins the CF_DIB block. Used by titlebar icon code. * * Results: * number of bytes in one scan line (DWORD aligned) * - * Side effects: None - * - * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -static DWORD -BytesPerLine( LPBITMAPINFOHEADER lpBMIH ) + +static DWORD +BytesPerLine( + LPBITMAPINFOHEADER lpBMIH) { return WIDTHBYTES(lpBMIH->biWidth * lpBMIH->biPlanes * lpBMIH->biBitCount); } @@ -675,39 +664,64 @@ BytesPerLine( LPBITMAPINFOHEADER lpBMIH ) * * AdjustIconImagePointers -- * - * Adjusts internal pointers in icon resource struct, as given - * by LPICONIMAGE lpImage - the resource to handle. Used by - * titlebar icon code. + * Adjusts internal pointers in icon resource struct, as given by + * LPICONIMAGE lpImage - the resource to handle. Used by titlebar icon + * code. * * Results: * BOOL - TRUE for success, FALSE for failure * - * Side effects: - * - * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -static BOOL -AdjustIconImagePointers( LPICONIMAGE lpImage ) + +static BOOL +AdjustIconImagePointers( + LPICONIMAGE lpImage) { - /* Sanity check */ - if (lpImage==NULL) + /* + * Sanity check. + */ + + if (lpImage == NULL) { return FALSE; - /* BITMAPINFO is at beginning of bits */ + } + + /* + * BITMAPINFO is at beginning of bits. + */ + lpImage->lpbi = (LPBITMAPINFO)lpImage->lpBits; - /* Width - simple enough */ + + /* + * Width - simple enough. + */ + lpImage->Width = lpImage->lpbi->bmiHeader.biWidth; - /* - * Icons are stored in funky format where height is doubled - * so account for that + + /* + * Icons are stored in funky format where height is doubled so account for + * that. */ + lpImage->Height = (lpImage->lpbi->bmiHeader.biHeight)/2; - /* How many colors? */ - lpImage->Colors = lpImage->lpbi->bmiHeader.biPlanes * - lpImage->lpbi->bmiHeader.biBitCount; - /* XOR bits follow the header and color table */ + + /* + * How many colors? + */ + + lpImage->Colors = lpImage->lpbi->bmiHeader.biPlanes + * lpImage->lpbi->bmiHeader.biBitCount; + + /* + * XOR bits follow the header and color table. + */ + lpImage->lpXOR = (LPBYTE)FindDIBBits(((LPSTR)lpImage->lpbi)); - /* AND bits follow the XOR bits */ + + /* + * AND bits follow the XOR bits. + */ + lpImage->lpAND = lpImage->lpXOR + (lpImage->Height* BytesPerLine((LPBITMAPINFOHEADER)(lpImage->lpbi))); return TRUE; @@ -718,50 +732,70 @@ AdjustIconImagePointers( LPICONIMAGE lpImage ) * * MakeIconOrCursorFromResource -- * - * Construct an actual HICON structure from the information - * in a resource. + * Construct an actual HICON structure from the information in a + * resource. * * Results: - * - * - * Side effects: - * + * Icon * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -static HICON -MakeIconOrCursorFromResource(LPICONIMAGE lpIcon, BOOL isIcon) { + +static HICON +MakeIconOrCursorFromResource( + LPICONIMAGE lpIcon, + BOOL isIcon) +{ HICON hIcon ; static FARPROC pfnCreateIconFromResourceEx=NULL; static int initinfo=0; - /* Sanity Check */ - if (lpIcon == NULL) + + /* + * Sanity Check + */ + + if (lpIcon == NULL) { return NULL; - if (lpIcon->lpBits == NULL) + } + if (lpIcon->lpBits == NULL) { return NULL; + } + if (!initinfo) { HMODULE hMod = GetModuleHandleA("USER32.DLL"); - initinfo=1; + + initinfo = 1; if (hMod){ - pfnCreateIconFromResourceEx = - GetProcAddress(hMod, "CreateIconFromResourceEx"); + pfnCreateIconFromResourceEx = GetProcAddress(hMod, + "CreateIconFromResourceEx"); } } - /* Let the OS do the real work :) */ - if (pfnCreateIconFromResourceEx!=NULL) { - hIcon = (HICON) (pfnCreateIconFromResourceEx) - (lpIcon->lpBits, lpIcon->dwNumBytes, isIcon, 0x00030000, - (*(LPBITMAPINFOHEADER)(lpIcon->lpBits)).biWidth, - (*(LPBITMAPINFOHEADER)(lpIcon->lpBits)).biHeight/2, 0); + + /* + * Let the OS do the real work :) + */ + + if (pfnCreateIconFromResourceEx != NULL) { + hIcon = (HICON) (pfnCreateIconFromResourceEx) (lpIcon->lpBits, + lpIcon->dwNumBytes, isIcon, 0x00030000, + (*(LPBITMAPINFOHEADER)(lpIcon->lpBits)).biWidth, + (*(LPBITMAPINFOHEADER)(lpIcon->lpBits)).biHeight/2, 0); } else { hIcon = NULL; } - /* It failed, odds are good we're on NT so try the non-Ex way */ + + /* + * It failed, odds are good we're on NT so try the non-Ex way. + */ + if (hIcon == NULL) { - /* We would break on NT if we try with a 16bpp image */ + /* + * We would break on NT if we try with a 16bpp image. + */ + if (lpIcon->lpbi->bmiHeader.biBitCount != 16) { - hIcon = CreateIconFromResource(lpIcon->lpBits, lpIcon->dwNumBytes, - isIcon, 0x00030000); + hIcon = CreateIconFromResource(lpIcon->lpBits, lpIcon->dwNumBytes, + isIcon, 0x00030000); } } return hIcon; @@ -775,43 +809,56 @@ MakeIconOrCursorFromResource(LPICONIMAGE lpIcon, BOOL isIcon) { * Reads the header from an ICO file, as specfied by channel. * * Results: - * UINT - Number of images in file, -1 for failure. - * If this succeeds, there is a decent chance this is a - * valid icon file. - * - * Side effects: - * + * UINT - Number of images in file, -1 for failure. If this succeeds, + * there is a decent chance this is a valid icon file. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -static int -ReadICOHeader( Tcl_Channel channel ) + +static int +ReadICOHeader( + Tcl_Channel channel) { - WORD Input; - DWORD dwBytesRead; + WORD Input; + DWORD dwBytesRead; - /* Read the 'reserved' WORD */ - dwBytesRead = Tcl_Read( channel, (char*)&Input, sizeof( WORD )); - /* Did we get a WORD? */ - if (dwBytesRead != sizeof( WORD )) + /* + * Read the 'reserved' WORD, which should be a zero word. + */ + + dwBytesRead = Tcl_Read(channel, (char*) &Input, sizeof(WORD)); + if (dwBytesRead != sizeof(WORD)) { return -1; - /* Was it 'reserved' ? (ie 0) */ - if (Input != 0) + } + if (Input != 0) { return -1; - /* Read the type WORD */ - dwBytesRead = Tcl_Read( channel, (char*)&Input, sizeof( WORD )); - /* Did we get a WORD? */ - if (dwBytesRead != sizeof( WORD )) + } + + /* + * Read the type WORD, which should be of type 1. + */ + + dwBytesRead = Tcl_Read(channel, (char*)&Input, sizeof(WORD)); + if (dwBytesRead != sizeof(WORD)) { return -1; - /* Was it type 1? */ - if (Input != 1) + } + if (Input != 1) { return -1; - /* Get the count of images */ + } + + /* + * Get the count of images + */ + dwBytesRead = Tcl_Read( channel, (char*)&Input, sizeof( WORD )); - /* Did we get a WORD? */ - if (dwBytesRead != sizeof( WORD )) + if (dwBytesRead != sizeof(WORD)) { return -1; - /* Return the count */ + } + + /* + * Return the count + */ + return (int)Input; } @@ -830,10 +877,12 @@ ReadICOHeader( Tcl_Channel channel ) * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -static int -InitWindowClass(WinIconPtr titlebaricon) + +static int +InitWindowClass( + WinIconPtr titlebaricon) { - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); if (! tsdPtr->initialized) { @@ -851,37 +900,37 @@ InitWindowClass(WinIconPtr titlebaricon) if (shgetfileinfoProc == NULL) { HINSTANCE hInstance = LoadLibraryA("shell32"); if (hInstance != NULL) { - shgetfileinfoProc = - (DWORD* (WINAPI *) (LPCTSTR pszPath, DWORD dwFileAttributes, - SHFILEINFO* psfi, UINT cbFileInfo, UINT uFlags)) GetProcAddress(hInstance, - "SHGetFileInfo"); + shgetfileinfoProc = (DWORD* (WINAPI *) (LPCTSTR pszPath, + DWORD dwFileAttributes, SHFILEINFO* psfi, + UINT cbFileInfo, UINT uFlags)) + GetProcAddress(hInstance, "SHGetFileInfo"); FreeLibrary(hInstance); } } if (setLayeredWindowAttributesProc == NULL) { HINSTANCE hInstance = LoadLibraryA("user32"); if (hInstance != NULL) { - setLayeredWindowAttributesProc = - (BOOL (WINAPI *) (HWND hwnd, COLORREF crKey, - BYTE bAlpha, DWORD dwFlags)) - GetProcAddress(hInstance, - "SetLayeredWindowAttributes"); + setLayeredWindowAttributesProc = (BOOL (WINAPI*)(HWND hwnd, + COLORREF crKey, BYTE bAlpha, DWORD dwFlags)) + GetProcAddress(hInstance,"SetLayeredWindowAttributes"); FreeLibrary(hInstance); } } + /* - * The only difference between WNDCLASSW and WNDCLASSA are - * in pointers, so we can use the generic structure WNDCLASS. + * The only difference between WNDCLASSW and WNDCLASSA are in + * pointers, so we can use the generic structure WNDCLASS. */ + ZeroMemory(&class, sizeof(WNDCLASS)); /* - * When threads are enabled, we cannot use CLASSDC because - * threads will then write into the same device context. + * When threads are enabled, we cannot use CLASSDC because threads + * will then write into the same device context. * - * This is a hack; we should add a subsystem that manages - * device context on a per-thread basis. See also tkWinX.c, - * which also initializes a WNDCLASS structure. + * This is a hack; we should add a subsystem that manages device + * context on a per-thread basis. See also tkWinX.c, which also + * initializes a WNDCLASS structure. */ #ifdef TCL_THREADS @@ -900,10 +949,12 @@ InitWindowClass(WinIconPtr titlebaricon) if (class.hIcon == NULL) { return TCL_ERROR; } + /* - * Store pointer to default icon so we know when - * we need to free that information + * Store pointer to default icon so we know when we need to + * free that information */ + tsdPtr->iconPtr = titlebaricon; } class.hCursor = LoadCursor(NULL, IDC_ARROW); @@ -914,9 +965,10 @@ InitWindowClass(WinIconPtr titlebaricon) #ifndef TCL_THREADS /* - * Use of WS_EX_LAYERED disallows CS_CLASSDC, as does - * TCL_THREADS usage, so only create this if necessary. + * Use of WS_EX_LAYERED disallows CS_CLASSDC, as does TCL_THREADS + * usage, so only create this if necessary. */ + if (setLayeredWindowAttributesProc != NULL) { class.style = CS_HREDRAW | CS_VREDRAW; Tcl_DStringFree(&classString); @@ -962,33 +1014,31 @@ InitWm(void) * * WinSetIcon -- * - * Sets either the default toplevel titlebar icon, or the icon - * for a specific toplevel (if tkw is given, then only that - * window is used). + * Sets either the default toplevel titlebar icon, or the icon for a + * specific toplevel (if tkw is given, then only that window is used). * - * The ref-count of the titlebaricon is NOT changed. If this - * function returns successfully, the caller should assume - * the icon was used (and therefore the ref-count should - * be adjusted to reflect that fact). If the function returned - * an error, the caller should assume the icon was not used - * (and may wish to free the memory associated with it). + * The ref-count of the titlebaricon is NOT changed. If this function + * returns successfully, the caller should assume the icon was used (and + * therefore the ref-count should be adjusted to reflect that fact). If + * the function returned an error, the caller should assume the icon was + * not used (and may wish to free the memory associated with it). * * Results: * A standard Tcl return code. * * Side effects: - * One or all windows may have their icon changed. - * The Tcl result may be modified. - * The window-manager will be initialised if it wasn't already. + * One or all windows may have their icon changed. The Tcl result may be + * modified. The window-manager will be initialised if it wasn't already. * The given window will be forced into existence. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ + static int -WinSetIcon(interp, titlebaricon, tkw) - Tcl_Interp *interp; - WinIconPtr titlebaricon; - Tk_Window tkw; +WinSetIcon( + Tcl_Interp *interp, + WinIconPtr titlebaricon, + Tk_Window tkw) { WmInfo *wmPtr; HWND hwnd; @@ -1001,7 +1051,7 @@ WinSetIcon(interp, titlebaricon, tkw) if (!(Tk_IsTopLevel(tkw))) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "window \"", Tk_PathName(tkw), - "\" isn't a top-level window", (char *) NULL); + "\" isn't a top-level window", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } if (Tk_WindowId(tkw) == None) { @@ -1015,54 +1065,59 @@ WinSetIcon(interp, titlebaricon, tkw) if (hwnd == NULL) { /* * I don't actually think this is ever the correct thing, unless - * perhaps the window doesn't have a wrapper. But I believe all + * perhaps the window doesn't have a wrapper. But I believe all * windows have wrappers. */ + hwnd = Tk_GetHWND(Tk_WindowId(tkw)); } + /* * If we aren't initialised, then just initialise with the user's - * icon. Otherwise our icon choice will be ignored moments later - * when Tk finishes initialising. + * icon. Otherwise our icon choice will be ignored moments later when + * Tk finishes initialising. */ + if (!initialized) { if (InitWindowClass(titlebaricon) != TCL_OK) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp,"Unable to set icon", (char*)NULL); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "Unable to set icon", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } } else { ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr; + if ( #ifdef _WIN64 - !SetClassLongPtr(hwnd, GCLP_HICONSM, - (LPARAM)GetIcon(titlebaricon, ICON_SMALL)) + !SetClassLongPtr(hwnd, GCLP_HICONSM, + (LPARAM)GetIcon(titlebaricon, ICON_SMALL)) #else - !SetClassLong(hwnd, GCL_HICONSM, - (LPARAM)GetIcon(titlebaricon, ICON_SMALL)) + !SetClassLong(hwnd, GCL_HICONSM, + (LPARAM)GetIcon(titlebaricon, ICON_SMALL)) #endif - ) { + ) { /* - * For some reason this triggers, even though it seems - * to be successful This is probably related to the - * WNDCLASS vs WNDCLASSEX difference. Anyway it seems - * we have to ignore errors returned here. + * For some reason this triggers, even though it seems to be + * successful. This is probably related to the WNDCLASS vs + * WNDCLASSEX difference. Anyway it seems we have to ignore + * errors returned here. */ /* - * Tcl_AppendResult(interp,"Unable to set new small icon", (char*)NULL); - * return TCL_ERROR; - */ + Tcl_AppendResult(interp,"Unable to set new small icon",NULL); + return TCL_ERROR; + */ } + if ( #ifdef _WIN64 - !SetClassLongPtr(hwnd, GCLP_HICON, - (LPARAM)GetIcon(titlebaricon, ICON_BIG)) + !SetClassLongPtr(hwnd, GCLP_HICON, + (LPARAM)GetIcon(titlebaricon, ICON_BIG)) #else - !SetClassLong(hwnd, GCL_HICON, - (LPARAM)GetIcon(titlebaricon, ICON_BIG)) + !SetClassLong(hwnd, GCL_HICON, + (LPARAM)GetIcon(titlebaricon, ICON_BIG)) #endif - ) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp,"Unable to set new icon", (char*)NULL); + ) { + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "Unable to set new icon", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) @@ -1075,31 +1130,34 @@ WinSetIcon(interp, titlebaricon, tkw) } else { if (!initialized) { /* - * Need to initialise the wm otherwise we will fail on - * code which tries to set a toplevel's icon before that - * happens. Ignore return result. + * Need to initialise the wm otherwise we will fail on code which + * tries to set a toplevel's icon before that happens. Ignore + * return result. */ - (void)InitWindowClass(NULL); + + (void) InitWindowClass(NULL); } /* * The following code is exercised if you do * * toplevel .t ; wm titlebaricon .t foo.icr * - * i.e. the wm hasn't had time to properly create - * the '.t' window before you set the icon. + * i.e. the wm hasn't had time to properly create the '.t' window + * before you set the icon. */ + if (hwnd == NULL) { /* - * This little snippet is copied from the 'Map' function, - * and should probably be placed in one proper location + * This little snippet is copied from the 'Map' function, and + * should probably be placed in one proper location. */ + UpdateWrapper(wmPtr->winPtr); wmPtr = ((TkWindow*)tkw)->wmInfoPtr; hwnd = wmPtr->wrapper; if (hwnd == NULL) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, - "Can't set icon; window has no wrapper.", (char*)NULL); + "Can't set icon; window has no wrapper.", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } } @@ -1108,16 +1166,23 @@ WinSetIcon(interp, titlebaricon, tkw) SendMessage(hwnd, WM_SETICON, ICON_BIG, (LPARAM) GetIcon(titlebaricon, ICON_BIG)); - /* Update the iconPtr we keep for each WmInfo structure. */ + /* + * Update the iconPtr we keep for each WmInfo structure. + */ + if (wmPtr->iconPtr != NULL) { - /* Free any old icon ptr which is associated with this window. */ + /* + * Free any old icon ptr which is associated with this window. + */ + DecrIconRefCount(wmPtr->iconPtr); } + /* - * We do not need to increment the ref count for the - * titlebaricon, because it was already incremented when we - * retrieved it. + * We do not need to increment the ref count for the titlebaricon, + * because it was already incremented when we retrieved it. */ + wmPtr->iconPtr = titlebaricon; } return TCL_OK; @@ -1128,8 +1193,8 @@ WinSetIcon(interp, titlebaricon, tkw) * * TkWinGetIcon -- * - * Gets either the default toplevel titlebar icon, or the icon - * for a specific toplevel (ICON_SMALL or ICON_BIG). + * Gets either the default toplevel titlebar icon, or the icon for a + * specific toplevel (ICON_SMALL or ICON_BIG). * * Results: * A Windows HICON. @@ -1140,21 +1205,27 @@ WinSetIcon(interp, titlebaricon, tkw) *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ HICON -TkWinGetIcon(Tk_Window tkwin, DWORD iconsize) +TkWinGetIcon( + Tk_Window tkwin, + DWORD iconsize) { WmInfo *wmPtr; HICON icon; - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); if (tsdPtr->iconPtr != NULL) { /* * return default toplevel icon */ + return GetIcon(tsdPtr->iconPtr, iconsize); } - /* ensure we operate on the toplevel, that has the icon refs */ + /* + * Ensure we operate on the toplevel, that has the icon refs. + */ + while (!Tk_IsTopLevel(tkwin)) { tkwin = Tk_Parent(tkwin); if (tkwin == NULL) { @@ -1171,13 +1242,15 @@ TkWinGetIcon(Tk_Window tkwin, DWORD iconsize) /* * return window toplevel icon */ + return GetIcon(wmPtr->iconPtr, iconsize); } /* - * Find the icon otherwise associated with the toplevel, or - * finally with the window class. + * Find the icon otherwise associated with the toplevel, or finally with + * the window class. */ + icon = (HICON) SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, WM_GETICON, iconsize, (LPARAM) NULL); if (icon == (HICON) NULL) { @@ -1197,42 +1270,42 @@ TkWinGetIcon(Tk_Window tkwin, DWORD iconsize) * * ReadIconFromFile -- * - * Read the contents of a file (usually .ico, .icr) and extract an - * icon resource, if possible, otherwise check if the shell has an - * icon assigned to the given file and use that. If both of those - * fail, then NULL is returned, and an error message will already be - * in the interpreter. - * + * Read the contents of a file (usually .ico, .icr) and extract an icon + * resource, if possible, otherwise check if the shell has an icon + * assigned to the given file and use that. If both of those fail, then + * NULL is returned, and an error message will already be in the + * interpreter. + * * Results: - * A WinIconPtr structure containing the icons in the file, with - * its ref count already incremented. The calling procedure should - * either place this structure inside a WmInfo structure, or it should - * pass it on to DecrIconRefCount() to ensure no memory leaks occur. + * A WinIconPtr structure containing the icons in the file, with its ref + * count already incremented. The calling function should either place + * this structure inside a WmInfo structure, or it should pass it on to + * DecrIconRefCount() to ensure no memory leaks occur. * * If the given fileName did not contain a valid icon structure, * return NULL. * * Side effects: - * Memory is allocated for the returned structure and the icons - * it contains. If the structure is not wanted, it should be - * passed to DecrIconRefCount, and in any case a valid ref count - * should be ensured to avoid memory leaks. + * Memory is allocated for the returned structure and the icons it + * contains. If the structure is not wanted, it should be passed to + * DecrIconRefCount, and in any case a valid ref count should be ensured + * to avoid memory leaks. * - * Currently icon resources are not shared, so the ref count of - * one of these structures will always be 0 or 1. However all we - * need do is implement some sort of lookup function between - * filenames and WinIconPtr structures and no other code will need - * to be changed. The pseudo-code for this is implemented below - * in the 'if (0)' branch. It did not seem necessary to implement - * this optimisation here, since moving to icon<->image - * conversions will probably make it obsolete. + * Currently icon resources are not shared, so the ref count of one of + * these structures will always be 0 or 1. However all we need do is + * implement some sort of lookup function between filenames and + * WinIconPtr structures and no other code will need to be changed. The + * pseudo-code for this is implemented below in the 'if (0)' branch. It + * did not seem necessary to implement this optimisation here, since + * moving to icon<->image conversions will probably make it obsolete. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ + static WinIconPtr -ReadIconFromFile(interp, fileName) - Tcl_Interp *interp; - Tcl_Obj *fileName; +ReadIconFromFile( + Tcl_Interp *interp, + Tcl_Obj *fileName) { WinIconPtr titlebaricon = NULL; @@ -1241,15 +1314,19 @@ ReadIconFromFile(interp, fileName) titlebaricon->refCount++; return titlebaricon; } else { - /* First check if it is a .ico file */ + /* + * First check if it is a .ico file. + */ + BlockOfIconImagesPtr lpIR; lpIR = ReadIconOrCursorFromFile(interp, fileName, TRUE); /* - * Then see if we can ask the shell for the icon for this file. - * We want both the regular and small icons so that the Alt-Tab - * (task-switching) display uses the right icon. + * Then see if we can ask the shell for the icon for this file. We + * want both the regular and small icons so that the Alt-Tab (task- + * switching) display uses the right icon. */ + if (lpIR == NULL && shgetfileinfoProc != NULL) { SHFILEINFO sfiSM; Tcl_DString ds, ds2; @@ -1257,7 +1334,9 @@ ReadIconFromFile(interp, fileName) CONST char *file; file = Tcl_TranslateFileName(interp, Tcl_GetString(fileName), &ds); - if (file == NULL) { return NULL; } + if (file == NULL) { + return NULL; + } Tcl_UtfToExternalDString(NULL, file, -1, &ds2); Tcl_DStringFree(&ds); res = (*shgetfileinfoProc)(Tcl_DStringValue(&ds2), 0, &sfiSM, @@ -1271,9 +1350,12 @@ ReadIconFromFile(interp, fileName) res = (*shgetfileinfoProc)(Tcl_DStringValue(&ds2), 0, &sfi, sizeof(SHFILEINFO), SHGFI_ICON); - /* Account for extra icon, if necessary */ - size = sizeof(BlockOfIconImages) + - ((res != 0) ? sizeof(ICONIMAGE) : 0); + /* + * Account for extra icon, if necessary. + */ + + size = sizeof(BlockOfIconImages) + + ((res != 0) ? sizeof(ICONIMAGE) : 0); lpIR = (BlockOfIconImagesPtr) ckalloc(size); if (lpIR == NULL) { if (res != 0) { @@ -1290,7 +1372,10 @@ ReadIconFromFile(interp, fileName) lpIR->IconImages[0].Height = 16; lpIR->IconImages[0].Colors = 4; lpIR->IconImages[0].hIcon = sfiSM.hIcon; - /* All other IconImages fields are ignored */ + + /* + * All other IconImages fields are ignored. + */ if (res != 0) { lpIR->IconImages[1].Width = 32; @@ -1315,45 +1400,45 @@ ReadIconFromFile(interp, fileName) * * GetIconFromPixmap -- * - * Turn a Tk Pixmap (i.e. a bitmap) into an icon resource, if - * possible, otherwise NULL is returned. + * Turn a Tk Pixmap (i.e. a bitmap) into an icon resource, if possible, + * otherwise NULL is returned. * * Results: - * A WinIconPtr structure containing a conversion of the given - * bitmap into an icon, with its ref count already incremented. The - * calling procedure should either place this structure inside a - * WmInfo structure, or it should pass it on to DecrIconRefCount() - * to ensure no memory leaks occur. - * - * If the given pixmap did not contain a valid icon structure, - * return NULL. + * A WinIconPtr structure containing a conversion of the given bitmap + * into an icon, with its ref count already incremented. The calling + * function should either place this structure inside a WmInfo structure, + * or it should pass it on to DecrIconRefCount() to ensure no memory + * leaks occur. + * + * If the given pixmap did not contain a valid icon structure, return + * NULL. * * Side effects: - * Memory is allocated for the returned structure and the icons - * it contains. If the structure is not wanted, it should be - * passed to DecrIconRefCount, and in any case a valid ref count - * should be ensured to avoid memory leaks. - * - * Currently icon resources are not shared, so the ref count of - * one of these structures will always be 0 or 1. However all we - * need do is implement some sort of lookup function between - * pixmaps and WinIconPtr structures and no other code will need - * to be changed. + * Memory is allocated for the returned structure and the icons it + * contains. If the structure is not wanted, it should be passed to + * DecrIconRefCount, and in any case a valid ref count should be ensured + * to avoid memory leaks. + * + * Currently icon resources are not shared, so the ref count of one of + * these structures will always be 0 or 1. However all we need do is + * implement some sort of lookup function between pixmaps and WinIconPtr + * structures and no other code will need to be changed. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -static WinIconPtr -GetIconFromPixmap(dsPtr, pixmap) - Display *dsPtr; - Pixmap pixmap; + +static WinIconPtr +GetIconFromPixmap( + Display *dsPtr, + Pixmap pixmap) { WinIconPtr titlebaricon = NULL; TkWinDrawable* twdPtr = (TkWinDrawable*) pixmap; - + if (twdPtr == NULL) { return NULL; } - + if (0 /* If we already have an icon for this pixmap */) { titlebaricon = NULL; /* Get the real value from a lookup */ titlebaricon->refCount++; @@ -1388,7 +1473,11 @@ GetIconFromPixmap(dsPtr, pixmap) lpIR->IconImages[0].Height = height; lpIR->IconImages[0].Colors = 1 << twdPtr->bitmap.depth; lpIR->IconImages[0].hIcon = hIcon; - /* These fields are ignored */ + + /* + * These fields are ignored. + */ + lpIR->IconImages[0].lpBits = 0; lpIR->IconImages[0].dwNumBytes = 0; lpIR->IconImages[0].lpXOR = 0; @@ -1412,14 +1501,17 @@ GetIconFromPixmap(dsPtr, pixmap) * None. * * Side effects: - * If the ref count falls to zero, free the memory associated - * with the icon resource structures. In this case the pointer - * passed into this function is no longer valid. + * If the ref count falls to zero, free the memory associated with the + * icon resource structures. In this case the pointer passed into this + * function is no longer valid. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -static void -DecrIconRefCount(WinIconPtr titlebaricon) { + +static void +DecrIconRefCount( + WinIconPtr titlebaricon) +{ titlebaricon->refCount--; if (titlebaricon->refCount <= 0) { @@ -1437,9 +1529,8 @@ DecrIconRefCount(WinIconPtr titlebaricon) { * * FreeIconBlock -- * - * Frees all memory associated with a previously loaded - * titlebaricon. The icon block pointer is no longer - * valid once this function returns. + * Frees all memory associated with a previously loaded titlebaricon. + * The icon block pointer is no longer valid once this function returns. * * Results: * None. @@ -1449,12 +1540,17 @@ DecrIconRefCount(WinIconPtr titlebaricon) { * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -static void -FreeIconBlock(BlockOfIconImagesPtr lpIR) + +static void +FreeIconBlock( + BlockOfIconImagesPtr lpIR) { int i; - /* Free all the bits */ + /* + * Free all the bits. + */ + for (i=0; i< lpIR->nNumImages; i++) { if (lpIR->IconImages[i].lpBits != NULL) { ckfree((char*)lpIR->IconImages[i].lpBits); @@ -1476,16 +1572,16 @@ FreeIconBlock(BlockOfIconImagesPtr lpIR) * Results: * Returns the icon, if found, else NULL. * - * Side effects: - * - * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -static HICON -GetIcon(WinIconPtr titlebaricon, int icon_size) + +static HICON +GetIcon( + WinIconPtr titlebaricon, + int icon_size) { BlockOfIconImagesPtr lpIR; - + if (titlebaricon == NULL) { return NULL; } @@ -1498,7 +1594,10 @@ GetIcon(WinIconPtr titlebaricon, int icon_size) int i; for (i = 0; i < lpIR->nNumImages; i++) { - /* Take the first or a 32x32 16 color icon*/ + /* + * Take the first or a 32x32 16 color icon + */ + if ((lpIR->IconImages[i].Height == size) && (lpIR->IconImages[i].Width == size) && (lpIR->IconImages[i].Colors >= 4)) { @@ -1506,10 +1605,10 @@ GetIcon(WinIconPtr titlebaricon, int icon_size) } } - /* - * If we get here, then just return the first one, - * it will have to do! + /* + * If we get here, then just return the first one, it will have to do! */ + if (lpIR->nNumImages >= 1) { return lpIR->IconImages[0].hIcon; } @@ -1517,12 +1616,14 @@ GetIcon(WinIconPtr titlebaricon, int icon_size) return NULL; } -static HCURSOR -TclWinReadCursorFromFile(Tcl_Interp* interp, Tcl_Obj* fileName) +static HCURSOR +TclWinReadCursorFromFile( + Tcl_Interp* interp, + Tcl_Obj* fileName) { BlockOfIconImagesPtr lpIR; HICON res = NULL; - + lpIR = ReadIconOrCursorFromFile(interp, fileName, FALSE); if (lpIR == NULL) { return NULL; @@ -1539,9 +1640,8 @@ TclWinReadCursorFromFile(Tcl_Interp* interp, Tcl_Obj* fileName) * * ReadIconOrCursorFromFile -- * - * Reads an Icon Resource from an ICO file, as given by - * char* fileName - Name of the ICO file. This name should - * be in Utf format. + * Reads an Icon Resource from an ICO file, as given by char* fileName - + * Name of the ICO file. This name should be in Utf format. * * Results: * Returns an icon resource, if found, else NULL. @@ -1551,21 +1651,27 @@ TclWinReadCursorFromFile(Tcl_Interp* interp, Tcl_Obj* fileName) * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -static BlockOfIconImagesPtr -ReadIconOrCursorFromFile(Tcl_Interp* interp, Tcl_Obj* fileName, BOOL isIcon) + +static BlockOfIconImagesPtr +ReadIconOrCursorFromFile( + Tcl_Interp *interp, + Tcl_Obj *fileName, + BOOL isIcon) { BlockOfIconImagesPtr lpIR, lpNew; - Tcl_Channel channel; - int i; - DWORD dwBytesRead; - LPICONDIRENTRY lpIDE; + Tcl_Channel channel; + int i; + DWORD dwBytesRead; + LPICONDIRENTRY lpIDE; + + /* + * Open the file. + */ - /* Open the file */ channel = Tcl_FSOpenFileChannel(interp, fileName, "r", 0); if (channel == NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp,"Error opening file \"", - Tcl_GetString(fileName), - "\" for reading",(char*)NULL); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp,"Error opening file \"", + Tcl_GetString(fileName), "\" for reading", NULL); return NULL; } if (Tcl_SetChannelOption(interp, channel, "-translation", "binary") @@ -1578,23 +1684,35 @@ ReadIconOrCursorFromFile(Tcl_Interp* interp, Tcl_Obj* fileName, BOOL isIcon) Tcl_Close(NULL, channel); return NULL; } - /* Allocate memory for the resource structure */ + + /* + * Allocate memory for the resource structure + */ + lpIR = (BlockOfIconImagesPtr) ckalloc(sizeof(BlockOfIconImages)); if (lpIR == NULL) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp,"Error allocating memory",(char*)NULL); Tcl_Close(NULL, channel); return NULL; } - /* Read in the header */ + + /* + * Read in the header + */ + if ((lpIR->nNumImages = ReadICOHeader( channel )) == -1) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp,"Invalid file header",(char*)NULL); Tcl_Close(NULL, channel); ckfree((char*) lpIR ); return NULL; } - /* Adjust the size of the struct to account for the images */ - lpNew = (BlockOfIconImagesPtr) ckrealloc((char*)lpIR, - sizeof(BlockOfIconImages) + ((lpIR->nNumImages-1) * sizeof(ICONIMAGE))); + + /* + * Adjust the size of the struct to account for the images. + */ + + lpNew = (BlockOfIconImagesPtr) ckrealloc((char*)lpIR, + sizeof(BlockOfIconImages) + ((lpIR->nNumImages-1)*sizeof(ICONIMAGE))); if (lpNew == NULL) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp,"Error allocating memory",(char*)NULL); Tcl_Close(NULL, channel); @@ -1602,7 +1720,11 @@ ReadIconOrCursorFromFile(Tcl_Interp* interp, Tcl_Obj* fileName, BOOL isIcon) return NULL; } lpIR = lpNew; - /* Allocate enough memory for the icon directory entries */ + + /* + * Allocate enough memory for the icon directory entries. + */ + lpIDE = (LPICONDIRENTRY) ckalloc(lpIR->nNumImages * sizeof(ICONDIRENTRY)); if (lpIDE == NULL) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp,"Error allocating memory",(char*)NULL); @@ -1610,67 +1732,99 @@ ReadIconOrCursorFromFile(Tcl_Interp* interp, Tcl_Obj* fileName, BOOL isIcon) ckfree( (char*)lpIR ); return NULL; } - /* Read in the icon directory entries */ - dwBytesRead = Tcl_Read(channel, (char*)lpIDE, - lpIR->nNumImages * sizeof( ICONDIRENTRY )); + + /* + * Read in the icon directory entries. + */ + + dwBytesRead = Tcl_Read(channel, (char*)lpIDE, + lpIR->nNumImages * sizeof(ICONDIRENTRY)); if (dwBytesRead != lpIR->nNumImages * sizeof( ICONDIRENTRY )) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp,"Error reading file",(char*)NULL); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "Error reading file", NULL); Tcl_Close(NULL, channel); - ckfree( (char*)lpIR ); + ckfree((char*) lpIR); return NULL; } - /* NULL-out everything to make memory management easier */ - for( i = 0; i < lpIR->nNumImages; i++ ) { + + /* + * NULL-out everything to make memory management easier. + */ + + for (i = 0; i < lpIR->nNumImages; i++) { lpIR->IconImages[i].lpBits = NULL; } - /* Loop through and read in each image */ + + /* + * Loop through and read in each image. + */ + for( i = 0; i < lpIR->nNumImages; i++ ) { - /* Allocate memory for the resource */ + /* + * Allocate memory for the resource. + */ + lpIR->IconImages[i].lpBits = (LPBYTE) ckalloc(lpIDE[i].dwBytesInRes); if (lpIR->IconImages[i].lpBits == NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp,"Error allocating memory",(char*)NULL); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "Error allocating memory", NULL); goto readError; } lpIR->IconImages[i].dwNumBytes = lpIDE[i].dwBytesInRes; - /* Seek to beginning of this image */ + + /* + * Seek to beginning of this image. + */ + if (Tcl_Seek(channel, lpIDE[i].dwImageOffset, FILE_BEGIN) == -1) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp,"Error seeking in file",(char*)NULL); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "Error seeking in file", NULL); goto readError; } - /* Read it in */ - dwBytesRead = Tcl_Read( channel, lpIR->IconImages[i].lpBits, - lpIDE[i].dwBytesInRes); + + /* + * Read it in. + */ + + dwBytesRead = Tcl_Read( channel, lpIR->IconImages[i].lpBits, + lpIDE[i].dwBytesInRes); if (dwBytesRead != lpIDE[i].dwBytesInRes) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp,"Error reading file",(char*)NULL); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "Error reading file", NULL); goto readError; } - /* Set the internal pointers appropriately */ + + /* + * Set the internal pointers appropriately. + */ + if (!AdjustIconImagePointers( &(lpIR->IconImages[i]))) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp,"Error converting to internal format", - (char*)NULL); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "Error converting to internal format", + NULL); goto readError; } lpIR->IconImages[i].hIcon = MakeIconOrCursorFromResource(&(lpIR->IconImages[i]), isIcon); } - /* Clean up */ + + /* + * Clean up + */ + ckfree((char*)lpIDE); Tcl_Close(NULL, channel); if (lpIR == NULL){ - Tcl_AppendResult(interp,"Reading of ", Tcl_GetString(fileName), - " failed!",(char*)NULL); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "Reading of ", Tcl_GetString(fileName), + " failed!", NULL); return NULL; } return lpIR; + readError: Tcl_Close(NULL, channel); - for( i = 0; i < lpIR->nNumImages; i++ ) { + for (i = 0; i < lpIR->nNumImages; i++) { if (lpIR->IconImages[i].lpBits != NULL) { - ckfree((char*)lpIR->IconImages[i].lpBits); + ckfree((char*) lpIR->IconImages[i].lpBits); } } - ckfree((char*)lpIDE ); - ckfree((char*)lpIR ); + ckfree((char*) lpIDE); + ckfree((char*) lpIR); return NULL; } @@ -1679,8 +1833,7 @@ ReadIconOrCursorFromFile(Tcl_Interp* interp, Tcl_Obj* fileName, BOOL isIcon) * * GetTopLevel -- * - * This function retrieves the TkWindow associated with the - * given HWND. + * This function retrieves the TkWindow associated with the given HWND. * * Results: * Returns the matching TkWindow. @@ -1690,17 +1843,18 @@ ReadIconOrCursorFromFile(Tcl_Interp* interp, Tcl_Obj* fileName, BOOL isIcon) * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ + static TkWindow * -GetTopLevel(hwnd) - HWND hwnd; +GetTopLevel( + HWND hwnd) { ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); /* - * If this function is called before the CreateWindowEx call - * has completed, then the user data slot will not have been - * set yet, so we use the global createWindow variable. + * If this function is called before the CreateWindowEx call has + * completed, then the user data slot will not have been set yet, so we + * use the global createWindow variable. */ if (tsdPtr->createWindow) { @@ -1724,16 +1878,16 @@ GetTopLevel(hwnd) * None. * * Side effects: - * Changes the values of the info pointer to reflect the current - * minimum and maximum size values. + * Changes the values of the info pointer to reflect the current minimum + * and maximum size values. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void -SetLimits(hwnd, info) - HWND hwnd; - MINMAXINFO *info; +SetLimits( + HWND hwnd, + MINMAXINFO *info) { register WmInfo *wmPtr; int maxWidth, maxHeight; @@ -1783,8 +1937,8 @@ SetLimits(hwnd, info) } /* - * If the window isn't supposed to be resizable, then set the - * minimum and maximum dimensions to be the same as the current size. + * If the window isn't supposed to be resizable, then set the minimum and + * maximum dimensions to be the same as the current size. */ if (!(wmPtr->flags & WM_SYNC_PENDING)) { @@ -1806,8 +1960,8 @@ SetLimits(hwnd, info) * * TkWinWmCleanup -- * - * Unregisters classes registered by the window manager. This is - * called from the DLL main entry point when the DLL is unloaded. + * Unregisters classes registered by the window manager. This is called + * from the DLL main entry point when the DLL is unloaded. * * Results: * None. @@ -1819,14 +1973,14 @@ SetLimits(hwnd, info) */ void -TkWinWmCleanup(hInstance) - HINSTANCE hInstance; +TkWinWmCleanup( + HINSTANCE hInstance) { ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr; /* - * If we're using stubs to access the Tcl library, and they - * haven't been initialized, we can't call Tcl_GetThreadData. + * If we're using stubs to access the Tcl library, and they haven't been + * initialized, we can't call Tcl_GetThreadData. */ #ifdef USE_TCL_STUBS @@ -1849,10 +2003,12 @@ TkWinWmCleanup(hInstance) tsdPtr->initialized = 0; UnregisterClass(TK_WIN_TOPLEVEL_CLASS_NAME, hInstance); + #ifndef TCL_THREADS /* * Clean up specialized class created for layered windows. */ + if (setLayeredWindowAttributesProc != NULL) { UnregisterClass(TK_WIN_TOPLEVEL_NOCDC_CLASS_NAME, hInstance); setLayeredWindowAttributesProc = NULL; @@ -1865,9 +2021,8 @@ TkWinWmCleanup(hInstance) * * TkWmNewWindow -- * - * This procedure is invoked whenever a new top-level - * window is created. Its job is to initialize the WmInfo - * structure for the window. + * This function is invoked whenever a new top-level window is created. + * Its job is to initialize the WmInfo structure for the window. * * Results: * None. @@ -1879,8 +2034,8 @@ TkWinWmCleanup(hInstance) */ void -TkWmNewWindow(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Newly-created top-level window. */ +TkWmNewWindow( + TkWindow *winPtr) /* Newly-created top-level window. */ { register WmInfo *wmPtr; @@ -1889,6 +2044,7 @@ TkWmNewWindow(winPtr) /* * Initialize full structure, then set what isn't NULL */ + ZeroMemory(wmPtr, sizeof(WmInfo)); winPtr->wmInfoPtr = wmPtr; wmPtr->winPtr = winPtr; @@ -1928,16 +2084,16 @@ TkWmNewWindow(winPtr) winPtr->dispPtr->firstWmPtr = wmPtr; /* - * Tk must monitor structure events for top-level windows, in order - * to detect size and position changes caused by window managers. + * Tk must monitor structure events for top-level windows, in order to + * detect size and position changes caused by window managers. */ Tk_CreateEventHandler((Tk_Window) winPtr, StructureNotifyMask, TopLevelEventProc, (ClientData) winPtr); /* - * Arrange for geometry requests to be reflected from the window - * to the window manager. + * Arrange for geometry requests to be reflected from the window to the + * window manager. */ Tk_ManageGeometry((Tk_Window) winPtr, &wmMgrType, (ClientData) 0); @@ -1948,24 +2104,23 @@ TkWmNewWindow(winPtr) * * UpdateWrapper -- * - * This function creates the wrapper window that contains the - * window decorations and menus for a toplevel. This function - * may be called after a window is mapped to change the window - * style. + * This function creates the wrapper window that contains the window + * decorations and menus for a toplevel. This function may be called + * after a window is mapped to change the window style. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * Destroys any old wrapper window and replaces it with a newly - * created wrapper. + * Destroys any old wrapper window and replaces it with a newly created + * wrapper. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void -UpdateWrapper(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Top-level window to redecorate. */ +UpdateWrapper( + TkWindow *winPtr) /* Top-level window to redecorate. */ { register WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; HWND parentHWND, oldWrapper = wmPtr->wrapper; @@ -1983,15 +2138,18 @@ UpdateWrapper(winPtr) /* * Ensure existence of the window to update the wrapper for. */ + Tk_MakeWindowExist((Tk_Window) winPtr); } child = TkWinGetHWND(winPtr->window); parentHWND = NULL; + /* - * nextHWND will help us maintain Z order. - * focusHWND will help us maintain focus, if we had it. + * nextHWND will help us maintain Z order. focusHWND will help us maintain + * focus, if we had it. */ + nextHWND = NULL; focusHWND = GetFocus(); if ((oldWrapper == NULL) || (oldWrapper != GetForegroundWindow())) { @@ -2009,13 +2167,13 @@ UpdateWrapper(winPtr) } else { /* - * Pick the decorative frame style. Override redirect windows get + * Pick the decorative frame style. Override redirect windows get * created as undecorated popups if they have no transient parent, - * otherwise they are children. This allows splash screens to operate + * otherwise they are children. This allows splash screens to operate * as an independent window, while having dropdows (like for a - * combobox) not grab focus away from their parent. Transient windows - * get a modal dialog frame. Neither override, nor transient windows - * appear in the Windows taskbar. Note that a transient window does + * combobox) not grab focus away from their parent. Transient windows + * get a modal dialog frame. Neither override, nor transient windows + * appear in the Windows taskbar. Note that a transient window does * not resize by default, so we need to explicitly add the * WS_THICKFRAME style if we want it to be resizeable. */ @@ -2023,7 +2181,11 @@ UpdateWrapper(winPtr) if (winPtr->atts.override_redirect) { wmPtr->style = WM_OVERRIDE_STYLE; wmPtr->exStyle = EX_OVERRIDE_STYLE; - /* parent must be desktop even if we have a transient parent */ + + /* + * Parent must be desktop even if we have a transient parent. + */ + parentHWND = GetDesktopWindow(); if (wmPtr->masterPtr) { wmPtr->style |= WS_CHILD; @@ -2067,9 +2229,9 @@ UpdateWrapper(winPtr) /* * Set the initial position from the user or program specified - * location. If nothing has been specified, then let the system - * pick a location. In full screen mode the x,y origin is 0,0 - * and the window width and height match that of the screen. + * location. If nothing has been specified, then let the system pick a + * location. In full screen mode the x,y origin is 0,0 and the window + * width and height match that of the screen. */ if (wmPtr->flags & WM_FULLSCREEN) { @@ -2087,13 +2249,14 @@ UpdateWrapper(winPtr) } /* - * Create the containing window, and set the user data to point - * to the TkWindow. + * Create the containing window, and set the user data to point to the + * TkWindow. */ tsdPtr->createWindow = winPtr; Tcl_WinUtfToTChar(((wmPtr->title != NULL) ? wmPtr->title : winPtr->nameUid), -1, &titleString); + #ifndef TCL_THREADS /* * Transparent windows require a non-CS_CLASSDC window class. @@ -2104,7 +2267,10 @@ UpdateWrapper(winPtr) -1, &classString); } else #endif + { Tcl_WinUtfToTChar(TK_WIN_TOPLEVEL_CLASS_NAME, -1, &classString); + } + wmPtr->wrapper = (*tkWinProcs->createWindowEx)(wmPtr->exStyle, (LPCTSTR) Tcl_DStringValue(&classString), (LPCTSTR) Tcl_DStringValue(&titleString), @@ -2123,9 +2289,10 @@ UpdateWrapper(winPtr) && setLayeredWindowAttributesProc != NULL) { /* * The user supplies a double from [0..1], but Windows wants an - * int (transparent) 0..255 (opaque), so do the translation. - * Add the 0.5 to round the value. + * int (transparent) 0..255 (opaque), so do the translation. Add + * the 0.5 to round the value. */ + setLayeredWindowAttributesProc((HWND) wmPtr->wrapper, (COLORREF) NULL, (BYTE) (wmPtr->alpha * 255 + 0.5), LWA_ALPHA); @@ -2150,14 +2317,15 @@ UpdateWrapper(winPtr) * We will adjust wrapper to have the same Z order as oldWrapper * if it isn't a TOPMOST window. */ + nextHWND = GetNextWindow(oldWrapper, GW_HWNDPREV); } } /* - * Now we need to reparent the contained window and set its - * style appropriately. Be sure to update the style first so that - * Windows doesn't try to set the focus to the child window. + * Now we need to reparent the contained window and set its style + * appropriately. Be sure to update the style first so that Windows + * doesn't try to set the focus to the child window. */ #ifdef _WIN64 @@ -2167,6 +2335,7 @@ UpdateWrapper(winPtr) SetWindowLong(child, GWL_STYLE, WS_CHILD | WS_CLIPCHILDREN | WS_CLIPSIBLINGS); #endif + if (winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED) { #ifdef _WIN64 SetWindowLongPtr(child, GWLP_WNDPROC, (LONG_PTR) TopLevelProc); @@ -2174,6 +2343,7 @@ UpdateWrapper(winPtr) SetWindowLong(child, GWL_WNDPROC, (LONG) TopLevelProc); #endif } + SetParent(child, wmPtr->wrapper); if (oldWrapper) { hSmallIcon = (HICON) SendMessage(oldWrapper, WM_GETICON, ICON_SMALL, @@ -2195,21 +2365,22 @@ UpdateWrapper(winPtr) * Unset the current wrapper as the parent for all transient * children for whom this is the master */ + WmInfo *wmPtr2; - childStateInfo = (int *)ckalloc((unsigned) wmPtr->numTransients - * sizeof(int)); + childStateInfo = (int *) + ckalloc((unsigned) wmPtr->numTransients * sizeof(int)); state = 0; for (wmPtr2 = winPtr->dispPtr->firstWmPtr; wmPtr2 != NULL; - wmPtr2 = wmPtr2->nextPtr) { - if (wmPtr2->masterPtr == winPtr) { - if (!(wmPtr2->flags & WM_NEVER_MAPPED)) { - childStateInfo[state++] = wmPtr2->hints.initial_state; - SetParent(TkWinGetHWND(wmPtr2->winPtr->window), NULL); - } + wmPtr2 = wmPtr2->nextPtr) { + if (wmPtr2->masterPtr == winPtr + && !(wmPtr2->flags & WM_NEVER_MAPPED)) { + childStateInfo[state++] = wmPtr2->hints.initial_state; + SetParent(TkWinGetHWND(wmPtr2->winPtr->window), NULL); } } } + /* * Remove the menubar before destroying the window so the menubar * isn't destroyed. @@ -2220,19 +2391,18 @@ UpdateWrapper(winPtr) } wmPtr->flags &= ~WM_NEVER_MAPPED; - if (winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED) { - if(SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_ATTACHWINDOW, (WPARAM) child, 0)) - { - SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_GEOMETRYREQ, - Tk_ReqWidth((Tk_Window)winPtr), Tk_ReqHeight((Tk_Window)winPtr)); - SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_SETMENU, (WPARAM)wmPtr->hMenu, (LPARAM)Tk_GetMenuHWND((Tk_Window)winPtr)); - } + if (winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED + && SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_ATTACHWINDOW, (WPARAM)child, 0)){ + SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_GEOMETRYREQ, + Tk_ReqWidth((Tk_Window)winPtr), + Tk_ReqHeight((Tk_Window)winPtr)); + SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_SETMENU, (WPARAM) wmPtr->hMenu, + (LPARAM) Tk_GetMenuHWND((Tk_Window) winPtr)); } /* - * Force an initial transition from withdrawn to the real - * initial state. Set the Z order based on previous wrapper - * before we set the state. + * Force an initial transition from withdrawn to the real initial state. + * Set the Z order based on previous wrapper before we set the state. */ state = wmPtr->hints.initial_state; @@ -2253,12 +2423,11 @@ UpdateWrapper(winPtr) } /* - * If we are embedded then force a mapping of the window now, - * because we do not necessarily own the wrapper and may not - * get another opportunity to map ourselves. We should not be - * in either iconified or zoomed states when we get here, so - * it is safe to just check for TK_EMBEDDED without checking - * what state we are supposed to be in (default to NormalState). + * If we are embedded then force a mapping of the window now, because we + * do not necessarily own the wrapper and may not get another opportunity + * to map ourselves. We should not be in either iconified or zoomed states + * when we get here, so it is safe to just check for TK_EMBEDDED without + * checking what state we are supposed to be in (default to NormalState). */ if (winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED) { @@ -2282,18 +2451,18 @@ UpdateWrapper(winPtr) if (childStateInfo) { if (wmPtr->numTransients > 0) { /* - * Reset all transient children for whom this is the master + * Reset all transient children for whom this is the master. */ + WmInfo *wmPtr2; state = 0; for (wmPtr2 = winPtr->dispPtr->firstWmPtr; wmPtr2 != NULL; - wmPtr2 = wmPtr2->nextPtr) { - if (wmPtr2->masterPtr == winPtr) { - if ( !(wmPtr2->flags & WM_NEVER_MAPPED)) { - UpdateWrapper(wmPtr2->winPtr); - TkpWmSetState(wmPtr2->winPtr, childStateInfo[state++]); - } + wmPtr2 = wmPtr2->nextPtr) { + if (wmPtr2->masterPtr == winPtr + && !(wmPtr2->flags & WM_NEVER_MAPPED)) { + UpdateWrapper(wmPtr2->winPtr); + TkpWmSetState(wmPtr2->winPtr, childStateInfo[state++]); } } } @@ -2302,11 +2471,11 @@ UpdateWrapper(winPtr) } /* - * If this is the first window created by the application, then - * we should activate the initial window. Otherwise, if this had - * the focus, we need to restore that. - * XXX: Rewrapping generates a <FocusOut> and <FocusIn> that would - * XXX: best be avoided, if we could safely mask them. + * If this is the first window created by the application, then we should + * activate the initial window. Otherwise, if this had the focus, we need + * to restore that. + * XXX: Rewrapping generates a <FocusOut> and <FocusIn> that would best be + * XXX: avoided, if we could safely mask them. */ if (tsdPtr->firstWindow) { @@ -2322,28 +2491,28 @@ UpdateWrapper(winPtr) * * TkWmMapWindow -- * - * This procedure is invoked to map a top-level window. This - * module gets a chance to update all window-manager-related - * information in properties before the window manager sees - * the map event and checks the properties. It also gets to - * decide whether or not to even map the window after all. + * This function is invoked to map a top-level window. This module gets a + * chance to update all window-manager-related information in properties + * before the window manager sees the map event and checks the + * properties. It also gets to decide whether or not to even map the + * window after all. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * Properties of winPtr may get updated to provide up-to-date - * information to the window manager. The window may also get - * mapped, but it may not be if this procedure decides that - * isn't appropriate (e.g. because the window is withdrawn). + * Properties of winPtr may get updated to provide up-to-date information + * to the window manager. The window may also get mapped, but it may not + * be if this function decides that isn't appropriate (e.g. because the + * window is withdrawn). * *-------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -TkWmMapWindow(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Top-level window that's about to - * be mapped. */ +TkWmMapWindow( + TkWindow *winPtr) /* Top-level window that's about to be + * mapped. */ { register WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) @@ -2369,7 +2538,7 @@ TkWmMapWindow(winPtr) } /* - * Map the window in either the iconified or normal state. Note that + * Map the window in either the iconified or normal state. Note that * we only send a map event if the window is in the normal state. */ @@ -2377,9 +2546,8 @@ TkWmMapWindow(winPtr) } /* - * This is the first time this window has ever been mapped. - * Store all the window-manager-related information for the - * window. + * This is the first time this window has ever been mapped. Store all the + * window-manager-related information for the window. */ UpdateWrapper(winPtr); @@ -2390,9 +2558,9 @@ TkWmMapWindow(winPtr) * * TkWmUnmapWindow -- * - * This procedure is invoked to unmap a top-level window. The - * only thing it does special is unmap the decorative frame before - * unmapping the toplevel window. + * This function is invoked to unmap a top-level window. The only thing + * it does special is unmap the decorative frame before unmapping the + * toplevel window. * * Results: * None. @@ -2404,9 +2572,9 @@ TkWmMapWindow(winPtr) */ void -TkWmUnmapWindow(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Top-level window that's about to - * be unmapped. */ +TkWmUnmapWindow( + TkWindow *winPtr) /* Top-level window that's about to be + * unmapped. */ { TkpWmSetState(winPtr, WithdrawnState); } @@ -2416,8 +2584,8 @@ TkWmUnmapWindow(winPtr) * * TkpWmSetState -- * - * Sets the window manager state for the wrapper window of a - * given toplevel window. + * Sets the window manager state for the wrapper window of a given + * toplevel window. * * Results: * None. @@ -2429,9 +2597,9 @@ TkWmUnmapWindow(winPtr) */ void -TkpWmSetState(winPtr, state) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Toplevel window to operate on. */ - int state; /* One of IconicState, ZoomState, NormalState, +TkpWmSetState( + TkWindow *winPtr, /* Toplevel window to operate on. */ + int state) /* One of IconicState, ZoomState, NormalState, * or WithdrawnState. */ { WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; @@ -2456,7 +2624,6 @@ TkpWmSetState(winPtr, state) ShowWindow(wmPtr->wrapper, cmd); wmPtr->flags &= ~WM_SYNC_PENDING; } - /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -2474,11 +2641,10 @@ TkpWmSetState(winPtr, state) *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -static -void -TkpWmSetFullScreen(winPtr, full_screen_state) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Toplevel window to operate on. */ - int full_screen_state; /* True if window should be full screen */ +static void +TkpWmSetFullScreen( + TkWindow *winPtr, /* Toplevel window to operate on. */ + int full_screen_state) /* True if window should be full screen */ { int changed = 0; int full_screen = False; @@ -2508,9 +2674,10 @@ TkpWmSetFullScreen(winPtr, full_screen_state) wmPtr->y = wmPtr->configY; } - /* If the window has been mapped, then we need to - * update the native wrapper window, and reset - * the focus to the widget that had it before. + /* + * If the window has been mapped, then we need to update the native + * wrapper window, and reset the focus to the widget that had it + * before. */ if (!(wmPtr->flags & (WM_NEVER_MAPPED) @@ -2520,7 +2687,7 @@ TkpWmSetFullScreen(winPtr, full_screen_state) if (focusWinPtr = TkGetFocusWin(winPtr)) { TkSetFocusWin(focusWinPtr, 1); } - } + } } } @@ -2540,8 +2707,9 @@ TkpWmSetFullScreen(winPtr, full_screen_state) *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -int TkpWmGetState(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; +int +TkpWmGetState( + TkWindow *winPtr) { return winPtr->wmInfoPtr->hints.initial_state; } @@ -2551,9 +2719,8 @@ int TkpWmGetState(winPtr) * * TkWmDeadWindow -- * - * This procedure is invoked when a top-level window is - * about to be deleted. It cleans up the wm-related data - * structures for the window. + * This function is invoked when a top-level window is about to be + * deleted. It cleans up the wm-related data structures for the window. * * Results: * None. @@ -2565,8 +2732,8 @@ int TkpWmGetState(winPtr) */ void -TkWmDeadWindow(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Top-level window that's being deleted. */ +TkWmDeadWindow( + TkWindow *winPtr) /* Top-level window that's being deleted. */ { register WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; WmInfo *wmPtr2; @@ -2658,10 +2825,11 @@ TkWmDeadWindow(winPtr) } if (wmPtr->masterPtr != NULL) { wmPtr2 = wmPtr->masterPtr->wmInfoPtr; + /* - * If we had a master, tell them that we aren't tied - * to them anymore + * If we had a master, tell them that we aren't tied to them anymore. */ + if (wmPtr2 != NULL) { wmPtr2->numTransients--; } @@ -2688,10 +2856,11 @@ TkWmDeadWindow(winPtr) } if (wmPtr->iconPtr != NULL) { /* - * This may delete the icon resource data. I believe we - * should do this after destroying the decorative frame, - * because the decorative frame is using this icon. + * This may delete the icon resource data. I believe we should do this + * after destroying the decorative frame, because the decorative frame + * is using this icon. */ + DecrIconRefCount(wmPtr->iconPtr); } @@ -2704,11 +2873,10 @@ TkWmDeadWindow(winPtr) * * TkWmSetClass -- * - * This procedure is invoked whenever a top-level window's - * class is changed. If the window has been mapped then this - * procedure updates the window manager property for the - * class. If the window hasn't been mapped, the update is - * deferred until just before the first mapping. + * This function is invoked whenever a top-level window's class is + * changed. If the window has been mapped then this function updates the + * window manager property for the class. If the window hasn't been + * mapped, the update is deferred until just before the first mapping. * * Results: * None. @@ -2720,9 +2888,10 @@ TkWmDeadWindow(winPtr) */ void -TkWmSetClass(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Newly-created top-level window. */ +TkWmSetClass( + TkWindow *winPtr) /* Newly-created top-level window. */ { + /* Do nothing */ return; } @@ -2731,8 +2900,8 @@ TkWmSetClass(winPtr) * * Tk_WmObjCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm" Tcl command. - * See the user documentation for details on what it does. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm" Tcl command. See the user + * documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -2745,12 +2914,11 @@ TkWmSetClass(winPtr) /* ARGSUSED */ int -Tk_WmObjCmd(clientData, interp, objc, objv) - ClientData clientData; /* Main window associated with - * interpreter. */ - Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Current interpreter. */ - int objc; /* Number of arguments. */ - Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]; /* Argument objects. */ +Tk_WmObjCmd( + ClientData clientData, /* Main window associated with interpreter. */ + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Current interpreter. */ + int objc, /* Number of arguments. */ + Tcl_Obj *CONST objv[]) /* Argument objects. */ { Tk_Window tkwin = (Tk_Window) clientData; static CONST char *optionStrings[] = { @@ -2762,7 +2930,8 @@ Tk_WmObjCmd(clientData, interp, objc, objv) "iconwindow", "maxsize", "minsize", "overrideredirect", "positionfrom", "protocol", "resizable", "sizefrom", "stackorder", "state", "title", "transient", - "withdraw", (char *) NULL }; + "withdraw", NULL + }; enum options { WMOPT_ASPECT, WMOPT_ATTRIBUTES, WMOPT_CLIENT, WMOPT_COLORMAPWINDOWS, WMOPT_COMMAND, WMOPT_DEICONIFY, WMOPT_FOCUSMODEL, WMOPT_FRAME, @@ -2772,14 +2941,15 @@ Tk_WmObjCmd(clientData, interp, objc, objv) WMOPT_ICONWINDOW, WMOPT_MAXSIZE, WMOPT_MINSIZE, WMOPT_OVERRIDEREDIRECT, WMOPT_POSITIONFROM, WMOPT_PROTOCOL, WMOPT_RESIZABLE, WMOPT_SIZEFROM, WMOPT_STACKORDER, WMOPT_STATE, WMOPT_TITLE, WMOPT_TRANSIENT, - WMOPT_WITHDRAW }; + WMOPT_WITHDRAW + }; int index, length; char *argv1; TkWindow *winPtr; TkDisplay *dispPtr = ((TkWindow *) tkwin)->dispPtr; if (objc < 2) { - wrongNumArgs: + wrongNumArgs: Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 1, objv, "option window ?arg ...?"); return TCL_ERROR; } @@ -2788,6 +2958,7 @@ Tk_WmObjCmd(clientData, interp, objc, objv) if ((argv1[0] == 't') && (strncmp(argv1, "tracing", length) == 0) && (length >= 3)) { int wmTracing; + if ((objc != 2) && (objc != 3)) { Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 2, objv, "?boolean?"); return TCL_ERROR; @@ -2824,70 +2995,70 @@ Tk_WmObjCmd(clientData, interp, objc, objv) } if (!Tk_IsTopLevel(winPtr)) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "window \"", winPtr->pathName, - "\" isn't a top-level window", (char *) NULL); + "\" isn't a top-level window", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } switch ((enum options) index) { - case WMOPT_ASPECT: + case WMOPT_ASPECT: return WmAspectCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_ATTRIBUTES: + case WMOPT_ATTRIBUTES: return WmAttributesCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_CLIENT: + case WMOPT_CLIENT: return WmClientCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_COLORMAPWINDOWS: + case WMOPT_COLORMAPWINDOWS: return WmColormapwindowsCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_COMMAND: + case WMOPT_COMMAND: return WmCommandCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_DEICONIFY: + case WMOPT_DEICONIFY: return WmDeiconifyCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_FOCUSMODEL: + case WMOPT_FOCUSMODEL: return WmFocusmodelCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_FRAME: + case WMOPT_FRAME: return WmFrameCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_GEOMETRY: + case WMOPT_GEOMETRY: return WmGeometryCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_GRID: + case WMOPT_GRID: return WmGridCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_GROUP: + case WMOPT_GROUP: return WmGroupCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_ICONBITMAP: + case WMOPT_ICONBITMAP: return WmIconbitmapCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_ICONIFY: + case WMOPT_ICONIFY: return WmIconifyCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_ICONMASK: + case WMOPT_ICONMASK: return WmIconmaskCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_ICONNAME: + case WMOPT_ICONNAME: return WmIconnameCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_ICONPHOTO: + case WMOPT_ICONPHOTO: return WmIconphotoCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_ICONPOSITION: + case WMOPT_ICONPOSITION: return WmIconpositionCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_ICONWINDOW: + case WMOPT_ICONWINDOW: return WmIconwindowCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_MAXSIZE: + case WMOPT_MAXSIZE: return WmMaxsizeCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_MINSIZE: + case WMOPT_MINSIZE: return WmMinsizeCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_OVERRIDEREDIRECT: + case WMOPT_OVERRIDEREDIRECT: return WmOverrideredirectCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_POSITIONFROM: + case WMOPT_POSITIONFROM: return WmPositionfromCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_PROTOCOL: + case WMOPT_PROTOCOL: return WmProtocolCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_RESIZABLE: + case WMOPT_RESIZABLE: return WmResizableCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_SIZEFROM: + case WMOPT_SIZEFROM: return WmSizefromCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_STACKORDER: + case WMOPT_STACKORDER: return WmStackorderCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_STATE: + case WMOPT_STATE: return WmStateCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_TITLE: + case WMOPT_TITLE: return WmTitleCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_TRANSIENT: + case WMOPT_TRANSIENT: return WmTransientCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); - case WMOPT_WITHDRAW: + case WMOPT_WITHDRAW: return WmWithdrawCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv); } @@ -2900,8 +3071,8 @@ Tk_WmObjCmd(clientData, interp, objc, objv) * * WmAspectCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm aspect" Tcl command. - * See the user documentation for details on what it does. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm aspect" Tcl command. See + * the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -2969,7 +3140,7 @@ WmAspectCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmAttributesCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm attributes" Tcl command. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm attributes" Tcl command. * See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: @@ -2997,7 +3168,7 @@ WmAttributesCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) int fullscreen_attr_changed = 0, fullscreen_attr = 0; if ((objc < 3) || ((objc > 5) && ((objc%2) == 0))) { - configArgs: + configArgs: Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 2, objv, "window" " ?-alpha ?double??" @@ -3057,8 +3228,7 @@ WmAttributesCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) styleBit = WS_EX_TOPMOST; if ((i < objc-1) && (winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED)) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't set topmost flag on ", - winPtr->pathName, ": it is an embedded window", - (char *) NULL); + winPtr->pathName, ": it is an embedded window", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } } else { @@ -3075,11 +3245,13 @@ WmAttributesCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) != TCL_OK)) { return TCL_ERROR; } + /* - * The user should give (transparent) 0 .. 1.0 (opaque), - * but we ignore the setting of this (it will always be 1) - * in the case that the API is not available. + * The user should give (transparent) 0 .. 1.0 (opaque), but + * we ignore the setting of this (it will always be 1) in the + * case that the API is not available. */ + if (dval < 0.0) { dval = 0; } else if (dval > 1.0) { @@ -3097,8 +3269,9 @@ WmAttributesCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * Set the window directly regardless of UpdateWrapper. * The user supplies a double from [0..1], but Windows * wants an int (transparent) 0..255 (opaque), so do the - * translation. Add the 0.5 to round the value. + * translation. Add the 0.5 to round the value. */ + setLayeredWindowAttributesProc((HWND) wmPtr->wrapper, (COLORREF) NULL, (BYTE) (wmPtr->alpha * 255 + 0.5), LWA_ALPHA); @@ -3142,9 +3315,10 @@ WmAttributesCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) } if (wmPtr->styleConfig != style) { /* - * Currently this means only WS_DISABLED changed, which we can - * effect with EnableWindow. + * Currently this means only WS_DISABLED changed, which we can effect + * with EnableWindow. */ + wmPtr->styleConfig = style; if ((wmPtr->exStyleConfig == exStyle) && !(wmPtr->flags & WM_NEVER_MAPPED)) { @@ -3153,9 +3327,10 @@ WmAttributesCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) } if (wmPtr->exStyleConfig != exStyle) { /* - * UpdateWrapper ensure that all effects are properly handled, - * such as TOOLWINDOW disappearing from the taskbar. + * UpdateWrapper ensure that all effects are properly handled, such as + * TOOLWINDOW disappearing from the taskbar. */ + wmPtr->exStyleConfig = exStyle; if (!(wmPtr->flags & WM_NEVER_MAPPED)) { UpdateWrapper(winPtr); @@ -3164,24 +3339,27 @@ WmAttributesCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) if (fullscreen_attr_changed) { if (fullscreen_attr) { if (Tk_Attributes((Tk_Window) winPtr)->override_redirect) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't set fullscreen attribute for \"", - winPtr->pathName, - "\": override-redirect flag is set", - (char *) NULL); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, + "can't set fullscreen attribute for \"", + winPtr->pathName, "\": override-redirect flag is set", + NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } - /* Check max width and height if set by the user, - * don't worry about the default values since they - * will likely be smaller than screen width/height. + + /* + * Check max width and height if set by the user, don't worry + * about the default values since they will likely be smaller than + * screen width/height. */ + if (((wmPtr->maxWidth > 0) && (WidthOfScreen(Tk_Screen(winPtr)) > wmPtr->maxWidth)) || ((wmPtr->maxHeight > 0) && (HeightOfScreen(Tk_Screen(winPtr)) > wmPtr->maxHeight))) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't set fullscreen attribute for \"", - winPtr->pathName, - "\": max width/height is too small", - (char *) NULL); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, + "can't set fullscreen attribute for \"", + winPtr->pathName, "\": max width/height is too small", + NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } } @@ -3197,8 +3375,8 @@ WmAttributesCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmClientCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm client" Tcl command. - * See the user documentation for details on what it does. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm client" Tcl command. See + * the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -3238,8 +3416,7 @@ WmClientCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) wmPtr->clientMachine = NULL; if (!(wmPtr->flags & WM_NEVER_MAPPED)) { XDeleteProperty(winPtr->display, winPtr->window, - Tk_InternAtom((Tk_Window) winPtr, - "WM_CLIENT_MACHINE")); + Tk_InternAtom((Tk_Window) winPtr,"WM_CLIENT_MACHINE")); } } return TCL_OK; @@ -3252,6 +3429,7 @@ WmClientCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) strcpy(wmPtr->clientMachine, argv3); if (!(wmPtr->flags & WM_NEVER_MAPPED)) { XTextProperty textProp; + if (XStringListToTextProperty(&wmPtr->clientMachine, 1, &textProp) != 0) { XSetWMClientMachine(winPtr->display, winPtr->window, @@ -3267,9 +3445,8 @@ WmClientCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmColormapwindowsCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm colormapwindows" - * Tcl command. - * See the user documentation for details on what it does. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm colormapwindows" Tcl + * command. See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -3362,8 +3539,8 @@ WmColormapwindowsCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmCommandCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm command" Tcl command. - * See the user documentation for details on what it does. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm command" Tcl command. See + * the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -3394,8 +3571,7 @@ WmCommandCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) if (objc == 3) { if (wmPtr->cmdArgv != NULL) { Tcl_SetResult(interp, - Tcl_Merge(wmPtr->cmdArgc, wmPtr->cmdArgv), - TCL_DYNAMIC); + Tcl_Merge(wmPtr->cmdArgc, wmPtr->cmdArgv), TCL_DYNAMIC); } return TCL_OK; } @@ -3430,7 +3606,7 @@ WmCommandCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmDeiconifyCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm deiconify" Tcl command. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm deiconify" Tcl command. * See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: @@ -3458,14 +3634,13 @@ WmDeiconifyCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) } if (wmPtr->iconFor != NULL) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't deiconify ", Tcl_GetString(objv[2]), - ": it is an icon for ", Tk_PathName(wmPtr->iconFor), - (char *) NULL); + ": it is an icon for ", Tk_PathName(wmPtr->iconFor), NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } if (winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED) { - if(!SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_DEICONIFY, 0, 0)) { + if (!SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_DEICONIFY, 0, 0)) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't deiconify ", winPtr->pathName, - ": the container does not support the request", (char *) NULL); + ": the container does not support the request", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } return TCL_OK; @@ -3479,7 +3654,7 @@ WmDeiconifyCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmFocusmodelCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm focusmodel" Tcl command. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm focusmodel" Tcl command. * See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: @@ -3501,9 +3676,11 @@ WmFocusmodelCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) { register WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; static CONST char *optionStrings[] = { - "active", "passive", (char *) NULL }; + "active", "passive", NULL + }; enum options { - OPT_ACTIVE, OPT_PASSIVE }; + OPT_ACTIVE, OPT_PASSIVE + }; int index; if ((objc != 3) && (objc != 4)) { @@ -3533,8 +3710,8 @@ WmFocusmodelCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmFrameCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm frame" Tcl command. - * See the user documentation for details on what it does. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm frame" Tcl command. See + * the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -3578,7 +3755,7 @@ WmFrameCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmGeometryCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm geometry" Tcl command. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm geometry" Tcl command. * See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: @@ -3610,6 +3787,7 @@ WmGeometryCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) if (objc == 3) { char buf[16 + TCL_INTEGER_SPACE * 4]; int x, y; + xSign = (wmPtr->flags & WM_NEGATIVE_X) ? '-' : '+'; ySign = (wmPtr->flags & WM_NEGATIVE_Y) ? '-' : '+'; if (wmPtr->gridWin != NULL) { @@ -3625,7 +3803,7 @@ WmGeometryCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) int result = SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_MOVEWINDOW, -1, -1); wmPtr->x = result >> 16; wmPtr->y = result & 0x0000ffff; - } + } x = wmPtr->x; y = wmPtr->y; sprintf(buf, "%dx%d%c%d%c%d", width, height, xSign, x, ySign, y); @@ -3647,8 +3825,8 @@ WmGeometryCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmGridCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm grid" Tcl command. - * See the user documentation for details on what it does. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm grid" Tcl command. See the + * user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -3688,8 +3866,8 @@ WmGridCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) } if (*Tcl_GetString(objv[3]) == '\0') { /* - * Turn off gridding and reset the width and height - * to make sense as ungridded numbers. + * Turn off gridding and reset the width and height to make sense as + * ungridded numbers. */ wmPtr->sizeHintsFlags &= ~(PBaseSize|PResizeInc); @@ -3736,8 +3914,8 @@ WmGridCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmGroupCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm group" Tcl command. - * See the user documentation for details on what it does. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm group" Tcl command. See + * the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -3799,7 +3977,7 @@ WmGroupCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmIconbitmapCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm iconbitmap" Tcl command. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm iconbitmap" Tcl command. * See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: @@ -3827,17 +4005,23 @@ WmIconbitmapCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) Tcl_WrongNumArgs(interp, 2, objv, "window ?-default? ?image?"); return TCL_ERROR; } else if (objc == 5) { - /* If we have 5 arguments, we must have a '-default' flag */ + /* + * If we have 5 arguments, we must have a '-default' flag. + */ + char *argv3 = Tcl_GetString(objv[3]); + if (strcmp(argv3, "-default")) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "illegal option \"", - argv3, "\" must be \"-default\"", - (char *) NULL); + argv3, "\" must be \"-default\"", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } useWinPtr = NULL; } else if (objc == 3) { - /* No arguments were given */ + /* + * No arguments were given. + */ + if (wmPtr->hints.flags & IconPixmapHint) { Tcl_SetResult(interp, (char *) Tk_NameOfBitmap(winPtr->display, wmPtr->hints.icon_pixmap), @@ -3859,42 +4043,46 @@ WmIconbitmapCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) } else { /* * In the future this block of code will use Tk's 'image' - * functionality to allow all supported image formats. - * However, this will require a change to the way icons are - * handled. We will need to add icon<->image conversions - * routines. + * functionality to allow all supported image formats. However, this + * will require a change to the way icons are handled. We will need to + * add icon<->image conversions routines. * - * Until that happens we simply try to find an icon in the - * given argument, and if that fails, we use the older - * bitmap code. We do things this way round (icon then - * bitmap), because the bitmap code actually seems to have - * no visible effect, so we want to give the icon code the - * first try at doing something. + * Until that happens we simply try to find an icon in the given + * argument, and if that fails, we use the older bitmap code. We do + * things this way round (icon then bitmap), because the bitmap code + * actually seems to have no visible effect, so we want to give the + * icon code the first try at doing something. */ /* - * Either return NULL, or return a valid titlebaricon with its - * ref count already incremented. + * Either return NULL, or return a valid titlebaricon with its ref + * count already incremented. */ + WinIconPtr titlebaricon = ReadIconFromFile(interp, objv[objc-1]); if (titlebaricon != NULL) { /* - * Try to set the icon for the window. If it is a '-default' - * icon, we must pass in NULL + * Try to set the icon for the window. If it is a '-default' icon, + * we must pass in NULL */ + if (WinSetIcon(interp, titlebaricon, (Tk_Window) useWinPtr) != TCL_OK) { - /* We didn't use the titlebaricon after all */ + /* + * We didn't use the titlebaricon after all. + */ + DecrIconRefCount(titlebaricon); titlebaricon = NULL; } } if (titlebaricon == NULL) { /* - * We didn't manage to handle the argument as a valid - * icon. Try as a bitmap. First we must clear the - * error message which was placed in the interpreter + * We didn't manage to handle the argument as a valid icon. Try as + * a bitmap. First we must clear the error message which was + * placed in the interpreter. */ + Pixmap pixmap; Tcl_ResetResult(interp); pixmap = Tk_GetBitmap(interp, (Tk_Window) winPtr, string); @@ -3904,13 +4092,14 @@ WmIconbitmapCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) wmPtr->hints.icon_pixmap = pixmap; wmPtr->hints.flags |= IconPixmapHint; titlebaricon = GetIconFromPixmap(Tk_Display(winPtr), pixmap); - if (titlebaricon != NULL) { - if (WinSetIcon(interp, titlebaricon, (Tk_Window) useWinPtr) - != TCL_OK) { - /* We didn't use the titlebaricon after all */ - DecrIconRefCount(titlebaricon); - titlebaricon = NULL; - } + if (titlebaricon != NULL && WinSetIcon(interp, titlebaricon, + (Tk_Window) useWinPtr) != TCL_OK) { + /* + * We didn't use the titlebaricon after all. + */ + + DecrIconRefCount(titlebaricon); + titlebaricon = NULL; } } } @@ -3922,8 +4111,8 @@ WmIconbitmapCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmIconifyCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm iconify" Tcl command. - * See the user documentation for details on what it does. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm iconify" Tcl command. See + * the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -3950,24 +4139,23 @@ WmIconifyCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) if (winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED) { if(!SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_ICONIFY, 0, 0)) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't iconify ", winPtr->pathName, - ": the container does not support the request", (char *) NULL); + ": the container does not support the request", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } } if (Tk_Attributes((Tk_Window) winPtr)->override_redirect) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't iconify \"", winPtr->pathName, - "\": override-redirect flag is set", (char *) NULL); + "\": override-redirect flag is set", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } if (wmPtr->masterPtr != NULL) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't iconify \"", winPtr->pathName, - "\": it is a transient", (char *) NULL); + "\": it is a transient", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } if (wmPtr->iconFor != NULL) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't iconify ", winPtr->pathName, - ": it is an icon for ", Tk_PathName(wmPtr->iconFor), - (char *) NULL); + ": it is an icon for ", Tk_PathName(wmPtr->iconFor), NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } TkpWmSetState(winPtr, IconicState); @@ -3979,7 +4167,7 @@ WmIconifyCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmIconmaskCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm iconmask" Tcl command. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm iconmask" Tcl command. * See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: @@ -4037,7 +4225,7 @@ WmIconmaskCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmIconnameCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm iconname" Tcl command. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm iconname" Tcl command. * See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: @@ -4089,8 +4277,7 @@ WmIconnameCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmIconphotoCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm iconphoto" - * Tcl command. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm iconphoto" Tcl command. * See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: @@ -4124,9 +4311,11 @@ WmIconphotoCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) "window ?-default? image1 ?image2 ...?"); return TCL_ERROR; } + /* * Iterate over all images to validate their existence. */ + if (strcmp(Tcl_GetString(objv[3]), "-default") == 0) { useWinPtr = NULL; startObj = 4; @@ -4144,10 +4333,13 @@ WmIconphotoCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) return TCL_ERROR; } } - /* We have calculated the size of the data. Try to allocate the needed - * memory space. */ - size = sizeof(BlockOfIconImages) - + (sizeof(ICONIMAGE) * (objc - (startObj+1))); + + /* + * We have calculated the size of the data. Try to allocate the needed + * memory space. + */ + + size = sizeof(BlockOfIconImages) + (sizeof(ICONIMAGE) * (objc-startObj-1)); lpIR = (BlockOfIconImagesPtr) Tcl_AttemptAlloc(size); if (lpIR == NULL) { return TCL_ERROR; @@ -4163,13 +4355,17 @@ WmIconphotoCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) /* * Encode the image data into an HICON. */ + hIcon = CreateIcon(Tk_GetHINSTANCE(), width, height, 1, 32, NULL, (BYTE *) block.pixelPtr); if (hIcon == NULL) { - /* XXX should free up created icons */ + /* + * XXX should free up created icons. + */ + Tcl_Free((char *) lpIR); Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "failed to create icon for \"", - Tcl_GetString(objv[i]), "\"", (char *) NULL); + Tcl_GetString(objv[i]), "\"", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } lpIR->IconImages[i-startObj].Width = width; @@ -4181,7 +4377,10 @@ WmIconphotoCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) titlebaricon->iconBlock = lpIR; titlebaricon->refCount = 1; if (WinSetIcon(interp, titlebaricon, (Tk_Window) useWinPtr) != TCL_OK) { - /* We didn't use the titlebaricon after all */ + /* + * We didn't use the titlebaricon after all. + */ + DecrIconRefCount(titlebaricon); return TCL_ERROR; } @@ -4193,8 +4392,7 @@ WmIconphotoCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmIconpositionCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm iconposition" - * Tcl command. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm iconposition" Tcl command. * See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: @@ -4250,7 +4448,7 @@ WmIconpositionCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmIconwindowCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm iconwindow" Tcl command. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm iconwindow" Tcl command. * See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: @@ -4289,8 +4487,8 @@ WmIconwindowCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) wmPtr->hints.flags &= ~IconWindowHint; if (wmPtr->icon != NULL) { /* - * Let the window use button events again, then remove - * it as icon window. + * Let the window use button events again, then remove it as icon + * window. */ atts.event_mask = Tk_Attributes(wmPtr->icon)->event_mask @@ -4307,14 +4505,14 @@ WmIconwindowCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) } if (!Tk_IsTopLevel(tkwin2)) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't use ", Tcl_GetString(objv[3]), - " as icon window: not at top level", (char *) NULL); + " as icon window: not at top level", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } wmPtr2 = ((TkWindow *) tkwin2)->wmInfoPtr; if (wmPtr2->iconFor != NULL) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, Tcl_GetString(objv[3]), - " is already an icon for ", - Tk_PathName(wmPtr2->iconFor), (char *) NULL); + " is already an icon for ", Tk_PathName(wmPtr2->iconFor), + NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } if (wmPtr->icon != NULL) { @@ -4331,10 +4529,9 @@ WmIconwindowCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) } /* - * Disable button events in the icon window: some window - * managers (like olvwm) want to get the events themselves, - * but X only allows one application at a time to receive - * button events for a window. + * Disable button events in the icon window: some window managers + * (like olvwm) want to get the events themselves, but X only allows + * one application at a time to receive button events for a window. */ atts.event_mask = Tk_Attributes(tkwin2)->event_mask @@ -4358,8 +4555,8 @@ WmIconwindowCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmMaxsizeCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm maxsize" Tcl command. - * See the user documentation for details on what it does. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm maxsize" Tcl command. See + * the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -4408,8 +4605,8 @@ WmMaxsizeCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmMinsizeCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm minsize" Tcl command. - * See the user documentation for details on what it does. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm minsize" Tcl command. See + * the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -4458,9 +4655,8 @@ WmMinsizeCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmOverrideredirectCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm overrideredirect" - * Tcl command. - * See the user documentation for details on what it does. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm overrideredirect" Tcl + * command. See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -4508,12 +4704,13 @@ WmOverrideredirectCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_OVERRIDEREDIRECT, boolean, 0); } else { /* - * Only do this if we are really changing value, because it - * causes some funky stuff to occur + * Only do this if we are really changing value, because it causes + * some funky stuff to occur. */ + atts.override_redirect = (boolean) ? True : False; Tk_ChangeWindowAttributes((Tk_Window) winPtr, CWOverrideRedirect, - &atts); + &atts); if (!(wmPtr->flags & (WM_NEVER_MAPPED)) && !(winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED)) { UpdateWrapper(winPtr); @@ -4528,8 +4725,7 @@ WmOverrideredirectCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmPositionfromCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm positionfrom" - * Tcl command. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm positionfrom" Tcl command. * See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: @@ -4592,7 +4788,7 @@ WmPositionfromCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmProtocolCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm protocol" Tcl command. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm protocol" Tcl command. * See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: @@ -4626,6 +4822,7 @@ WmProtocolCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) /* * Return a list of all defined protocols for the window. */ + for (protPtr = wmPtr->protPtr; protPtr != NULL; protPtr = protPtr->nextPtr) { Tcl_AppendElement(interp, @@ -4638,6 +4835,7 @@ WmProtocolCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) /* * Return the command to handle a given protocol. */ + for (protPtr = wmPtr->protPtr; protPtr != NULL; protPtr = protPtr->nextPtr) { if (protPtr->protocol == protocol) { @@ -4649,13 +4847,12 @@ WmProtocolCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) } /* - * Delete any current protocol handler, then create a new - * one with the specified command, unless the command is - * empty. + * Delete any current protocol handler, then create a new one with the + * specified command, unless the command is empty. */ for (protPtr = wmPtr->protPtr, prevPtr = NULL; protPtr != NULL; - prevPtr = protPtr, protPtr = protPtr->nextPtr) { + prevPtr = protPtr, protPtr = protPtr->nextPtr) { if (protPtr->protocol == protocol) { if (prevPtr == NULL) { wmPtr->protPtr = protPtr->nextPtr; @@ -4683,7 +4880,7 @@ WmProtocolCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmResizableCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm resizable" Tcl command. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm resizable" Tcl command. * See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: @@ -4746,7 +4943,7 @@ WmResizableCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmSizefromCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm sizefrom" Tcl command. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm sizefrom" Tcl command. * See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: @@ -4768,9 +4965,11 @@ WmSizefromCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) { register WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; static CONST char *optionStrings[] = { - "program", "user", (char *) NULL }; + "program", "user", NULL + }; enum options { - OPT_PROGRAM, OPT_USER }; + OPT_PROGRAM, OPT_USER + }; int index; if ((objc != 3) && (objc != 4)) { @@ -4810,7 +5009,7 @@ WmSizefromCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmStackorderCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm stackorder" Tcl command. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm stackorder" Tcl command. * See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: @@ -4864,33 +5063,31 @@ WmStackorderCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) if (!Tk_IsTopLevel(winPtr2)) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "window \"", winPtr2->pathName, - "\" isn't a top-level window", (char *) NULL); + "\" isn't a top-level window", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } if (!Tk_IsMapped(winPtr)) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "window \"", winPtr->pathName, - "\" isn't mapped", (char *) NULL); + "\" isn't mapped", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } if (!Tk_IsMapped(winPtr2)) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "window \"", winPtr2->pathName, - "\" isn't mapped", (char *) NULL); + "\" isn't mapped", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } /* - * Lookup stacking order of all toplevels that are children - * of "." and find the position of winPtr and winPtr2 - * in the stacking order. + * Lookup stacking order of all toplevels that are children of "." and + * find the position of winPtr and winPtr2 in the stacking order. */ windows = TkWmStackorderToplevel(winPtr->mainPtr->winPtr); if (windows == NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "TkWmStackorderToplevel failed", - (char *) NULL); + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "TkWmStackorderToplevel failed", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } else { for (window_ptr = windows; *window_ptr ; window_ptr++) { @@ -4927,8 +5124,8 @@ WmStackorderCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmStateCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm state" Tcl command. - * See the user documentation for details on what it does. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm state" Tcl command. See + * the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -4961,9 +5158,8 @@ WmStateCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) if (objc == 4) { if (wmPtr->iconFor != NULL) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't change state of ", - Tcl_GetString(objv[2]), - ": it is an icon for ", Tk_PathName(wmPtr->iconFor), - (char *) NULL); + Tcl_GetString(objv[2]), ": it is an icon for ", + Tk_PathName(wmPtr->iconFor), NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } if (Tcl_GetIndexFromObj(interp, objv[3], optionStrings, "argument", 0, @@ -4979,19 +5175,16 @@ WmStateCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) if (winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED) { int state; switch(index) { - case OPT_NORMAL: + case OPT_NORMAL: state = NormalState; break; - - case OPT_ICONIC: + case OPT_ICONIC: state = IconicState; break; - - case OPT_WITHDRAWN: + case OPT_WITHDRAWN: state = WithdrawnState; break; - - case OPT_ZOOMED: + case OPT_ZOOMED: state = ZoomState; break; } @@ -5008,22 +5201,21 @@ WmStateCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) if (index == OPT_NORMAL) { wmPtr->flags &= ~WM_WITHDRAWN; TkpWmSetState(winPtr, NormalState); + /* - * This varies from 'wm deiconify' because it does not - * force the window to be raised and receive focus + * This varies from 'wm deiconify' because it does not force the + * window to be raised and receive focus. */ } else if (index == OPT_ICONIC) { if (Tk_Attributes((Tk_Window) winPtr)->override_redirect) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't iconify \"", - winPtr->pathName, - "\": override-redirect flag is set", - (char *) NULL); + winPtr->pathName, "\": override-redirect flag is set", + NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } if (wmPtr->masterPtr != NULL) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't iconify \"", - winPtr->pathName, - "\": it is a transient", (char *) NULL); + winPtr->pathName, "\": it is a transient", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } TkpWmSetState(winPtr, IconicState); @@ -5040,21 +5232,23 @@ WmStateCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) Tcl_SetResult(interp, "icon", TCL_STATIC); } else { int state; - if(winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED) + + if (winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED) { state = SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_STATE, -1, -1)-1; - else + } else { state = wmPtr->hints.initial_state; + } switch (state) { - case NormalState: + case NormalState: Tcl_SetResult(interp, "normal", TCL_STATIC); break; - case IconicState: + case IconicState: Tcl_SetResult(interp, "iconic", TCL_STATIC); break; - case WithdrawnState: + case WithdrawnState: Tcl_SetResult(interp, "withdrawn", TCL_STATIC); break; - case ZoomState: + case ZoomState: Tcl_SetResult(interp, "zoomed", TCL_STATIC); break; } @@ -5068,8 +5262,8 @@ WmStateCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmTitleCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm title" Tcl command. - * See the user documentation for details on what it does. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm title" Tcl command. See + * the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: * A standard Tcl result. @@ -5104,18 +5298,18 @@ WmTitleCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) wrapper = wmPtr->wrapper; } if (objc == 3) { - if(wrapper) { + if (wrapper) { char buf[512]; Tcl_DString titleString; int size = tkWinProcs->useWide? 256:512; (*tkWinProcs->getWindowText)(wrapper, (LPCTSTR)buf, size); - Tcl_WinTCharToUtf(buf, -1, &titleString); - Tcl_SetResult(interp, Tcl_DStringValue(&titleString), TCL_VOLATILE); + Tcl_WinTCharToUtf(buf, -1, &titleString); + Tcl_SetResult(interp, Tcl_DStringValue(&titleString),TCL_VOLATILE); Tcl_DStringFree(&titleString); } else { Tcl_SetResult(interp, (char *) - ((wmPtr->title != NULL) ? wmPtr->title : winPtr->nameUid), - TCL_STATIC); + ((wmPtr->title != NULL) ? wmPtr->title : winPtr->nameUid), + TCL_STATIC); } } else { if (wmPtr->title != NULL) { @@ -5129,7 +5323,7 @@ WmTitleCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) Tcl_DString titleString; Tcl_WinUtfToTChar(wmPtr->title, -1, &titleString); (*tkWinProcs->setWindowText)(wrapper, - (LPCTSTR) Tcl_DStringValue(&titleString)); + (LPCTSTR) Tcl_DStringValue(&titleString)); Tcl_DStringFree(&titleString); } } @@ -5141,7 +5335,7 @@ WmTitleCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmTransientCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm transient" Tcl command. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm transient" Tcl command. * See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: @@ -5178,8 +5372,8 @@ WmTransientCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) if (Tcl_GetString(objv[3])[0] == '\0') { if (masterPtr != NULL) { /* - * If we had a master, tell them that we aren't tied - * to them anymore + * If we had a master, tell them that we aren't tied to them + * anymore. */ masterPtr->wmInfoPtr->numTransients--; @@ -5204,35 +5398,30 @@ WmTransientCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) Tk_MakeWindowExist((Tk_Window) masterPtr); if (wmPtr->iconFor != NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't make \"", - Tcl_GetString(objv[2]), + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't make \"", Tcl_GetString(objv[2]), "\" a transient: it is an icon for ", - Tk_PathName(wmPtr->iconFor), - (char *) NULL); + Tk_PathName(wmPtr->iconFor), NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } wmPtr2 = masterPtr->wmInfoPtr; if (wmPtr2->iconFor != NULL) { - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't make \"", - Tcl_GetString(objv[3]), + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't make \"", Tcl_GetString(objv[3]), "\" a master: it is an icon for ", - Tk_PathName(wmPtr2->iconFor), - (char *) NULL); + Tk_PathName(wmPtr2->iconFor), NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } if (masterPtr == winPtr) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't make \"", Tk_PathName(winPtr), - "\" its own master", - (char *) NULL); + "\" its own master", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } else if (masterPtr != wmPtr->masterPtr) { /* - * Remove old master map/unmap binding before setting - * the new master. The event handler will ensure that - * transient states reflect the state of the master. + * Remove old master map/unmap binding before setting the new + * master. The event handler will ensure that transient states + * reflect the state of the master. */ if (wmPtr->masterPtr != NULL) { @@ -5267,7 +5456,7 @@ WmTransientCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) * * WmWithdrawCmd -- * - * This procedure is invoked to process the "wm withdraw" Tcl command. + * This function is invoked to process the "wm withdraw" Tcl command. * See the user documentation for details on what it does. * * Results: @@ -5295,15 +5484,14 @@ WmWithdrawCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) } if (wmPtr->iconFor != NULL) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't withdraw ", Tcl_GetString(objv[2]), - ": it is an icon for ", Tk_PathName(wmPtr->iconFor), - (char *) NULL); + ": it is an icon for ", Tk_PathName(wmPtr->iconFor), NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } - if(winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED) { - if(SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_WITHDRAW, 0, 0) < 0) { + if (winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED) { + if (SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_WITHDRAW, 0, 0) < 0) { Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "can't withdraw", Tcl_GetString(objv[2]), - ": the container does not support the request", NULL); + ": the container does not support the request", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } } else { @@ -5314,13 +5502,14 @@ WmWithdrawCmd(tkwin, winPtr, interp, objc, objv) } /* - * Invoked by those wm subcommands that affect geometry. - * Schedules a geometry update. + * Invoked by those wm subcommands that affect geometry. Schedules a geometry + * update. */ + static void -WmUpdateGeom(wmPtr, winPtr) - WmInfo *wmPtr; - TkWindow *winPtr; +WmUpdateGeom( + WmInfo *wmPtr, + TkWindow *winPtr) { if (!(wmPtr->flags & (WM_UPDATE_PENDING|WM_NEVER_MAPPED))) { Tcl_DoWhenIdle(UpdateGeometryInfo, (ClientData) winPtr); @@ -5330,9 +5519,9 @@ WmUpdateGeom(wmPtr, winPtr) /*ARGSUSED*/ static void -WmWaitVisibilityOrMapProc(clientData, eventPtr) - ClientData clientData; /* Pointer to window. */ - XEvent *eventPtr; /* Information about event. */ +WmWaitVisibilityOrMapProc( + ClientData clientData, /* Pointer to window. */ + XEvent *eventPtr) /* Information about event. */ { TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) clientData; TkWindow *masterPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr->masterPtr; @@ -5364,34 +5553,34 @@ WmWaitVisibilityOrMapProc(clientData, eventPtr) * * Tk_SetGrid -- * - * This procedure is invoked by a widget when it wishes to set a grid - * coordinate system that controls the size of a top-level window. - * It provides a C interface equivalent to the "wm grid" command and - * is usually asscoiated with the -setgrid option. + * This function is invoked by a widget when it wishes to set a grid + * coordinate system that controls the size of a top-level window. It + * provides a C interface equivalent to the "wm grid" command and is + * usually asscoiated with the -setgrid option. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * Grid-related information will be passed to the window manager, so - * that the top-level window associated with tkwin will resize on - * even grid units. If some other window already controls gridding - * for the top-level window then this procedure call has no effect. + * Grid-related information will be passed to the window manager, so that + * the top-level window associated with tkwin will resize on even grid + * units. If some other window already controls gridding for the + * top-level window then this function call has no effect. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -Tk_SetGrid(tkwin, reqWidth, reqHeight, widthInc, heightInc) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Token for window. New window mgr info - * will be posted for the top-level window +Tk_SetGrid( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Token for window. New window mgr info will + * be posted for the top-level window * associated with this window. */ - int reqWidth; /* Width (in grid units) corresponding to - * the requested geometry for tkwin. */ - int reqHeight; /* Height (in grid units) corresponding to - * the requested geometry for tkwin. */ - int widthInc, heightInc; /* Pixel increments corresponding to a - * change of one grid unit. */ + int reqWidth, /* Width (in grid units) corresponding to the + * requested geometry for tkwin. */ + int reqHeight, /* Height (in grid units) corresponding to the + * requested geometry for tkwin. */ + int widthInc, int heightInc)/* Pixel increments corresponding to a change + * of one grid unit. */ { TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) tkwin; register WmInfo *wmPtr; @@ -5399,6 +5588,7 @@ Tk_SetGrid(tkwin, reqWidth, reqHeight, widthInc, heightInc) /* * Ensure widthInc and heightInc are greater than 0 */ + if (widthInc <= 0) { widthInc = 1; } @@ -5406,7 +5596,6 @@ Tk_SetGrid(tkwin, reqWidth, reqHeight, widthInc, heightInc) heightInc = 1; } - /* * Find the top-level window for tkwin, plus the window manager * information. @@ -5434,15 +5623,15 @@ Tk_SetGrid(tkwin, reqWidth, reqHeight, widthInc, heightInc) } /* - * If gridding was previously off, then forget about any window - * size requests made by the user or via "wm geometry": these are - * in pixel units and there's no easy way to translate them to - * grid units since the new requested size of the top-level window in - * pixels may not yet have been registered yet (it may filter up - * the hierarchy in DoWhenIdle handlers). However, if the window - * has never been mapped yet then just leave the window size alone: - * assume that it is intended to be in grid units but just happened - * to have been specified before this procedure was called. + * If gridding was previously off, then forget about any window size + * requests made by the user or via "wm geometry": these are in pixel + * units and there's no easy way to translate them to grid units since the + * new requested size of the top-level window in pixels may not yet have + * been registered yet (it may filter up the hierarchy in DoWhenIdle + * handlers). However, if the window has never been mapped yet then just + * leave the window size alone: assume that it is intended to be in grid + * units but just happened to have been specified before this function was + * called. */ if ((wmPtr->gridWin == NULL) && !(wmPtr->flags & WM_NEVER_MAPPED)) { @@ -5451,8 +5640,8 @@ Tk_SetGrid(tkwin, reqWidth, reqHeight, widthInc, heightInc) } /* - * Set the new gridding information, and start the process of passing - * all of this information to the window manager. + * Set the new gridding information, and start the process of passing all + * of this information to the window manager. */ wmPtr->gridWin = tkwin; @@ -5472,23 +5661,22 @@ Tk_SetGrid(tkwin, reqWidth, reqHeight, widthInc, heightInc) * * Tk_UnsetGrid -- * - * This procedure cancels the effect of a previous call - * to Tk_SetGrid. + * This function cancels the effect of a previous call to Tk_SetGrid. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: * If tkwin currently controls gridding for its top-level window, - * gridding is cancelled for that top-level window; if some other - * window controls gridding then this procedure has no effect. + * gridding is cancelled for that top-level window; if some other window + * controls gridding then this function has no effect. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -Tk_UnsetGrid(tkwin) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Token for window that is currently +Tk_UnsetGrid( + Tk_Window tkwin) /* Token for window that is currently * controlling gridding. */ { TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) tkwin; @@ -5533,23 +5721,23 @@ Tk_UnsetGrid(tkwin) * * TopLevelEventProc -- * - * This procedure is invoked when a top-level (or other externally- - * managed window) is restructured in any way. + * This function is invoked when a top-level (or other externally-managed + * window) is restructured in any way. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * Tk's internal data structures for the window get modified to - * reflect the structural change. + * Tk's internal data structures for the window get modified to reflect + * the structural change. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void -TopLevelEventProc(clientData, eventPtr) - ClientData clientData; /* Window for which event occurred. */ - XEvent *eventPtr; /* Event that just happened. */ +TopLevelEventProc( + ClientData clientData, /* Window for which event occurred. */ + XEvent *eventPtr) /* Event that just happened. */ { register TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) clientData; @@ -5559,8 +5747,8 @@ TopLevelEventProc(clientData, eventPtr) if (!(winPtr->flags & TK_ALREADY_DEAD)) { /* * A top-level window was deleted externally (e.g., by the window - * manager). This is probably not a good thing, but cleanup as - * best we can. The error handler is needed because + * manager). This is probably not a good thing, but cleanup as + * best we can. The error handler is needed because * Tk_DestroyWindow will try to destroy the window, but of course * it's already gone. */ @@ -5578,24 +5766,24 @@ TopLevelEventProc(clientData, eventPtr) * * TopLevelReqProc -- * - * This procedure is invoked by the geometry manager whenever - * the requested size for a top-level window is changed. + * This function is invoked by the geometry manager whenever the + * requested size for a top-level window is changed. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * Arrange for the window to be resized to satisfy the request - * (this happens as a when-idle action). + * Arrange for the window to be resized to satisfy the request (this + * happens as a when-idle action). * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ /* ARGSUSED */ static void -TopLevelReqProc(dummy, tkwin) - ClientData dummy; /* Not used. */ - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Information about window. */ +TopLevelReqProc( + ClientData dummy, /* Not used. */ + Tk_Window tkwin) /* Information about window. */ { TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) tkwin; WmInfo *wmPtr; @@ -5616,26 +5804,25 @@ TopLevelReqProc(dummy, tkwin) * * UpdateGeometryInfo -- * - * This procedure is invoked when a top-level window is first - * mapped, and also as a when-idle procedure, to bring the - * geometry and/or position of a top-level window back into - * line with what has been requested by the user and/or widgets. - * This procedure doesn't return until the system has + * This function is invoked when a top-level window is first mapped, and + * also as a when-idle function, to bring the geometry and/or position of + * a top-level window back into line with what has been requested by the + * user and/or widgets. This function doesn't return until the system has * responded to the geometry change. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * The window's size and location may change, unless the WM prevents - * that from happening. + * The window's size and location may change, unless the WM prevents that + * from happening. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void -UpdateGeometryInfo(clientData) - ClientData clientData; /* Pointer to the window's record. */ +UpdateGeometryInfo( + ClientData clientData) /* Pointer to the window's record. */ { int x, y; /* Position of border on desktop. */ int width, height; /* Size of client area. */ @@ -5647,10 +5834,10 @@ UpdateGeometryInfo(clientData) wmPtr->flags &= ~WM_UPDATE_PENDING; /* - * If the window is minimized or maximized, we should not update - * our geometry since it will end up with the wrong values. - * ConfigureToplevel will reschedule UpdateGeometryInfo when the - * state of the window changes. + * If the window is minimized or maximized, we should not update our + * geometry since it will end up with the wrong values. ConfigureToplevel + * will reschedule UpdateGeometryInfo when the state of the window + * changes. */ if (wmPtr->wrapper && (IsIconic(wmPtr->wrapper) || @@ -5659,12 +5846,11 @@ UpdateGeometryInfo(clientData) } /* - * Compute the border size for the current window style. This - * size will include the resize handles, the title bar and the - * menubar. Note that this size will not be correct if the - * menubar spans multiple lines. The height will be off by a - * multiple of the menubar height. It really only measures the - * minimum size of the border. + * Compute the border size for the current window style. This size will + * include the resize handles, the title bar and the menubar. Note that + * this size will not be correct if the menubar spans multiple lines. The + * height will be off by a multiple of the menubar height. It really only + * measures the minimum size of the border. */ rect.left = rect.right = rect.top = rect.bottom = 0; @@ -5674,15 +5860,13 @@ UpdateGeometryInfo(clientData) wmPtr->borderHeight = rect.bottom - rect.top; /* - * Compute the new size for the top-level window. See the - * user documentation for details on this, but the size - * requested depends on (a) the size requested internally - * by the window's widgets, (b) the size requested by the - * user in a "wm geometry" command or via wm-based interactive - * resizing (if any), (c) whether or not the window is - * gridded, and (d) the current min or max size for - * the toplevel. Don't permit sizes <= 0 because this upsets - * the X server. + * Compute the new size for the top-level window. See the user + * documentation for details on this, but the size requested depends on + * (a) the size requested internally by the window's widgets, (b) the size + * requested by the user in a "wm geometry" command or via wm-based + * interactive resizing (if any), (c) whether or not the window is + * gridded, and (d) the current min or max size for the toplevel. Don't + * permit sizes <= 0 because this upsets the X server. */ if (wmPtr->width == -1) { @@ -5696,9 +5880,11 @@ UpdateGeometryInfo(clientData) if (width <= 0) { width = 1; } + /* * Account for window max/min width */ + if (wmPtr->gridWin != NULL) { min = winPtr->reqWidth + (wmPtr->minWidth - wmPtr->reqGridWidth)*wmPtr->widthInc; @@ -5729,9 +5915,11 @@ UpdateGeometryInfo(clientData) if (height <= 0) { height = 1; } + /* * Account for window max/min height */ + if (wmPtr->gridWin != NULL) { min = winPtr->reqHeight + (wmPtr->minHeight - wmPtr->reqGridHeight)*wmPtr->heightInc; @@ -5753,10 +5941,10 @@ UpdateGeometryInfo(clientData) /* * Compute the new position for the upper-left pixel of the window's - * decorative frame. This is tricky, because we need to include the - * border widths supplied by a reparented parent in this calculation, - * but can't use the parent's current overall size since that may - * change as a result of this code. + * decorative frame. This is tricky, because we need to include the border + * widths supplied by a reparented parent in this calculation, but can't + * use the parent's current overall size since that may change as a result + * of this code. */ if (wmPtr->flags & WM_NEGATIVE_X) { @@ -5773,11 +5961,12 @@ UpdateGeometryInfo(clientData) } /* - * Reconfigure the window if it isn't already configured correctly. Base + * Reconfigure the window if it isn't already configured correctly. Base * the size check on what we *asked for* last time, not what we got. * Return immediately if there have been no changes in the requested * geometry of the toplevel. */ + /* TODO: need to add flag for possible menu size change */ if (!((wmPtr->flags & WM_MOVE_PENDING) @@ -5791,9 +5980,8 @@ UpdateGeometryInfo(clientData) wmPtr->configHeight = height; /* - * Don't bother moving the window if we are in the process of - * creating it. Just update the geometry info based on what - * we asked for. + * Don't bother moving the window if we are in the process of creating it. + * Just update the geometry info based on what we asked for. */ if (wmPtr->flags & WM_CREATE_PENDING) { @@ -5807,11 +5995,12 @@ UpdateGeometryInfo(clientData) wmPtr->flags |= WM_SYNC_PENDING; if (winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED) { /* - * The wrapper window is in a different process, so we need - * to send it a geometry request. This protocol assumes that - * the other process understands this Tk message, otherwise - * our requested geometry will be ignored. + * The wrapper window is in a different process, so we need to send it + * a geometry request. This protocol assumes that the other process + * understands this Tk message, otherwise our requested geometry will + * be ignored. */ + SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_MOVEWINDOW, x, y); SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_GEOMETRYREQ, width, height); } else { @@ -5821,15 +6010,13 @@ UpdateGeometryInfo(clientData) int newHeight; /* - * We have to keep resizing the window until we get the - * requested height in the client area. If the client - * area has zero height, then the window rect is too - * small by definition. Try increasing the border height - * and try again. Once we have a positive size, then - * we can adjust the height exactly. If the window - * rect comes back smaller than we requested, we have - * hit the maximum constraints that Windows imposes. - * Once we find a positive client size, the next size + * We have to keep resizing the window until we get the requested + * height in the client area. If the client area has zero height, then + * the window rect is too small by definition. Try increasing the + * border height and try again. Once we have a positive size, then we + * can adjust the height exactly. If the window rect comes back + * smaller than we requested, we have hit the maximum constraints that + * Windows imposes. Once we find a positive client size, the next size * is the one we try no matter what. */ @@ -5861,11 +6048,13 @@ UpdateGeometryInfo(clientData) /* * We're done. */ + break; } else if (newHeight > height) { /* * One last resize to get rid of the extra space. */ + menuInc = newHeight - height; reqHeight -= menuInc; if (wmPtr->flags & WM_NEGATIVE_Y) { @@ -5876,11 +6065,10 @@ UpdateGeometryInfo(clientData) } /* - * We didn't get enough space to satisfy our requested - * height, so the menu must have wrapped. Increase the - * size of the window by one menu height and move the - * window if it is positioned relative to the lower right - * corner of the screen. + * We didn't get enough space to satisfy our requested height, so + * the menu must have wrapped. Increase the size of the window by + * one menu height and move the window if it is positioned + * relative to the lower right corner of the screen. */ reqHeight += menuInc; @@ -5900,13 +6088,12 @@ UpdateGeometryInfo(clientData) * * ParseGeometry -- * - * This procedure parses a geometry string and updates - * information used to control the geometry of a top-level - * window. + * This function parses a geometry string and updates information used to + * control the geometry of a top-level window. * * Results: - * A standard Tcl return value, plus an error message in - * the interp's result if an error occurs. + * A standard Tcl return value, plus an error message in the interp's + * result if an error occurs. * * Side effects: * The size and/or location of winPtr may change. @@ -5915,12 +6102,12 @@ UpdateGeometryInfo(clientData) */ static int -ParseGeometry(interp, string, winPtr) - Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Used for error reporting. */ - char *string; /* String containing new geometry. Has the +ParseGeometry( + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Used for error reporting. */ + char *string, /* String containing new geometry. Has the * standard form "=wxh+x+y". */ - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Pointer to top-level window whose - * geometry is to be changed. */ + TkWindow *winPtr) /* Pointer to top-level window whose geometry + * is to be changed. */ { register WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; int x, y, width, height, flags; @@ -5936,9 +6123,9 @@ ParseGeometry(interp, string, winPtr) } /* - * Parse the width and height, if they are present. Don't - * actually update any of the fields of wmPtr until we've - * successfully parsed the entire geometry string. + * Parse the width and height, if they are present. Don't actually update + * any of the fields of wmPtr until we've successfully parsed the entire + * geometry string. */ width = wmPtr->width; @@ -5992,10 +6179,10 @@ ParseGeometry(interp, string, winPtr) } /* - * Assume that the geometry information came from the user, - * unless an explicit source has been specified. Otherwise - * most window managers assume that the size hints were - * program-specified and they ignore them. + * Assume that the geometry information came from the user, unless an + * explicit source has been specified. Otherwise most window managers + * assume that the size hints were program-specified and they ignore + * them. */ if ((wmPtr->sizeHintsFlags & (USPosition|PPosition)) == 0) { @@ -6004,9 +6191,9 @@ ParseGeometry(interp, string, winPtr) } /* - * Everything was parsed OK. Update the fields of *wmPtr and - * arrange for the appropriate information to be percolated out - * to the window manager at the next idle moment. + * Everything was parsed OK. Update the fields of *wmPtr and arrange for + * the appropriate information to be percolated out to the window manager + * at the next idle moment. */ wmPtr->width = width; @@ -6022,9 +6209,8 @@ ParseGeometry(interp, string, winPtr) } return TCL_OK; - error: - Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad geometry specifier \"", - string, "\"", (char *) NULL); + error: + Tcl_AppendResult(interp, "bad geometry specifier \"", string, "\"", NULL); return TCL_ERROR; } @@ -6033,13 +6219,13 @@ ParseGeometry(interp, string, winPtr) * * Tk_GetRootCoords -- * - * Given a token for a window, this procedure traces through the - * window's lineage to find the (virtual) root-window coordinates - * corresponding to point (0,0) in the window. + * Given a token for a window, this function traces through the window's + * lineage to find the (virtual) root-window coordinates corresponding to + * point (0,0) in the window. * * Results: - * The locations pointed to by xPtr and yPtr are filled in with - * the root coordinates of the (0,0) point in tkwin. + * The locations pointed to by xPtr and yPtr are filled in with the root + * coordinates of the (0,0) point in tkwin. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -6048,10 +6234,10 @@ ParseGeometry(interp, string, winPtr) */ void -Tk_GetRootCoords(tkwin, xPtr, yPtr) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Token for window. */ - int *xPtr; /* Where to store x-displacement of (0,0). */ - int *yPtr; /* Where to store y-displacement of (0,0). */ +Tk_GetRootCoords( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Token for window. */ + int *xPtr, /* Where to store x-displacement of (0,0). */ + int *yPtr) /* Where to store y-displacement of (0,0). */ { register TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) tkwin; @@ -6081,13 +6267,13 @@ Tk_GetRootCoords(tkwin, xPtr, yPtr) * * Tk_CoordsToWindow -- * - * Given the (virtual) root coordinates of a point, this procedure - * returns the token for the top-most window covering that point, - * if there exists such a window in this application. + * Given the (virtual) root coordinates of a point, this function returns + * the token for the top-most window covering that point, if there exists + * such a window in this application. * * Results: - * The return result is either a token for the window corresponding - * to rootX and rootY, or else NULL to indicate that there is no such + * The return result is either a token for the window corresponding to + * rootX and rootY, or else NULL to indicate that there is no such * window. * * Side effects: @@ -6097,13 +6283,13 @@ Tk_GetRootCoords(tkwin, xPtr, yPtr) */ Tk_Window -Tk_CoordsToWindow(rootX, rootY, tkwin) - int rootX, rootY; /* Coordinates of point in root window. If - * a virtual-root window manager is in use, +Tk_CoordsToWindow( + int rootX, int rootY, /* Coordinates of point in root window. If a + * virtual-root window manager is in use, * these coordinates refer to the virtual * root, not the real root. */ - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Token for any window in application; - * used to identify the display. */ + Tk_Window tkwin) /* Token for any window in application; used + * to identify the display. */ { POINT pos; HWND hwnd; @@ -6125,16 +6311,15 @@ Tk_CoordsToWindow(rootX, rootY, tkwin) * * Tk_GetVRootGeometry -- * - * This procedure returns information about the virtual root - * window corresponding to a particular Tk window. + * This function returns information about the virtual root window + * corresponding to a particular Tk window. * * Results: - * The values at xPtr, yPtr, widthPtr, and heightPtr are set - * with the offset and dimensions of the root window corresponding - * to tkwin. If tkwin is being managed by a virtual root window - * manager these values correspond to the virtual root window being - * used for tkwin; otherwise the offsets will be 0 and the - * dimensions will be those of the screen. + * The values at xPtr, yPtr, widthPtr, and heightPtr are set with the + * offset and dimensions of the root window corresponding to tkwin. If + * tkwin is being managed by a virtual root window manager these values + * correspond to the virtual root window being used for tkwin; otherwise + * the offsets will be 0 and the dimensions will be those of the screen. * * Side effects: * Vroot window information is refreshed if it is out of date. @@ -6143,22 +6328,24 @@ Tk_CoordsToWindow(rootX, rootY, tkwin) */ void -Tk_GetVRootGeometry(tkwin, xPtr, yPtr, widthPtr, heightPtr) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Window whose virtual root is to be +Tk_GetVRootGeometry( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Window whose virtual root is to be * queried. */ - int *xPtr, *yPtr; /* Store x and y offsets of virtual root + int *xPtr, int *yPtr, /* Store x and y offsets of virtual root * here. */ - int *widthPtr, *heightPtr; /* Store dimensions of virtual root here. */ + int *widthPtr, int *heightPtr) + /* Store dimensions of virtual root here. */ { TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) tkwin; /* - * XXX: This is not correct for multiple monitors. There may be many + * XXX: This is not correct for multiple monitors. There may be many * changes required to get this right, and it may effect existing - * applications that don't consider possible <0 vroot. See - * http://msdn.microsoft.com/library/en-us/gdi/monitor_3lrn.asp - * for more info. + * applications that don't consider possible <0 vroot. See + * http://msdn.microsoft.com/library/en-us/gdi/monitor_3lrn.asp for more + * info. */ + *xPtr = 0; *yPtr = 0; *widthPtr = DisplayWidth(winPtr->display, winPtr->screenNum); @@ -6170,27 +6357,25 @@ Tk_GetVRootGeometry(tkwin, xPtr, yPtr, widthPtr, heightPtr) * * Tk_MoveToplevelWindow -- * - * This procedure is called instead of Tk_MoveWindow to adjust - * the x-y location of a top-level window. It delays the actual - * move to a later time and keeps window-manager information - * up-to-date with the move + * This function is called instead of Tk_MoveWindow to adjust the x-y + * location of a top-level window. It delays the actual move to a later + * time and keeps window-manager information up-to-date with the move * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: * The window is eventually moved so that its upper-left corner - * (actually, the upper-left corner of the window's decorative - * frame, if there is one) is at (x,y). + * (actually, the upper-left corner of the window's decorative frame, if + * there is one) is at (x,y). * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -Tk_MoveToplevelWindow(tkwin, x, y) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Window to move. */ - int x, y; /* New location for window (within - * parent). */ +Tk_MoveToplevelWindow( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* Window to move. */ + int x, int y) /* New location for window (within parent). */ { TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) tkwin; register WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; @@ -6208,9 +6393,8 @@ Tk_MoveToplevelWindow(tkwin, x, y) /* * If the window has already been mapped, must bring its geometry - * up-to-date immediately, otherwise an event might arrive from the - * server that would overwrite wmPtr->x and wmPtr->y and lose the - * new position. + * up-to-date immediately, otherwise an event might arrive from the server + * that would overwrite wmPtr->x and wmPtr->y and lose the new position. */ if (!(wmPtr->flags & WM_NEVER_MAPPED)) { @@ -6226,25 +6410,23 @@ Tk_MoveToplevelWindow(tkwin, x, y) * * TkWmProtocolEventProc -- * - * This procedure is called by the Tk_HandleEvent whenever a - * ClientMessage event arrives whose type is "WM_PROTOCOLS". - * This procedure handles the message from the window manager - * in an appropriate fashion. + * This function is called by the Tk_HandleEvent whenever a ClientMessage + * event arrives whose type is "WM_PROTOCOLS". This function handles the + * message from the window manager in an appropriate fashion. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * Depends on what sort of handler, if any, was set up for the - * protocol. + * Depends on what sort of handler, if any, was set up for the protocol. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -TkWmProtocolEventProc(winPtr, eventPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Window to which the event was sent. */ - XEvent *eventPtr; /* X event. */ +TkWmProtocolEventProc( + TkWindow *winPtr, /* Window to which the event was sent. */ + XEvent *eventPtr) /* X event. */ { WmInfo *wmPtr; register ProtocolHandler *protPtr; @@ -6261,9 +6443,10 @@ TkWmProtocolEventProc(winPtr, eventPtr) protPtr = protPtr->nextPtr) { if (protocol == protPtr->protocol) { /* - * Cache atom name, as we might destroy the window as a - * result of the eval. + * Cache atom name, as we might destroy the window as a result of + * the eval. */ + CONST char *name = Tk_GetAtomName((Tk_Window) winPtr, protocol); Tcl_Preserve((ClientData) protPtr); @@ -6283,8 +6466,8 @@ TkWmProtocolEventProc(winPtr, eventPtr) } /* - * No handler was present for this protocol. If this is a - * WM_DELETE_WINDOW message then just destroy the window. + * No handler was present for this protocol. If this is a WM_DELETE_WINDOW + * message then just destroy the window. */ if (protocol == Tk_InternAtom((Tk_Window) winPtr, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW")) { @@ -6297,9 +6480,8 @@ TkWmProtocolEventProc(winPtr, eventPtr) * * TkWmStackorderToplevelEnumProc -- * - * This procedure is invoked once for each HWND Window on the - * display as a result of calling EnumWindows from - * TkWmStackorderToplevel. + * This function is invoked once for each HWND Window on the display as a + * result of calling EnumWindows from TkWmStackorderToplevel. * * Results: * TRUE to request further iteration. @@ -6310,9 +6492,10 @@ TkWmProtocolEventProc(winPtr, eventPtr) *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -BOOL CALLBACK TkWmStackorderToplevelEnumProc(hwnd, lParam) - HWND hwnd; /* handle to parent window */ - LPARAM lParam; /* application-defined value */ +BOOL CALLBACK +TkWmStackorderToplevelEnumProc( + HWND hwnd, /* Handle to parent window */ + LPARAM lParam) /* Application-defined value */ { Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr; TkWindow *childWinPtr; @@ -6325,7 +6508,11 @@ BOOL CALLBACK TkWmStackorderToplevelEnumProc(hwnd, lParam) hPtr = Tcl_FindHashEntry(pair->table, (char *) hwnd); if (hPtr != NULL) { childWinPtr = (TkWindow *) Tcl_GetHashValue(hPtr); - /* Double check that same HWND does not get passed twice */ + + /* + * Double check that same HWND does not get passed twice. + */ + if (childWinPtr == NULL) { Tcl_Panic("duplicate HWND in TkWmStackorderToplevelEnumProc"); } else { @@ -6343,8 +6530,8 @@ BOOL CALLBACK TkWmStackorderToplevelEnumProc(hwnd, lParam) * * TkWmStackorderToplevelWrapperMap -- * - * This procedure will create a table that maps the wrapper - * HWND id for a toplevel to the TkWindow structure that is wraps. + * This function will create a table that maps the wrapper HWND id for a + * toplevel to the TkWindow structure that is wraps. * * Results: * None. @@ -6356,10 +6543,10 @@ BOOL CALLBACK TkWmStackorderToplevelEnumProc(hwnd, lParam) */ static void -TkWmStackorderToplevelWrapperMap(winPtr, display, table) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* TkWindow to recurse on */ - Display *display; /* X display of parent window */ - Tcl_HashTable *table; /* Table to maps HWND to TkWindow */ +TkWmStackorderToplevelWrapperMap( + TkWindow *winPtr, /* TkWindow to recurse on */ + Display *display, /* X display of parent window */ + Tcl_HashTable *table) /* Table to maps HWND to TkWindow */ { TkWindow *childPtr; Tcl_HashEntry *hPtr; @@ -6373,8 +6560,7 @@ TkWmStackorderToplevelWrapperMap(winPtr, display, table) /*fprintf(stderr, "Mapped HWND %d to %x (%s)\n", wrapper, winPtr, winPtr->pathName);*/ - hPtr = Tcl_CreateHashEntry(table, - (char *) wrapper, &newEntry); + hPtr = Tcl_CreateHashEntry(table, (char *) wrapper, &newEntry); Tcl_SetHashValue(hPtr, winPtr); } @@ -6388,11 +6574,11 @@ TkWmStackorderToplevelWrapperMap(winPtr, display, table) * * TkWmStackorderToplevel -- * - * This procedure returns the stack order of toplevel windows. + * This function returns the stack order of toplevel windows. * * Results: - * An array of pointers to tk window objects in stacking order - * or else NULL if there was an error. + * An array of pointers to tk window objects in stacking order or else + * NULL if there was an error. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -6401,8 +6587,8 @@ TkWmStackorderToplevelWrapperMap(winPtr, display, table) */ TkWindow ** -TkWmStackorderToplevel(parentPtr) - TkWindow *parentPtr; /* Parent toplevel window. */ +TkWmStackorderToplevel( + TkWindow *parentPtr) /* Parent toplevel window. */ { TkWmStackorderToplevelPair pair; TkWindow **windows; @@ -6421,8 +6607,8 @@ TkWmStackorderToplevel(parentPtr) * sizeof(TkWindow *)); /* - * Special cases: If zero or one toplevels were mapped - * there is no need to call EnumWindows. + * Special cases: If zero or one toplevels were mapped there is no need to + * call EnumWindows. */ switch (table.numEntries) { @@ -6437,9 +6623,9 @@ TkWmStackorderToplevel(parentPtr) } /* - * We will be inserting into the array starting at the end - * and working our way to the beginning since EnumWindows - * returns windows in highest to lowest order. + * We will be inserting into the array starting at the end and working our + * way to the beginning since EnumWindows returns windows in highest to + * lowest order. */ pair.table = &table; @@ -6450,12 +6636,11 @@ TkWmStackorderToplevel(parentPtr) (LPARAM) &pair) == 0) { ckfree((char *) windows); windows = NULL; - } else { - if (pair.window_ptr != (windows-1)) - Tcl_Panic("num matched toplevel windows does not equal num children"); + } else if (pair.window_ptr != (windows-1)) { + Tcl_Panic("num matched toplevel windows does not equal num children"); } - done: + done: Tcl_DeleteHashTable(&table); return windows; } @@ -6465,33 +6650,33 @@ TkWmStackorderToplevel(parentPtr) * * TkWmRestackToplevel -- * - * This procedure restacks a top-level window. + * This function restacks a top-level window. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * WinPtr gets restacked as specified by aboveBelow and otherPtr. - * This procedure doesn't return until the restack has taken - * effect and the ConfigureNotify event for it has been received. + * WinPtr gets restacked as specified by aboveBelow and otherPtr. This + * function doesn't return until the restack has taken effect and the + * ConfigureNotify event for it has been received. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -TkWmRestackToplevel(winPtr, aboveBelow, otherPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Window to restack. */ - int aboveBelow; /* Gives relative position for restacking; +TkWmRestackToplevel( + TkWindow *winPtr, /* Window to restack. */ + int aboveBelow, /* Gives relative position for restacking; * must be Above or Below. */ - TkWindow *otherPtr; /* Window relative to which to restack; - * if NULL, then winPtr gets restacked - * above or below *all* siblings. */ + TkWindow *otherPtr) /* Window relative to which to restack; if + * NULL, then winPtr gets restacked above or + * below *all* siblings. */ { HWND hwnd, insertAfter; /* - * Can't set stacking order properly until the window is on the - * screen (mapping it may give it a reparent window). + * Can't set stacking order properly until the window is on the screen + * (mapping it may give it a reparent window). */ if (winPtr->window == None) { @@ -6511,13 +6696,14 @@ TkWmRestackToplevel(winPtr, aboveBelow, otherPtr) TkWmMapWindow(otherPtr); } insertAfter = (otherPtr->wmInfoPtr->wrapper != NULL) - ? otherPtr->wmInfoPtr->wrapper : Tk_GetHWND(otherPtr->window); + ? otherPtr->wmInfoPtr->wrapper : Tk_GetHWND(otherPtr->window); } else { insertAfter = NULL; } - if(winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED) { - SendMessage(winPtr->wmInfoPtr->wrapper, TK_RAISEWINDOW, (WPARAM)insertAfter, aboveBelow); + if (winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED) { + SendMessage(winPtr->wmInfoPtr->wrapper, TK_RAISEWINDOW, + (WPARAM)insertAfter, aboveBelow); } else { TkWinSetWindowPos(hwnd, insertAfter, aboveBelow); } @@ -6528,28 +6714,27 @@ TkWmRestackToplevel(winPtr, aboveBelow, otherPtr) * * TkWmAddToColormapWindows -- * - * This procedure is called to add a given window to the - * WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property for its top-level, if it - * isn't already there. It is invoked by the Tk code that - * creates a new colormap, in order to make sure that colormap - * information is propagated to the window manager by default. + * This function is called to add a given window to the + * WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property for its top-level, if it isn't already + * there. It is invoked by the Tk code that creates a new colormap, in + * order to make sure that colormap information is propagated to the + * window manager by default. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * WinPtr's window gets added to the WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS - * property of its nearest top-level ancestor, unless the - * colormaps have been set explicitly with the - * "wm colormapwindows" command. + * WinPtr's window gets added to the WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property of its + * nearest top-level ancestor, unless the colormaps have been set + * explicitly with the "wm colormapwindows" command. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -TkWmAddToColormapWindows(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Window with a non-default colormap. - * Should not be a top-level window. */ +TkWmAddToColormapWindows( + TkWindow *winPtr) /* Window with a non-default colormap. Should + * not be a top-level window. */ { TkWindow *topPtr; TkWindow **oldPtr, **newPtr; @@ -6562,7 +6747,7 @@ TkWmAddToColormapWindows(winPtr) for (topPtr = winPtr->parentPtr; ; topPtr = topPtr->parentPtr) { if (topPtr == NULL) { /* - * Window is being deleted. Skip the whole operation. + * Window is being deleted. Skip the whole operation. */ return; @@ -6594,8 +6779,7 @@ TkWmAddToColormapWindows(winPtr) /* * Make a new bigger array and use it to reset the property. - * Automatically add the toplevel itself as the last element - * of the list. + * Automatically add the toplevel itself as the last element of the list. */ newPtr = (TkWindow **) ckalloc((unsigned) ((count+2)*sizeof(TkWindow*))); @@ -6630,26 +6814,26 @@ TkWmAddToColormapWindows(winPtr) * * TkWmRemoveFromColormapWindows -- * - * This procedure is called to remove a given window from the - * WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property for its top-level. It is invoked - * when windows are deleted. + * This function is called to remove a given window from the + * WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property for its top-level. It is invoked when + * windows are deleted. * * Results: * None. * * Side effects: - * WinPtr's window gets removed from the WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS - * property of its nearest top-level ancestor, unless the - * top-level itself is being deleted too. + * WinPtr's window gets removed from the WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property of + * its nearest top-level ancestor, unless the top-level itself is being + * deleted too. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -TkWmRemoveFromColormapWindows(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Window that may be present in +TkWmRemoveFromColormapWindows( + TkWindow *winPtr) /* Window that may be present in * WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property for its - * top-level. Should not be a top-level + * top-level. Should not be a top-level * window. */ { TkWindow *topPtr; @@ -6671,8 +6855,8 @@ TkWmRemoveFromColormapWindows(winPtr) } if (topPtr->flags & TK_ALREADY_DEAD) { /* - * Top-level is being deleted, so there's no need to cleanup - * the WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property. + * Top-level is being deleted, so there's no need to cleanup the + * WM_COLORMAP_WINDOWS property. */ return; @@ -6683,8 +6867,7 @@ TkWmRemoveFromColormapWindows(winPtr) } /* - * Find the window and slide the following ones down to cover - * it up. + * Find the window and slide the following ones down to cover it up. */ count = topPtr->wmInfoPtr->cmapCount; @@ -6711,16 +6894,16 @@ TkWmRemoveFromColormapWindows(winPtr) * None. * * Side effects: - * The menu will end up being drawn in the window, and the geometry - * of the window will have to be changed. + * The menu will end up being drawn in the window, and the geometry of + * the window will have to be changed. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -TkWinSetMenu(tkwin, hMenu) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* the window to put the menu in */ - HMENU hMenu; /* the menu to set */ +TkWinSetMenu( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* the window to put the menu in */ + HMENU hMenu) /* the menu to set */ { TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) tkwin; WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; @@ -6742,7 +6925,7 @@ TkWinSetMenu(tkwin, hMenu) } } else { SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_SETMENU, - (WPARAM)hMenu, (LPARAM)Tk_GetMenuHWND(tkwin)); + (WPARAM)hMenu, (LPARAM)Tk_GetMenuHWND(tkwin)); } } @@ -6752,7 +6935,7 @@ TkWinSetMenu(tkwin, hMenu) * ConfigureTopLevel -- * * Generate a ConfigureNotify event based on the current position - * information. This procedure is called by TopLevelProc. + * information. This function is called by TopLevelProc. * * Results: * None. @@ -6764,8 +6947,8 @@ TkWinSetMenu(tkwin, hMenu) */ static void -ConfigureTopLevel(pos) - WINDOWPOS *pos; +ConfigureTopLevel( + WINDOWPOS *pos) { TkWindow *winPtr = GetTopLevel(pos->hwnd); WmInfo *wmPtr; @@ -6789,15 +6972,15 @@ ConfigureTopLevel(pos) windowPos.length = sizeof(WINDOWPLACEMENT); GetWindowPlacement(wmPtr->wrapper, &windowPos); switch (windowPos.showCmd) { - case SW_SHOWMAXIMIZED: - state = ZoomState; - break; - case SW_SHOWMINIMIZED: - state = IconicState; - break; - case SW_SHOWNORMAL: - state = NormalState; - break; + case SW_SHOWMAXIMIZED: + state = ZoomState; + break; + case SW_SHOWMINIMIZED: + state = IconicState; + break; + case SW_SHOWNORMAL: + state = NormalState; + break; } } @@ -6809,27 +6992,26 @@ ConfigureTopLevel(pos) if (wmPtr->hints.initial_state != state) { wmPtr->hints.initial_state = state; switch (state) { - case WithdrawnState: - case IconicState: - XUnmapWindow(winPtr->display, winPtr->window); - break; + case WithdrawnState: + case IconicState: + XUnmapWindow(winPtr->display, winPtr->window); + break; - case NormalState: - /* - * Schedule a geometry update. Since we ignore geometry - * requests while in any other state, the geometry info - * may be stale. - */ + case NormalState: + /* + * Schedule a geometry update. Since we ignore geometry requests + * while in any other state, the geometry info may be stale. + */ - if (!(wmPtr->flags & WM_UPDATE_PENDING)) { - Tcl_DoWhenIdle(UpdateGeometryInfo, (ClientData) winPtr); - wmPtr->flags |= WM_UPDATE_PENDING; - } - /* fall through */ - case ZoomState: - XMapWindow(winPtr->display, winPtr->window); - pos->flags |= SWP_NOMOVE | SWP_NOSIZE; - break; + if (!(wmPtr->flags & WM_UPDATE_PENDING)) { + Tcl_DoWhenIdle(UpdateGeometryInfo, (ClientData) winPtr); + wmPtr->flags |= WM_UPDATE_PENDING; + } + /* fall through */ + case ZoomState: + XMapWindow(winPtr->display, winPtr->window); + pos->flags |= SWP_NOMOVE | SWP_NOSIZE; + break; } } @@ -6843,8 +7025,8 @@ ConfigureTopLevel(pos) /* - * Compute the current geometry of the client area, reshape the - * Tk window and generate a ConfigureNotify event. + * Compute the current geometry of the client area, reshape the Tk window + * and generate a ConfigureNotify event. */ GetClientRect(wmPtr->wrapper, &rect); @@ -6864,16 +7046,16 @@ ConfigureTopLevel(pos) if (state == NormalState) { /* - * Update size information from the event. There are a couple of + * Update size information from the event. There are a couple of * tricky points here: * * 1. If the user changed the size externally then set wmPtr->width * and wmPtr->height just as if a "wm geometry" command had been * invoked with the same information. - * 2. However, if the size is changing in response to a request - * coming from us (sync is set), then don't set - * wmPtr->width or wmPtr->height (otherwise the window will stop - * tracking geometry manager requests). + * 2. However, if the size is changing in response to a request coming + * from us (sync is set), then don't set wmPtr->width or + * wmPtr->height (otherwise the window will stop tracking geometry + * manager requests). */ if (!(wmPtr->flags & WM_SYNC_PENDING)) { @@ -6881,8 +7063,8 @@ ConfigureTopLevel(pos) if ((wmPtr->width == -1) && (winPtr->changes.width == winPtr->reqWidth)) { /* - * Don't set external width, since the user didn't - * change it from what the widgets asked for. + * Don't set external width, since the user didn't change + * it from what the widgets asked for. */ } else { if (wmPtr->gridWin != NULL) { @@ -6917,9 +7099,10 @@ ConfigureTopLevel(pos) wmPtr->configWidth = winPtr->changes.width; wmPtr->configHeight = winPtr->changes.height; } + /* - * If the user moved the window, we should switch back - * to normal coordinates. + * If the user moved the window, we should switch back to normal + * coordinates. */ if (!(pos->flags & SWP_NOMOVE)) { @@ -6933,15 +7116,15 @@ ConfigureTopLevel(pos) if (wmPtr->flags & WM_NEGATIVE_X) { wmPtr->x = DisplayWidth(winPtr->display, winPtr->screenNum) - - winPtr->changes.x - (winPtr->changes.width - + wmPtr->borderWidth); + - winPtr->changes.x - (winPtr->changes.width + + wmPtr->borderWidth); } else { wmPtr->x = winPtr->changes.x; } if (wmPtr->flags & WM_NEGATIVE_Y) { wmPtr->y = DisplayHeight(winPtr->display, winPtr->screenNum) - - winPtr->changes.y - (winPtr->changes.height - + wmPtr->borderHeight); + - winPtr->changes.y - (winPtr->changes.height + + wmPtr->borderHeight); } else { wmPtr->y = winPtr->changes.y; } @@ -6953,8 +7136,8 @@ ConfigureTopLevel(pos) * * GenerateConfigureNotify -- * - * Generate a ConfigureNotify event from the current geometry - * information for the specified toplevel window. + * Generate a ConfigureNotify event from the current geometry information + * for the specified toplevel window. * * Results: * None. @@ -6966,8 +7149,8 @@ ConfigureTopLevel(pos) */ static void -GenerateConfigureNotify(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; +GenerateConfigureNotify( + TkWindow *winPtr) { XEvent event; @@ -6996,8 +7179,8 @@ GenerateConfigureNotify(winPtr) * * InstallColormaps -- * - * Installs the colormaps associated with the toplevel which is - * currently active. + * Installs the colormaps associated with the toplevel which is currently + * active. * * Results: * None. @@ -7009,12 +7192,12 @@ GenerateConfigureNotify(winPtr) */ static int -InstallColormaps(hwnd, message, isForemost) - HWND hwnd; /* Toplevel wrapper window whose colormaps +InstallColormaps( + HWND hwnd, /* Toplevel wrapper window whose colormaps * should be installed. */ - int message; /* Either WM_PALETTECHANGED or + int message, /* Either WM_PALETTECHANGED or * WM_QUERYNEWPALETTE */ - int isForemost; /* 1 if window is foremost, else 0 */ + int isForemost) /* 1 if window is foremost, else 0 */ { int i; HDC dc; @@ -7061,11 +7244,11 @@ InstallColormaps(hwnd, message, isForemost) } else { /* - * Window is being notified of a change in the system palette. - * If this window is the foreground window, then we should only - * install the secondary palettes, since the primary was installed - * in response to the WM_QUERYPALETTE message. Otherwise, install - * all of the palettes. + * Window is being notified of a change in the system palette. If this + * window is the foreground window, then we should only install the + * secondary palettes, since the primary was installed in response to + * the WM_QUERYPALETTE message. Otherwise, install all of the + * palettes. */ @@ -7107,11 +7290,10 @@ InstallColormaps(hwnd, message, isForemost) * * RefreshColormap -- * - * This function is called to force all of the windows that use - * a given colormap to redraw themselves. The quickest way to - * do this is to iterate over the toplevels, looking in the - * cmapList for matches. This will quickly eliminate subtrees - * that don't use a given colormap. + * This function is called to force all of the windows that use a given + * colormap to redraw themselves. The quickest way to do this is to + * iterate over the toplevels, looking in the cmapList for matches. This + * will quickly eliminate subtrees that don't use a given colormap. * * Results: * None. @@ -7123,9 +7305,9 @@ InstallColormaps(hwnd, message, isForemost) */ static void -RefreshColormap(colormap, dispPtr) - Colormap colormap; - TkDisplay *dispPtr; +RefreshColormap( + Colormap colormap, + TkDisplay *dispPtr) { WmInfo *wmPtr; int i; @@ -7150,9 +7332,9 @@ RefreshColormap(colormap, dispPtr) * * InvalidateSubTree -- * - * This function recursively generates damage for a window and - * all of its mapped children that belong to the same toplevel and - * are using the specified colormap. + * This function recursively generates damage for a window and all of its + * mapped children that belong to the same toplevel and are using the + * specified colormap. * * Results: * None. @@ -7164,15 +7346,15 @@ RefreshColormap(colormap, dispPtr) */ static void -InvalidateSubTree(winPtr, colormap) - TkWindow *winPtr; - Colormap colormap; +InvalidateSubTree( + TkWindow *winPtr, + Colormap colormap) { TkWindow *childPtr; /* - * Generate damage for the current window if it is using the - * specified colormap. + * Generate damage for the current window if it is using the specified + * colormap. */ if (winPtr->atts.colormap == colormap) { @@ -7182,8 +7364,7 @@ InvalidateSubTree(winPtr, colormap) for (childPtr = winPtr->childList; childPtr != NULL; childPtr = childPtr->nextPtr) { /* - * We can stop the descent when we hit an unmapped or - * toplevel window. + * We can stop the descent when we hit an unmapped or toplevel window. */ if (!Tk_TopWinHierarchy(childPtr) && Tk_IsMapped(childPtr)) { @@ -7197,8 +7378,8 @@ InvalidateSubTree(winPtr, colormap) * * InvalidateSubTreeDepth -- * - * This function recursively updates depth info for a window and - * all of its children that belong to the same toplevel. + * This function recursively updates depth info for a window and all of + * its children that belong to the same toplevel. * * Results: * None. @@ -7210,8 +7391,8 @@ InvalidateSubTree(winPtr, colormap) */ static void -InvalidateSubTreeDepth(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; +InvalidateSubTreeDepth( + TkWindow *winPtr) { Display *display = Tk_Display(winPtr); int screenNum = Tk_ScreenNumber(winPtr); @@ -7221,10 +7402,10 @@ InvalidateSubTreeDepth(winPtr) #if 0 /* - * XXX: What other elements may require changes? Changing just - * the depth works for standard windows and 16/24/32-bpp changes. - * I suspect 8-bit (palettized) displays may require colormap and/or - * visual changes as well. + * XXX: What other elements may require changes? Changing just the depth + * works for standard windows and 16/24/32-bpp changes. I suspect 8-bit + * (palettized) displays may require colormap and/or visual changes as + * well. */ if (winPtr->window) { @@ -7238,7 +7419,7 @@ InvalidateSubTreeDepth(winPtr) for (childPtr = winPtr->childList; childPtr != NULL; childPtr = childPtr->nextPtr) { /* - * We can stop the descent when we hit a non-embedded toplevel window, + * We can stop the descent when we hit a non-embedded toplevel window, * as it should get its own message. */ @@ -7256,8 +7437,8 @@ InvalidateSubTreeDepth(winPtr) * Retrieves the currently installed foreground palette. * * Results: - * Returns the global foreground palette, if there is one. - * Otherwise, returns NULL. + * Returns the global foreground palette, if there is one. Otherwise, + * returns NULL. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -7266,7 +7447,7 @@ InvalidateSubTreeDepth(winPtr) */ HPALETTE -TkWinGetSystemPalette() +TkWinGetSystemPalette(void) { ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); @@ -7279,17 +7460,16 @@ TkWinGetSystemPalette() * * GetMinSize -- * - * This procedure computes the current minWidth and minHeight - * values for a window, taking into account the possibility - * that they may be defaulted. + * This function computes the current minWidth and minHeight values for a + * window, taking into account the possibility that they may be + * defaulted. * * Results: - * The values at *minWidthPtr and *minHeightPtr are filled - * in with the minimum allowable dimensions of wmPtr's window, - * in grid units. If the requested minimum is smaller than the - * system required minimum, then this procedure computes the - * smallest size that will satisfy both the system and the - * grid constraints. + * The values at *minWidthPtr and *minHeightPtr are filled in with the + * minimum allowable dimensions of wmPtr's window, in grid units. If the + * requested minimum is smaller than the system required minimum, then + * this function computes the smallest size that will satisfy both the + * system and the grid constraints. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -7298,21 +7478,21 @@ TkWinGetSystemPalette() */ static void -GetMinSize(wmPtr, minWidthPtr, minHeightPtr) - WmInfo *wmPtr; /* Window manager information for the +GetMinSize( + WmInfo *wmPtr, /* Window manager information for the * window. */ - int *minWidthPtr; /* Where to store the current minimum - * width of the window. */ - int *minHeightPtr; /* Where to store the current minimum - * height of the window. */ + int *minWidthPtr, /* Where to store the current minimum width of + * the window. */ + int *minHeightPtr) /* Where to store the current minimum height + * of the window. */ { int tmp, base; TkWindow *winPtr = wmPtr->winPtr; /* - * Compute the minimum width by taking the default client size - * and rounding it up to the nearest grid unit. Return the greater - * of the default minimum and the specified minimum. + * Compute the minimum width by taking the default client size and + * rounding it up to the nearest grid unit. Return the greater of the + * default minimum and the specified minimum. */ tmp = wmPtr->defMinWidth - wmPtr->borderWidth; @@ -7357,15 +7537,15 @@ GetMinSize(wmPtr, minWidthPtr, minHeightPtr) * * GetMaxSize -- * - * This procedure computes the current maxWidth and maxHeight - * values for a window, taking into account the possibility - * that they may be defaulted. + * This function computes the current maxWidth and maxHeight values for a + * window, taking into account the possibility that they may be + * defaulted. * * Results: * The values at *maxWidthPtr and *maxHeightPtr are filled * in with the maximum allowable dimensions of wmPtr's window, * in grid units. If no maximum has been specified for the - * window, then this procedure computes the largest sizes that + * window, then this function computes the largest sizes that * will fit on the screen. * * Side effects: @@ -7375,13 +7555,13 @@ GetMinSize(wmPtr, minWidthPtr, minHeightPtr) */ static void -GetMaxSize(wmPtr, maxWidthPtr, maxHeightPtr) - WmInfo *wmPtr; /* Window manager information for the +GetMaxSize( + WmInfo *wmPtr, /* Window manager information for the * window. */ - int *maxWidthPtr; /* Where to store the current maximum - * width of the window. */ - int *maxHeightPtr; /* Where to store the current maximum - * height of the window. */ + int *maxWidthPtr, /* Where to store the current maximum width of + * the window. */ + int *maxHeightPtr) /* Where to store the current maximum height + * of the window. */ { int tmp; @@ -7389,14 +7569,14 @@ GetMaxSize(wmPtr, maxWidthPtr, maxHeightPtr) *maxWidthPtr = wmPtr->maxWidth; } else { /* - * Must compute a default width. Fill up the display, leaving a - * bit of extra space for the window manager's borders. + * Must compute a default width. Fill up the display, leaving a bit of + * extra space for the window manager's borders. */ tmp = wmPtr->defMaxWidth - wmPtr->borderWidth; if (wmPtr->gridWin != NULL) { /* - * Gridding is turned on; convert from pixels to grid units. + * Gridding is turned on; convert from pixels to grid units. */ tmp = wmPtr->reqGridWidth @@ -7421,8 +7601,7 @@ GetMaxSize(wmPtr, maxWidthPtr, maxHeightPtr) * * TopLevelProc -- * - * Callback from Windows whenever an event occurs on a top level - * window. + * Callback from Windows whenever an event occurs on a top level window. * * Results: * Standard Windows return value. @@ -7434,11 +7613,11 @@ GetMaxSize(wmPtr, maxWidthPtr, maxHeightPtr) */ static LRESULT CALLBACK -TopLevelProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) - HWND hwnd; - UINT message; - WPARAM wParam; - LPARAM lParam; +TopLevelProc( + HWND hwnd, + UINT message, + WPARAM wParam, + LPARAM lParam) { if (message == WM_WINDOWPOSCHANGED || message == WM_WINDOWPOSCHANGING) { WINDOWPOS *pos = (WINDOWPOS *) lParam; @@ -7457,7 +7636,8 @@ TopLevelProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) winPtr->changes.height = pos->cy; } if (!(pos->flags & SWP_NOMOVE)) { - long result = SendMessage(winPtr->wmInfoPtr->wrapper, TK_MOVEWINDOW, -1, -1); + long result = SendMessage(winPtr->wmInfoPtr->wrapper, + TK_MOVEWINDOW, -1, -1); winPtr->wmInfoPtr->x = winPtr->changes.x = result >> 16; winPtr->wmInfoPtr->y = winPtr->changes.y = result & 0xffff; } @@ -7488,189 +7668,195 @@ TopLevelProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) */ static LRESULT CALLBACK -WmProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) - HWND hwnd; - UINT message; - WPARAM wParam; - LPARAM lParam; +WmProc( + HWND hwnd, + UINT message, + WPARAM wParam, + LPARAM lParam) { static int inMoveSize = 0; - static int oldMode; /* This static is set upon entering move/size mode - * and is used to reset the service mode after - * leaving move/size mode. Note that this mechanism - * assumes move/size is only one level deep. */ + static int oldMode; /* This static is set upon entering move/size + * mode and is used to reset the service mode + * after leaving move/size mode. Note that + * this mechanism assumes move/size is only + * one level deep. */ LRESULT result; TkWindow *winPtr = NULL; switch (message) { - case WM_KILLFOCUS: - case WM_ERASEBKGND: - result = 0; - goto done; - - case WM_ENTERSIZEMOVE: - inMoveSize = 1; - - /* - * Cancel any current mouse timer. If the mouse timer - * fires during the size/move mouse capture, it will - * release the capture, which is wrong. - */ + case WM_KILLFOCUS: + case WM_ERASEBKGND: + result = 0; + goto done; - TkWinCancelMouseTimer(); + case WM_ENTERSIZEMOVE: + inMoveSize = 1; - oldMode = Tcl_SetServiceMode(TCL_SERVICE_ALL); - break; - - case WM_ACTIVATE: - case WM_EXITSIZEMOVE: - if (inMoveSize) { - inMoveSize = 0; - Tcl_SetServiceMode(oldMode); - } - break; + /* + * Cancel any current mouse timer. If the mouse timer fires during the + * size/move mouse capture, it will release the capture, which is + * wrong. + */ - case WM_GETMINMAXINFO: - SetLimits(hwnd, (MINMAXINFO *) lParam); - result = 0; - goto done; + TkWinCancelMouseTimer(); - case WM_DISPLAYCHANGE: - /* display and/or color resolution changed */ - winPtr = GetTopLevel(hwnd); - if (winPtr) { - Screen *screen = Tk_Screen(winPtr); - if (screen->root_depth != (int) wParam) { - /* - * Color resolution changed, so do extensive rebuild of - * display parameters. This will affect the display for - * all Tk windows. We will receive this event for each - * toplevel, but this check makes us update only once, for - * the first toplevel that receives the message. - */ - TkWinDisplayChanged(Tk_Display(winPtr)); - } else { - HDC dc = GetDC(NULL); - screen->width = LOWORD(lParam); /* horizontal res */ - screen->height = HIWORD(lParam); /* vertical res */ - screen->mwidth = MulDiv(screen->width, 254, - GetDeviceCaps(dc, LOGPIXELSX) * 10); - screen->mheight = MulDiv(screen->height, 254, - GetDeviceCaps(dc, LOGPIXELSY) * 10); - ReleaseDC(NULL, dc); - } - if (Tk_Depth(winPtr) != (int) wParam) { - /* - * Defer the window depth check to here so that each - * toplevel will properly update depth info. - */ - InvalidateSubTreeDepth(winPtr); - } - } - result = 0; - goto done; + oldMode = Tcl_SetServiceMode(TCL_SERVICE_ALL); + break; - case WM_SYSCOLORCHANGE: - /* - * XXX: Called when system color changes. We need to - * update any widgets that use a system color. - */ - break; + case WM_ACTIVATE: + case WM_EXITSIZEMOVE: + if (inMoveSize) { + inMoveSize = 0; + Tcl_SetServiceMode(oldMode); + } + break; - case WM_PALETTECHANGED: - result = InstallColormaps(hwnd, WM_PALETTECHANGED, - hwnd == (HWND)wParam); - goto done; + case WM_GETMINMAXINFO: + SetLimits(hwnd, (MINMAXINFO *) lParam); + result = 0; + goto done; - case WM_QUERYNEWPALETTE: - result = InstallColormaps(hwnd, WM_QUERYNEWPALETTE, TRUE); - goto done; + case WM_DISPLAYCHANGE: + /* + * Display and/or color resolution changed. + */ - case WM_WINDOWPOSCHANGED: - ConfigureTopLevel((WINDOWPOS *) lParam); - result = 0; - goto done; + winPtr = GetTopLevel(hwnd); + if (winPtr) { + Screen *screen = Tk_Screen(winPtr); + if (screen->root_depth != (int) wParam) { + /* + * Color resolution changed, so do extensive rebuild of + * display parameters. This will affect the display for all Tk + * windows. We will receive this event for each toplevel, but + * this check makes us update only once, for the first + * toplevel that receives the message. + */ - case WM_NCHITTEST: { - winPtr = GetTopLevel(hwnd); - if (winPtr && (TkGrabState(winPtr) == TK_GRAB_EXCLUDED)) { + TkWinDisplayChanged(Tk_Display(winPtr)); + } else { + HDC dc = GetDC(NULL); + + screen->width = LOWORD(lParam); /* horizontal res */ + screen->height = HIWORD(lParam); /* vertical res */ + screen->mwidth = MulDiv(screen->width, 254, + GetDeviceCaps(dc, LOGPIXELSX) * 10); + screen->mheight = MulDiv(screen->height, 254, + GetDeviceCaps(dc, LOGPIXELSY) * 10); + ReleaseDC(NULL, dc); + } + if (Tk_Depth(winPtr) != (int) wParam) { /* - * This window is outside the grab heirarchy, so don't let any - * of the normal non-client processing occur. Note that this - * implementation is not strictly correct because the grab - * might change between now and when the event would have been - * processed by Tk, but it's close enough. + * Defer the window depth check to here so that each toplevel + * will properly update depth info. */ - result = HTCLIENT; - goto done; + InvalidateSubTreeDepth(winPtr); } - break; } + result = 0; + goto done; - case WM_MOUSEACTIVATE: { - ActivateEvent *eventPtr; - winPtr = GetTopLevel((HWND) wParam); + case WM_SYSCOLORCHANGE: + /* + * XXX: Called when system color changes. We need to update any + * widgets that use a system color. + */ - if (winPtr && (TkGrabState(winPtr) != TK_GRAB_EXCLUDED)) { - /* - * This allows us to pass the message onto the - * native menus [Bug: 2272] - */ - result = (*tkWinProcs->defWindowProc)(hwnd, message, - wParam, lParam); - goto done; - } + break; + + case WM_PALETTECHANGED: + result = InstallColormaps(hwnd, WM_PALETTECHANGED, + hwnd == (HWND)wParam); + goto done; + + case WM_QUERYNEWPALETTE: + result = InstallColormaps(hwnd, WM_QUERYNEWPALETTE, TRUE); + goto done; + case WM_WINDOWPOSCHANGED: + ConfigureTopLevel((WINDOWPOS *) lParam); + result = 0; + goto done; + + case WM_NCHITTEST: { + winPtr = GetTopLevel(hwnd); + if (winPtr && (TkGrabState(winPtr) == TK_GRAB_EXCLUDED)) { /* - * Don't activate the window yet since there is a grab - * that takes precedence. Instead we need to queue - * an event so we can check the grab state right before we - * handle the mouse event. + * This window is outside the grab heirarchy, so don't let any of + * the normal non-client processing occur. Note that this + * implementation is not strictly correct because the grab might + * change between now and when the event would have been processed + * by Tk, but it's close enough. */ - if (winPtr) { - eventPtr = (ActivateEvent *)ckalloc(sizeof(ActivateEvent)); - eventPtr->ev.proc = ActivateWindow; - eventPtr->winPtr = winPtr; - Tcl_QueueEvent((Tcl_Event*)eventPtr, TCL_QUEUE_TAIL); - } - result = MA_NOACTIVATE; + result = HTCLIENT; goto done; } + break; + } - default: - break; + case WM_MOUSEACTIVATE: { + ActivateEvent *eventPtr; + winPtr = GetTopLevel((HWND) wParam); + + if (winPtr && (TkGrabState(winPtr) != TK_GRAB_EXCLUDED)) { + /* + * This allows us to pass the message onto the native menus [Bug: + * 2272] + */ + + result = (*tkWinProcs->defWindowProc)(hwnd, message, + wParam, lParam); + goto done; + } + + /* + * Don't activate the window yet since there is a grab that takes + * precedence. Instead we need to queue an event so we can check the + * grab state right before we handle the mouse event. + */ + + if (winPtr) { + eventPtr = (ActivateEvent *)ckalloc(sizeof(ActivateEvent)); + eventPtr->ev.proc = ActivateWindow; + eventPtr->winPtr = winPtr; + Tcl_QueueEvent((Tcl_Event*)eventPtr, TCL_QUEUE_TAIL); + } + result = MA_NOACTIVATE; + goto done; + } + + default: + break; } winPtr = GetTopLevel(hwnd); switch(message) { - case WM_SYSCOMMAND: - case WM_INITMENU: - case WM_COMMAND: - case WM_MENUCHAR: - case WM_MEASUREITEM: - case WM_DRAWITEM: - case WM_MENUSELECT: - case WM_ENTERIDLE: - case WM_INITMENUPOPUP: - { - HWND hMenuHWnd = Tk_GetEmbeddedMenuHWND((Tk_Window)winPtr); - if(hMenuHWnd) { - if(SendMessage(hMenuHWnd, message, wParam, lParam)) { - goto done; - } - } else { - if (TkWinHandleMenuEvent(&hwnd, &message, &wParam, &lParam, &result)) { - goto done; - } + case WM_SYSCOMMAND: + case WM_INITMENU: + case WM_COMMAND: + case WM_MENUCHAR: + case WM_MEASUREITEM: + case WM_DRAWITEM: + case WM_MENUSELECT: + case WM_ENTERIDLE: + case WM_INITMENUPOPUP: { + HWND hMenuHWnd = Tk_GetEmbeddedMenuHWND((Tk_Window)winPtr); + if (hMenuHWnd) { + if (SendMessage(hMenuHWnd, message, wParam, lParam)) { + goto done; } + } else if (TkWinHandleMenuEvent(&hwnd, &message, &wParam, &lParam, + &result)) { + goto done; } break; } if (winPtr && winPtr->window) { HWND child = Tk_GetHWND(winPtr->window); + if (message == WM_SETFOCUS) { SetFocus(child); result = 0; @@ -7683,7 +7869,7 @@ WmProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) result = (*tkWinProcs->defWindowProc)(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam); } - done: + done: Tcl_ServiceAll(); return result; } @@ -7693,8 +7879,8 @@ WmProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) * * TkpMakeMenuWindow -- * - * Configure the window to be either a pull-down (or pop-up) - * menu, or as a toplevel (torn-off) menu or palette. + * Configure the window to be either a pull-down (or pop-up) menu, or as + * a toplevel (torn-off) menu or palette. * * Results: * None. @@ -7706,12 +7892,12 @@ WmProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) */ void -TkpMakeMenuWindow(tkwin, transient) - Tk_Window tkwin; /* New window. */ - int transient; /* 1 means menu is only posted briefly as - * a popup or pulldown or cascade. 0 means - * menu is always visible, e.g. as a torn-off - * menu. Determines whether save_under and +TkpMakeMenuWindow( + Tk_Window tkwin, /* New window. */ + int transient) /* 1 means menu is only posted briefly as a + * popup or pulldown or cascade. 0 means menu + * is always visible, e.g. as a torn-off menu. + * Determines whether save_under and * override_redirect should be set. */ { XSetWindowAttributes atts; @@ -7755,23 +7941,21 @@ TkWinGetWrapperWindow( TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *)tkwin; return (winPtr->wmInfoPtr->wrapper); } - /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkWmFocusToplevel -- * - * This is a utility procedure invoked by focus-management code. It - * exists because of the extra wrapper windows that exist under - * Unix; its job is to map from wrapper windows to the - * corresponding toplevel windows. On PCs and Macs there are no - * wrapper windows so no mapping is necessary; this procedure just - * determines whether a window is a toplevel or not. + * This is a utility function invoked by focus-management code. It exists + * because of the extra wrapper windows that exist under Unix; its job is + * to map from wrapper windows to the corresponding toplevel windows. On + * PCs and Macs there are no wrapper windows so no mapping is necessary; + * this function just determines whether a window is a toplevel or not. * * Results: - * If winPtr is a toplevel window, returns the pointer to the - * window; otherwise returns NULL. + * If winPtr is a toplevel window, returns the pointer to the window; + * otherwise returns NULL. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -7780,8 +7964,8 @@ TkWinGetWrapperWindow( */ TkWindow * -TkWmFocusToplevel(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; /* Window that received a focus-related +TkWmFocusToplevel( + TkWindow *winPtr) /* Window that received a focus-related * event. */ { if (!(winPtr->flags & TK_TOP_HIERARCHY)) { @@ -7789,19 +7973,19 @@ TkWmFocusToplevel(winPtr) } return winPtr; } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkpGetWrapperWindow -- * - * This is a utility procedure invoked by focus-management code. It - * maps to the wrapper for a top-level, which is just the same - * as the top-level on Macs and PCs. + * This is a utility function invoked by focus-management code. It maps + * to the wrapper for a top-level, which is just the same as the + * top-level on Macs and PCs. * * Results: - * If winPtr is a toplevel window, returns the pointer to the - * window; otherwise returns NULL. + * If winPtr is a toplevel window, returns the pointer to the window; + * otherwise returns NULL. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -7850,8 +8034,8 @@ ActivateWindow( winPtr = ((ActivateEvent *) evPtr)->winPtr; /* - * If the window is excluded by a grab, call SetFocus on the - * grabbed window instead. [Bug 220908] + * If the window is excluded by a grab, call SetFocus on the grabbed + * window instead. [Bug 220908] */ if (winPtr) { @@ -7864,16 +8048,14 @@ ActivateWindow( return 1; } - /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkWinSetForegroundWindow -- * - * This function is a wrapper for SetForegroundWindow, calling - * it on the wrapper window because it has no affect on child - * windows. + * This function is a wrapper for SetForegroundWindow, calling it on the + * wrapper window because it has no affect on child windows. * * Results: * none @@ -7885,8 +8067,8 @@ ActivateWindow( */ void -TkWinSetForegroundWindow(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; +TkWinSetForegroundWindow( + TkWindow *winPtr) { register WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; @@ -7896,14 +8078,14 @@ TkWinSetForegroundWindow(winPtr) SetForegroundWindow(Tk_GetHWND(winPtr->window)); } } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkpWinToplevelWithdraw -- * - * This function is to be used by a window manage to withdraw - * a toplevel window. + * This function is to be used by a window manage to withdraw a toplevel + * window. * * Results: * none @@ -7913,7 +8095,8 @@ TkWinSetForegroundWindow(winPtr) * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -void + +void TkpWinToplevelWithDraw(winPtr) TkWindow *winPtr; { @@ -7927,8 +8110,8 @@ TkpWinToplevelWithDraw(winPtr) * * TkpWinToplevelIconify -- * - * This function is to be used by a window manage to iconify - * a toplevel window. + * This function is to be used by a window manage to iconify a toplevel + * window. * * Results: * none @@ -7938,19 +8121,20 @@ TkpWinToplevelWithDraw(winPtr) * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -void TkpWinToplevelIconify(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; + +void TkpWinToplevelIconify( + TkWindow *winPtr) { TkpWmSetState(winPtr, IconicState); } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkpWinToplevelDeiconify -- * - * This function is to be used by a window manage to deiconify - * a toplevel window. + * This function is to be used by a window manage to deiconify a toplevel + * window. * * Results: * none @@ -7960,19 +8144,20 @@ void TkpWinToplevelIconify(winPtr) * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -void TkpWinToplevelDeiconify(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; + +void TkpWinToplevelDeiconify( + TkWindow *winPtr) { register WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; wmPtr->flags &= ~WM_WITHDRAWN; /* - * If WM_UPDATE_PENDING is true, a pending UpdateGeometryInfo may - * need to be called first to update a withdrawn toplevel's geometry - * before it is deiconified by TkpWmSetState. - * Don't bother if we've never been mapped. + * If WM_UPDATE_PENDING is true, a pending UpdateGeometryInfo may need to + * be called first to update a withdrawn toplevel's geometry before it is + * deiconified by TkpWmSetState. Don't bother if we've never been mapped. */ + if ((wmPtr->flags & WM_UPDATE_PENDING) && !(wmPtr->flags & WM_NEVER_MAPPED)) { Tcl_CancelIdleCall(UpdateGeometryInfo, (ClientData) winPtr); @@ -7980,9 +8165,10 @@ void TkpWinToplevelDeiconify(winPtr) } /* - * If we were in the ZoomState (maximized), 'wm deiconify' - * should not cause the window to shrink + * If we were in the ZoomState (maximized), 'wm deiconify' should not + * cause the window to shrink */ + if (wmPtr->hints.initial_state == ZoomState) { TkpWmSetState(winPtr, ZoomState); } else { @@ -7990,10 +8176,10 @@ void TkpWinToplevelDeiconify(winPtr) } /* - * An unmapped window will be mapped at idle time - * by a call to MapFrame. That calls CreateWrapper - * which sets the focus and raises the window. + * An unmapped window will be mapped at idle time by a call to MapFrame. + * That calls CreateWrapper which sets the focus and raises the window. */ + if (wmPtr->flags & WM_NEVER_MAPPED) { return; } @@ -8001,19 +8187,20 @@ void TkpWinToplevelDeiconify(winPtr) /* * Follow Windows-like style here, raising the window to the top. */ + TkWmRestackToplevel(winPtr, Above, NULL); if (!(Tk_Attributes((Tk_Window) winPtr)->override_redirect)) { TkSetFocusWin(winPtr, 1); } } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkpWinGeometryIsControlledByWm -- * - * This function is to be used by a window manage to see if - * wm has canceled geometry control. + * This function is to be used by a window manage to see if wm has + * canceled geometry control. * * Results: * 0 - if the window manager has canceled its control @@ -8024,27 +8211,29 @@ void TkpWinToplevelDeiconify(winPtr) * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -long TkpWinToplevelIsControlledByWm(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; + +long +TkpWinToplevelIsControlledByWm( + TkWindow *winPtr) { register WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; - if(wmPtr) { + + if (wmPtr) { return ((wmPtr->width != -1) && (wmPtr->height != -1))? 1:0; } else { return 0; } } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkpWinToplevelMove -- * - * This function is to be used by a container to move - * an embedded window. + * This function is to be used by a container to move an embedded window. * * Results: - * position of the upper left frame in a 32-bit long: + * position of the upper left frame in a 32-bit long: * 16-MSBits - x; 16-LSBits - y * * Side effects: @@ -8052,24 +8241,28 @@ long TkpWinToplevelIsControlledByWm(winPtr) * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -long TkpWinToplevelMove(winPtr, x, y) - TkWindow *winPtr; - int x, y; + +long +TkpWinToplevelMove( + TkWindow *winPtr, + int x, int y) { register WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; - if(wmPtr && x >= 0 && y >= 0 && !TkpWinToplevelIsControlledByWm(winPtr)) { + + if (wmPtr && x >= 0 && y >= 0 && !TkpWinToplevelIsControlledByWm(winPtr)) { Tk_MoveToplevelWindow((Tk_Window)winPtr, x, y); } - return ((winPtr->changes.x << 16) & 0xffff0000) | (winPtr->changes.y & 0xffff); + return ((winPtr->changes.x << 16) & 0xffff0000) + | (winPtr->changes.y & 0xffff); } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkpWinToplevelOverrideRedirect -- * - * This function is to be used by a container to overrideredirect - * the contaner's frame window. + * This function is to be used by a container to overrideredirect the + * contaner's frame window. * * Results: * The current overrideredirect value @@ -8079,9 +8272,11 @@ long TkpWinToplevelMove(winPtr, x, y) * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -long TkpWinToplevelOverrideRedirect(winPtr, reqValue) - TkWindow *winPtr; - int reqValue; + +long +TkpWinToplevelOverrideRedirect( + TkWindow *winPtr, + int reqValue) { int curValue; register WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; @@ -8091,21 +8286,23 @@ long TkpWinToplevelOverrideRedirect(winPtr, reqValue) if (curValue != reqValue) { XSetWindowAttributes atts; + /* - * Only do this if we are really changing value, because it - * causes some funky stuff to occur + * Only do this if we are really changing value, because it causes + * some funky stuff to occur */ + atts.override_redirect = reqValue ? True : False; Tk_ChangeWindowAttributes((Tk_Window) winPtr, CWOverrideRedirect, &atts); if (!(wmPtr->flags & (WM_NEVER_MAPPED)) - && !(winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED)) { + && !(winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED)) { UpdateWrapper(winPtr); } } return reqValue; } - + /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * @@ -8123,19 +8320,33 @@ long TkpWinToplevelOverrideRedirect(winPtr, reqValue) *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -void TkpWinToplevelDetachWindow(winPtr) - TkWindow *winPtr; +void +TkpWinToplevelDetachWindow( + TkWindow *winPtr) { register WmInfo *wmPtr = winPtr->wmInfoPtr; - if(winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED) { - int state = SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_STATE, -1, -1)-1; + + if (winPtr->flags & TK_EMBEDDED) { + int state = SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_STATE, -1, -1) - 1; + SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_SETMENU, 0, 0); SendMessage(wmPtr->wrapper, TK_DETACHWINDOW, 0, 0); winPtr->flags &= ~TK_EMBEDDED; winPtr->privatePtr = NULL; wmPtr->wrapper = None; - if(state >= 0 && state <= 3) wmPtr->hints.initial_state = state; + if (state >= 0 && state <= 3) { + wmPtr->hints.initial_state = state; + } } - if(winPtr->flags & TK_TOP_LEVEL) + if (winPtr->flags & TK_TOP_LEVEL) { TkpWinToplevelOverrideRedirect(winPtr, 1); + } } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/tkWinX.c b/win/tkWinX.c index d13e59a..1ee8171 100644 --- a/win/tkWinX.c +++ b/win/tkWinX.c @@ -1,16 +1,16 @@ -/* +/* * tkWinX.c -- * - * This file contains Windows emulation procedures for X routines. + * This file contains Windows emulation procedures for X routines. * * Copyright (c) 1995-1996 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * Copyright (c) 1994 Software Research Associates, Inc. * Copyright (c) 1998-2000 by Scriptics Corporation. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinX.c,v 1.49 2005/08/21 03:29:22 mistachkin Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: tkWinX.c,v 1.50 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ /* @@ -24,9 +24,9 @@ #include "tkWinInt.h" /* - * The w32api 1.1 package (included in Mingw 1.1) does not define _WIN32_IE - * by default. Define it here to gain access to the InitCommonControlsEx API - * in commctrl.h. + * The w32api 1.1 package (included in Mingw 1.1) does not define _WIN32_IE by + * default. Define it here to gain access to the InitCommonControlsEx API in + * commctrl.h. */ #ifndef _WIN32_IE @@ -109,38 +109,37 @@ static int keyInputCharset = -1; /* The Win32 CHARSET for the keyboard static Tcl_Encoding unicodeEncoding = NULL; /* unicode encoding */ /* - * Thread local storage. Notice that now each thread must have its - * own TkDisplay structure, since this structure contains most of - * the thread-specific date for threads. + * Thread local storage. Notice that now each thread must have its own + * TkDisplay structure, since this structure contains most of the + * thread-specific date for threads. */ + typedef struct ThreadSpecificData { - TkDisplay *winDisplay; /* TkDisplay structure that * - * represents Windows screen. */ - int updatingClipboard; /* If 1, we are updating the clipboard */ + TkDisplay *winDisplay; /* TkDisplay structure that represents Windows + * screen. */ + int updatingClipboard; /* If 1, we are updating the clipboard. */ } ThreadSpecificData; static Tcl_ThreadDataKey dataKey; /* - * Forward declarations of procedures used in this file. + * Forward declarations of functions used in this file. */ -static void GenerateXEvent _ANSI_ARGS_((HWND hwnd, UINT message, - WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam)); -static unsigned int GetState _ANSI_ARGS_((UINT message, WPARAM wParam, - LPARAM lParam)); -static void GetTranslatedKey _ANSI_ARGS_((XKeyEvent *xkey)); -static void UpdateInputLanguage _ANSI_ARGS_((int charset)); -static int HandleIMEComposition _ANSI_ARGS_((HWND hwnd, - LPARAM lParam)); +static void GenerateXEvent(HWND hwnd, UINT message, + WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam); +static unsigned int GetState(UINT message, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam); +static void GetTranslatedKey(XKeyEvent *xkey); +static void UpdateInputLanguage(int charset); +static int HandleIMEComposition(HWND hwnd, LPARAM lParam); /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * TkGetServerInfo -- * - * Given a window, this procedure returns information about - * the window server for that window. This procedure provides - * the guts of the "winfo server" command. + * Given a window, this function returns information about the window + * server for that window. This function provides the guts of the "winfo + * server" command. * * Results: * None. @@ -152,11 +151,11 @@ static int HandleIMEComposition _ANSI_ARGS_((HWND hwnd, */ void -TkGetServerInfo(interp, tkwin) - Tcl_Interp *interp; /* The server information is returned in - * this interpreter's result. */ - Tk_Window tkwin; /* Token for window; this selects a - * particular display and server. */ +TkGetServerInfo( + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* The server information is returned in this + * interpreter's result. */ + Tk_Window tkwin) /* Token for window; this selects a particular + * display and server. */ { char buffer[60]; OSVERSIONINFO os; @@ -170,7 +169,7 @@ TkGetServerInfo(interp, tkwin) #else "Win32" #endif - ); + ); Tcl_SetResult(interp, buffer, TCL_VOLATILE); } @@ -191,7 +190,7 @@ TkGetServerInfo(interp, tkwin) */ HINSTANCE -Tk_GetHINSTANCE() +Tk_GetHINSTANCE(vpod) { if (tkInstance == NULL) { tkInstance = GetModuleHandle(NULL); @@ -204,8 +203,8 @@ Tk_GetHINSTANCE() * * TkWinSetHINSTANCE -- * - * Sets the global instance handle used by the Tk library. - * This should be called by DllMain. + * Sets the global instance handle used by the Tk library. This should be + * called by DllMain. * * Results: * None. @@ -217,8 +216,8 @@ Tk_GetHINSTANCE() */ void -TkWinSetHINSTANCE(hInstance) - HINSTANCE hInstance; +TkWinSetHINSTANCE( + HINSTANCE hInstance) { tkInstance = hInstance; } @@ -240,8 +239,8 @@ TkWinSetHINSTANCE(hInstance) */ void -TkWinXInit(hInstance) - HINSTANCE hInstance; +TkWinXInit( + HINSTANCE hInstance) { INITCOMMONCONTROLSEX comctl; @@ -263,12 +262,12 @@ TkWinXInit(hInstance) } /* - * When threads are enabled, we cannot use CLASSDC because - * threads will then write into the same device context. - * - * This is a hack; we should add a subsystem that manages - * device context on a per-thread basis. See also tkWinWm.c, - * which also initializes a WNDCLASS structure. + * When threads are enabled, we cannot use CLASSDC because threads will + * then write into the same device context. + * + * This is a hack; we should add a subsystem that manages device context + * on a per-thread basis. See also tkWinWm.c, which also initializes a + * WNDCLASS structure. */ #ifdef TCL_THREADS @@ -299,6 +298,7 @@ TkWinXInit(hInstance) /* * Make sure we cleanup on finalize. */ + TkCreateExitHandler(TkWinXCleanup, (ClientData) hInstance); } @@ -319,14 +319,15 @@ TkWinXInit(hInstance) */ void -TkWinXCleanup(clientData) - ClientData clientData; +TkWinXCleanup( + ClientData clientData) { HINSTANCE hInstance = (HINSTANCE) clientData; + /* * Clean up our own class. */ - + if (childClassInitialized) { childClassInitialized = 0; UnregisterClass(TK_WIN_CHILD_CLASS_NAME, hInstance); @@ -340,7 +341,7 @@ TkWinXCleanup(clientData) /* * And let the window manager clean up its own class(es). */ - + TkWinWmCleanup(hInstance); TkWinCleanupContainerList(); } @@ -350,12 +351,12 @@ TkWinXCleanup(clientData) * * TkWinGetPlatformId -- * - * Determines whether running under NT, 95, or Win32s, to allow - * runtime conditional code. Win32s is no longer supported. + * Determines whether running under NT, 95, or Win32s, to allow runtime + * conditional code. Win32s is no longer supported. * * Results: * The return value is one of: - * VER_PLATFORM_WIN32s Win32s on Windows 3.1. + * VER_PLATFORM_WIN32s Win32s on Windows 3.1. * VER_PLATFORM_WIN32_WINDOWS Win32 on Windows 95. * VER_PLATFORM_WIN32_NT Win32 on Windows NT * @@ -366,7 +367,7 @@ TkWinXCleanup(clientData) */ int -TkWinGetPlatformId() +TkWinGetPlatformId(vpod { if (tkPlatformId == 0) { OSVERSIONINFO os; @@ -374,17 +375,20 @@ TkWinGetPlatformId() os.dwOSVersionInfoSize = sizeof(OSVERSIONINFO); GetVersionEx(&os); tkPlatformId = os.dwPlatformId; - - /* Set tkWinTheme to be TK_THEME_WIN_XP or TK_THEME_WIN_CLASSIC. - * The TK_THEME_WIN_CLASSIC could be set even when running - * under XP if the windows classic theme was selected. */ + + /* + * Set tkWinTheme to be TK_THEME_WIN_XP or TK_THEME_WIN_CLASSIC. The + * TK_THEME_WIN_CLASSIC could be set even when running under XP if the + * windows classic theme was selected. + */ if ((os.dwPlatformId == VER_PLATFORM_WIN32_NT) && (os.dwMajorVersion == 5 && os.dwMinorVersion == 1)) { - HKEY hKey; + HKEY hKey; LPCSTR szSubKey = TEXT("Control Panel\\Appearance"); LPCSTR szCurrent = TEXT("Current"); - DWORD dwSize = 200; + DWORD dwSize = 200; char pBuffer[200]; + memset(pBuffer, 0, dwSize); if (RegOpenKeyEx(HKEY_CURRENT_USER, szSubKey, 0L, KEY_READ, &hKey) != ERROR_SUCCESS) { @@ -414,8 +418,8 @@ TkWinGetPlatformId() * * Results: * The return value is one of: - * TK_THEME_WIN_CLASSIC 95/98/NT or XP in classic mode - * TK_THEME_WIN_XP XP not in classic mode + * TK_THEME_WIN_CLASSIC 95/98/NT or XP in classic mode + * TK_THEME_WIN_XP XP not in classic mode * * Side effects: * Could invoke TkWinGetPlatformId. @@ -424,7 +428,7 @@ TkWinGetPlatformId() */ int -TkWinGetPlatformTheme() +TkWinGetPlatformTheme(void) { if (tkPlatformId == 0) { TkWinGetPlatformId(); @@ -450,9 +454,9 @@ TkWinGetPlatformTheme() */ CONST char * -TkGetDefaultScreenName(interp, screenName) - Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Not used. */ - CONST char *screenName; /* If NULL, use default string. */ +TkGetDefaultScreenName( + Tcl_Interp *interp, /* Not used. */ + CONST char *screenName) /* If NULL, use default string. */ { if ((screenName == NULL) || (screenName[0] == '\0')) { screenName = winScreenName; @@ -478,7 +482,8 @@ TkGetDefaultScreenName(interp, screenName) */ void -TkWinDisplayChanged(Display *display) +TkWinDisplayChanged( + Display *display) { HDC dc; Screen *screen; @@ -499,9 +504,9 @@ TkWinDisplayChanged(Display *display) /* * On windows, when creating a color bitmap, need two pieces of * information: the number of color planes and the number of pixels per - * plane. Need to remember both quantities so that when constructing an + * plane. Need to remember both quantities so that when constructing an * HBITMAP for offscreen rendering, we can specify the correct value for - * the number of planes. Otherwise the HBITMAP won't be compatible with + * the number of planes. Otherwise the HBITMAP won't be compatible with * the HWND and we'll just get blank spots copied onto the screen. */ @@ -559,8 +564,8 @@ TkWinDisplayChanged(Display *display) * * TkpOpenDisplay -- * - * Create the Display structure and fill it with device - * specific information. + * Create the Display structure and fill it with device specific + * information. * * Results: * Returns a TkDisplay structure on success or NULL on failure. @@ -572,17 +577,17 @@ TkWinDisplayChanged(Display *display) */ TkDisplay * -TkpOpenDisplay(display_name) - CONST char *display_name; +TkpOpenDisplay( + CONST char *display_name) { Screen *screen; TkWinDrawable *twdPtr; Display *display; - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); if (tsdPtr->winDisplay != NULL) { - if (strcmp(tsdPtr->winDisplay->display->display_name, display_name) + if (strcmp(tsdPtr->winDisplay->display->display_name, display_name) == 0) { return tsdPtr->winDisplay; } else { @@ -658,11 +663,11 @@ TkpOpenDisplay(display_name) */ void -TkpCloseDisplay(dispPtr) - TkDisplay *dispPtr; +TkpCloseDisplay( + TkDisplay *dispPtr) { Display *display = dispPtr->display; - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); if (dispPtr != tsdPtr->winDisplay) { @@ -695,11 +700,10 @@ TkpCloseDisplay(dispPtr) * * TkClipCleanup -- * - * This procedure is called to cleanup resources associated with - * claiming clipboard ownership and for receiving selection get - * results. This function is called in tkWindow.c. This has to be - * called by the display cleanup function because we still need the - * access display elements. + * This function is called to cleanup resources associated with claiming + * clipboard ownership and for receiving selection get results. This + * function is called in tkWindow.c. This has to be called by the display + * cleanup function because we still need the access display elements. * * Results: * None. @@ -711,8 +715,8 @@ TkpCloseDisplay(dispPtr) */ void -TkClipCleanup(dispPtr) - TkDisplay *dispPtr; /* display associated with clipboard */ +TkClipCleanup( + TkDisplay *dispPtr) /* Display associated with clipboard. */ { if (dispPtr->clipWindow != NULL) { /* @@ -720,6 +724,7 @@ TkClipCleanup(dispPtr) */ HWND hwnd = Tk_GetHWND(Tk_WindowId(dispPtr->clipWindow)); + if (GetClipboardOwner() == hwnd) { OpenClipboard(hwnd); EmptyClipboard(); @@ -755,9 +760,9 @@ TkClipCleanup(dispPtr) */ void -XBell(display, percent) - Display* display; - int percent; +XBell( + Display *display, + int percent) { MessageBeep(MB_OK); } @@ -767,8 +772,7 @@ XBell(display, percent) * * TkWinChildProc -- * - * Callback from Windows whenever an event occurs on a child - * window. + * Callback from Windows whenever an event occurs on a child window. * * Results: * Standard Windows return value. @@ -780,69 +784,68 @@ XBell(display, percent) */ LRESULT CALLBACK -TkWinChildProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) - HWND hwnd; - UINT message; - WPARAM wParam; - LPARAM lParam; +TkWinChildProc( + HWND hwnd, + UINT message, + WPARAM wParam, + LPARAM lParam) { LRESULT result; switch (message) { - case WM_INPUTLANGCHANGE: - UpdateInputLanguage(wParam); - result = 1; - break; - - case WM_IME_COMPOSITION: - result = 0; - if (HandleIMEComposition(hwnd, lParam) == 0) { - result = DefWindowProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam); - } - break; - - case WM_SETCURSOR: - /* - * Short circuit the WM_SETCURSOR message since we set - * the cursor elsewhere. - */ - - result = TRUE; - break; - - case WM_CREATE: - case WM_ERASEBKGND: - result = 0; - break; - - case WM_PAINT: - GenerateXEvent(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam); + case WM_INPUTLANGCHANGE: + UpdateInputLanguage(wParam); + result = 1; + break; + + case WM_IME_COMPOSITION: + result = 0; + if (HandleIMEComposition(hwnd, lParam) == 0) { result = DefWindowProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam); - break; + } + break; - case TK_CLAIMFOCUS: - case TK_GEOMETRYREQ: - case TK_ATTACHWINDOW: - case TK_DETACHWINDOW: - case TK_ICONIFY: - case TK_DEICONIFY: - case TK_MOVEWINDOW: - case TK_WITHDRAW: - case TK_RAISEWINDOW: - case TK_GETFRAMEWID: - case TK_OVERRIDEREDIRECT: - case TK_SETMENU: - case TK_STATE: - case TK_INFO: - result = TkWinEmbeddedEventProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam); - break; + case WM_SETCURSOR: + /* + * Short circuit the WM_SETCURSOR message since we set the cursor + * elsewhere. + */ - default: - if (!Tk_TranslateWinEvent(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam, - &result)) { - result = DefWindowProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam); - } - break; + result = TRUE; + break; + + case WM_CREATE: + case WM_ERASEBKGND: + result = 0; + break; + + case WM_PAINT: + GenerateXEvent(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam); + result = DefWindowProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam); + break; + + case TK_CLAIMFOCUS: + case TK_GEOMETRYREQ: + case TK_ATTACHWINDOW: + case TK_DETACHWINDOW: + case TK_ICONIFY: + case TK_DEICONIFY: + case TK_MOVEWINDOW: + case TK_WITHDRAW: + case TK_RAISEWINDOW: + case TK_GETFRAMEWID: + case TK_OVERRIDEREDIRECT: + case TK_SETMENU: + case TK_STATE: + case TK_INFO: + result = TkWinEmbeddedEventProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam); + break; + + default: + if (!Tk_TranslateWinEvent(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam, &result)) { + result = DefWindowProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam); + } + break; } /* @@ -858,8 +861,8 @@ TkWinChildProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) * * Tk_TranslateWinEvent -- * - * This function is called by widget window procedures to handle - * the translation from Win32 events to Tk events. + * This function is called by widget window functions to handle the + * translation from Win32 events to Tk events. * * Results: * Returns 1 if the event was handled, else 0. @@ -871,74 +874,79 @@ TkWinChildProc(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) */ int -Tk_TranslateWinEvent(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam, resultPtr) - HWND hwnd; - UINT message; - WPARAM wParam; - LPARAM lParam; - LRESULT *resultPtr; +Tk_TranslateWinEvent( + HWND hwnd, + UINT message, + WPARAM wParam, + LPARAM lParam, + LRESULT *resultPtr) { *resultPtr = 0; switch (message) { - case WM_RENDERFORMAT: { - TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) Tk_HWNDToWindow(hwnd); - if (winPtr) { - TkWinClipboardRender(winPtr->dispPtr, wParam); - } - return 1; + case WM_RENDERFORMAT: { + TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *) Tk_HWNDToWindow(hwnd); + + if (winPtr) { + TkWinClipboardRender(winPtr->dispPtr, wParam); } + return 1; + } - case WM_COMMAND: - case WM_NOTIFY: - case WM_VSCROLL: - case WM_HSCROLL: { - /* - * Reflect these messages back to the sender so that they - * can be handled by the window proc for the control. Note - * that we need to be careful not to reflect a message that - * is targeted to this window, or we will loop. - */ + case WM_COMMAND: + case WM_NOTIFY: + case WM_VSCROLL: + case WM_HSCROLL: { + /* + * Reflect these messages back to the sender so that they can be + * handled by the window proc for the control. Note that we need to be + * careful not to reflect a message that is targeted to this window, + * or we will loop. + */ - HWND target = (message == WM_NOTIFY) + HWND target = (message == WM_NOTIFY) ? ((NMHDR*)lParam)->hwndFrom : (HWND) lParam; - if (target && target != hwnd) { - *resultPtr = SendMessage(target, message, wParam, lParam); - return 1; - } - break; - } - case WM_LBUTTONDOWN: - case WM_LBUTTONDBLCLK: - case WM_MBUTTONDOWN: - case WM_MBUTTONDBLCLK: - case WM_RBUTTONDOWN: - case WM_RBUTTONDBLCLK: - case WM_LBUTTONUP: - case WM_MBUTTONUP: - case WM_RBUTTONUP: - case WM_MOUSEMOVE: - Tk_PointerEvent(hwnd, (short) LOWORD(lParam), - (short) HIWORD(lParam)); + if (target && target != hwnd) { + *resultPtr = SendMessage(target, message, wParam, lParam); return 1; + } + break; + } - case WM_CLOSE: - case WM_SETFOCUS: - case WM_KILLFOCUS: - case WM_DESTROYCLIPBOARD: - case WM_CHAR: - case WM_SYSKEYDOWN: - case WM_SYSKEYUP: - case WM_KEYDOWN: - case WM_KEYUP: - case WM_MOUSEWHEEL: - GenerateXEvent(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam); - return 1; - case WM_MENUCHAR: - GenerateXEvent(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam); - /* MNC_CLOSE is the only one that looks right. This is a hack. */ - *resultPtr = MAKELONG (0, MNC_CLOSE); - return 1; + case WM_LBUTTONDOWN: + case WM_LBUTTONDBLCLK: + case WM_MBUTTONDOWN: + case WM_MBUTTONDBLCLK: + case WM_RBUTTONDOWN: + case WM_RBUTTONDBLCLK: + case WM_LBUTTONUP: + case WM_MBUTTONUP: + case WM_RBUTTONUP: + case WM_MOUSEMOVE: + Tk_PointerEvent(hwnd, (short) LOWORD(lParam), (short) HIWORD(lParam)); + return 1; + + case WM_CLOSE: + case WM_SETFOCUS: + case WM_KILLFOCUS: + case WM_DESTROYCLIPBOARD: + case WM_CHAR: + case WM_SYSKEYDOWN: + case WM_SYSKEYUP: + case WM_KEYDOWN: + case WM_KEYUP: + case WM_MOUSEWHEEL: + GenerateXEvent(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam); + return 1; + case WM_MENUCHAR: + GenerateXEvent(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam); + + /* + * MNC_CLOSE is the only one that looks right. This is a hack. + */ + + *resultPtr = MAKELONG (0, MNC_CLOSE); + return 1; } return 0; } @@ -948,8 +956,8 @@ Tk_TranslateWinEvent(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam, resultPtr) * * GenerateXEvent -- * - * This routine generates an X event from the corresponding - * Windows event. + * This routine generates an X event from the corresponding Windows + * event. * * Results: * None. @@ -961,15 +969,15 @@ Tk_TranslateWinEvent(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam, resultPtr) */ static void -GenerateXEvent(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) - HWND hwnd; - UINT message; - WPARAM wParam; - LPARAM lParam; +GenerateXEvent( + HWND hwnd, + UINT message, + WPARAM wParam, + LPARAM lParam) { XEvent event; TkWindow *winPtr = (TkWindow *)Tk_HWNDToWindow(hwnd); - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); if (!winPtr || winPtr->window == None) { @@ -982,243 +990,237 @@ GenerateXEvent(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) event.xany.window = winPtr->window; switch (message) { - case WM_PAINT: { - PAINTSTRUCT ps; - - event.type = Expose; - BeginPaint(hwnd, &ps); - event.xexpose.x = ps.rcPaint.left; - event.xexpose.y = ps.rcPaint.top; - event.xexpose.width = ps.rcPaint.right - ps.rcPaint.left; - event.xexpose.height = ps.rcPaint.bottom - ps.rcPaint.top; - EndPaint(hwnd, &ps); - event.xexpose.count = 0; - break; - } + case WM_PAINT: { + PAINTSTRUCT ps; + + event.type = Expose; + BeginPaint(hwnd, &ps); + event.xexpose.x = ps.rcPaint.left; + event.xexpose.y = ps.rcPaint.top; + event.xexpose.width = ps.rcPaint.right - ps.rcPaint.left; + event.xexpose.height = ps.rcPaint.bottom - ps.rcPaint.top; + EndPaint(hwnd, &ps); + event.xexpose.count = 0; + break; + } - case WM_CLOSE: - event.type = ClientMessage; - event.xclient.message_type = + case WM_CLOSE: + event.type = ClientMessage; + event.xclient.message_type = Tk_InternAtom((Tk_Window) winPtr, "WM_PROTOCOLS"); - event.xclient.format = 32; - event.xclient.data.l[0] = + event.xclient.format = 32; + event.xclient.data.l[0] = Tk_InternAtom((Tk_Window) winPtr, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW"); - break; + break; - case WM_SETFOCUS: - case WM_KILLFOCUS: { - TkWindow *otherWinPtr = (TkWindow *)Tk_HWNDToWindow((HWND) wParam); - - /* - * Compare toplevel windows to avoid reporting focus - * changes within the same toplevel. - */ + case WM_SETFOCUS: + case WM_KILLFOCUS: { + TkWindow *otherWinPtr = (TkWindow *)Tk_HWNDToWindow((HWND) wParam); - while (!(winPtr->flags & TK_TOP_LEVEL)) { - winPtr = winPtr->parentPtr; - if (winPtr == NULL) { - return; - } - } - while (otherWinPtr && !(otherWinPtr->flags & TK_TOP_LEVEL)) { - otherWinPtr = otherWinPtr->parentPtr; - } - - /* - * Do a catch-all Tk_SetCaretPos here to make sure that the - * window receiving focus sets the caret at least once. - */ - if (message == WM_SETFOCUS) { - Tk_SetCaretPos((Tk_Window) winPtr, 0, 0, 0); - } + /* + * Compare toplevel windows to avoid reporting focus changes within + * the same toplevel. + */ - if (otherWinPtr == winPtr) { + while (!(winPtr->flags & TK_TOP_LEVEL)) { + winPtr = winPtr->parentPtr; + if (winPtr == NULL) { return; } + } + while (otherWinPtr && !(otherWinPtr->flags & TK_TOP_LEVEL)) { + otherWinPtr = otherWinPtr->parentPtr; + } - event.xany.window = winPtr->window; - event.type = (message == WM_SETFOCUS) ? FocusIn : FocusOut; - event.xfocus.mode = NotifyNormal; - event.xfocus.detail = NotifyNonlinear; + /* + * Do a catch-all Tk_SetCaretPos here to make sure that the window + * receiving focus sets the caret at least once. + */ + if (message == WM_SETFOCUS) { + Tk_SetCaretPos((Tk_Window) winPtr, 0, 0, 0); + } + + if (otherWinPtr == winPtr) { + return; + } + + event.xany.window = winPtr->window; + event.type = (message == WM_SETFOCUS) ? FocusIn : FocusOut; + event.xfocus.mode = NotifyNormal; + event.xfocus.detail = NotifyNonlinear; + + /* + * Destroy the caret if we own it. If we are moving to another Tk + * window, it will reclaim and reposition it with Tk_SetCaretPos. + */ + + if (message == WM_KILLFOCUS) { + DestroyCaret(); + } + break; + } + + case WM_DESTROYCLIPBOARD: + if (tsdPtr->updatingClipboard == TRUE) { /* - * Destroy the caret if we own it. If we are moving to another Tk - * window, it will reclaim and reposition it with Tk_SetCaretPos. + * We want to avoid this event if we are the ones that caused this + * event. */ - if (message == WM_KILLFOCUS) { - DestroyCaret(); - } - break; - } - case WM_DESTROYCLIPBOARD: - if (tsdPtr->updatingClipboard == TRUE) { - /* - * We want to avoid this event if we are the ones that caused - * this event. - */ - return; - } - event.type = SelectionClear; - event.xselectionclear.selection = + return; + } + event.type = SelectionClear; + event.xselectionclear.selection = Tk_InternAtom((Tk_Window)winPtr, "CLIPBOARD"); - event.xselectionclear.time = TkpGetMS(); - break; + event.xselectionclear.time = TkpGetMS(); + break; + + case WM_MOUSEWHEEL: + /* + * The mouse wheel event is closer to a key event than a mouse event + * in that the message is sent to the window that has focus. + */ + + case WM_CHAR: + case WM_SYSKEYDOWN: + case WM_SYSKEYUP: + case WM_KEYDOWN: + case WM_KEYUP: { + unsigned int state = GetState(message, wParam, lParam); + Time time = TkpGetMS(); + POINT clientPoint; + POINTS rootPoint; /* Note: POINT and POINTS are different */ + DWORD msgPos; + + /* + * Compute the screen and window coordinates of the event. + */ + + msgPos = GetMessagePos(); + rootPoint = MAKEPOINTS(msgPos); + clientPoint.x = rootPoint.x; + clientPoint.y = rootPoint.y; + ScreenToClient(hwnd, &clientPoint); + + /* + * Set up the common event fields. + */ + event.xbutton.root = RootWindow(winPtr->display, winPtr->screenNum); + event.xbutton.subwindow = None; + event.xbutton.x = clientPoint.x; + event.xbutton.y = clientPoint.y; + event.xbutton.x_root = rootPoint.x; + event.xbutton.y_root = rootPoint.y; + event.xbutton.state = state; + event.xbutton.time = time; + event.xbutton.same_screen = True; + + /* + * Now set up event specific fields. + */ + + switch (message) { case WM_MOUSEWHEEL: /* - * The mouse wheel event is closer to a key event than a - * mouse event in that the message is sent to the window - * that has focus. + * We have invented a new X event type to handle this event. It + * still uses the KeyPress struct. However, the keycode field has + * been overloaded to hold the zDelta of the wheel. Set nbytes to + * 0 to prevent conversion of the keycode to a keysym in + * TkpGetString. [Bug 1118340]. */ - case WM_CHAR: + event.type = MouseWheelEvent; + event.xany.send_event = -1; + event.xkey.nbytes = 0; + event.xkey.keycode = (short) HIWORD(wParam); + break; case WM_SYSKEYDOWN: - case WM_SYSKEYUP: case WM_KEYDOWN: - case WM_KEYUP: { - unsigned int state = GetState(message, wParam, lParam); - Time time = TkpGetMS(); - POINT clientPoint; - POINTS rootPoint; /* Note: POINT and POINTS are different */ - DWORD msgPos; - /* - * Compute the screen and window coordinates of the event. + * Check for translated characters in the event queue. Setting + * xany.send_event to -1 indicates to the Windows implementation + * of TkpGetString() that this event was generated by windows and + * that the Windows extension xkey.trans_chars is filled with the + * MBCS characters that came from the TranslateMessage call. */ - msgPos = GetMessagePos(); - rootPoint = MAKEPOINTS(msgPos); - clientPoint.x = rootPoint.x; - clientPoint.y = rootPoint.y; - ScreenToClient(hwnd, &clientPoint); + event.type = KeyPress; + event.xany.send_event = -1; + event.xkey.keycode = wParam; + GetTranslatedKey(&event.xkey); + break; + case WM_SYSKEYUP: + case WM_KEYUP: /* - * Set up the common event fields. + * We don't check for translated characters on keyup because Tk + * won't know what to do with them. Instead, we wait for the + * WM_CHAR messages which will follow. */ - event.xbutton.root = RootWindow(winPtr->display, - winPtr->screenNum); - event.xbutton.subwindow = None; - event.xbutton.x = clientPoint.x; - event.xbutton.y = clientPoint.y; - event.xbutton.x_root = rootPoint.x; - event.xbutton.y_root = rootPoint.y; - event.xbutton.state = state; - event.xbutton.time = time; - event.xbutton.same_screen = True; + event.type = KeyRelease; + event.xkey.keycode = wParam; + event.xkey.nbytes = 0; + break; + case WM_CHAR: /* - * Now set up event specific fields. + * Synthesize both a KeyPress and a KeyRelease. Strings generated + * by Input Method Editor are handled in the following manner: + * 1. A series of WM_KEYDOWN & WM_KEYUP messages that cause + * GetTranslatedKey() to be called and return immediately + * because the WM_KEYDOWNs have no associated WM_CHAR messages + * -- the IME window is accumulating the characters and + * translating them itself. In the "bind" command, you get an + * event with a mystery keysym and %A == "" for each WM_KEYDOWN + * that actually was meant for the IME. + * 2. A WM_KEYDOWN corresponding to the "confirm typing" + * character. This causes GetTranslatedKey() to be called. + * 3. A WM_IME_NOTIFY message saying that the IME is done. A side + * effect of this message is that GetTranslatedKey() thinks + * this means that there are no WM_CHAR messages and returns + * immediately. In the "bind" command, you get an another event + * with a mystery keysym and %A == "". + * 4. A sequence of WM_CHAR messages that correspond to the + * characters in the IME window. A bunch of simulated + * KeyPress/KeyRelease events will be generated, one for each + * character. Adjacent WM_CHAR messages may actually specify + * the high and low bytes of a multi-byte character -- in that + * case the two WM_CHAR messages will be combined into one + * event. It is the event-consumer's responsibility to convert + * the string returned from XLookupString from system encoding + * to UTF-8. + * 5. And finally we get the WM_KEYUP for the "confirm typing" + * character. */ - switch (message) { - case WM_MOUSEWHEEL: - /* - * We have invented a new X event type to handle - * this event. It still uses the KeyPress struct. - * However, the keycode field has been overloaded - * to hold the zDelta of the wheel. Set nbytes to 0 - * to prevent conversion of the keycode to a keysym - * in TkpGetString. [Bug 1118340]. - */ - - event.type = MouseWheelEvent; - event.xany.send_event = -1; - event.xkey.nbytes = 0; - event.xkey.keycode = (short) HIWORD(wParam); - break; - case WM_SYSKEYDOWN: - case WM_KEYDOWN: - /* - * Check for translated characters in the event queue. - * Setting xany.send_event to -1 indicates to the - * Windows implementation of TkpGetString() that this - * event was generated by windows and that the Windows - * extension xkey.trans_chars is filled with the - * MBCS characters that came from the TranslateMessage - * call. - */ - - event.type = KeyPress; - event.xany.send_event = -1; - event.xkey.keycode = wParam; - GetTranslatedKey(&event.xkey); - break; + event.type = KeyPress; + event.xany.send_event = -1; + event.xkey.keycode = 0; + event.xkey.nbytes = 1; + event.xkey.trans_chars[0] = (char) wParam; - case WM_SYSKEYUP: - case WM_KEYUP: - /* - * We don't check for translated characters on keyup - * because Tk won't know what to do with them. Instead, we - * wait for the WM_CHAR messages which will follow. - */ - event.type = KeyRelease; - event.xkey.keycode = wParam; - event.xkey.nbytes = 0; - break; + if (IsDBCSLeadByte((BYTE) wParam)) { + MSG msg; - case WM_CHAR: - /* - * Synthesize both a KeyPress and a KeyRelease. - * Strings generated by Input Method Editor are handled - * in the following manner: - * 1. A series of WM_KEYDOWN & WM_KEYUP messages that - * cause GetTranslatedKey() to be called and return - * immediately because the WM_KEYDOWNs have no - * associated WM_CHAR messages -- the IME window is - * accumulating the characters and translating them - * itself. In the "bind" command, you get an event - * with a mystery keysym and %A == "" for each - * WM_KEYDOWN that actually was meant for the IME. - * 2. A WM_KEYDOWN corresponding to the "confirm typing" - * character. This causes GetTranslatedKey() to be - * called. - * 3. A WM_IME_NOTIFY message saying that the IME is - * done. A side effect of this message is that - * GetTranslatedKey() thinks this means that there - * are no WM_CHAR messages and returns immediately. - * In the "bind" command, you get an another event - * with a mystery keysym and %A == "". - * 4. A sequence of WM_CHAR messages that correspond to - * the characters in the IME window. A bunch of - * simulated KeyPress/KeyRelease events will be - * generated, one for each character. Adjacent - * WM_CHAR messages may actually specify the high - * and low bytes of a multi-byte character -- in that - * case the two WM_CHAR messages will be combined into - * one event. It is the event-consumer's - * responsibility to convert the string returned from - * XLookupString from system encoding to UTF-8. - * 5. And finally we get the WM_KEYUP for the "confirm - * typing" character. - */ - - event.type = KeyPress; - event.xany.send_event = -1; - event.xkey.keycode = 0; - event.xkey.nbytes = 1; - event.xkey.trans_chars[0] = (char) wParam; - - if (IsDBCSLeadByte((BYTE) wParam)) { - MSG msg; - - if ((PeekMessage(&msg, NULL, 0, 0, PM_NOREMOVE) != 0) - && (msg.message == WM_CHAR)) { - GetMessage(&msg, NULL, 0, 0); - event.xkey.nbytes = 2; - event.xkey.trans_chars[1] = (char) msg.wParam; - } - } - Tk_QueueWindowEvent(&event, TCL_QUEUE_TAIL); - event.type = KeyRelease; - break; + if ((PeekMessage(&msg, NULL, 0, 0, PM_NOREMOVE) != 0) + && (msg.message == WM_CHAR)) { + GetMessage(&msg, NULL, 0, 0); + event.xkey.nbytes = 2; + event.xkey.trans_chars[1] = (char) msg.wParam; + } } + Tk_QueueWindowEvent(&event, TCL_QUEUE_TAIL); + event.type = KeyRelease; break; } + break; + } - default: - return; + default: + return; } Tk_QueueWindowEvent(&event, TCL_QUEUE_TAIL); } @@ -1228,12 +1230,12 @@ GenerateXEvent(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) * * GetState -- * - * This function constructs a state mask for the mouse buttons - * and modifier keys as they were before the event occured. + * This function constructs a state mask for the mouse buttons and + * modifier keys as they were before the event occured. * * Results: - * Returns a composite value of all the modifier and button state - * flags that were set at the time the event occurred. + * Returns a composite value of all the modifier and button state flags + * that were set at the time the event occurred. * * Side effects: * None. @@ -1242,18 +1244,18 @@ GenerateXEvent(hwnd, message, wParam, lParam) */ static unsigned int -GetState(message, wParam, lParam) - UINT message; /* Win32 message type */ - WPARAM wParam; /* wParam of message, used if key message */ - LPARAM lParam; /* lParam of message, used if key message */ +GetState( + UINT message, /* Win32 message type */ + WPARAM wParam, /* wParam of message, used if key message */ + LPARAM lParam) /* lParam of message, used if key message */ { int mask; int prevState; /* 1 if key was previously down */ unsigned int state = TkWinGetModifierState(); /* - * If the event is a key press or release, we check for modifier - * keys so we can report the state of the world before the event. + * If the event is a key press or release, we check for modifier keys so + * we can report the state of the world before the event. */ if (message == WM_SYSKEYDOWN || message == WM_KEYDOWN @@ -1261,33 +1263,33 @@ GetState(message, wParam, lParam) mask = 0; prevState = HIWORD(lParam) & KF_REPEAT; switch(wParam) { - case VK_SHIFT: - mask = ShiftMask; - break; - case VK_CONTROL: - mask = ControlMask; - break; - case VK_MENU: - mask = ALT_MASK; - break; - case VK_CAPITAL: - if (message == WM_SYSKEYDOWN || message == WM_KEYDOWN) { - mask = LockMask; - prevState = ((state & mask) ^ prevState) ? 0 : 1; - } - break; - case VK_NUMLOCK: - if (message == WM_SYSKEYDOWN || message == WM_KEYDOWN) { - mask = Mod1Mask; - prevState = ((state & mask) ^ prevState) ? 0 : 1; - } - break; - case VK_SCROLL: - if (message == WM_SYSKEYDOWN || message == WM_KEYDOWN) { - mask = Mod3Mask; - prevState = ((state & mask) ^ prevState) ? 0 : 1; - } - break; + case VK_SHIFT: + mask = ShiftMask; + break; + case VK_CONTROL: + mask = ControlMask; + break; + case VK_MENU: + mask = ALT_MASK; + break; + case VK_CAPITAL: + if (message == WM_SYSKEYDOWN || message == WM_KEYDOWN) { + mask = LockMask; + prevState = ((state & mask) ^ prevState) ? 0 : 1; + } + break; + case VK_NUMLOCK: + if (message == WM_SYSKEYDOWN || message == WM_KEYDOWN) { + mask = Mod1Mask; + prevState = ((state & mask) ^ prevState) ? 0 : 1; + } + break; + case VK_SCROLL: + if (message == WM_SYSKEYDOWN || message == WM_KEYDOWN) { + mask = Mod3Mask; + prevState = ((state & mask) ^ prevState) ? 0 : 1; + } + break; } if (prevState) { state |= mask; @@ -1310,26 +1312,26 @@ GetState(message, wParam, lParam) * * GetTranslatedKey -- * - * Retrieves WM_CHAR messages that are placed on the system queue - * by the TranslateMessage system call and places them in the - * given KeyPress event. + * Retrieves WM_CHAR messages that are placed on the system queue by the + * TranslateMessage system call and places them in the given KeyPress + * event. * * Results: * Sets the trans_chars and nbytes member of the key event. * * Side effects: - * Removes any WM_CHAR messages waiting on the top of the system - * event queue. + * Removes any WM_CHAR messages waiting on the top of the system event + * queue. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ static void -GetTranslatedKey(xkey) - XKeyEvent *xkey; +GetTranslatedKey( + XKeyEvent *xkey) { MSG msg; - + xkey->nbytes = 0; while ((xkey->nbytes < XMaxTransChars) @@ -1338,11 +1340,10 @@ GetTranslatedKey(xkey) GetMessage(&msg, NULL, 0, 0); /* - * If this is a normal character message, we may need to strip - * off the Alt modifier (e.g. Alt-digits). Note that we don't - * want to do this for system messages, because those were - * presumably generated as an Alt-char sequence (e.g. accelerator - * keys). + * If this is a normal character message, we may need to strip off + * the Alt modifier (e.g. Alt-digits). Note that we don't want to + * do this for system messages, because those were presumably + * generated as an Alt-char sequence (e.g. accelerator keys). */ if ((msg.message == WM_CHAR) && (msg.lParam & 0x20000000)) { @@ -1353,11 +1354,10 @@ GetTranslatedKey(xkey) if (((unsigned short) msg.wParam) > ((unsigned short) 0xff)) { /* - * Some "addon" input devices, such as the popular - * PenPower Chinese writing pad, generate 16 bit - * values in WM_CHAR messages (instead of passing them - * in two separate WM_CHAR messages containing two - * 8-bit values. + * Some "addon" input devices, such as the popular PenPower + * Chinese writing pad, generate 16 bit values in WM_CHAR + * messages (instead of passing them in two separate WM_CHAR + * messages containing two 8-bit values. */ xkey->trans_chars[xkey->nbytes] = (char) (msg.wParam >> 8); @@ -1374,13 +1374,12 @@ GetTranslatedKey(xkey) * * UpdateInputLanguage -- * - * Gets called when a WM_INPUTLANGCHANGE message is received - * by the TK child window procedure. This message is sent - * by the Input Method Editor system when the user chooses - * a different input method. All subsequent WM_CHAR - * messages will contain characters in the new encoding. We record - * the new encoding so that TkpGetString() knows how to - * correctly translate the WM_CHAR into unicode. + * Gets called when a WM_INPUTLANGCHANGE message is received by the TK + * child window function. This message is sent by the Input Method Editor + * system when the user chooses a different input method. All subsequent + * WM_CHAR messages will contain characters in the new encoding. We + * record the new encoding so that TkpGetString() knows how to correctly + * translate the WM_CHAR into unicode. * * Results: * Records the new encoding in keyInputEncoding. @@ -1392,8 +1391,8 @@ GetTranslatedKey(xkey) */ static void -UpdateInputLanguage(charset) - int charset; +UpdateInputLanguage( + int charset) { CHARSETINFO charsetInfo; Tcl_Encoding encoding; @@ -1434,8 +1433,8 @@ UpdateInputLanguage(charset) * * TkWinGetKeyInputEncoding -- * - * Returns the current keyboard input encoding selected by the - * user (with WM_INPUTLANGCHANGE events). + * Returns the current keyboard input encoding selected by the user (with + * WM_INPUTLANGCHANGE events). * * Results: * The current keyboard input encoding. @@ -1447,7 +1446,7 @@ UpdateInputLanguage(charset) */ Tcl_Encoding -TkWinGetKeyInputEncoding() +TkWinGetKeyInputEncoding(void) { return keyInputEncoding; } @@ -1469,7 +1468,7 @@ TkWinGetKeyInputEncoding() */ Tcl_Encoding -TkWinGetUnicodeEncoding() +TkWinGetUnicodeEncoding(void) { if (unicodeEncoding == NULL) { unicodeEncoding = Tcl_GetEncoding(NULL, "unicode"); @@ -1482,19 +1481,18 @@ TkWinGetUnicodeEncoding() * * HandleIMEComposition -- * - * This function works around a definciency in some versions - * of Windows 2000 to make it possible to entry multi-lingual - * characters under all versions of Windows 2000. + * This function works around a definciency in some versions of Windows + * 2000 to make it possible to entry multi-lingual characters under all + * versions of Windows 2000. * - * When an Input Method Editor (IME) is ready to send input - * characters to an application, it sends a WM_IME_COMPOSITION - * message with the GCS_RESULTSTR. However, The DefWindowProc() - * on English Windows 2000 arbitrarily converts all non-Latin-1 - * characters in the composition to "?". + * When an Input Method Editor (IME) is ready to send input characters to + * an application, it sends a WM_IME_COMPOSITION message with the + * GCS_RESULTSTR. However, The DefWindowProc() on English Windows 2000 + * arbitrarily converts all non-Latin-1 characters in the composition to + * "?". * - * This function correctly processes the composition data and - * sends the UNICODE values of the composed characters to - * TK's event queue. + * This function correctly processes the composition data and sends the + * UNICODE values of the composed characters to TK's event queue. * * Results: * If this function has processed the composition data, returns 1. @@ -1507,10 +1505,9 @@ TkWinGetUnicodeEncoding() */ static int -HandleIMEComposition(hwnd, lParam) - HWND hwnd; /* Window receiving the message. */ - LPARAM lParam; /* Flags for the WM_IME_COMPOSITION - * message */ +HandleIMEComposition( + HWND hwnd, /* Window receiving the message. */ + LPARAM lParam) /* Flags for the WM_IME_COMPOSITION message */ { HIMC hIMC; int i, n; @@ -1551,10 +1548,11 @@ HandleIMEComposition(hwnd, lParam) i = Tcl_DStringLength(&unicodeString); if (n < i) { /* - * Only alloc more space if we need, otherwise just - * use what we've created. Don't realloc as that may - * copy data we no longer need. + * Only alloc more space if we need, otherwise just use + * what we've created. Don't realloc as that may copy data + * we no longer need. */ + ckfree((char *) buff); buff = (char *) ckalloc(i); } @@ -1568,9 +1566,9 @@ HandleIMEComposition(hwnd, lParam) * Set up the fields pertinent to key event. * * We set send_event to the special value of -2, so that - * TkpGetString() in tkWinKey.c knows that trans_chars[] - * already contains a UNICODE char and there's no need to - * do encoding conversion. + * TkpGetString in tkWinKey.c knows that trans_chars[] already + * contains a UNICODE char and there's no need to do encoding + * conversion. */ winPtr = (TkWindow *)Tk_HWNDToWindow(hwnd); @@ -1589,8 +1587,8 @@ HandleIMEComposition(hwnd, lParam) for (i=0; i<n;) { /* - * Simulate a pair of KeyPress and KeyRelease events - * for each UNICODE character in the composition. + * Simulate a pair of KeyPress and KeyRelease events for each + * UNICODE character in the composition. */ event.xkey.trans_chars[0] = (char) buff[i++]; @@ -1629,9 +1627,9 @@ HandleIMEComposition(hwnd, lParam) */ void -Tk_FreeXId(display, xid) - Display *display; - XID xid; +Tk_FreeXId( + Display *display, + XID xid) { } @@ -1641,22 +1639,22 @@ Tk_FreeXId(display, xid) * TkWinResendEvent -- * * This function converts an X event into a Windows event and - * invokes the specified windo procedure. + * invokes the specified windo function. * * Results: * A standard Windows result. * * Side effects: - * Invokes the window procedure + * Invokes the window function * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ LRESULT -TkWinResendEvent(wndproc, hwnd, eventPtr) - WNDPROC wndproc; - HWND hwnd; - XEvent *eventPtr; +TkWinResendEvent( + WNDPROC wndproc, + HWND hwnd, + XEvent *eventPtr) { UINT msg; WPARAM wparam; @@ -1664,20 +1662,20 @@ TkWinResendEvent(wndproc, hwnd, eventPtr) if (eventPtr->type == ButtonPress) { switch (eventPtr->xbutton.button) { - case Button1: - msg = WM_LBUTTONDOWN; - wparam = MK_LBUTTON; - break; - case Button2: - msg = WM_MBUTTONDOWN; - wparam = MK_MBUTTON; - break; - case Button3: - msg = WM_RBUTTONDOWN; - wparam = MK_RBUTTON; - break; - default: - return 0; + case Button1: + msg = WM_LBUTTONDOWN; + wparam = MK_LBUTTON; + break; + case Button2: + msg = WM_MBUTTONDOWN; + wparam = MK_MBUTTON; + break; + case Button3: + msg = WM_RBUTTONDOWN; + wparam = MK_RBUTTON; + break; + default: + return 0; } if (eventPtr->xbutton.state & Button1Mask) { wparam |= MK_LBUTTON; @@ -1707,8 +1705,8 @@ TkWinResendEvent(wndproc, hwnd, eventPtr) * * TkpGetMS -- * - * Return a relative time in milliseconds. It doesn't matter - * when the epoch was. + * Return a relative time in milliseconds. It doesn't matter when the + * epoch was. * * Results: * Number of milliseconds. @@ -1720,7 +1718,7 @@ TkWinResendEvent(wndproc, hwnd, eventPtr) */ unsigned long -TkpGetMS() +TkpGetMS(void) { return GetTickCount(); } @@ -1741,9 +1739,10 @@ TkpGetMS() */ void -TkWinUpdatingClipboard(int mode) +TkWinUpdatingClipboard( + int mode) { - ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) + ThreadSpecificData *tsdPtr = (ThreadSpecificData *) Tcl_GetThreadData(&dataKey, sizeof(ThreadSpecificData)); tsdPtr->updatingClipboard = mode; @@ -1754,17 +1753,17 @@ TkWinUpdatingClipboard(int mode) * * Tk_SetCaretPos -- * - * This enables correct movement of focus in the MS Magnifier, as well - * as allowing us to correctly position the IME Window. The following - * Win32 APIs are used to work with MS caret: + * This enables correct movement of focus in the MS Magnifier, as well as + * allowing us to correctly position the IME Window. The following Win32 + * APIs are used to work with MS caret: * * CreateCaret DestroyCaret SetCaretPos GetCaretPos * - * Only one instance of caret can be active at any time - * (e.g. DestroyCaret API does not take any argument such as handle). - * Since do-it-right approach requires to track the create/destroy - * caret status all the time in a global scope among windows (or - * widgets), we just implement this minimal setup to get the job done. + * Only one instance of caret can be active at any time (e.g. + * DestroyCaret API does not take any argument such as handle). Since + * do-it-right approach requires to track the create/destroy caret status + * all the time in a global scope among windows (or widgets), we just + * implement this minimal setup to get the job done. * * Results: * None @@ -1776,16 +1775,20 @@ TkWinUpdatingClipboard(int mode) */ void -Tk_SetCaretPos(Tk_Window tkwin, int x, int y, int height) +Tk_SetCaretPos( + Tk_Window tkwin, + int x, int y, + int height) { static HWND caretHWND = NULL; TkCaret *caretPtr = &(((TkWindow *) tkwin)->dispPtr->caret); Window win; /* - * Prevent processing anything if the values haven't changed. - * Windows only has one display, so we can do this with statics. + * Prevent processing anything if the values haven't changed. Windows only + * has one display, so we can do this with statics. */ + if ((caretPtr->winPtr == ((TkWindow *) tkwin)) && (caretPtr->x == x) && (caretPtr->y == y)) { return; @@ -1797,9 +1800,8 @@ Tk_SetCaretPos(Tk_Window tkwin, int x, int y, int height) caretPtr->height = height; /* - * We adjust to the toplevel to get the coords right, as setting - * the IME composition window is based on the toplevel hwnd, so - * ignore height. + * We adjust to the toplevel to get the coords right, as setting the IME + * composition window is based on the toplevel hwnd, so ignore height. */ while (!Tk_IsTopLevel(tkwin)) { @@ -1834,6 +1836,7 @@ Tk_SetCaretPos(Tk_Window tkwin, int x, int y, int height) * be converted to the final characters and the other clauses still * stay on the composition window. -- yamamoto */ + hIMC = ImmGetContext(hwnd); if (hIMC) { COMPOSITIONFORM cform; @@ -1855,26 +1858,28 @@ Tk_SetCaretPos(Tk_Window tkwin, int x, int y, int height) * * Results: * Milliseconds of user inactive time or -1 if the user32.dll doesn't - * have the symbol GetLastInputInfo or GetLastInputInfo returns an - * error. + * have the symbol GetLastInputInfo or GetLastInputInfo returns an error. * * Side effects: * None. + * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ long -Tk_GetUserInactiveTime(dpy) - Display *dpy; /* Ignored on Windows */ +Tk_GetUserInactiveTime( + Display *dpy) /* Ignored on Windows */ { struct tagLASTINPUTINFO { UINT cbSize; DWORD dwTime; } li; + /* - * Multiple settings of either of these variables should be OK; - * any thread hazards should just cause inefficiency... + * Multiple settings of either of these variables should be OK; any thread + * hazards should just cause inefficiency... */ + static FARPROC pfnGetLastInputInfo = NULL; static int initinfo = 0; @@ -1894,7 +1899,11 @@ Tk_GetUserInactiveTime(dpy) if (!(BOOL)(pfnGetLastInputInfo)(&li)) { return -1; } - /* last input info is in milliseconds, since restart time. */ + + /* + * Last input info is in milliseconds, since restart time. + */ + return (GetTickCount()-li.dwTime); } @@ -1909,15 +1918,15 @@ Tk_GetUserInactiveTime(dpy) * none * * Side effects: - * The user inactivity timer of the underlaying windowing system - * is reset to zero. + * The user inactivity timer of the underlaying windowing system is reset + * to zero. * *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ void -Tk_ResetUserInactiveTime(dpy) - Display *dpy; +Tk_ResetUserInactiveTime( + Display *dpy) { INPUT inp; @@ -1931,3 +1940,11 @@ Tk_ResetUserInactiveTime(dpy) SendInput(1, &inp, sizeof(inp)); } + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ diff --git a/win/winMain.c b/win/winMain.c index 4f89b2c..5176a00 100644 --- a/win/winMain.c +++ b/win/winMain.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* +/* * winMain.c -- * * Main entry point for wish and other Tk-based applications. @@ -6,10 +6,10 @@ * Copyright (c) 1995-1997 Sun Microsystems, Inc. * Copyright (c) 1998-1999 by Scriptics Corporation. * - * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution - * of this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. + * See the file "license.terms" for information on usage and redistribution of + * this file, and for a DISCLAIMER OF ALL WARRANTIES. * - * RCS: @(#) $Id: winMain.c,v 1.22 2005/09/13 21:25:21 dgp Exp $ + * RCS: @(#) $Id: winMain.c,v 1.23 2005/12/02 00:19:04 dkf Exp $ */ #include <tk.h> @@ -21,16 +21,15 @@ #include "tkInt.h" /* - * The following declarations refer to internal Tk routines. These - * interfaces are available for use, but are not supported. + * The following declarations refer to internal Tk routines. These interfaces + * are available for use, but are not supported. */ - /* * Forward declarations for procedures defined later in this file: */ -static void WishPanic _ANSI_ARGS_((CONST char *format, ...)); +static void WishPanic(CONST char *format, ...); #ifdef TK_TEST extern int Tktest_Init(Tcl_Interp *interp); #endif /* TK_TEST */ @@ -38,27 +37,25 @@ extern int Tktest_Init(Tcl_Interp *interp); static BOOL consoleRequired = TRUE; /* - * The following #if block allows you to change the AppInit - * function by using a #define of TCL_LOCAL_APPINIT instead - * of rewriting this entire file. The #if checks for that - * #define and uses Tcl_AppInit if it doesn't exist. + * The following #if block allows you to change the AppInit function by using + * a #define of TCL_LOCAL_APPINIT instead of rewriting this entire file. The + * #if checks for that #define and uses Tcl_AppInit if it doesn't exist. */ - + #ifndef TK_LOCAL_APPINIT -#define TK_LOCAL_APPINIT Tcl_AppInit +#define TK_LOCAL_APPINIT Tcl_AppInit #endif -extern int TK_LOCAL_APPINIT _ANSI_ARGS_((Tcl_Interp *interp)); - +extern int TK_LOCAL_APPINIT(Tcl_Interp *interp); + /* * The following #if block allows you to change how Tcl finds the startup - * script, prime the library or encoding paths, fiddle with the argv, - * etc., without needing to rewrite Tk_Main() + * script, prime the library or encoding paths, fiddle with the argv, etc., + * without needing to rewrite Tk_Main() */ #ifdef TK_LOCAL_MAIN_HOOK -extern int TK_LOCAL_MAIN_HOOK _ANSI_ARGS_((int *argc, char ***argv)); +extern int TK_LOCAL_MAIN_HOOK(int *argc, char ***argv); #endif - /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -68,8 +65,7 @@ extern int TK_LOCAL_MAIN_HOOK _ANSI_ARGS_((int *argc, char ***argv)); * Main entry point from Windows. * * Results: - * Returns false if initialization fails, otherwise it never - * returns. + * Returns false if initialization fails, otherwise it never returns. * * Side effects: * Just about anything, since from here we call arbitrary Tcl code. @@ -78,11 +74,11 @@ extern int TK_LOCAL_MAIN_HOOK _ANSI_ARGS_((int *argc, char ***argv)); */ int APIENTRY -WinMain(hInstance, hPrevInstance, lpszCmdLine, nCmdShow) - HINSTANCE hInstance; - HINSTANCE hPrevInstance; - LPSTR lpszCmdLine; - int nCmdShow; +WinMain( + HINSTANCE hInstance, + HINSTANCE hPrevInstance, + LPSTR lpszCmdLine, + int nCmdShow) { char **argv; int argc; @@ -91,22 +87,22 @@ WinMain(hInstance, hPrevInstance, lpszCmdLine, nCmdShow) Tcl_SetPanicProc(WishPanic); /* - * Create the console channels and install them as the standard - * channels. All I/O will be discarded until Tk_CreateConsoleWindow is - * called to attach the console to a text widget. + * Create the console channels and install them as the standard channels. + * All I/O will be discarded until Tk_CreateConsoleWindow is called to + * attach the console to a text widget. */ consoleRequired = TRUE; /* - * Set up the default locale to be standard "C" locale so parsing - * is performed correctly. + * Set up the default locale to be standard "C" locale so parsing is + * performed correctly. */ setlocale(LC_ALL, "C"); /* - * Get our args from the c-runtime. Ignore lpszCmdLine. + * Get our args from the c-runtime. Ignore lpszCmdLine. */ argc = __argc; @@ -129,20 +125,19 @@ WinMain(hInstance, hPrevInstance, lpszCmdLine, nCmdShow) Tk_Main(argc, argv, TK_LOCAL_APPINIT); return 1; } - /* *---------------------------------------------------------------------- * * Tcl_AppInit -- * - * This procedure performs application-specific initialization. - * Most applications, especially those that incorporate additional - * packages, will have their own version of this procedure. + * This procedure performs application-specific initialization. Most + * applications, especially those that incorporate additional packages, + * will have their own version of this procedure. * * Results: - * Returns a standard Tcl completion code, and leaves an error - * message in the interp's result if an error occurs. + * Returns a standard Tcl completion code, and leaves an error message in + * the interp's result if an error occurs. * * Side effects: * Depends on the startup script. @@ -151,8 +146,8 @@ WinMain(hInstance, hPrevInstance, lpszCmdLine, nCmdShow) */ int -Tcl_AppInit(interp) - Tcl_Interp *interp; /* Interpreter for application. */ +Tcl_AppInit( + Tcl_Interp *interp) /* Interpreter for application. */ { if (Tcl_Init(interp) == TCL_ERROR) { goto error; @@ -193,8 +188,7 @@ Tcl_AppInit(interp) if (Tktest_Init(interp) == TCL_ERROR) { goto error; } - Tcl_StaticPackage(interp, "Tktest", Tktest_Init, - (Tcl_PackageInitProc *) NULL); + Tcl_StaticPackage(interp, "Tktest", Tktest_Init, NULL); #endif /* TK_TEST */ Tcl_SetVar(interp, "tcl_rcFileName", "~/wishrc.tcl", TCL_GLOBAL_ONLY); @@ -205,7 +199,11 @@ error: MessageBox(NULL, Tcl_GetStringResult(interp), "Error in Wish", MB_ICONSTOP | MB_OK | MB_TASKMODAL | MB_SETFOREGROUND); ExitProcess(1); - /* we won't reach this, but we need the return */ + + /* + * We won't reach this, but we need the return. + */ + return TCL_ERROR; } @@ -226,11 +224,12 @@ error: */ void -WishPanic(CONST char *format, ...) +WishPanic( + CONST char *format, ...) { va_list argList; char buf[1024]; - + va_start(argList, format); vsprintf(buf, format, argList); @@ -252,8 +251,8 @@ WishPanic(CONST char *format, ...) * Main entry point from the console. * * Results: - * None: Tk_Main never returns here, so this procedure never - * returns either. + * None: Tk_Main never returns here, so this procedure never returns + * either. * * Side effects: * Whatever the applications does. @@ -261,21 +260,24 @@ WishPanic(CONST char *format, ...) *---------------------------------------------------------------------- */ -int main(int argc, char **argv) +int +main( + int argc, + char **argv) { Tcl_SetPanicProc(WishPanic); /* - * Set up the default locale to be standard "C" locale so parsing - * is performed correctly. + * Set up the default locale to be standard "C" locale so parsing is + * performed correctly. */ setlocale(LC_ALL, "C"); /* - * Create the console channels and install them as the standard - * channels. All I/O will be discarded until Tk_CreateConsoleWindow is - * called to attach the console to a text widget. + * Create the console channels and install them as the standard channels. + * All I/O will be discarded until Tk_CreateConsoleWindow is called to + * attach the console to a text widget. */ consoleRequired = FALSE; @@ -284,3 +286,11 @@ int main(int argc, char **argv) return 0; } #endif /* !__GNUC__ || TK_TEST */ + +/* + * Local Variables: + * mode: c + * c-basic-offset: 4 + * fill-column: 78 + * End: + */ |